ДЕРЖАВНА ФIСКАЛЬНА СЛУЖБА УКРАЇНИ
13.11.2018 | N 35177/7/99-99-19-03-02-17 |
---|
Митницям ДФС Департамент податкових та митних експертиз ДФС |
Про iнформацiю щодо Регламентiв ЄС з питань
класифiкацiї товарiв
Вiдповiдно до статтi 1 "Угоди про асоцiацiю мiж Україною, з однiєї сторони, та Європейським Союзом, Європейським спiвтовариством з атомної енергiї i їхнiми державами-членами, з iншої сторони" вiд 27 червня 2014 року основними цiлями асоцiацiї є запровадження умов для посилених економiчних та торговельних вiдносин, якi вестимуть до поступової iнтеграцiї України до внутрiшнього ринку ЄС, у тому числi шляхом поступової адаптацiї її законодавства до acquis ЄС.
Враховуючи викладене вище та вiдповiдно до статтi 68 Митного кодексу України з метою забезпечення органами доходiв i зборiв прийняття гармонiзованих рiшень щодо класифiкацiї та кодування товарiв в УКТ ЗЕД у складних випадках, надаємо до вiдома та використання у роботi iнформацiю щодо Регламентiв Європейського Союзу з питань класифiкацiї товарiв, яку актуалiзовано станом на 23.10.2018 (додається).
Iнформацiя надається в електронному виглядi мовою оригiналу (англiйською мовою).
Iнформуємо, що у разi потреби з повним текстом Регламентiв ЄС, а також з додатковою iнформацiєю та малюнками до товарiв, що зазначенi в Регламентах, можна ознайомитись на офiцiйному Веб-сайтi законодавства ЄС за посиланням: https://eur-lex.europa.eu/homepage.html. Для прискореного пошуку рекомендуємо застосовувати слова "...the classification of certain goods in the combined nomenclature...".
Листи ДФС вiд 24.07.2014 N 344/7/99-99-24-02-03-17 та вiд 14.05.2015 N 17158/7/99-99-25-04-01-17 вважати такими, що втратили чиннiсть.
Додаток: файл Commission Regulation_Регламенти ЄС_2018.docx.
В.о. заступника Голови | В. КРИВIЦЬКИЙ |
Додаток до листа ДФС України вiд 13.11.2018 N 35177/7/99-99-19-03-02-17 |
Про iнформацiю щодо Регламентiв ЄС з питань класифiкацiї товарiв
Commission Regulation (EEC)/(EC) No Регламенти ЄС N. |
Item Пункт |
Description of the goods Опис товару |
CN-code КН код |
731/93 of 26.3.1993 (OJ L 75, 30.3.1993, p. 7) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
Annelida (Polychaetes), commonly known as 'segmented worms', found in marine shoreline-habitats and sometimes known as 'marine worms', generally used as fishing-bait. | 0106 90 00 | |
1523/70 of 29.7.1970 (OJ L 167, 30.7.1970, p. 28) amended by Reg. 2723/90 |
Partially or totally de-frozen meat of domestic bovine animals. | 0202 | |
1669/77 of 25.7.1977 (OJ L 186, 26.7.1977, p. 23) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
Frozen raw poultry-meat, in particular turkey-meat, obtained by scraping poultry-bones from which the prime cuts have been removed or in any other way (for example, in the reduction of larger cuts to smaller size) and consisting of small irregularly-shaped pieces, sometimes with fibrous, gristly and fatty tissue attached thereto and individually weighing from 5 to 40 g approximately. | 0207 14 10 0207 27 10 0207 45 10 0207 55 10 0207 60 10 |
|
1125/2006 of 21.7.2006 (OJ L 200, 22.7.2006, p. 3) |
1 | Edible offal, dried pig ears, even when used as animal feed. | 0210 99 49 |
3491/88 of 9.11.1988 (OJ L 306, 11.11.1988, p. 18) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
1 | 'Flaps of herring', comprising the right and left sides of a herring [from which the head, guts, fins (other than the dorsal fin) and bones have been removed], the two sides being held together by the skin of the back. | 0304 99 23 |
1858/98 of 27.8.1998 (OJ L 241, 29.8.1998, p. 17) |
1 | Shark-cartilage powder, with the following characteristics: 95 % dry matter, 65 % ash and 22 % protein. | 0305 10 00 |
3482/89 of 20.11.1989 (OJ L 338, 22.11.1989, p. 9) |
1 | Right or left side of salted saithe, without the head, spinal column, fins or guts, with the skin and pin bones (epipleuralis), but without any other bones, known as 'standard fillets'. | 0305 32 90 |
3481/89 of 20.11.1989 (OJ L 338, 22.11.1989, p. 7) |
Lobster heads and lower parts thereof (soubassements) obtained by removing the upper shell and liver, blanched or boiled in water, put up frozen. These products are used in the preparation of bisques, sauces and crustacean butter. | 0306 12 90 | |
729/2013 of 25.7.2013 (OJ L 203, 30.7.2013, p.4) | Product consisting of green-lipped mussel powder (species Perna canalicula), fit for human consumption. It is presented in bags of 10 kg to 20 kg. | 0307 99 80 | |
2275/88 of 25.7.1988 (OJ L 200, 26.7.1988, p. 10) |
3 | Milk-product, consisting of a skimmed-milk powder containing 50-100 million live yoghurt-bacteria (Streptococcus thermophilus and Lactobacillus bulgaricus) per gram, with a fat-content not exceeding 3 %. | 0403 10 11 |
1160/98 of 2.6.1998 (OJ L 160, 4.6.1998, p. 20) |
1 | Milk-powder (0,6 % milk-fat), containing between 2 and 27 million live lactic bacilli (Streptococcus lactus) per gram. | 0403 90 11 |
1533/92 of 12.6.1992 (OJ L 162, 16.6.1992, p. 5) |
1 | Pale-yellow powder, with the taste of dried milk, containing by weight: 11,4 % milk-fat, 85,9 % low-fat milk-solids, 2,7 % water, 30,6 % proteins (N x 6,38), 42,9 % lactose and 17 % phospholipids (P x 26) (as percentage of fat-content. The product is traded with the name of 'sweet buttermilk-powder enriched with milk-fat'. | 0403 90 13 |
1160/98 of 2.6.1998 (OJ L 160, 4.6.1998, p. 20) |
2 | Mixture of lactose, caseins, albumins, globulins of milk, and milk-fat containing sporulated micro-organisms (Lactobacillus pentosus and Streptococcus lactus), in the form of a powder with the following characteristics by weight: 39 % lactose, 22 % caseins, 4 % albumin/globulin of milk, 6 % ash, 24 % milk-fat and 5 % water. | 0403 90 13 |
1160/98 of 2.6.1998 (OJ L 160, 4.6.1998, p. 20) |
3 | Product, consisting of milk-powder with added lactic ferments (Streptococcus lactus and Lactobacillus, approximately 150 million per gram) and dead lactic yeast (Kluveromyces lactis and Fragilis), with the following characteristics by weight: 28 % protein, 95-96 % dry matter, 25 % milk-fat and 39 % lactose. | 0403 90 13 |
2291/93 of 13.8.1993 (OJ L 206, 18.8.1993, p. 1) |
1 | Semi-liquid product with the flavour of yoghurt, made from fermented milk, with the addition of apricot-pulp, sugar, stabilisers and thickening-agents (modified starches, pectin and gelatine, totalling less than 1,8 % by weight, taken together), and with a milk-fat content of less than 3 % by weight. Microscopic examination shows Streptococcus thermophilus and Lactobacillus bulgaricus bacteria in a ratio of approximately 1: 1; these have been completely inactivated by ultra-heat-treatment. | 0403 90 91 |
3056/94 of 14.12.1994 (OJ L 323, 16.12.1994, p. 10) |
Modified whey, with: 13,3 % dry matter, 5,3 % lactose, 7,6 % lactic acid, 0,6 % crude protein (N x 6,38), traces of fat and no starch, saccharose, glucose or fructose. The product is mainly used to replace vinegar in the preparation of vinaigrettes, dressings, mayonnaise, etc. | 0404 10 48 | |
775/2011 of 2.8.2011 (OJ L 201, 4.8.2011, p. 8) |
1 | Bovine colostrum, in liquid form, defatted and de-caseinated, packaged for retail sale in a 125 ml bottle, having the following nutritional information per 100 ml: - Milk protein 2,5 to 5,5 g - Carbohydrates 3,3 g - Milk fat < 0,5 g The product is a yellow-brown, slightly cloudy liquid. It has a higher immunoglobulin content than natural whey or milk. According to the label the product is for human consumption and is to be taken once a day (1 to 2 tablespoons) on its own or with cold fruit juice. Its area of application is not indicated. | 0404 10 48 |
1160/98 of 2.6.1998 (OJ L 160, 4.6.1998, p. 20) |
4 | Mixture of milk-constituents, with added sodium chloride and sodium citrate (2 %) and vitamins (0,2 %), with the following characteristics by weight: 95 % dry matter, 56,5 % lactose, 28,8 % protein, 1,1 % milk-fat and 8 % ash. | 0404 90 21 |
1160/98 of 2.6.1998 (OJ L 160, 4.6.1998, p. 20) |
5 | Mixture of milk-constituents, with added sodium chloride and sodium citrate (4,5 %) and vitamins (0,2 %), with the following characteristics by weight: 96,2 % dry matter, 59,7 % lactose, 23,3 % protein, 0,9 % milk-fat and 11,5 % ash. | 0404 90 21 |
1887/2003 of 27.10.2003 (OJ L 277, 28.10.2003, p. 11) |
Skimmed-milk powder with added lactose, with the following composition (percentage by weight): 0,6 % milkfat, 33,5 % protein, 57 % lactose. | 0404 90 21 | |
775/2011 of 2.8.2011 (OJ L 201, 4.8.2011, p. 8) |
2 | Spray-dried, reduced-fat colostrum powder which has not been de-caseinated, packaged for retail sale as 64 g of powder in a plastic screw-top container with the following composition (% by weight): - Milk fat 1,2 - Milk protein at least 50 and typically 65,5 The product has a dry matter content of 93,3 % by weight. The product is a cream-coloured powder that tends to form lumps and has a milky odour. It has a higher immunoglobulin content than natural whey or milk. According to the label the product is for human consumption. | 0404 90 21 |
1264/98 of 17.6.1998 (OJ L 175, 19.6.1998, p. 4) |
1 | Powder, consisting by weight of 80 % whole-milk powder and 20 % lactoserum, with the following constituents (by weight): 5 % water, 21 % protein, 24 % milk-fat, 6 % ash, and 44 % lactose. | 0404 90 23 |
2291/93 of 13.8.1993 (OJ L 206, 18.8.1993, p. 1) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Brown-beige powder, obtained by roller-drying a mixture of milk, whey and sugar. The powder has individual brown grains, tends to form lumps, and is sweet with the taste of powdered milk and caramel. It has the following analysis by weight: 97,2 % drymatter, 23,5 % total fat (milk-fat), 20,4 % total protein-content (N x 6,38), 1,8 % sucrose, 44,6 % lactose, 17,1 % casein, with sweet whey (GMP) detectable. As a result of the high temperature in the manufacturing process, the sugars are caramelised and the proteins are partly degraded. | 0404 90 83 |
1264/98 of 17.6.1998 (OJ L 175, 19.6.1998, p. 4) |
2 | Powder, consisting by weight of 80 % milk-powder and 20 % other ingredients (8 % lactose, 11,8 % maltodextrin with a reducing-sugar content, expressed as dextrose on the dry substance, exceeding 10 % but less than 20 %, and minerals, lecithin and vitamins), with the following constituents (by weight): 41 % lactose, 21 % milk-fat, 21 % milk-protein, and 12 % maltodextrin. | 0404 90 83 |
286/97 of 17.2.1997 (OJ L 48, 19.2.1997, p. 3) |
Spreadable emulsion, of the water-in-oil type, containing milk-fat (61,2 % by weight), milk-protein and small pieces of garlic, parsley and other herbs. | 0405 20 30 | |
2510/97 of 15.12.1997 (OJ L 345, 16.12.1997, p. 45) |
1 | Yellowish spreadable emulsion consisting by weight of: 77,5 % butter, 7,7 % salt, 3,1 % sugar, 4,65 % potato-starch, 6,2 % parsley and 0,85 % other flavourings. The milk-fat content averages 60 to 62 % by weight. | 0405 20 30 |
725/2008 of 24.7.2008 (OJ L 198, 26.7.2008, p. 32) |
1 | Product consisting of (% by weight): Curd 32,4 Skimmed milk 32,9 Cream (33,5 % fat) 12,4 Sugar 4,5 also fruit preparation, whey product, stabiliser, yogurt cultures The fat content is 4,3 % by weight. The colour of the product is light red. The appearance of the substance is that of fresh cheese. Parts of the fruit preparation can be seen in the substance. The product is put up in containers holding 150 g. |
0406 10 20 |
725/2008 of 24.7.2008 (OJ L 198, 26.7.2008, p. 32) |
2 | Product consisting of (% by weight): Curd 41,7 Skimmed milk yogurt 29,7 Fruit preparation 20 Fructose syrup 5 Protein concentrate 2 Binder 0,9 Cream 0,7 The fat content is 0,4 % by weight. The product has two layers: the white substance containing the curd on top and the fruit preparation is underneath. The appearance of the substance on top is that of fresh cheese. The product is put up in containers holding 125 g. |
0406 10 20 |
1264/98 of 17.6.1998 (OJ L 175, 19.6.1998, p. 4) |
3 | Product, in the form of a block of irregular yellowish/greyish granules with a cheese-smell, frozen, with the following characteristics by weight: 60 % dry matter, 28 % milk-fat, 27 % protein, 3,5 % whey-protein, 1 % lactose, 3,3 % ash, and 0,7 % sodium chloride. | 0406 10 20 |
904/2007 of 27.7.2007 (OJ L 196, 28.7.2007, p. 37) |
'Pasta filata'-type cheese, in the form of a block, made by adding rennin and
thermophilic bacteria (e.g. Streptococcus thermophilus) to milk. The whey is separated
after curdling. The curd is then heated to about 80 °C. The curd is kneaded and stretched
to give it a stringy texture. The product is then divided into the requisite sizes (1 to 3
kg) and salted. The cheese is wrapped in ripening film and stored, after its manufacture, for one to two weeks at a low temperature (2 to 4 °C). The composition of the cheese is (% by weight): dry matter 54,2 total fat 23,3 fat-content in the dry matter 43,0 water-content in the fat-free matter 59,7 The cheese has a mild, buttery, slightly salty flavour. It is used, inter alia, as cheese for pizzas. |
0406 10 20 | |
316/91 of 7.2.1991 (OJ L 37, 9.2.1991, p. 25) |
1 | Grated cheese which becomes agglomerated, as a result of its high moisture-content and the conditions of transport or packaging (partially-vacuum-packed). | 0406 20 90 |
719/93 of 25.3.1993 (OJ L 74, 27.3.1993, p. 47) |
Emmentaler cheese, in irregularly-formed particles approximately 3 mm wide, less than 1 mm thick and of varying lengths, but generally exceeding 10 mm. | 0406 20 90 | |
710/2000 of 3.4.2000 (OJ L 84, 5.4.2000, p. 8) |
1 | Pale-yellow cheese of a cheddar-type, matured for approximately four weeks, with no holes, with the following characteristics by weight: 63 % dry matter, 51,2 % fat-content in the dry matter, 24 % protein on the product as it is, and 54,6 % water-content in the non-fatty matter. | 0406 90 21 |
874/2011 of 27.7.2011 (OJ L 227, 2.9.2011, p. 7) |
1 | Raw propolis presented in bulk in brown blocks of irregular form. The product consists essentially of the following components (% by weight): - vegetable resins and vegetable balsams 55 - waxes 30 - essential oils 8 to 10 - pollen 5 These materials collected by bees are transformed with the enzymes of their saliva. The product is used in the manufacture of pharmaceutical products and food supplements. | 0410 00 00 |
1125/2006 of 21.7.2006 (OJ L 200, 22.7.2006, p. 3) |
2 | Dried offal, pigs ears, unfit for human consumption. | 0511 99 85 |
902/2007 of 27. 7. 2007 (OJ L 196, 28. 7. 2007, p. 33) |
1 | Whole bulbs of garlic (Allium sativum) at a temperature between 0 °C and - 5 °C but not frozen throughout. | 0703 20 00 |
1196/97 of 27.6.1997 (OJ L 170, 28.6.1997, p. 13) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
2 | Mushrooms (of the genus Agaricus), provisionally preserved and immersed in liquid, with the following specifications: 0,1 % acetic acid by weight, 270 ppm sulphite and 19 % salt by weight. | 0711 51 00 |
765/2014 of 11.7.2014 (OJ L 209, 11.7.2014, p. 7) |
A mixture of frozen fruits consisting of (in % by weight): strawberries 55 bananas 20 pineapples 15 blueberries 10 The product is put up in bags containing the frozen fruits in pieces ready to be blended in a blender. | 0811 10 90 | |
214/96 of 2.2.1996 (OJ L 28, 6.2.1996, p. 7) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Vanilla pods, smelling slightly of vanilla and alcohol, cut into pieces, with a mean vanillin-content of 0,14 %, a sugar-content of 0,6 % by weight, and an alcoholic strength by mass of 8,6 % mas. The product, from which vanillin has been extracted by means of alcohol, is used in the food-processing industry, e.g. in the manufacture of ice-cream. | 0905 10 00 |
323/2008 of 8 .4.2008 (OJ L 98, 10.4.2008, p. 3) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
3 | Fabric tissue article, in the form of a belt and containing common wheat grains, that, after being heated by microwave, is used to relieve lower-back pain. | 1001 99 00 |
1395/93 of 4.6.1993 (OJ L 137, 8.6.1993, p. 7) |
Wholly-milled 'micronised' rice. The rice has undergone heat-treatment using infra-red radiation, during which the starch is not gelatinized. | 1006 30 92 1006 30 94 1006 30 96 1006 30 98 |
|
2275/88 of 25.7.1988 (OJ L 200, 26.7.1988, p. 10) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Grains of Zizania aquatica ('wild rice') not dehulled, resembling pine-needles, brown in colour. | 1008 90 00 |
2275/88 of 25.7.1988 (OJ L 200, 26.7.1988, p. 10) |
4 | Product, obtained by dry turbo-separation of wheat-flour and having the following characteristics by dry weight: starch-content 83 % using the modified Ewer's polarimetric method; ash-content 0,4 %; protein-content approximately 4,5 %. | 1101 00 11 or 1101 00 15 |
169/1999 of 25.1.1999 (OJ L 19, 26.1.1999, p. 6) |
2 | Mixed flours, for the preparation of multigrain bread, consisting by weight of 78,5 % common wheat flour, 7 % rye flour, 4 % oat flour, 4 % rice flour, 2 % barley flour, 1 % milled germ and 3,5 % wheat gluten. | 1101 00 15 |
169/1999 of 25.1.1999 (OJ L 19, 26.1.1999, p. 6) |
3 | Flour, for bread-making, consisting by weight of 99,85 % common wheat flour and 0,015 % salt, with very small quantities of amylase and antioxidant. | 1101 00 15 |
169/1999 of 25.1.1999 (OJ L 19, 26.1.1999, p. 6) |
1 | Mixed flours, for the preparation of rye-bread, consisting by weight of 50 % rye flour, 48,6 % wheat flour and 1,4 % wheat gluten. | 1101 00 90 |
2510/97 of 15.12.1997 (OJ L 345, 16.12.1997, p. 45) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Spelt wheat (Triticum spelta L.), from which the spelt (but not the pericarp) has been removed. | 1104 29 17 |
28/90 of 4.1.1990 (OJ L 3, 6.1.1990, p. 9) |
1 | Product, in the form of a fine white powder, consisting of a mixture of native wheat starch and small quantities of acetylated wheat starch or very-weakly acetylated wheat starch, and having the following characteristics: starch-content (determined by Ewer's method) of 95 % or more by weight on the dry product, and acetyl-content (determined by the enzymatic method) of less than 0,5 % by weight on the dry product. | 1108 11 00 |
28/90 of 4.1.1990 (OJ L 3, 6.1.1990, p. 9) |
2 | Product, in the form of a fine white powder, consisting of a mixture of native maize starch and small quantities of acetylated maize starch or very-weakly acetylated maize starch, and having the following characteristics: starch-content (determined by Ewer's method) of 95 % or more by weight on the dry product, and acetyl-content (determined by the enzymatic method) of less than 0,5 % by weight on the dry product. | 1108 12 00 |
28/90 of 4.1.1990 (OJ L 3, 6.1.1990, p. 9) |
3 | Product, in the form of a fine white powder, consisting of a mixture of native potato starch and small quantities of acetylated potato starch or very-weakly acetylated potato starch, and having the following characteristics: starch-content (determined by Ewer's method) of 95 % or more by weight on the dry product, and acetyl-content (determined by the enzymatic method) of less than 0,5 % by weight on the dry product. | 1108 13 00 |
28/90 of 4.1.1990 (OJ L 3, 6.1.1990, p. 9) |
4 | Product, in the form of a fine white powder, consisting of a mixture of native manioc starch and small quantities of acetylated manioc starch or very-weakly acetylated manioc starch, and having the following characteristics: starch-content (determined by Ewer's method) of 95 % or more by weight on the dry product, and acetyl-content (determined by the enzymatic method) of less than 0,5 % by weight on the dry product. | 1108 14 00 |
446/2009 of 14.5.2009 (OJ L 132, 29.5.2009, p. 3) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
White, shelled and skinned groundnuts (blanched peanuts). The shelled groundnuts are blanched by passing through a gas oven with four heating zones, where the kernels are steamed by being sprayed with 88-93 °C hot water vapour, before being passed through two cooling zones. The gradual increase in temperature of the kernels causes them to expand and thereby loosen the red skin from the kernel. The skin is subsequently removed by mechanical means. The groundnuts, which have not been treated beyond the removal of the skin, are presented in bulk or in 'big bags' of approximately 1 000 kg. | 1202 42 00 | |
2016/996 of 16.6.2016 (OJ L 164, 22.6.2016, p. 1) |
A product in powder form consisting of the dried leaves of the moringa tree (Moringa
oleifera). The product is used as an ingredient in foods (such as creams, sauces, salads, pizzas, meats, soups or spices) or separately to prepare teas or as a food supplement. |
1212 99 95 | |
901/2007 of 27.7.2007 (OJ L 196, 28.7.2007, p. 31) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
Product consisting of the cut, fermented and dried leaves and plant tips of the
rooibos plant (Aspalathus linearis), also known as 'Red Bush'. After harvesting, the green leaves and plant tips are cut into pieces of 2 to 5 mm in length. These are then bruised, fermented and dried. The product is mainly used to prepare infusions. |
1212 99 95 | |
2748/79 of 6.12.1979 (OJ L 311, 7.12.1979, p. 20) amended by Reg. 2723/90 |
Product composed of 62,1 % calcium carrageenate, 32,9 % dextrose and 5 % sucrose. | 1302 39 00 | |
327/2013 of 8.4.2013 (OJ L 102, 8.4.2013, p. 8) |
1 | A product presented in the form of rolls (18 mm x 200 mm), put up for retail sale in a box containing 10 rolls. Each roll weighs 28 g and consists of the following components (% by weight): - dried mugwort (Artemisia vulgaris) leaves 95 - other dried herbs (such as salvia) 5 The product is used for the treatment of patients: the rolls are lit and held close to the skin of the patient on specific acupuncture points and are burned to create deeply penetrating heat. | 1404 90 00 |
1858/98 of 27.8.1998 (OJ L 241, 29.8.1998, p. 17) |
3 | Mixture of rape oil (97 %) and rape-oil methyl ester (3 %). | 1518 00 99 |
1989/2004 of 19.11.2004 (OJ L 344, 20.11.2004, p. 5) |
1 | Cooked meat-preparation with the following composition by weight: 15 % liver, 5 % chopped pork, 2 %collar, 6 % kidney, 13 % lung, 7 % spleen, 20 % rind, 20 % fat with rind, 2 % other ingredients, and 10 % water. The preparation is put up in cans. | 1602 20 90 |
314/90 of 5.2.1990 (OJ L 35, 7.2.1990, p. 9) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
1 | Frozen blocks of fillet of chicken-breast, put up in a broth made from water, poultrymeat carcases, vegetables and broth-powder. The blocks weigh about 15 kg and contain approximately equal parts of fillet and broth. | 1602 32 30 |
2376/1999 of 9.11.1999 (OJ L 287, 10.11.1999, p. 4) |
Frozen food-preparation, in the form of a small ball of meat enclosed in pastry, open at the base, with part of a prawn protruding from the top. The dough is wrapped round a cooked mixture of chicken-meat, pieces of onion, seasoning and the rest of the prawn. The composition of the product is by weight: 48,2 % chicken-meat, 13,3 % prawn, 9,7 % onion and 28,8 % dough. It is ready for eating after cooking in fat or in oil. | 1602 32 30 | |
1533/92 of 12.6.1992 (OJ L 162, 16.6.1992, p. 5) |
2 | Cooked preparation of pig-meat, consisting of a pinkish-brown meat-mass containing pieces of meat (of a size up to 6 cm), pieces of fat and gelatine. The content of meat and fat exceeds 80 % by weight, as measured in accordance with Regulation (EEC) No 226/89. From the size and characteristics of the muscle-tissue, it is not possible to identify whether the pieces of meat come from hams, shoulders, loins or collars of domestic swine. The preparation is put up in cans of a net weight of less than 500 g. | 1602 49 19 |
3534/87 of 24.11.1987 (OJ L 336, 26.11.1987, p. 14) amended by Reg. 2723/90 + 936/1999 |
Deep-frozen skinless tuna-pieces ('tuna-loins') which have been precooked by both steam and water, particularly so as to facilitate the removal of the skin, and resulting in the proteins being partially coagulated. | 1604 14 16 | |
756/2011 of 27.7.2011 (OJ L 199, 2.8.2011, p. 35) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
A product composed of (% by weight): - raw fish (in pieces) of the genus Mullus 64 - raw shrimps 10 - raw vegetables 26 presented on a wooden stick. | 1604 19 97 | |
2015/2455 of 21.12.2015 (OJ L 339, 24.12.2014, p. 40) | A product composed of the meat of different crustaceans and molluscs (in % per
weight): - raw squid and cuttlefish entacles 25; - raw squid and cuttlefish strips strips 20; - raw squid rings 20; - cooked baby yellow clam 20; - blanched shrimps 15. The product is presented in frozen state (at a temperature of - 20 °C) in bags of 1 kg (net weight 800 grams). |
1605 54 00 | |
2015/1721 of 22.9.2015 (OJ L 252, 29.9.2015, p. 3) | Whole clams (Meretrix meretrix, Meretrix lyrata) in the shell, having undergone a heat
treatment, subsequently frozen, in tightly packed mesh bags, presented in 10 kg packages. During the heat treatment the clams are immersed in water at a temperature of between 98 °C and 100 °C for at least 7 minutes. During that immersion, the temperature of the inside of the clams reaches at least 90 °C for 90 seconds. The product is not suitable for immediate consumption. |
1605 56 00 | |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
11 | Product consisting of (% by weight) white sugar 97; liquorice extract 3. The product has the form of granular sugar and is put up for retail sale. | 1701 91 00 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
1 | Product consisting of (% by weight) sucrose 99,05; citric acid 0,95. | 1701 99 90 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
2 | Product consisting of (% by weight) sucrose 99,5; citric acid 0,5. | 1701 99 90 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
3 | Product consisting of (% by weight) sucrose 99,5; citric acid 0,4; ascorbic acid 0,1. | 1701 99 90 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
4 | Product consisting of (% by weight) sucrose 99,7; citric acid 0,2; ascorbic acid 0,1. | 1701 99 90 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
7 | Product consisting of (% by weight) sucrose 97,5; cocoa butter 2,5. This product consists of white, sweet, crystalline powder, resembling a commercial white sugar. | 1701 99 90 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
8 | Product consisting of (% by weight) sucrose 97,7; sodium chloride 2,3. The product is presented in a form of white, crystalline, sweet and slightly salty-tasting powder. It consists mainly of sucrose crystals with very sporadic discernible cube-shaped sodium chloride crystals. | 1701 99 90 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
10 | Product consisting of (% by weight) sucrose 95; lactose 5. | 1701 99 90 |
447/2009 of 27.5.2009 (OJ L 132, 29.5.2009, p. 5) |
Invert sugar syrup consisting of (% by weight): - sugar (expressed as sucrose): 66,5; - water: 31; - propylene glycol: 2,5. The product is used, inter alia, in the tobacco industry as a moistening substance and is presented in bulk. | 1702 90 95 | |
3513/92 of 3.12.1992 (OJ L 355, 5.12.1992, p. 12) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Colourless, transparent, sweetened invert-sugar syrup, with no detectable fruit-flavour, with the following characteristics, by weight: 67 % extract refr. 20° C, sucrose undetectable, 48 % glucose (dextrose) in the dry state, 48,8 % fructose in the dry state, less than 0,01 % ash, 0,11 % titratable acids (pH 7,0) as tartaric acid. The trade-description of the product is 'rectified grape-must concentrate'). | 1702 90 95 |
2694/95 of 21.11.1995 (OJ L 280, 23.11.1995, p. 13) |
Syrup, containing by weight: 51,3 % lactulose, 5,3 % lactose, 7,2 % galactose, 1,6 % tagatose and 0,1 % fructose. The syrup contains only the by-products from the synthesis of lactulose, as well as very small quantities of preservative. | 1702 90 95 | |
717/85 of 19.3.1985 (OJ L 78, 21.3.1985, p. 13) amended by Reg. 2723/90 |
Cough and throat-irritation pastilles, having the following composition by weight: 99,5 % sucrose, glucose and caramel, 0,007 % camphor, 0,207 % menthol, 0,069 % eucalyptol, 0,003 % Balsam Tolu, 0,069 % thymol and 0,138 % benzyl alcohol. | 1704 90 55 | |
1049/2006 of 10.7.2006 (OJ L 188, 11.7.2006, p. 5) |
1 | Product made up of two hollow hemispherical wafers joined together, filled with a milky cream that does not contain cocoa, and embedding an almond. The product has a white coating on the outside which consists of a preparation based on sugar, vegetable fat, skimmed milk and coconut milk, and is covered with grated coconut. The product has the shape of a ball with a diameter of approximately 2,5 cm. The baked wafer, which is not visible from the outside, is approximately 2 mm thick. | 1704 90 99 |
242/2006 of 10.2.2006 (OJ L 40, 11.2.2006, p. 7) |
Food preparation consisting of cocoa powder and sugar (% by weight): Sugar 99,5 to 99,7; Cocoa powder calculated on a totally defatted basis 0,2 to 0,4. The product is in the form of brownish crystals. It is used and sold as sugar. | 1806 10 90 | |
1264/98 of 17.6.1998 (OJ L 175, 19.6.1998, p. 4) |
4 | Food-preparation, in the form of a ball, capable of being consumed in a single mouthful, coated with gum arabic, mainly consisting of milk chocolate, sugar, rum, shredded coconut, cocoa-paste and cocoa-butter. | 1806 90 11 |
1049/2006 of 10.7.2006 (OJ L 188, 11.7.2006, p. 5) |
2 | Product made up of two hollow hemispherical wafers joined together, filled with a creamy nougat and nut centre containing cocoa, and a hazelnut. It is completely coated on the outside with chocolate and chopped hazelnuts. The product has the shape of a ball with a diameter of approximately 3 cm. The baked wafer, which is not visible from outside, is approximately 2 mm thick. | 1806 90 19 |
440/91 of 25.2.1991 (OJ L 52, 27.2.1991, p. 7) |
1 | Deep-frozen ready-mixed dough, made primarily from wheat flour to which has been added margarine, fat water, yeast and eggs, and which is filled with a paste made from marzipan, sugar, maize starch water and margarine. After thawing, the product in a given form is ready for baking. | 1901 20 00 |
169/1999 of 25.1.1999 (OJ L 19, 26.1.1999, p. 6) |
4 | Bread-making preparation based on flour, for making farmhouse loaf, consisting by weight of 88 % common wheat flour, 10 % rye flour, 1 % dried rye leaven and 1 % baker's yeast and emulsifier, with very small quantities of amylase and antioxidant. | 1901 20 00 |
161/2007 of 15.2.2007 (OJ L 51, 20.2.2007, p. 5) |
2 | Product with the following composition (percentage by weight): - yogurt (milkfat content 0,1 % by weight) 76 - aromatised aloe vera preparation 22 - sugar 2 The colour of the product is greenish-white. The consistency of the substance is that of a common yogurt. Parts of the aloe vera can be seen in the substance. The product is put up in containers holding 150 g. |
1901 90 91 |
973/2014 of 11.9.2014 (OJ L 274, 16.9.2014, p. 4) |
A product consisting of slightly glutinous and sticky translucent white pieces of approximately 1 cm in length and of approximately 3 mm in diameter. The product is floating in brine, has a gel-like consistency and has an appearance similar to glass noodles. It is put up for retail sale in packs containing 250 g (160 g drained net weight). The product is produced by mixing konjak tuber (Amorphophallus konjac) flour with water containing calcium hydroxide (proportions of the mixture in % by weight: konjak tuber flour 3-7, water 93-97). The mixture is then boiled and the resultant gel is pressed through a mould to give the product its final shape. | 1901 90 91 | |
440/91 of 25.2.1991 (OJ L 52, 27.2.1991, p. 7) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Product, in the form of a powder, consisting of sodium caseinate (30 %), skimmed milk (69 %) and hydrolysed vegetable oil (1 %), and containing by weight: 50,5 % proteins, 34,6 % lactose, 7,4 % cendre cheese, 1,5 % milk fats, 1 % hydrolysed vegetable oil and 5 % moisture. | 1901 90 99 |
635/2005 of 26.4.2005 (OJ L 106, 27.4.2005, p. 10) Sis punktas panaikintas reglamentu 2015/183, 2.2.2015 (OJ L 31, 7.2.2015) |
1 | Product, consisting of approximately 80 g of dried, pre-cooked wheat-flour noodles and a sachet of approximately 11 g of spices, put up for retail sale in a 250-ml expanded-polystyrene bowl. According to the instructions printed on the wrapping, up to 200 ml of boiling water are to be added, with the spices, to the bowl of noodles. After three minutes, the noodles are ready for consumption. | |
767/2014 of 11.7.2014 (OJ L 209, 11.7.2014, p. 13) |
A product consisting of a block of dried pre- cooked noodles (approximately 65 g), a sachet of seasoning (approximately 3,4 g), a sachet of edible oil (approximately 2 g) and a sachet of dried vegetables (approximately 0,8 g). The product is presented as a set (packaged together) put up for retail sale for the preparation of a noodle dish. According to the instructions printed on the packaging, boiling water has to be added before consumption. | 1902 30 10 | |
443/2013 of 7.5.2013 (OJ L 130, 15.5.2013, p. 17) |
1 | A product presented as small bites in the form of an arch, flavoured with cheese and composed of maize meal, vegetable oil, cheese powder (yeast extract, colorants), milk powder, salt, starch and dextrose. The product is produced from dried, crushed maize (maize meal), which is moistened with water (6 % to 9 %). The water is added as a process agent. The mixture is forwarded into the extrusion machine under high pressure and heat. When the paste meets the atmospheric pressure it expands. The extrusion process takes place at a temperature of 150 °C. After the extrusion the product is dried and slightly roasted at a temperature of 120-130 °C in an electrical drier. Then it is forwarded into a coating tumbler where it is coated with a mix of oil and dry goods. The product is put up for retail sale in packings with a net weight of 34 g to 450 g. | 1904 10 10 |
1021/2003 of 13.6.2003 (OJ L 147, 14.6.2003, p. 12) |
Product in the form of discs (approximately 4,5 cm in diameter and approximately 1 cm thick), made of puffed rice, with one face being covered with a thin layer of dark-brown icing of a thickness not exceeding 0,5 mm and containing less than 0,4 % of cocoa. In addition, the product contains sugar, vegetable fat, skimmed and half-skimmed milk powder, whey powder, carob powder, soya-bean lecithin, a colouring agent and a flavouring agent. It is put up for retail sale. | 1904 10 30 | |
359/2008 of 18.4.2008 (OJ L 111, 23.4.2008, p. 7) |
Food preparation in the form of roasted cereal products. Wheat grains are steamed,
shelled, chopped and cooled. The product is then pressed into thin strands, folded into
lattice shapes and cut into pillow shapes. The product is then roasted. Vitamins and
sometimes frosting are applied to the final product. The preparation is marketed as a
cereal-based breakfast food Skrudintu javu produktu pavidalo maisto gaminys. |
1904 10 90 | |
55/2003 of 13.1.2003 (OJ L 8, 14.1.2003, p. 3) |
1 | Ready-made meal, consisting of the following two individually packed components, put up in a set for retail sale: (a) pre-cooked rice (150 g), and (b) curry (200 g) consisting of coconut milk (72 %), chicken meat (20 %), a mixture of spices (7 %), lemon grass (0,5 %) and anchovy extract (0,5 %). | 1904 90 10 |
55/2003 of 13.1.2003 (OJ L 8, 14.1.2003, p. 3) |
2 | Ready-made meal, consisting of the following two individually packed components, put up in a set for retail sale: (a) pre-cooked rice (150 g), and (b) curry (200 g) consisting of coconut milk (65 %), chicken meat (14 %), a mixture of spices (13,2 %), aubergines (3 %), basil (2,5 %) and anchovy extract (2,3 %). | 1904 90 10 |
55/2003 of 13.1.2003 (OJ L 8, 14.1.2003, p. 3) |
3 | Ready-made meal, consisting of the following two individually packed components, put up in a set for retail sale: (a) pre-cooked rice (150 g), and (b) curry (200 g) consisting of coconut milk (65,4 %), chicken meat (15,5 %), potatoes (10 %), a mixture of spices (7,1 %) and anchovy extract (2 %). | 1904 90 10 |
55/2003 of 13.1.2003 (OJ L 8, 14.1.2003, p. 3) |
4 | Ready-made meal, consisting of the following two individually packed components, put up in a set for retail sale: (a) pre-cooked rice (150 g), and (b) curry (200 g) consisting of coconut milk (50 %), beef (20 %), potatoes (15 %), a mixture of spices (7 %), groundnuts (3 %), anchovy extract (3 %) and onions (2 %). | 1904 90 10 |
447/2011 of 6.5.2011 (OJ L 122, 11.5.2011, p. 63) |
Tinned stuffed vine leaves ready for consumption. The product is made of a mixture of rice, onion, soya oil, salt, citric acid, black pepper, mint and dill, wrapped in vine leaves. The composition (percentage by weight): - Rice: around 50, - Vine leaves: around 15, - Onion: around 9, - Other ingredients: oil, salt, spices and water. | 1904 90 10 | |
1196/97 of 27.6.1997 (OJ L 170, 28.6.1997, p. 13) |
1 | Food-preparation, in the form of dry translucent sheets of different sizes, made from rice-flour, salt and water. After being steeped in water to make them pliable, these sheets are generally used to make the wrappers for 'spring-rolls' and similar products. | 1905 90 20 |
710/2000 of 3.4.2000 (OJ L 84, 5.4.2000, p. 8) |
3 | Prawn-crackers, in the form of hard translucent discs, partially cooked by steaming and oven-dried, made from starch, water, salt, sugar (approximately 4 %) and shrimp-meat (approximately 5 %), and containing flavour-enhancers. The product is ready for consumption only after being fried in oil or fat. | 1905 90 60 |
218/2003 of 4.2.2003 (OJ L 29, 5.2.2003, p. 5) |
Frozen, translucent sheets of dough (e.g., 20 x 20 cm), made from wheat flour, water, vegetable oil and salt and having undergone a heat-treatment at 90 °C for 15 seconds. The product contains by weight 52,5 % of starch/glucose and less than 4 % of sugar. These sheets are used directly, after thawing, for the preparation of spring rolls which are then further cooked before consumption. | 1905 90 90 | |
1694/2001 of 24.8.2001 (OJ L 229, 25.8.2001, p. 3) |
1 | Preparation, consisting of pulped tomatoes and tomato-juice, containing seeds, skins and fibrous material of tomatoes. The preparation, which has a dry-matter content of 7 % by weight, is obtained by the crushing and extruding of tomatoes, followed by heat-sterilisation. It is put up in hermetically-sealed tins with a net content of 2500 g. | 2002 90 11 |
964/91 of 18.4.1991 (OJ L 100, 20.4.1991, p. 14) valid from 1.8.1991 1.5.1992 amended by Reg. 2293/91, 3411/91 + 705/2005 |
2 | Mushrooms of the genus Agaricus, completely simmered. The mushrooms are immersed in water to which salt and/or citric acid and/or SO2 may have been added, and then chilled. These mushrooms are not put up in packs for retail sale and are generally used as a starting material in the canning industry. | 2003 10 20 |
306/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 44, 15.2.2001, p. 25) |
1 | Mushrooms (of the genus Agaricus), fully cooked (irreversible inhibition of the polyphenol oxydase activity), preserved in brine (15 to 25 % salt by weight) with added vinegar or acetic acid, with a free volatile acid content of 0,5 % by weight, expressed as acetic acid. | 2003 10 30 |
710/2000 of 3.4.2000 (OJ L 84, 5.4.2000, p. 8) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
4 | Cucumbers which have undergone complete lactic fermentation, immersed in brine. The brine contains by weight 8,4 % salt and 1 % lactic acid. The cucumbers are used for the preparation of products known as 'pickles'. | 2005 99 80 |
627/2003 of 4.4.2003 (OJ L 90, 8.4.2003, p. 34) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Preparation (hummus), consisting of chickpea puree (81 % by weight), water, oil, sesame, spices, citric acid, salt and preservatives. This preparation is put up in packings (e.g., 250 g) for retail sale. | 2005 99 80 |
377/2007 of 29.03. 2007 (OJ L 94, 4.4.2007, p.20) |
1 | Hazelnut preparation consisting of a mixture of hazelnuts and sugar, presented in the
form of grains (% by weight) (*), Hazelnut kernels 40 Added sugar 60 Hazelnuts kernels are roasted at 140 °C for 20 to 25 minutes. Sugar is roasted separately at the same temperature for 15 to 17 minutes. Roasted hazelnuts and sugar are then mixed and roasted together for 12 to 15 minutes. The preparation is then cooled and chopped into a particle size of 1 to 4 mm. It is then packed in bags of at least 10 kg for wholesale. This preparation is an intermediate product not intended for immediate consumption but used in the manufacture of chocolates, ice-cream, confectionery and pastry. |
2008 19 19 |
377/2007 29.3.2007 (OJ L 94, 4.4.2007, p. 20) |
2 | Hazelnut preparation consisting of a mixture of hazelnuts and sugar, presented in the
form of powder (% by weight), Hazelnut kernels 40 Added sugar 60 Hazelnuts kernels are roasted at 140 °C for 20 to 25 minutes. Sugar is roasted separately at the same temperature for 15 to 17 minutes. Roasted hazelnuts and sugar are then mixed and roasted together for 12 to 15 minutes. The preparation is then cooled and chopped into a particle size of 1 to 4 mm before being ground to a size of 20 to 30 microns. It is then packed in bags of at least 12,5 kg for wholesale. This preparation is an intermediate product not intended for immediate consumption but used in the manufacture of chocolates, ice-cream, confectionery and pastry. |
2008 19 19 |
377/2007 29.03. 2007 (OJ L 94, 4.4.2007, p.20) |
3 | Hazelnut preparation consisting of a mixture of hazelnuts and sugar, presented in the
form of paste (% by weight), Hazelnut kernels 40 Added sugar 60 Hazelnuts kernels are roasted at 140 °C for 20 to 25 minutes. Sugar is roasted separately at the same temperature for 15 to 17 minutes. Roasted hazelnuts and sugar are then mixed and roasted together for 12 to 15 minutes. The preparation is then cooled and chopped into a particle size of 1 to 4 mm before being ground to a size of 20 to 30 microns. The ground preparation is mixed until it reaches the form of a homogeneous paste. It is then packed in bags of at least 20 kg for wholesale. This preparation is an intermediate product not intended for immediate consumption but used in the manufacture of chocolates, ice-cream, confectionery and pastry. |
2008 19 19 |
1709/74 of 2.7.1974 (OJ L 180, 3.7.1974, p. 15) amended by Reg. 2723/90 |
Cherries, put up in a mixture of water and ethyl alcohol, suitable for immediate consumption. | 2008 60 11 to 2008 60 39 |
|
627/2003 of 4.4.2003 (OJ L 90, 8.4.2003, p. 34) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
2 | Dried dates filled with an almond paste. The filling consists of a paste prepared from almonds, sucrose, glucose and vanilla flavouring with a sugar content of 63 % by weight. The product is put up for retail sale in packings of 250 g. | 2008 99 67 |
1967/2005 of 1.12.2005 (OJ L 316, 2.12.2005, p. 7) |
4 | Green coloured crushed avocado pulp (guacamole), with the following composition (% by
weight): avocado 90,5; other ingredients (e.g. salt, spices, citric acid, antioxidant, stabiliser, preservative) less than 1; the content of various sugars according to Additional Note 2 (a) to Chapter 20 9,6. The product is put up in packing of a net content not exceeding 1 kg. |
2008 99 67 |
306/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 44, 15.2.2001, p. 25) |
2 | Product, known as 'lemon tea', in the form of a powder, for the preparation of tea, with the following composition by weight: 90,1 % sugar, 2,5 % tea-extract, and small quantities of maltodextrin, citric acid, lemon-flavouring and an anti-caking agent. The product is intended to be mixed with water and consumed as a beverage. | 2101 20 92 |
306/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 44, 15.2.2001, p. 25) |
3 | Liquid product, for the preparation of tea, with the following composition by weight: 58,1 % sugar (94 % calculated on the dry matter), 38,8 % water, 2,2 % tea-extract, and 0,9 % trisodium citrate. The product is intended to be mixed with water and consumed as a beverage. | 2101 20 92 |
1385/83 of 27.5.1983 (OJ L 141, 1.6.1983, p. 43) amended by Reg. 2723/90 |
Product, consisting of non-germinated barley-grains, husked, roasted and usable in the production of beer as a colouring- and flavouring-agent, or as a coffee-substitute. | 2101 30 19 | |
2510/97 of 15.12.1997 (OJ L 345, 16.12.1997, p. 45) |
3 | Yeast (Saccharomyces cerevisiae), rendered 95 % inactive by drying. The product is of a kind generally used in animal-fodder. | 2102 20 19 |
314/90 of 5.2.1990 (OJ L 35, 7.2.1990, p. 9) |
3 | Preparation in the form of a powder, for the manufacture of a sauce for a noodle-dish simply by adding milk or water. Composition by weight: 48 % of powdered cheese, 20 % powdered whey, 8 % various seasonings and kitchen herbs, 6 % powdered buttermilk, 6 % modified starch, 4 % powdered cream, 4 % wheat flour, 4 % various flavourings, including cooking salt. | 2103 90 90 |
1510/96 of 26.7.1996 (OJ L 189, 30.7.1996, p. 89) |
2 | Food-preparation, in the form of a powder, consisting by weight of: 30-35 % powdered whey, 20-25 % powdered cheese, 15-18 % salt, 8-10 % onion and garlic, 8-10 % powdered buttermilk, 3-4 % lactic acid and citric acid, <1 % parsley, <0,5 % extract of paprika, <0,5 % spice, <0,25 % soyabean oil and <0,5 % silicon dioxide. This product is used as seasoning in the manufacture of snack-foods. | 2103 90 90 |
724/2008 of 24.7.2008 (OJ L 198, 26.7.2008, p. 30) |
Liquid product made up as a pepper sauce, prepared from pods of pepper, which is mixed with salt and is fermented over three years. After fermentation, vinegar is added. The product is available in different varieties, e.g. as a green-pepper sauce. | 2103 90 90 | |
442/2013 of 7.5.2013 (OJ L 130, 15.5.2013, p. 15) |
1 | Homogeneous, non-grainy, soft paste with a spicy smell and a predominately salty, spicy flavour ('Shiro miso'). The product consists of (% by weight): - soya beans 43; - rice 43; - salt 12; - water 2. The paste is obtained by fermentation (Koji mould) of a mixture of steamed soya beans and steamed rice. Different flavours develop during the fermentation and the product is used as an ingredient in traditional Japanese dishes. | 2103 90 90 |
2015/185 of 30.1.2015 (OJ L 31, 7.2.2015, p.7) |
A red, viscous product containing strawberries (whole fruits and pieces thereof),
consisting of (% by weight): - strawberries 38, - sugar 48, - water 13, and small quantities of pectin and citric acid. During the production process the ingredients are mixed and boiled under reduced pressure to reduce the water content. The product is presented in a 2 kg plastic bag and is used as a sauce e.g. for desserts. |
2103 90 90 | |
2017/960 of 02.06.2017 (OJ L 145, 8.6.2017, p.4) |
A product in the form of a brownish, turbid extract of vanilla beans (which contains
water and 35 % vol. alcohol as solvents), to which 5 % by weight of sugar has been added. The product has an intense vanilla flavour and a distinctive taste of alcohol and sugar. It is put up for retail sale in 100 ml bottles and is used to improve the taste of dishes. |
2103 90 90 | |
2016/933 of 8.6.2016 (OJ L 155, 14.6.2016, p.11) |
A product in the form of a yellow powder with a scent of banana, consisting of: - enzymatically hydrolysed whey protein isolate (90 % by weight expressed in proteins), - soy lecithin (emulsifier), - natural banana flavour, - E 104 (colouring agent), and - sucralose (sweetening agent). The product is put up for retail sale in a plastic container with a net content of 1,8 kg. The product is intended to be mixed with beverages. According to the label, one measuring spoon (30 g) has to be mixed with around 3 dl of water or milk. |
2106 90 92 | |
223/2005 of 10.2.2005 (OJ L 39, 11.2.2005, p. 18) |
Red, syrupy liquid, tasting of red fruit, of a Brix value of 67, and with the following composition per 1 000 litres: 426,7 l of water, 794,0 kg of saccharose, 80,0 kg of citric acid, 12,0 kg of red-fruit flavouring, 4,6 kg of sodium cyclamate, 3,5 kg of acesulfame K, 1,0 kg of sodium benzoate, 2,0 kg of ascorbic acid, 7,0 kg of trisodium citrate, and colouring agents. The preparation has an alcohol content of 1,3 %vol, and is ready for drinking after dilution with water. | 2106 90 20 | |
1836/1999 of 24.8.1999 (OJ L 224, 25.8.1999, p. 6) |
1 | Preparation, in the form of a solution composed by weight of about 84 % water, 15,6 % sugar, 0,4 % citric acid and 0,01 % flavouring. It has a limited shelf-life and is put up in bulk. | 2106 90 59 |
1989/2004 of 19.11.2004 (OJ L 344, 20.11.2004, p. 5) |
2(1) | Product consisting of a sugar solution and small quantities of other ingredients, with the following composition by weight: 31,5 % sugar, 28,5 % glucose syrup, 5 % citric acid, 2,5 % malic acid, 0,2 % xanthan gum, 0,05 % sodium benzoate, 0,03 % acesulfame potassium, 0,009 % aspartame, 0,5 % flavouring, 0,002 % colouring, and water. The product is put up for retail sale, in a small plastic bottle (of height 6 cm and diameter 2 cm), and is intended for immediate consumption, without further dilution with water. | 2106 90 59 |
1989/2004 of 19.11.2004 (OJ L 344, 20.11.2004, p. 5) |
2(2) | Product consisting of a sugar solution and small quantities of other ingredients, with the following composition by weight: 34 % sugar, 5 % citric acid, 3 % malic acid, 0,05 % fumaric acid, 0,07 % sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, 0,016 % potassium sorbate, 0,01 % sodium benzoate, 0,03 % acesulfame potassium, 0,01 % aspartame, 0,5 % flavouring, 0,002 % colouring, and water. The product is put up for retail sale, as a spray, in a small plastic bottle (of height 10 cm and diameter 1,5 cm), and is intended for immediate consumption, without further dilution with water. | 2106 90 59 |
497/2011 of 18.5.2011 (OJ L 134, 21.5.2011, p. 11) |
1 | Syrupy flavoured liquid with the following composition (percentage by weight): Water 65,13; Cane sugar 28,47; Lime juice 3,18; Citric acid 1,49; Lemon juice 1,18 ; Flavouring 0,46; Colourings 0,0003; Excipients. After dilution with water or alcohol the preparation is ready to drink as a cocktail. |
2106 90 59 |
3149/81 of 30.10.1981 (OJ L 314, 4.11.1981, p. 5) amended by Reg. 2695/95 |
Product consisting of D-glucitol (sorbitol) containing one part per thousand of added 1,2-benzisothiazol-3-one 1,1-dioxide (saccharin). | 2106 90 92 | |
3565/88 of 16.11.1988 (OJ L 311, 17.11.1988, p. 25) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
1 | Chewing-gum consisting of nicotine bound to an ion-exchange resin (2 mg of nicotine per tablet), of glycerine, of a synthetic polymer, of sodium carbonate, sodium hydrogencarbonate, D-glucitol (sorbitol) and flavouring to simulate, in particular, the taste of tobacco-smoke, for use by persons wishing to give up smoking. | 2106 90 92 |
2061/89 of 7.7.1989 (OJ L 196, 12.7.1989, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Preparation in the form of tablets, put up in packings for retail sale, with instructions on dosage and composition to counter deficiency resulting from food lacking in proteins. Composition per 100 g of the preparation: 4,2 g each - L-histidine, L-isoleucine, L-leucine, L-lysine, L-methionine, L-phenylalanine, L-threonine, L-tryptophan, L-valine; 2,8 g each - L-cystine, L-glycine, L-cysteine, L-tyrosine, L-taurine, L-arginine, L-ornithine, L-glutamine; 1,4 g each - L-alanine, L-aspartic acid, L-glutamic acid, L-citruline, L-serine, L-proline, L-glutathion, L-carnitine; ad 100 g - cellulose, stearic acid, magnesium stearate, silicon dioxide and food-glaze containing protein. | 2106 90 92 |
2061/89 of 7.7.1989 (OJ L 196, 12.7.1989, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Preparation in the form of tablets, put up in packings for retail sale, with instructions on dosage and composition to counter, in particular, deficiency resulting from growth in children. Composition per 100 g of the preparation: glycine (36,2 g), L-ornithine (27,2 g), L-tryptophan (9,1 g), niacinamide (2,2 g), vitamin B6 (0,8 g), and cellulose, stearic acid, magnesium stearate, silicon dioxide, and food-glaze containing protein (ad 100 g). | 2106 90 92 |
2061/89 of 7.7.1989 (OJ L 196, 12.7.1989, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
3 | Preparation in the form of tablets, put up in packings for retail sale, with instructions on dosage and composition to counter deficiency resulting from menstruation in women. Composition per 100 g of the preparation: oil of evening primrose (11,4 g), vitamin B6 (6,8 g), magnesium oxide (5,7 g), calcium carbonate (2,9 g), herbal mixture (2,4 g), potassium gluconate (2,3 g), folic acid (0,009 g), and cellulose, stearic acid, magnesium stearate, silicon dioxide, and food-glaze containing protein (ad 100 g). | 2106 90 92 |
2061/89 of 7.7.1989 (OJ L 196, 12.7.1989, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
4 | Preparation in the form of tablets, put up in packings for retail sale, with instructions on dosage and composition to ensure a balance of substances contained in the hair. Each tablet of approximately 2 g contains: biotin (500 mg), L-cysteine (150 mg), choline bitartrate (125 mg), inositol (62,5 mg), vitamin B12 (12,5 mg), folic acid (400 mg), ascorbic acid (150 mg), manganese gluconate (5 mg), p-aminobenzoic acid (37,5 mg), niacinamide (15 mg), pantothenic acid (50 mg), vitamin B6 (37,5 mg), zincgluconate (15 mg), ferrous gluconate (10 mg), iodine (75 mg), copper gluconate (1 mg) and millet extract (200 mg), in a base containing beta-carotene, aloe vera, amino acids, cellulose, stearic acid and food-glaze containing protein. | 2106 90 92 |
1422/90 of 23.5.1990 (OJ L 137, 30.5.1990, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Preparation in the form of gelatin capsules, not put up for retail sale. Each capsule contains: sardine oil (500 mg), garlic powder (60 mg), beeswax (24 mg), vegetable emulsifier (11 mg) and antioxidant (5 mg). | 2106 90 92 |
1422/90 of 23.5.1990 (OJ L 137, 30.5.1990, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Preparation in the form of tablets, put up for retail sale with instructions on
composition and directions for use. Each tablet contains: - powdered papaya leaves (152,5 mg), - papain (17,5 mg) and - adjuvants (80 mg). The product contains 4 % sucrose (including invert sugar). |
2106 90 92 |
1422/90 of 23.5.1990 (OJ L 137, 30.5.1990, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
3 | Preparation in the form of gelatin capsules, containing an extract of garlic in vegetable oil, packed for retail sale with information on composition and directions for use. | 2106 90 92 |
440/91 of 25.2.1991 (OJ L 52, 27.2.1991, p. 7) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
3 | Preparation, in the form of gelatine capsules packed for retail sale. Each capsule contains 1 222 mg lecithin and 28 mg glycerine. | 2106 90 92 |
1486/93 of 16.6.1993 (OJ L 147, 18.6.1993, p. 8) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
Sterilised food-preparation, in the form of a milky-white, opaque liquid tasting and smelling of coconut, made by milling and squeezing coconut-pulp combined with water, and with the following analysis by weight: 79,6 % water, 3,3 % sucrose, 16,6 % total fat-content, 0,1 % fibre and 0,4 % ash. The product is sold as 'coconut-milk' in a 400-ml can, generally for culinary purposes, in the preparation of desserts, sauces, etc. | 2106 90 92 | |
2696/95 of 21.11.1995 (OJ L 280, 23.11.1995, p. 17) |
1 | Food-preparation, composed of: 55,9 % water, 23,5 % monoglycerides of fatty acids, 7,3 % propylene glycol, 5,9 % polyglycerol esters, 3,5 % sorbitol, 2,6 % soap, 1,1 % diglycerides of fatty acids, and 0,1 % potassium propionate. The product is an emulsifier used in the manufacture of various types of baker's wares. | 2106 90 92 |
214/96 of 2.2.1996 (OJ L 28, 6.2.1996, p. 7) |
2 | Preparation, in the form of effervescent tablets, put up for retail sale with information on dosage and composition, used as a tonic. Each tablet (2 g) contains 1 g arginine aspartate and 1 g excipients (citric acid, sodium bicarbonate, sodium carbonate, sodium dihydrogen citrate, saccharin sodium, orange yellow (E 110), colloidal silica, flavouring). | 2106 90 92 |
1858/98 of 27.8.1998 (OJ L 241, 29.8.1998, p. 17) |
4 | Oval rust-coloured gelatine capsules filled with a pasty, ochre-coloured substance. Each capsule contains 38 mg aqueous millet-extract, 32 mg oily millet-extract, 178,5 mg wheat-germ oil, 1 mg L-cystine, and 5 mg calcium pantothenate as well as soya lecithin, wax, magnesium oxide, glycerine, gelatine and sorbitol. | 2106 90 92 |
169/1999 of 25.1.1999 (OJ L 19, 26.1.1999, p. 6) |
5 | Tablets weighing 550 mg, containing 200 mg calcium ascorbate (salt of vitamin C), 342 mg excipient consisting of dicalcium phosphate, microcrystalline cellulose, cross-linked sodium carboxymethylcellulose and stearic acid, and 8 mg magnesium stearate as an anti-caking agent. | 2106 90 92 |
1380/2002 of 29.7.2002 (OJ L 200, 30.7.2002, p. 12) |
1 | Liquid product consisting of lemon juice, added citric acid (7,6 % by total weight) and preservatives, put up for retail sale in a plastic bottle (e.g., 100 ml) with a nozzle. The nozzle holds lemon essential oils. The product is used to impart a tart taste to foods or beverages. | 2106 90 92 |
635/2005 of 26.4.2005 (OJ L 106, 27.4.2005, p. 10) |
2 | Diuretic tea-bags put up for retail sale. The label gives the following information: Each bag of 1,8 g contains the medicinal ingredients: 0,47 g of horsetail, 0,45 g of birch leaves, 0,38 g of golden rod, and 0,20 g of spiny restharrow root, as well as the other ingredients: rose-hip husks, cornflower leaves, peppermint leaves, marigold blossom and liquorice root; Dosage and mode of application: pour approximately 150 ml of boiling water over a tea bag in a cup; cover and leave to brew for about fifteen minutes, then remove the tea bag; unless otherwise prescribed, drink three or four cups per day, between meals; Applications: to increase urinary flow, in the case of cystitis, so as to prevent the formation of stones. | 2106 90 92 |
1139/2005 of 15.7.2005 (OJ L 185, 16.7.2005, p. 8) |
Nonwoven sheet, measuring approximately 0,60 x 0,96 m and coated on one side with a mixture of aromatic herbs (rosemary 30 %, oregano 15 %, sage 15 %, basil 20 %, thyme 20 %). The sheet is for placing into the cooking dish prior to the preparation of pate or ham, etc., for cooking. The preparation takes on the flavours of the aromatic herbs, during cooking. The nonwoven sheet does not serve as the final wrapping of the cooked preparation. | 2106 90 92 | |
438/2007 of 20.4.2007 (OJ L 104, 21.4.2007, p. 18) |
Preparation in the form of gelatine capsules. Each capsule contains: - coenzyme Q10: 30 mg - soya oil: 178 mg - soya lecithin: 6,3 mg - coconut oil: 15,1 mg - beeswax: 15,1 mg - palm oil: 45,5 mg |
2106 90 92 | |
349/2009 of 24.4.2009 (OJ L 106, 28.4.2009, p. 5) |
Product in powdered form consisting of (% by weight): - L-ascorbic acid (vitamin C): 97; - hydroxypropylmethylcellulose: 3. The addition of hydroxypropylmethylcellulose is not necessary for the preservation or transport of vitamin C. The product is suitable for a specific use (manufacture of vitamin tablets) rather than for general use. | 2106 90 92 | |
380/2010 of 30.4.2010 (OJ L 112, 5.5.2010, p. 4) |
Tablets of 1 772 mg, put up for retail sale, one tablet consisting of (% by weight): - Calcium carbonate (corresponding to 630 mg calcium) 88,9 - Starch 3,5 - Hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose 2,7 - Crospovidone 1,9 - Maltodextrin 1,3 - Mineral oil 1,2 Additionally one tablet has a content of 7 mg = 284 IU (international units) vitamin D3 (cholecalciferol). Other substances are present in quantities less than 1,0 % by weight. The recommended daily dose indicated on the label is one tablet per day. According to the information on the label the product is used as a preventive treatment for example against osteoporosis and for reinforcement of the bones. | 2106 90 92 | |
897/2011 of 2.9.2011 (OJ L 231, 8.9.2011, p. 9) |
1 | Product put up for retail sale in a bottle of 500 ml, containing (% by weight): - water 45,9 - fructose 33,3 - oligofructose 7,6 - apple juice concentrate 3,6 - blackcurrant juice concentrate 2,3 - vegetable oligopeptides 2,3 - citric acid 3,6 - mate concentrate 0,7 - food yeast 0,5 - L-carnitine 0,1 - potassium sorbate 0,1 The product is a reddish brown, cloudy, slightly viscose liquid with a density of 1,1812 g/cm 3 and a Brix value of 40. According to the packaging the product is based on water enriched with nutrients, which is destined to be integrated into the diet. Instructions for use: 50 ml of the product diluted with 100 ml of water or juice. | 2106 90 92 |
749/2012 of 14. 8. 2012 (OJ L 222, 18. 8. 2012, p. 1) |
A product (so-called 'Chitosan') prepared from crustacean shells, consisting of amino polysaccharides. The product is presented in gelatine capsules, put up for retail sale. According to the label the product is presented as a food supplement for human consumption. | 2106 90 92 | |
750/2012 of 14. 8. 2012 (OJ L 222, 18. 8. 2012, p. 3) |
A product (so-called 'Propolis') presented in gelatine capsules, put up for retail sale. The content of each capsule consists of the following components (% by weight): - vegetable resins and vegetable waxes 55 - waxes 30 - essential oils 8 to 10 - pollen 5 Those components are materials collected by bees and are transformed with the enzymes of their saliva. According to the label the product is presented as a food supplement for human consumption. | 2106 90 92 | |
328/2013 of 8.4.2013 (OJ L 102, 8.4.2013, p. 10) |
1 | Product in powder form consisting of (% by weight): - calcium carbonate 97, - starch 3. The product is suitable for use in several different areas, e.g. human foodstuffs, medicaments and paint fillers. The product is suitable for use in the manufacturing of calcium tablets. | 2106 90 92 |
198/2014 of 28.2.2014 (OJ L 62, 4.3.2014, p. 4) |
A product presented in tablets, put up for retail sale in a plastic box containing 30 tablets. The content of each tablet consists of the following components: - bromelain (500 mg), - cellulose, - calcium phosphate, - silica, - magnesium stearate. According to the label the product is presented as a food supplement for human consumption. | 2106 90 92 | |
764/2014 of 11.7.2014 (OJ L 209, 11.7.2014, p. 5) |
A product presented as colourless capsules filled with a yellowish powder, put up for retail sale in a labelled, small plastic bottle with screw top, containing 60 capsules. Each capsule contains the following components: - glucosamine hydrochloride (300 mg), - chondroitin sulphate, - methyl sulfonyl methane, - small quantities of esters of ascorbic acid (vitamin C). According to the label the product is presented as a food supplement for human consumption. The recommended daily dose indicated on the label is three capsules. | 2106 90 92 | |
2015/1799 of 5.10.2015 (OJ L 263 of 8.10.2015, p.14) | A product in the form of powder, put up for retail sale in a plastic box containing
300 g. The recommended daily dose (10 g) consists of (in milligrams): - amino-acids (blend of arginine and citrulline) 5200; - vitamin C (as ascorbic acid) 500; - L-taurine 300; - vitamin E (as D-alpha-tocopheryl acetate) 90; - alpha-lipoic acid 10; - folic acid 0,4; - lemon balm 50; - calcium (as CaCO3) 66. The product also contains small amounts of citric acid, sucralose and silicon dioxide. According to the label, the product is a dietary supplement for human consumption which provides help in taking care of the body and offering a lifetime of well-being. The recommended daily dose indicated is 10 g (2 scoops). |
2106 90 92 | |
2017/268 of 14.2.2017 (OJ L 40 of 17.2.2017, p.1) |
A product consisting of white tablets composed of the following: - steviol glycosides, - sodium carbonate, - sodium citrate, - leucine. 200 tablets (each of 56 mg) put up for retail sale in a pocket dispenser. The product has a caloric value of 0,06 kcal per tablet. |
2106 90 92 | |
3931/88 of 16.12.1988 (OJ L 348, 17.12.1988, p. 15) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Preparation in the form of tablets (weighing 100 mg per tablet), put up in retail packages with instructions on dosage and used to counter calcium-deficiency, having the following homeopathic composition: lactose 79 mg, silica D-6 2,5 mg, calcium phosphate D-6 0,5 mg, calcium carbonate D-4 0,5 mg, sodium phosphate D-6 0,5 mg, urtica D-1 10 mg, starch 5 mg and magnesium stearate 2 mg. | 2106 90 98 |
3482/89 of 20.11.1989 (OJ L 338, 22.11.1989, p. 9) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Food-preparation containing 99,2 % sucrose, 0,6 % aspartame and 0,2 % acesulphame K. The product is put up in small cubes and is used as a diet sweetener | 2106 90 98 |
1422/90 of 23.5.1990 (OJ L 137, 30.5.1990, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
4 | Preparation in the form of tablets, not put up for retail sale. Each tablet contains: - garlic powder (270 mg), - whey powder (216,5 mg), - brewer's yeast (27 mg), - alginic acid (22 mg), - kelp (seaweed) (9 mg) and - magnesium stearate (5,5 mg). The product contains more than 2,5 % by weight of milk-protein. |
2106 90 98 |
1422/90 of 23.5.1990 (OJ L 137, 30.5.1990, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
5 | Preparation in the form of tablets, put up for retail sale with information on
composition and directions for use. Each tablet contains: madder (Radix rubia) powder (200
mg) and adjuvants (50 mg). The product contains 14 % sucrose (including invert sugar). Preparatas tableciu pavidalu, skirtas mazmeninei prekybai, su sudeties aprasymu ir vartojimo nurodymais. Kiekvienoje tableteje yra dazines raudes (Radix Rubia) milteliu 200 mg ir pagalbiniu medziagu 50 mg. Produkte yra daugiau kaip 14 % sacharozes (iskaitant invertuota cukru). |
2106 90 98 |
2399/91 of 6.8.1991 (OJ L 220, 8.8.1991, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Preparation, in powder form, for the manufacture of confectionery, composed by weight of: 84,4 % dehydrated egg-white (total protein-content: 69,1 %), 14,6 % maltodextrin (expressed in starch: 9,3 %) and 1 % gelatine. | 2106 90 98 |
1533/92 of 12.6.1992 (OJ L 162, 16.6.1992, p. 5) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
3 | Food-preparation, in the form of a water-in-milk-fat emulsion, consisting of: 38,5 % milk-fats, 52,4 % water, 5 % sodium caseinate, 2 % gelatine, 1,5 % salt and 0,6 % emulsifiers. The product resembles butter in consistency, colour, appearance and taste, and is used as a low-fat spread. | 2106 90 98 |
1637/94 of 5.7.1994 (OJ L 172, 7.7.1994, p. 3) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
Preparation, in the form of a syrupy liquid tasting and smelling of oranges, containing about 58 % by weight of sugar and having an essential-oil content of 0,25 ml/100 g of product. When diluted with water, the product may be consumed as a beverage. | 2106 90 98 | |
287/97 of 17.2.1997 (OJ L 48, 19.2.1997, p. 5) |
1 | Food-preparation, of the following composition by weight: 74 % milk-fat, 5 % whole-egg powder, 4 % wine vinegar, 1,5 % salt and 15,5 % water. The product, presented in the chilled state, takes the form of a pale yellow, oily block. | 2106 90 98 |
287/97 of 17.2.1997 (OJ L 48, 19.2.1997, p. 5) |
2 | Spreadable fat, consisting by weight of 70 to 80 % milk-fat and 20 to 30 % vegetable-fat, generally put up for retail sale in 500-g packets. The product may be obtained by mixing butter (heading 0405) and vegetable-fat (Chapter 15), or by mixing cream (heading 0401) and vegetable-fat (Chapter 15) and churning after mixing. | 2106 90 98 |
1196/97 of 27.6.1997 (OJ L 170, 28.6.1997, p. 13) |
5 | Food-preparation, in the form of a powder, consisting by weight of: 55,3 % powdered cheese, 38,7 % powdered whey, 4 % lactose and 2 % salt. | 2106 90 98 |
1196/97 of 27.6.1997 (OJ L 170, 28.6.1997, p. 13) |
6 | Food-preparation, in the form of a powder, consisting by weight of: 46-56 % powdered cheddar cheese, 16-21 % powdered whey, 16-21 % powdered buttermilk, 6-9 % salt and 2-5 % disodium phosphate. | 2106 90 98 |
1264/98 of 17.6.1998 (OJ L 175, 19.6.1998, p. 4) |
5 | Food-supplement, in capsules containing 70 % maltodextrin, 3 % magnesium stearate and 0,5 % ascorbic acid, with added lactic ferments (Bifidobacterium breve and B. longum, Lactobacillus acidophilus and L. rhamnosus, approximately 1 billion per gram). | 2106 90 98 |
1836/1999 of 24.8.1999 (OJ L 224, 25.8.1999, p. 6) |
2 | Preparation, in the form of a solution composed by weight of about 84 % water, 16 % sugar and 0,2 % citric acid. It has a limited shelf-life and is put up in bulk. | 2106 90 98 |
1380/2002 of 29.7.2002 (OJ L 200, 30.7.2002, p. 12) |
2 | Oily spreadable paste with the following composition (percentage by weight): 23,3 % water, 17,7 % tomato puree, 15,4 % cheese, 11,3 % salami, 9,6 % tomato powder, 6 % butter, 3,6 % yogurt, 2,8 % garlic preparation, 2,4 % sweet whey powder, 2,3 % cooking salt, 1,3 % capers, 1,2 % olive oil, and small quantities of emulsifying salts, sugar, pepper, oregano, parsley, flavouring, lecithin and potassium sorbate. The preparation is an intermediate product used in the food industry. | 2106 90 98 |
627/2003 of 4.4.2003 (OJ L 90, 8.4.2003, p. 34) |
3 | Viscous preparation with a brix value of 69 and with the following composition
(percentage by weight): - glucose syrup 32,2 - condensed milk 26,6 - sugar 18,0 - water 12,4 - cream 4,2 - brown sugar 3,2 - milk 1,1 - butter 1,1 and small quantities of salt, thickening agents, preservatives, anti-foaming agents and flavours. The product is used in the manufacture of ice-cream and provides a marbled/rippled appearance and imparts a caramel taste. It is put up in packings of 20 kg. |
2106 90 98 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
5 | Preparation consisting of (% by weight) sucrose 90; cocoa butter 10. This preparation is a light-coloured, yellow-tinged, very sweet, coarse powder with a cocoa butter taste. | 2106 90 98 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
6 | Preparation consisting of (% by weight) sucrose 95; cocoa butter 5. This preparation consists of white, sweet, sticky crystals with a slight cocoa taste. | 2106 90 98 |
227/2006 of 9.2.2006 (OJ L 39, 10.2.2006, p. 3) |
9 | Preparation consisting of (% by weight) white sugar 90; wheat flour 10. | 2106 90 98 |
903/2007 of 27.7.2007 (OJ L 196, 28.7.2007, p. 35) |
Flat sheets measuring 32 mm x 21 mm, with the following ingredients (% by weight): sodium alginate 24-32 maltodextrin 20-28 flavouring 5-15 water 5-15 carrageenan 5-15 microcrystalline cellulose 4-10 glycerine 4-10 lecithin, aspartame, sodium saccharin, acesulfame K, neohesperidine DC, colour E102 and colour E133. The product is marketed as 'breath-freshening strips' which are dissolved on the tongue. |
2106 90 98 | |
42/2010 of 15.1.2010 (OJ L 12, 19.1.2010, p. 2) 715/2012 of 30. 7. 2012 (OJ L 210, 7. 8. 2012, p. 4) |
Product consisting of (% by weight): - barley grass, powdered 28,8 - honey 27,5 - wheatgrass, powdered 21,5 - alfalfa, powdered 21,5 - stearic acid 0,4 - pepper 0,25 - chromium picolinate 0,01 (corresponds to 8,7 mg Cr per tablet) The product is presented for retail sale, in tablet form and used as a food supplement (one tablet twice a day). | 2106 90 98 | |
497/2011 of 18.5.2011 (OJ L 134, 21.5.2011, p. 11) |
2 | Syrupy flavoured liquid with the following composition (percentage by weight): - Water 51,27; - Cane sugar 28,40; - Raspberry juice 10,60; - Raspberry puree 8,20; - Flavouring 0,18; - Colourings 0,02; - Excipients. After dilution with water or alcohol the preparation is ready to drink as a cocktail. |
2106 90 98 |
826/2011 of 12.8.2011 (OJ L 211, 18.8.2011, p. 7) |
1 | Tablets in different colours and shapes of animals with an average weight of ca. 950
mg each, put up for retail sale, one tablet consisting of (% by weight): - sucrose 61 - starch 2,4. Additionally one tablet has a content of: - vitamin A (50 % as retinol acetate: 375 mg and 50 % as beta carotene: 2 252 mg) - vitamin B1 1,05 mg - vitamin B2 1,2 mg - vitamin B3 13,5 mg - vitamin B6 1,05 mg - vitamin B9 300 mg - vitamin B12 4,5 mg - vitamin C 60 mg - vitamin D 10 mg - vitamin E 10 mg. Furthermore the following substances are present: stearic acid, maleic acid, magnesium stearate, sodium bisulfite, gluten, cotton-seed oil, silicon dioxide, citric acid, gelatine, calcium carbonate, mono- and diglycerides, natural and artificial fragrances, and food colouring agents. The recommended daily dose indicated on the label is one tablet per day. According to the label the product is for human consumption. |
2106 90 98 |
455/2012 of 22. 5. 2012 (OJ L 141, 31. 5. 2012, p. 5) |
A product with the following composition (% by weight): - part skimmed mozzarella cheese 45 - coating 55 consisting of: - flour (wheat and rice) 25-30 - water 20-25 - whole dried egg < 2 - medium fat hard cheese < 2 - salt < 2 - spices/flavourings < 2 - inulin < 2 - thickener (E 464) < 2 - oat fibres < 2 - sunflower oil < 2 The product consists of a block or strips of cheese which are coated in several steps, before being packed and frozen. It contains herbs and spices and has not been cooked or pre-baked. The product is presented in a frozen state, generally sealed in plastic bags and/or cardboard cartons. Prior to consumption it is deep fried in oil and is to be consumed as a hot snack. | 2106 90 98 | |
727/2012 of 6. 8. 2012 (OJ L 213, 10. 8. 2012, p. 5) |
Cultures of micro-organisms presented in gelatine capsules, put up for retail sale. The content of each capsule consists of the following components (% by weight): - L. rhamnosus 3,36 - L. acidophilus 3,36 - L. plantarum 0,84 - B. lactis 0,84 - Maltodextrine 50,6 - Micro-crystalline cellulose 10 - Corn starch 30 - Magnesium stearate 1 According to the label the product is presented as a food supplement for human consumption. | 2106 90 98 | |
1127/2012 of 26.11.2012 (OJ L 331, 1.12.2012, p. 13) |
1 | Fine light tan, spray dried powder in a stable and protected microencapsulated form with the following composition (% by weight): refined tuna fish oil 48 sodium caseinate 24 dextrose monohydrate 10 modified starch 10 sodium ascorbate 5 water 3 and containing traces of natural tocopherols, lecithin, d1-alpha tocopherol and ascorbyl palmitate. The product is used to increase the level of Omega-3 fatty acids in food preparations. | 2106 90 98 |
387/2013 of .23.4.2013 (OJ L 117, 27.4.2013, p. 14) |
1 | A product presented in gelatine capsules, put up for retail sale. Each capsule
contains the following ingredients: - powdered bark of cat's claw (Uncaria tomentosa) 500 mg; - ascorbyl palmitate 57 mg; - microcrystalline cellulose 79 mg; - rice flour 17 mg; - silica 32 mg. The product contains approximately 17 % by weight, of starch/glucose. According to the label the product is presented as a food supplement for human consumption. |
2106 90 98 |
1224/2003 of 9.7.2003 (OJ L 172, 10.7.2003, p. 4) |
1 | Non-alcoholic beverage consisting of carbonated water, sucrose, glucose, citric acid, taurine (0,4 %), glucuronolactone (0,24 %), caffeine (0,03 %), inositol, vitamins, flavouring and colouring. It is presented as an energy drink, in cans holding 250 ml. | 2202 10 00 |
184/89 of 25.1.1989 (OJ L 23, 27.1.1989, p. 19) |
Liquid preparation containing sodium caseinate and calcium caseinate, soya protein, soya lecithin, maize oil, soya oil, medium-chain triglycerides, maltodextrins, minerals, vitamins and water, capable also of being administered by enteral tube. | 2202 90 10 | |
3513/92 of 3.12.1992 (OJ L 355, 5.12.1992, p. 12) |
3 | Carrot-juice which has been subject to lactic fermentation, ready for consumption as a beverage. | 2202 90 10 |
1232/2013 of 28.11.2013 (OJ L 322, 3.12.2013, p. 15) |
1 | A non-alcoholic beverage ready for immediate consumption consisting of (% by weight): Peach puree 31 Carrot juice concentrate 28 Apple juice concentrate 12 Pear puree 7 Pineapple juice concentrate 7 Grape juice concentrate 4 Pear juice concentrate 3 and orange pulp, acerola cherry puree concentrate, apple fibre and lemon juice concentrate. The ingredients of this product are pasteurised and filled in small containers (100 ml) for retail sale. | 2202 90 10 |
306/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 44, 15.2.2001, p. 25) |
4 | Liquid fermented product, with the following composition by weight: 81 % water, 15 % sucrose, 1,5 % lactose, 1,2 % protein, 0,6 % lactic acid, 0,4 % dextrose, 0,1 % total fat, and small quantities of flavourings. The product is put up in a 65-ml bottle and is used directly as a beverage. | 2202 90 91 |
161/2007 of 15.02.2007 (OJ L 51, 20.02.2007, p5) | 1 | A liquid product based on fermented milk products with added vegetable sterols and
fruit flavour obtained from a fruit preparation. The composition (percentage by weight) is
as follows: - sucrose/glucose syrup 12,2 - lactose 2,5 - protein 2,6 - fat 2,2 - vegetable sterols (stanol esters) 3 - milk fat content less than 0,2 - moisture content 76,9 and small quantities of vitamins and aroma preparations (flavourings). The product is available in different flavours (for example, strawberry or orange). The fruit preparation consists of a fruit juice that is obtained from a fruit juice concentrate to which a stabiliser (pectin) is added. The product, put up in a 65-ml bottle, is intended for direct consumption as a beverage. |
2202 90 91 |
766/2013 of 7.8.2013 (OJ L 214, 9.8.2013, p. 3) |
Liquid product based on fermented milk products with added fruit and cereal flakes,
consisting of (% by weight): - yoghurt (milk fat content 1,9% by weight) 78,9; - sugar 8,4; - water 7,4; - peach 4,3; - wheat flakes 0,6; - rye flakes 0,3; and small quantities of aroma preparations (flavourings), carotene (colouring agent) and microorganisms used in food products. The product, put up in a plastic bottle containing 400 g, is intended for direct consumption as a beverage. |
2202 90 95 | |
1967/2005 of 1.12.2005 (OJ L 316, 2.12.2005, p. 7) |
1 | Product consisting of a clear, slightly foaming liquid of yellow to amber colour. It has an alcoholic strength of 5,9 % by volume. It is obtained from the fermentation of a wort of 15,3 degrees Plato. The fermented solution is submitted to clarification and filtration. To that solution 3,34 % sugar syrup, 0,14 % aromatic components (of which 75 % stem from Tequila), 0,11 % citric acid and 0,002 % ascorbic acid are added. The product has the smell and taste of beer. The product is intended for direct consumption. It is presented as beer in bottles containing 330 ml/0,33 l, which are labelled accordingly. | 2203 00 01 |
600/2006 of 18.4.2006 (OJ L 106, 19.4.2006, p. 5) |
1 | Product consisting of a dark red, non-foaming liquid, without sediment. It has an
actual alcoholic strength of approximately 16 % by volume of which, according to
laboratory analysis, at least half does not derive from grape. The product is obtained
from grape must to which beet sugar and ethyl alcohol, derived from maize are added,
during the fermentation. Values of parameters: - total content of sugars: 169,7 g/l, - citric acid: 1,4 g/l, - tartaric acid: 1,4 g/l, - malic acid: 0,2 g/, - acetic acid: 0,3 g/l. The taste of the product is sweet, slightly acerbic, tart, aromatic, and slightly spicy. The product is intended for direct consumption as a beverage. It is presented in bottles containing 0,75 l. |
2206 00 59 |
1676/89 of 13.6.1989 (OJ L 164, 15.6.1989, p. 7) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
Glass bottle containing 0,7 l of rice-wine (sake), a small porcelain jug and three small drinking bowls (also of porcelain), put up together in a box. | sake: 2206 00 59 porcelain: 6911 10 00 |
|
1160/98 of 2.6.1998 (OJ L 160, 4.6.1998, p. 20) |
6 | Undenatured ethyl alcohol, of an alcoholic strength by volume of 80 % or more and containing up to 20 % activated carbon. | 2207 10 00 |
142/2002 of 25.1.2002 (OJ L 24, 26.1.2002, p. 14) |
1 | Blend, consisting of ethyl alcohol (88,5 %), ethyl acetate (5 %), and water. Ethyl acetate, which has been added to the blend, is regarded as a denaturant.. | 2207 20 00 |
142/2002 of 25.1.2002 (OJ L 24, 26.1.2002, p. 14) |
2 | Blend, consisting of ethyl alcohol (approximately 90 %), ethyl acetate (approximately 5 %), and aldehydes, higher alcohols and water. Ethyl acetate, which has been added to the blend, is regarded as a denaturant. | 2207 20 00 |
334/2008 of 11.4.2008 (OJ L 102, 12.4.2008, p. 20) |
Product having the following composition (by weight): - over 90 % ethyl alcohol; - less than 7,4 % water; - 1,3 % ethylene glycol; and - 1,3 % butanone. The product is packed in bottles of 1 and 3 litres and in containers of about 100 litres. According to the packaging, the product can be used directly, or it can be diluted with water for uses such as anti-freeze fluid or de-icing fluid |
2207 20 00 | |
211/2012 of 12.3.2012 (OJ L 73, 13.3.2012, p. 1) amended by Reg 2017/2157 of 16.11.2017 (OJ L 304, 21.11.2017, p. 21) |
A product of the following composition (% by weight): - ethyl alcohol 70 - gasoline (automotive petrol) conforming to EN 228 30 The product is used as raw material to produce fuels for motor vehicles. It is transported in bulk. |
2207 20 00 | |
70/2013 of 23.1.2013 (OJ L 26, 26.1.2013, p. 5) |
1 | The product has the following composition (% by weight): - ethyl alcohol 90 - ethyl tertiary butyl ether (ETBE) 10 The product is transported in bulk. |
2207 20 00 |
1405/2013 of 20.12.2013 (OJ L 349, 21.12.2013, p. 91) |
1 | A product with the following composition: - 90,0 to 99,9 % by weight of ethyl alcohol (anti-freeze agent); - Additives (denaturation agents): - 20 mg/litre pure alcohol of denatonium benzoate, - 5 ml/litre pure alcohol of isopropyl alcohol, and - either 5 ml/litre pure alcohol of butyl alcohol or 10 ml/litre pure alcohol of methyl ethyl ketone; - 1 g/litre pure alcohol of surface active agent. The addition of denatonium benzoate, isopropyl alcohol, and butyl alcohol or methyl ethyl ketone renders the product unfit for human consumption. The product is transported in tanks or cisterns. No packaging is available for retail sale. According to the accompanying documents, the product is a concentrate for the production of anti-freezing fluid. |
2207 20 00 |
1114/2006 of 20.7.2006 (OJ L 199, 21.7.2006, p. 3) |
1 | Liquid product based on arnica tincture (ratio arnica/extract 1:10), put up for retail sale in a bottle of 50 ml volume and with an alcoholic strength by volume of 45 %. According to the packaging the product is intended for human consumption for uses other than liquor production. Recommended dosage: 30 to 50 drops, diluted in half a glass of water, 2 to 3 times a day. | 2208 90 69 |
1114/2006 of 20.7.2006 (OJ L 199, 21.7.2006, p. 3) |
2 | Liquid product put up for retail sale in a bottle of 30 ml volume, with an alcoholic
strength by volume of 68 %, containing: - plantain (Plantago lanceolata) leaves, thyme (Thymus vulgaris) and helichrysum (Helichrysum italicum) flowers 2,1 g - dry extract of propolis 84 mg - freeze-dried extract of grindelia (Grindelia robusta) 45mg - eucalyptus (Eucalyptus globulus) essential oil 10,5 mg - Scotch pine (Pinus sylvestris) essential oil 10,5 mg - alcohol - water. According to the packaging the product could be used to improve respiration and is intended for human consumption. Recommended dosage: 25 drops, diluted in a little water, 3 times a day. |
2208 90 69 |
1114/2006 of 20.7.2006 (OJ L 199, 21.7.2006, p. 3) |
3 | Liquid product put up for retail sale in a bottle of 30 ml volume, with an alcoholic
strength by volume of 70 %, containing: - propolis (min 38 mg/ml total flavonoids expressed as galangin) 16 % by weight - alcohol - water. According to the packaging the product could be used to enhance the throat's natural defences and is intended for human consumption. Recommended dosage: 40 to 60 drops per day in a teaspoon of sugar or honey. |
2208 90 69 |
1114/2006 of 20.7.2006 (OJ L 199, 21.7.2006, p. 3) |
4 | Liquid product put up for retail sale in a bottle of 30 ml volume, with an alcoholic
strength by volume of 70 %, containing: - hydroalcoholic extract of propolis (standardized with native dry extract of propolis 0,6 g - alcohol - water. According to the packaging the product is intended for human consumption in a recommended dosage of 25 drops once or twice a day, diluted in half a glass of water. It can also be used as a mouthwash, by diluting 25 drops in water as desired. |
2208 90 69 |
1114/2006 of 20.7.2006 (OJ L 199, 21.7.2006, p. 3) |
5 | Liquid product based on glycerine macerate of blackcurrant (Ribes nigrum) buds (ratio drug/ extract 1:20), put up for retail sale in a bottle of 100 ml volume, with an alcoholic strength by volume of 38 %. According to the packaging the product is intended for human consumption for uses other than liquor production. Recommended dosage: 50 to 150 drops, diluted in a little water, per day. | 2208 90 69 |
160/2007 of 15.02.2007 (OJ L 51, 20.02.2007, p4) | Product consisting of a clear, dark brown liquid with an aromatic, herb-like smell and
a bitter, herbal taste. It has an actual alcoholic strength of 43 % by volume. The product consists of a mixture of 32 kinds of medicinal herb extracts with caramel extract, water and alcohol (96 % alcohol by volume). The following ingredients, among others, are used for the manufacture of this product: - Zedoary (Radix Zedoariae), - Manna (Manna), - Angelica root (Radix Angelicae), - Carline root (Radix Carlinae), - Myrrha (Myrrha), - Camphor (Camphora), - Saffron (Flos Croci). According to the packaging it is recommended to take the product in small quantities (a spoonful per morning and evening, dilution with water, tea or juice possible but not mandatory). The product, put up in a 500-ml bottle, is directly consumable as a beverage. |
2208 90 69 | |
1271/2011 of 5.12.2011 (OJ L 325, 8.12.2011, p. 1) |
The product is a beige powder consisting of (% by weight): Food/dietary fibre 66,1 (thereof crude fibre 15,2) proteins 18,8 moisture 7,5 ash 2,3 fat 0,2 The product is a solid vegetable residue obtained from soybeans after the extraction of the oil and partial removal of the proteins, followed by drying and grinding. The product has the characteristics of non-textured flour. The product is a by-product of the production of soya protein concentrates and isolates and has as a result a reduced content of proteins. The product is used for the fortification of food preparations and animal feeding products. The product is presented in bags of 25 kg. |
2304 00 00 | |
444/2013 of 7.5.2013 (OJ L 130, 15.5.2013, p. 19) |
1 | The product is a yellow to yellow-brown powder consisting of (% by weight): proteins 62,5 starch/glucose 7 moisture 9 crude fibre 3,9 crude fat 1,1 crude ash 6 The product is obtained from defatted soya beans after the extraction of the oil, further extracted with water and ethanol to remove soluble carbohydrates and minerals. The product is unsuitable for human consumption and used for animal feeding. | 2309 90 31 |
509/92 of 28.2.1992 (OJ L 55, 29.2.1992, p. 80) |
1 | Product, consisting of a mixture of residues from the manufacture of starch from maize (approximately 40 %), residues from the extraction of oil from maize-germ by the wet-method (approximately 30 %) and residues from the distillation of alcohol from maize ('corn-distillers') (approximately 30 %), containing by weight on the dry matter: 18 % starch (determined in accordance with the method in Annex I.1 to Commission Directive 72/199/EEC); 28 % proteins (N x 6,25) (determined in accordance with the method in Annex I.2 to Commission Directive 72/199/EEC); 4,4 % fats (determined in accordance with method A in Annex I to Commission Directive 84/4/EEC). It is used in animal fodder. | 2309 90 41 |
3802/92 of 23.12.1992 (OJ L 384, 30.12.1992, p. 13) |
Preparation, of a kind used in animal-fodder, consisting of a mixture of malt-sprouts, barley-screenings before the malting-process (possibly containing other seeds) and barley-cleanings after the malting-process, containing more than 10 % but not more than 30 % by weight of starch. | 2309 90 41 | |
3044/90 of 22.10.1990 (OJ L 292, 24.10.1990, p. 5) |
2 | Product consisting of a mixture of milled whole maize and of residues from the
extraction of oil by compression of maize-germ obtained by dry-processing. The mixture
contains by weight on the dry product: - 44,9 % starch, - 4,9 % fats and - 16,8 % proteins (nitrogen-content x 6,25). Starch- and protein-content determined using methods set out in Commision Directive 72/199/EEC of 27.4.1972, Annex I(1) and (2) (OJ L 123, 29.5.1972, p. 6). Fat- and moisture-content determined using methods set out in Commission Directive 71/393/EEC of 18.11.1971, Annex: Section 4 (method A) and Section 1, respectively (OJ L 279, 20.12.1971, p. 7). |
2309 90 51 |
3044/90 of 22.10.1990 (OJ L 292, 24.10.1990, p. 5) |
3 | Product consisting of a mixture of milled whole maize and of residues from the
extraction of oil by compression of maize-germ obtained by wet-processing. The mixture
contains by weight on the dry product: - 42,7 % starch, - 4,9 % fats and - 13,5 % proteins (nitrogen-content x 6,25). Starch- and protein-content determined using methods set out in Commission Directive 72/199/EEC of 27.4.1972, Annex I(1) and (2) (OJ L 123, 29.5.1972, p. 6). Fat- and moisture-content determined using methods set out in Commission Directive 71/393/EEC of 18.11.1971, Annex: Section 4 (method A) and Section 1, respectively (OJ L 279, 20.12.1971, p. 7). |
2309 90 51 |
3044/90 of 22.10.1990 (OJ L 292, 24.10.1990, p. 5) |
4 | Product consisting of a mixture of maize husk and of residues from the extraction of
oil by solvents of maize-germ obtained by dry-processing. The mixture contains by weight
on the dry product: - 44,8 % starch, - 4,2 % fats and - 13,4 % proteins (nitrogen-content x 6,25). Starch- and protein-content determined using methods set out in Commision Directive 72/199/EEC of 27.4.1972, Annex I(1) and (2) (OJ L 123, 29.5.1972, p. 6). Fat- and moisture-content determined using methods set out in Commission Directive 71/393/EEC of 18.11.1971, Annex: Section 4 (method A) and Section 1, respectively (OJ L 279, 20.12.1971, p. 7). |
2309 90 51 |
323/2000 of 11.2.2000 (OJ L 37, 12.2.2000, p. 12) |
1 | Pellets, consisting of a mixture of maize-milling products (approximately 70 % by weight) and barley-forage meal (approximately 30 % by weight), with the following characteristics by weight: 87,5 % dry matter (105 °C), 2,1 % ash (800 °C) and 47,2 % starch (determined by the modified Ewers polarimetric method). | 2309 90 51 |
2084/91 of 12.7.1991 (OJ L 193, 17.7.1991, p. 16) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Preparation consisting by weight of approximately 50 % choline chloride, 35 % colloidal silicon dioxide and 15 % water, for use in animal fodder (premix). | 2309 90 96 |
1144/2012 of 28.11.2012 (OJ L 333, 5.12.2012, p. 3) |
1 | A product consisting of modified dehydrated cane molasses presented in powder, with a
light brown colour, containing (% by weight): - sucrose (including invert sugar) 82,4, - ash 1,5, - crude fibre 7. The product contains no starch and has a polarisation of 83,4°. During the production process, plant fibres and cane molasses concentrates are added and a dehydrated cane molasses is obtained. The product is not fit for human consumption and is used solely in animal feeding. |
2309 90 96 |
509/92 of 28.2.1992 (OJ L 55, 29.2.1992, p. 80) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Preparation consisting mainly of a mixture, by weight, of approximately 60 % calcium hydrogenorthophosphate [dicalcium phosphate] and approximately 40 % calcium bis(dihydrogenorthophosphate) [monocalcium phosphate], used in animal fodder. | 2309 90 96 |
1533/92 of 12.6.1992 (OJ L 162, 16.6.1992, p. 5) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
4 | Preparation, consisting mainly of a mixture of, by weight, approximately 60 % hexacalcium trisodium pentakis(orthophosphate), and approximately 40 % tricalcium bis(orthophosphate), used in animal-fodder. | 2309 90 96 |
2696/95 of 21.11.1995 (OJ L 280, 23.11.1995, p. 17) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Product, in the form of powder, granules or pellets, containing approximately by weight: 48 % calcium hydrogenorthophosphate ['dicalcium phosphate'], 40 % calcium bis(dihydrogenorthophosphate) ['monocalcium phosphate'], and 12 % calcium carbonate (of a kind used in animal fodder). | 2309 90 96 |
2354/2000 of 24.10.2000 (OJ L 272, 25.10.2000, p. 10) amended by 441/2013 |
1 | Preparation, of a kind used in animal-feeding, obtained via a high-temperature chemical reaction of a mixture of apatite, phosphoric acid and sodium carbonate or sodium hydroxide. This product is defluorinated, and consists mainly of a mixture of phosphates of calcium and of calcium-sodium. | 2309 90 96 |
3425/91 of 25.11.1991 (OJ L 325, 27.11.1991, p. 6) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Rolls of tobacco, wrapped in a porous cellulose film, which, in length, thickness, colour, type of tobacco and firmness, have the appearance of cigarettes. These rolls of tobacco are insert into a tube of cigarette-paper, before being smoked. | 2402 20 90 |
1035/92 of 24.4.1992 (OJ L 110, 28.4.1992, p. 29) |
1 | Cigarettes made from the leaves of coltsfoot and peppermint, not containing tobacco. | 2402 90 00 |
3311/86 of 29.10.1986 (OJ L 305, 31.10.1986, p. 30) amended by Reg. 2723/90 |
1 | Cut and expanded tobacco (not put up for retail sale), of which at least 80 % by weight floats on the surface when placed in benzyl acetate (determined by the analytical procecdure laid down in the Annex). | 2403 99 90 |
536/94 of 9.3.1994 (OJ L 68, 11.3.1994, p. 16) |
1 | Diatomite, in the form an off-white powder with the following physical and chemical properties: 4,7 % moisture-content, 5,6 % ignition-loss, pH 7 (10 % suspension), and 0,2 % sodium (% Na2O). When calcined, the product takes on a pinkish tinge. The product is used as a filter-medium. | 2512 00 00 |
536/94 of 9.3.1994 (OJ L 68, 11.3.1994, p. 16) |
2 | Diatomite, in the form a pink/off-white powder with the following physical and chemical properties: 0,2 % moisture-content, 0,4 % ignition-loss, pH 6 (10 % suspension), and 0,3 % sodium (% Na2O). The product is used as a filter-medium. | 2512 00 00 |
2113/1999 of 5.10.1999 (OJ L 259, 6.10.1999, p. 3) |
1 | Magnesium oxide, produced by the calcination of magnesium carbonate followed by arc-fusion, in the form of irregular granules ranging from colourless through yellowish to greyish brown. The granules consist of translucent to transparent crystalline particles of approximately 1 to 10 mm in size, with a density (bulk density) approximately 3,5 g/cm3 and magnesium-oxide content at least 95 % by weight. | 2519 90 10 |
1785/94 of 19.7.1994 (OJ L 186, 21.7.1994, p. 20) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | 'Synthetic rutile', obtained from ilmenite by roasting, treatment with hydrochloric acid, and calcination, and containing approximately by weight 95 % titanium dioxide, 2 % diiron trioxide and 1 % silicon dioxide. It is presented in the form of a beige-coloured powder. | 2614 00 00 |
3541/85 of 12.12.1985 (OJ L 338, 17.12.1985, p. 1) amended by Reg. 2695/95 |
1 | Mixture of peat (containing not less than 75 % turf by weight) and other substances such as farmyard-manure, lime, sand, rotted leaf-mould, marl and small quantities of other fertilisers, with a total content of potassium (calculated as K2O), nitrogen and phosphorus (calculated as P2O5) not exceeding 3 % by weight. | 2703 00 00 |
1231/2013 of 28.11.2013 (OJ L 322, 3.12.2013, p. 13) |
1 | Treated distillate aromatic extract (TDAE) having the following physico-chemical properties: - content of aromatic constituents between 74,2 % and 75 % by weight, as determined by the chromatography column process described in Annex A to Chapter 27 of the Explanatory Notes to the Combined Nomenclature (CNEN); - density at 15 °C between 0,9521 and 0,9590 g/cm3; - not more than 4 % by volume distils up to 300 °C, as determined by the ASTM D 86-67 (EN ISO 3405) method. TDAE is an extract that is the result of the refining of lubricants from vacuum distillation residues. The aromatic constituents are produced as by- products in the refining of lubricating oil base stocks and waxes. The product is used as plasticizer for non- vulcanised rubber compounds that constitute raw materials in the manufacture of tyres and other vulcanised rubber products. | 2707 99 99 |
314/90 of 5.2.1990 (OJ L 35, 7.2.1990, p. 9) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
4 | Liquid mixture of hydrocarbons consisting by weight of approximately 87 % of linear paraffins with chain-lengths of 8 to 16 carbon atoms, and approximately 13 % of alkylbenzenes with lateral chains of 10 to 12 carbon atoms. | 2710 19 29 |
231/2004 of 10.2.2004 (OJ L 39, 11.2.2004, p. 15) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Yellow, oily liquid preparation containing by weight 70 % or more of petroleum oils, and containing additives. The product has the following characteristics: - distillation (ASTM D 86) at 250 °C: 0; at 266 °C: start of distillation; at 339 °C (end of distillation: more than 85 % by volume; at 350 °C: more than 85 % by volume; - flash-point (Pensky-Martens): higher than 100 °C; - infrared spectroscopy: aliphatic hydrocarbons; - sulphur content (EN ISO 8754): less than 0,05 % by weight. The preparation can be used as lubricating oil. | 2710 19 43 2710 19 46 2710 19 47 |
1260/89 of 8.5.1989 (OJ L 126, 9.5.1989, p. 12) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Product having the appearance of a soft white wax, consisting of a mixture of alpha-olefins which have even-numbered carbon chains of 18 to 26 atoms, of which the 20- and 22-carbon chains represent more than 80 % by weight of the total. | 2712 90 99 |
1639/94 of 5.7.1994 (OJ L 172, 7.7.1994, p. 8) |
1 | Emulsion of natural bitumen in water, consisting of approximately 70 % bitumen, 30 % water and 0,2 % surface-active agent to help form the emulsion. The purpose of the emulsion in water is to transport the bitumen. The product is used as a fuel in special burners; the water is eliminated by evaporation before the bitumen is burned. | 2714 90 00 |
1663/94 of 7.7.1994 (OJ L 176, 9.7.1994, p. 2) |
1 | Silicon, containing by weight more than 98,7 % silicon, 0,1 % or more but not more than 0,2 % aluminium, and less than 0,1 % calcium, used generally in the manufacture of alkylchlorosilanes. | 2804 69 00 |
2399/91 of 6.8.1991 (OJ L 220, 8.8.1991, p. 5) |
2 | Artificial iron oxide, containing approximately 95 % Fe2O3, and approximately 4 % of aluminium and silica resulting from the manufacturing process. | 2821 10 00 |
2084/91 of 12.7.1991 (OJ L 193, 17.7.1991, p. 16) |
2 | Tricobalt tetraoxide, of a purity of approximately 96 % or more by weight, obtained from cobalt hydroxide. | 2822 00 00 |
2015/1723 of 22.9.2015 (OJ L 252, 29.9.2015, p. 7) | 1 | A product with a stoichiometric composition consisting of magnesium aluminate
(magnesium aluminium oxide) with the crystalline structure of spinel, a chemically defined
product, in the form of irregular granules, lumps or powder. The product has a magnesium
content, calculated as magnesium oxide, of approx. 28 % by weight, and an aluminium
content, calculated as aluminium oxide, of approx. 72 % by weight. The product is used in the manufacture of refractory bricks and tiles used in the steel industry. The product is obtained from a chemical reaction between magnesium oxide and aluminium oxide by fusion in a rotary furnace. |
2841 90 85 |
2017/1267 of 11.7.2017 (OJ L 183, 14.7.2017, p. 3) | A product in the form of a fine, white, odourless powder consisting of microspheres
(particle size < 10 mm) with a density of approximately
2,1-2,5 g/cm3. The microspheres consist of nepheline or nepheline syenite that has been heated to make the material more ellipse-shaped and to round off the rough edges. As a result of this process, the nepheline or nepheline syenite forms a glassy surface. Nepheline and nepheline syenite are sodium potassium aluminosilicates. The product is used as an additive for paints, coatings and films in order to reduce volatile organic compound levels, increase filler loadings, improve hardness, and add burnish, scrub and abrasion resistance. |
2842 10 00 | |
2812/92 of 25.9.1992 (OJ L 284, 29.9.1992, p. 10) |
1st. | Vanadium carbonitride, containing by weight 79,5 % vanadium, 12 % nitrogen and 7 % carbon. | 2849 90 50 |
2812/92 of 25.9.1992 (OJ L 284, 29.9.1992, p. 10) |
2nd. | Vanadium carbonitride, containing by weight 79 % vanadium, 16 % nitrogen and 3,5 % carbon. | 2849 90 50 |
496/98 of 27.2.1998 (OJ L 62, 3.3.1998, p. 19) |
Bromomethane, to which a small quantity of chloropicrin has been added (2 % by weight), not packaged for retail sale. | 2903 39 11 | |
2084/91 of 12.7.1991 (OJ L 193, 17.7.1991, p. 16) |
3 | Product consisting of cholic acid (of a purity of more than 95 % by weight), and fatty acids and inorganic salts resulting from the manufacturing process. | 2918 19 30 |
1825/93 of 7.7.1993 (OJ L 167, 9.7.1993, p. 8) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Technical methoprene, containing by weight 90 % or more of methoprene (total isomers), with residual impurities from the manufacturing process, not put up in forms for retail sale. | 2918 99 90 |
609/2009 of 8.7.2009 (OJ L 180, 11.7.2009, p. 3) |
Product in granular form consisting of (% by weight): - anhydrous betaine: 95,8; - water: 1,5; - calcium stearate (anti-caking agent): 1,0; and the rest being impurities. The product is used in preparations of a kind used in animal feeding. | 2923 90 00 | |
1260/89 of 8.5.1989 (OJ L 126, 9.5.1989, p. 12) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2nd | [4,4'-bis(1,1,3,3-tetramethylbutyl)- 2,2'-thiodiphenolato-O,O',S](butylamine)nickel(II). | 2930 90 99 |
1825/93 of 7.7.1993 (OJ L 167, 9.7.1993, p. 8) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
2 | Gamma-cyclodextrin. | 2940 00 00 |
2084/91 of 12.7.1991 (OJ L 193, 17.7.1991, p. 16) |
4 | Ox-bile extract, obtained by purifying the liquid bile with ethanol and animal black (to deodorise and remove colour) and evaporating to dryness. This product is used therapeutically. | 3001 20 90 |
2061/89 of 7.7.1989 (OJ L 196, 12.7.1989, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 replaced by Reg. 1966/2005 |
5 | Preparation in the form of tablets, put up in packings for retail sale, with instructions on dosage and composition to counter deficiency in vitamin C. Each tablet weighing 750 mg contains: ascorbic acid: 500 mg, and rose-hip powder, cellulose, vegetable stearine, botanical oil solids, magnesium stearate, silicon dioxide and food glaze containing protein: 250 mg. | 3004 50 00 |
2016/936 of 8.6.2016 (OJ L 155, 14.6.2016, p. 19) |
A product put up for retail sale in gelatine capsules, one capsule consisting of (mg): - simethicone: 257,5 - gelatine, glycerol, dimethicone, titanium dioxide (E 171), potassium sorbate, food colourants E 110 and E 122: approx. 196 The product soothes stomach pain and prevents bloating and flatulence. According to its label, the product is presented for human consumption with a recommended daily dose of one to two capsules after each main meal of the day. |
3004 90 00 | |
2061/89 of 7.7.1989 (OJ L 196, 12.7.1989, p. 5) |
6 | Injectable preparation, sterile, pyrogen-free, consisting of purified collagen dispersed in a phosphate-buffered physiological saline solution, whether or not containing lidocaine (INN), put up for retail sale. | 3004 90 00 |
2802/95 of 4.12.1995 (OJ L 291, 6.12.1995, p. 5) amended by Reg. 547/1999 |
1 | Amber syrup, intended to correct iron-deficiency, put up in 125-ml bottles. Its composition per 100 g is: 4,13 g sodium feredetate (a soluble ferric compound of crystallised sodium ethylenediamine tetra-acetate), 24 g sorbitol, 13 g glycerine, 0,1 g citric acid, 0,09 g ethyl alcohol 95°, 0,01 g flavouring agent, 0,01 g propyl parahydroxybenzoate, 0,08 g methyl parahydroxybenzoate, and quant suff water. | 3004 90 19 |
1414/2004 of 28.7.2004 (OJ L 257, 4.8.2004, p. 4) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Eyecare product (ophthalmic solution) composed of the active ingredient: poly(vinyl alcohol) (lubricant) 1,4 %, and of the other ingredients: sodium chloride (tonicity agent); sodium dihydrogenphosphate (buffering agent); disodium hydrogenphosphate (buffering agent); benzalkonium chloride (preservative); disodium edetate (chelating agent); hydrochloric acid (pH-adjuster); sodium hydroxide (pH-adjuster); and purified water, q.s. to 100 % (vehicle). The product is put up for retail sale (15ml-dropper bottle), with indications on dosage and use. | 3004 90 00 |
1230/2013 of 28.11.2013 (OJ L 322, 3.12.2013, p. 11) |
1 | The product is put up for retail sale in tablet form with a total weight of ca. 900 mg each, one tablet consisting of (mg): - alpha-lipoic acid 300, - calcium (as dibasic calcium phosphate) 88,5, - microcrystalline cellulose, hydroxypropyl ethylcellulose, colloidal silicon dioxide and magnesium stearate ca. 511. According to the label, the product is presented as a food supplement for human consumption. The recommended daily dose indicated on the label is one tablet per day. | 3004 90 00 |
3565/88 of 16.11.1988 (OJ L 311, 17.11.1988, p. 25) |
3 | Self-adhesive plastic film, coated on one side with glycerol trinitrate mixed with an acrylic adhesive and protected by a release-sheet, and containing 4 mg/cm2 or more of glycerol trinitrate | 3005 10 00 |
1214/91 of 7.5.1991 (OJ L 116, 9.5.1991, p. 44) |
1 | Rolls of self-adhesive hypoallergenic tape made of a micro-perforated extruded polyethylene film (of dimensions 91,4 m x 2,5 cm), put up in a cardboard box of twelve rolls for retail sale for medical use. | 3005 10 00 |
972/2014 of 11.9.2014 (OJ L 274, 16.9.2014, p. 1) |
A liquid product consisting of a silane, MDP phosphate monomer, dimethacrylate resins, 2-hydroxyethyl-methacrylate (HEMA), a copolymer, filler, ethanol, water and initiators. It is intended for dental use. The product prepares the surface of tooth cavities for bonding with filling material. It can also be used for root desensitisation, for sealing of dentine prior to cementation of amalgam restorations, as protective coating for glass ionomer restorative materials or for bonding of pit and fissure sealants. | 3006 40 00 | |
1661/98 of 27.7.1998 (OJ L 211, 29.7.1998, p. 3) |
1 | Tanning-preparation, based on inorganic compounds and containing approximately 26 % chromium expressed as chromium oxide, 8 % sodium and 17 % sulphur, and having a basicity of about 33 %. | 3202 90 00 |
2053/83 of 20.7.1983 (OJ L 202, 26.7.1983, p. 5) amended by Reg. 2695/95 + 705/2005 |
1 | Product, consisting of paprika-extract, with the following characteristics: highly-viscous deep-red liquid with high colouring-strength, aromatic (similar to paprika) not pungent, 0,49 % ash by weight, 0,15 ml essential oils per 100 g, capsaicin not detectable, 0,01 % glucose by weight, sucrose not detectable, triglycerides positive test, and about 2,2 g capsanthin per kg (about 60 000 colour-units EOA (Essential Oil Association)). | 3203 00 10 |
2016/2033 of 17.11.2016 (OJ L 314, 22.11.2016, p. 1) |
A product consisting of glitter for toothpaste in the form of dark blue particles
which dissolve when brushing the teeth and give a blue colour to the foam formed by the
toothpaste. The colouring matter adheres to the cleaned teeth, allowing a reflection of
blue light from the teeth enamel, thereby causing the teeth to appear whiter for a limited
period of time. The product is composed of the following ingredients (% by weight): - hydroxypropyl methylcellulose approx. 55, - propylene glycol approx. 21, - blue pigment approx. 17, - polysorbate 80 approx. 4, - red dye approx. 3. The blue pigment and the red dye serve as colouring matter. The product is presented in bulk. |
3204 19 00 | |
169/1999 of 25.1.1999 (OJ L 19, 26.1.1999, p. 6) |
6 | (a) Paste based on silver (high concentration) containing 72 % silver, 8,9 % cadmium
compound and 8,9 % lead compound; (b) Paste based on silver (medium concentration) containing 45 % silver, 3,5 % cadmium compound and 3,5 % lead compound. The products are used to apply electronic circuits on to enamelled steel sheets by means of heat-treatment. |
3207 30 00 |
827/2011 of 12.8.2011 (OJ L 211, 18.8.2011, p. 9) Panaikintas reglamentu 2015/182, of 2.2.2015 (OJ L 31, 7.2.2015) |
1 | Blue polymethine dye (fluorescent dye) diluted in a mixture of the solvents ethylene glycol and methanol. Composition (% by weight): - Ethylene glycol 96,9 - Methanol 3,0 - Polymethine dye 0,002 The product is meant to be used in automatic blood analysers. It is used for staining leukocytes by means of fluorescent marking after they have undergone a specific preparatory treatment. The product is put up in a small, labelled container for use in laboratories. | |
1380/2002 of 29.7.2002 (OJ L 200, 30.7.2002, p. 12) |
3 | Saturated solution of essential oils in ethyl alcohol (60 % by volume), containing approximately 3 g of orange essential oils per litre, used as a raw material in the food industry (e.g., bakers' wares, chocolate). | 3302 10 90 |
1272/2011 of 5.12.2011 (OJ L 325, 8.12.2011, p. 3) |
1 | Flavouring preparation composed of a mixture of odoriferous substances (carvacrol, cinnamaldehyde and capsicum oleoresin) and hydrogenated vegetable fat (micro-encapsulation). The product is used in the animal feeding industry as a feed appetiser in quantities of 75 g to 300 g/1 000 kg of feed for monogastric animals. | 3302 90 90 |
1272/2011 of 5.12.2011 (OJ L 325, 8.12.2011, p. 3) |
2 | Flavouring preparation composed of capsicum oleoresin in hydrogenated vegetable fat (micro- encapsulation) with hydroxypropyl methylcellulose as a binder. The product is used in the animal feeding industry as a feed appetiser in quantities of 12,5 g to 50 g/1 000 kg of feed for ruminants. | 3302 90 90 |
1272/2011 of 5.12.2011 (OJ L 325, 8.12.2011, p. 3) |
3 | Flavouring preparation composed of a mixture of odoriferous substances
(cinnamaldehyde, eugenol) on a silica support, in cellulose and methylcellulose
(micro-encapsulation). The product is used in the animal feeding industry as a feed appetiser in quantities of 12,5 g to 50 g/1 000 kg of feed for dairy cows. |
3302 90 90 |
267/2018 of 19.2.2018 (OJ L 51, 23.2.2018, p. 8-10) |
1 | A product (so-called 'masterbatch') in the form of thermoplastic pellets composed of:-
lavender oil, - peppermint oil, - citronellal, - sodium benzoate, - a polymer (Ethylene-Vinyl Acetate (EVA) or Low Density Polyethylene (LDPE)). The product is used as raw material for the incorporation of the essential oils during the plastic transformation process. The purpose is to prevent certain animals biting and damaging finished plastic products. |
3302 90 90 |
1440/2007 of 5.12.2007 (OJ L 322 , 07.12.2007 p. 10) |
1 | Small envelope, of approximate dimensions 40 x 50 mm, self-adhesive, consisting of two heat-sealed foils of a plastic and aluminium complex, and containing a sample of perfume in the form of a gel. It is printed with the name of the perfume.The foil can be lifted to reveal the sample of perfume in a quantity sufficient to give fragrance when rubbed onto the wrists.The product is not intended for retail sale. It is intended to be stuck onto brochures, leaflets, cards, or advertising pages of magazines printed with images and text designed to advertise a specific perfume. | 3303 00 10 |
840/92 of 1.4.1992 (OJ L 88, 3.4.1992, p. 29) |
1st. | Samples of perfume-paste, on a support of printed publicity-material. | 3303 00 10 |
1508/2000 of 11.7.2000 (OJ L 174, 13.7.2000, p. 3) |
2 | Set, consisting of a plastic model of the human skull (approximately 10 cm long, 5 cm wide and 0,5 cm high) of which the eye-, nose- and mouth-cavities contain different-coloured make-up preparations, as well as a stick with synthetic foam at the ends for applying the make-up. The set is put up in packaging for retail sale. | 3304 99 00 |
385/2013 of 22.4.2013 (OJ L 117, 27.4.2013, p. 10) |
1 | A product composed of 25 wipes made of non-wovens with a size of approximately 15 cm x 20 cm per wipe, put up in a plastic bag for retail sale. Amongst other ingredients the wipes are impregnated with water, soybean oil, sweet almond oil (Prunus dulcis), cetyl alcohol, xanthan gum, perfume/fragrance, citronellol, geraniol, glycerine, tetrasodium EDTA and disodium cocoamphodiacetate. According to the information provided the product is used to remove make-up, tone and purify normal and combination skin. | 3304 99 00 |
4/97 of 3.1.1997 (OJ L 3, 7.1.1997, p. 1) |
1 | Preparation, in the form of a paste flavoured with mint or aniseed or in the form of a gel flavoured with mint, containing: 0,760 g disodium fluorophosphate, 0,3315 g sodium fluoride (250 mg active fluoride per 100 g), 4 g sodium benzoate and 100 g excipient q.s.p. This preparation, used as a toothpaste, is put up for sale in standard 50-ml, 75-ml and 125-ml containers. | 3306 10 00 |
1114/2006 of 20.7.2006 (OJ L 199, 21.7.2006, p. 3) |
6 | Product put up for retail sale in a spray bottle of 30 ml volume, with an alcoholic
strength by volume of 20 %, containing - hydro alcoholic extract of propolis 86,75 % - honey 13 % - natural flavouring (lemon) 0,1 % - xanthan gum 0,1 % - lemon (Citrus limonum) essential oil 0,05 %. The product is packaged as a mouth spray for oral hygiene. It is sprayed directly into the mouth. |
3306 90 00 |
1172/2012 of 3.12.2012 (OJ L 337, 11.12.2012, p. 11) |
1 | Wipes made of non-wovens with a size of approximately 15 cm x 20 cm, put up in individual plastic bags for retail sale. The wipes are impregnated with water (98,32 %), propylene glycol (1 %), perfume (0,3 %), tetrasodium EDTA (0,2 %), aloe vera extract (0,1 %), bronopol (0,05 %), citric acid (0,02 %), mixture of methylchloroisothiazolinone and methylisothiazolinone (0,01 %). According to the information provided, the product is used as a refreshing wipe. | 3307 90 00 |
766/2014 of 11.7.2014 (OJ L 209, 11.7.2014, p. 11) |
1 | A product presented in liquid form and put up for retail sale in bottles containing 200 ml, 500 ml or 1 000 ml. The product consists of: - sodium chloride (0,9 %), - sterile water. Each bottle is equipped with an ergonomic eye cup, a dust cap and it is for a single use. According to the label, the product is used to rinse eyes in case of an emergency in order to remove foreign bodies and chemicals. | 3307 90 00 |
766/2014 of 11.7.2014 (OJ L 209, 11.7.2014, p. 11) |
2 | A product presented in liquid form and put up for retail sale in bottles containing 200 ml or 1 000 ml. The product consists of: - disodium phosphate (1-5 %), - potassium phosphate (1 %), - sterile water. Each bottle is equipped with an ergonomic eye cup, a dust cap and it is for a single use. According to the label, the product is used to rinse eyes in case of an emergency in order to neutralise acids and alkalis from the eyes. | 3307 90 00 |
2015/1722 of 22.9.2015 (OJ L 252, 29.9.2015, p. 5) | A product in form of a cream put up for retail sale in a plastic jar with a content of
227 g. The product consists of water, fatty acid ester, dimethicone, plant oil, emulsifier, glycerine, flavour, preservatives, thickener and colourants. The packing of the product does not qualify as a packing of a kind sold by retail for the care of the skin as the product is mainly intended to be used for sensual massage and stimulation. |
3307 90 00 | |
1145/2012 of 28.11.2012 (OJ L 333, 5.12.2012, p. 5) |
1 | Sterilised wipes made of non-wovens, put up in a plastic bag for retail sale. The wipes are impregnated, amongst other ingredients with demineralised water, detergent and skin conditioning cleansing agent. The product is alcohol free. According to the information provided, the product is designed for cleaning hands and face. | 3401 11 00 |
761/2014 of 10.7.2014 (OJ L 207, 15.7.2014, p.13) | Surface-active preparation for washing the skin and the hair, presented in the form of a gel. The product contains in similar proportions specific components for washing the skin and for washing the hair. The product is presented in a plastic bottle containing 300 ml, put up for retail sale. | 3401 30 00 | |
2015/181 of 30.1.2015 (OJ L 31, 7.2.2015, p.1) | A product in the form of fine white-yellowish powder packed in 25 kg bags, made from hydrogenated vegetable oil with added mono- and diglycerides from a different vegetable oil. The added mono- and diglycerides from a different vegetable oil constitute 10 % by weight. The product is presented to be used as an emulsifier in the food industry. The dropping point is 58 °C and viscosity at 68 °C is less than 1 Pa.s. | 3404 90 00 | |
2017/1268 of 11.7.2017 (OJ L 183, 14.7.2017, p.6) | A product in the form of fine white wax beads of approximatively 1 mm in diameter,
obtained from refined palm oil. The product consists of: - hydrogenated hard palm stearin, - non-hydrogenated hard palm stearin, - an optical brightener (approx. 0,01 % by weight). Palm stearin obtained from palm oil is subjected to a multi-stage fractionation and the hard stearin (solid fraction) is separated from the soft stearin. Then, a part of the hard stearin is subjected to a hydrogenation process, and mixed with the non- hydrogenated part of the hard stearin and with an optical brightener. Subsequently, the obtained product is subjected to a beading process. The product is of waxy character and is used as raw material for manufacturing candles. The dropping point is 59,2 °C ± 0,5 °C and the viscosity measured with a rotational viscometer does not exceed 10 Pa.s at a temperature of 10 °C above the dropping point. The product is packed in 25 kg bags. |
3404 90 00 | |
1989/2004 of 19.11.2004 (OJ L 344, 20.11.2004, p. 5) |
3 | Whey-protein isolates, in the form of a powder and containing by weight more than 90 %
of protein (calculated on the dry matter). The product is obtained by the microfiltration
of whey. The protein profile is as follows: - 50-60 % b-lactoglobulin, - 10-25 % a-lactalbumin, - 5-7 % immunoglobulin, and - about 20 % of glycopeptides. The content of lactose and fat is less than 1 %. There may be small quantities of lecithin present, used as a wetting agent in the manufacturing process. The product is intended for human consumption. |
3502 20 91 |
55/2003 of 13.1.2003 (OJ L 8, 14.1.2003, p. 3) |
5 | Product in the form of a powder with the following composition by weight: 92 % protein of which 65 % collagen content, 4 % moisture, and 4 % ash (550 °C). The product, soluble in water, is made from bones by hydrolysis. It is used to bind water in, e.g., meat products. | 3504 00 90 |
386/2013 of 22.4.2013 (OJ L 117, 27.4.2013, p. 12) |
1 | Product consisting of 20 mg to 5 mg recombinant human glycoprotein (laminin) in an aqueous storage buffer. The product is intended for use for coating cell culture vessels. It serves as a matrix for growing stem cells by improving the surface of such vessels to which the cells can adhere. The product does not provide nourishment for the stem cells and is to be used in combination with a cell culture medium in order to maintain or grow stem cells. | 3504 00 90 |
316/91 of 7.2.1991 (OJ L 37, 9.2.1991, p. 25) |
3 | Product obtained solely by the etherification of starch with epichlorohydrin and sodium monochloroacetate in the presence of sodium hydroxide; appearance: white crumbly powder; dry matter: 92,8 %; ash (at 600° C): 15,1 %; containing: sodium and chloride ions; solution-pH: 11,6; image under the microscope: starch-type not recognisable; iodine-test: dark blue; paper chromatography: positive for starch ether; IR spec: characteristic carboxymethyl groups. | 3505 10 50 |
1417/2007of 28.11.2007 (OJ L 316 , 04.12.2007 p.4) | 3 | Bonding solution composed of :EthylcyanoacrylateSilicaPoly(methyl methacrylate)CalixarenesHydroquinoneTriglycerides. The solution is intended to adhere moulded plastic false nails to the natural nail. It hardens slowly to allow modelling of the false nails.The solution is packaged in small nozzled tubes for easy and precise application. Net weight not exceeding 1 kg. | 3506 10 00 |
645/2001 of 30.3.2001 (OJ L 91, 31.3.2001, p. 40) |
1 | Product, in the form of granules, consisting of a mixture of enzymes stabilised on a carrier (wheat-flour) and containing per gram 2 500 units of xylanase and 800 units of protease. The product may be used, inter alia, as an additive in animal-fodder (in the proportion of approximately 1 to 1 000), to improve the nutritional efficency of the feed by making it more easily digested. | 3507 90 90 |
884/2011 of 22.8.2011 (OJ L 229, 6.9.2011, p. 1) |
1 | Deoxyribonuclease enzyme, with an activity range of 10 000 to 25 000 units/mg, in an aqueous storage buffer of pH 6,5. The product is put up for retail sale for laboratory use in the reverse transcriptase polymerase chain reaction (RT-PCR). | 3507 90 90 |
1586/89 of 7.6.1989 (OJ L 156, 8.6.1989, p. 20) |
1 | Lumpwood charcoal impregnated with a heavy (waxy) hydrocarbon, the hydrocarbon content being approximately 25 % by weight of the whole. The goods are used as barbecue fuel and put up in 2- to 10-kg bags. | 3606 90 90 |
1586/89 of 7.6.1989 (OJ L 156, 8.6.1989, p. 20) |
2 | Briquettes of wood charcoal agglomerated with a binder and containing sodium nitrate. The goods are used as barbecue fuel and put up in 2- to 10-kg bags. | 3606 90 90 |
2017/2246 of 30.11.2017 (OJ L 324, 8.12.2017, p. 8) |
Unexposed aluminum plates (so-called 'positive thermal plates with laser diode
sensitivity'), rectangular in shape, with one side exceeding 255 mm in length, coated on
one side with an emulsion (essentially containing alkali-soluble resin, one or more IR
(infrared) dyes (photo thermal converter) and a solubility suppressor (colourant)) that is
sensitive to infrared laser diodes at a wavelength of 830 nm. They are designed for use with CTP (Computer To Plate technology) equipment for medium to large print runs. To increase the life span of the finished product, the plates undergo a so-called 'baking' process to harden the image once it has been developed. |
3701 30 00 | |
457/2008 of 23.5.2008 (OJ L 137, 27.5.2008, p. 4) |
1 | Product consisting of a quartz plate coated with chrome and photoresist, with overall dimensions of 15 (L) x 15 (W) x 0,6 (D) cm (so-called 'photomask blank'). The product is to be exposed and developed, to become a 'photomask' used in the production of semiconductor devices. | 3701 99 00 |
457/2008 of 23.5.2008 (OJ L 137, 27.5.2008, p. 4) |
2 | Product consisting of a quartz plate coated with chrome, with overall dimensions of 15 (L) x 15 (W) x 0,6 (D) cm, upon which circuit diagram patterns have been produced in the same manner as in the case of exposed and developed photographic plates (so-called 'photomask'). The product is used in the manufacture of semiconductor wafers, for photographically transferring circuit diagrams onto wafers. | 3705 90 90 |
169/1999 of 25.1.1999 (OJ L 19, 26.1.1999, p. 6) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
7 | Powdered toner with magnetic properties, used as a developer for photocopying machines, composed of 40 % styrene and butyl acrylate copolymer, 3 % polypropylene, 56 % magnetite and <1 % silica. | 3707 90 20 |
536/94 of 9.3.1994 (OJ L 68, 11.3.1994, p. 16) |
3 | Diatomite, in the form a white powder with the following physical and chemical properties: < 0,1 % moisture-content, 0,3 % ignition-loss, pH 8 (10 % suspension), and 3,5 % sodium (% Na2O). The colour remains unchanged, even after calcination. The product is used as a filter-medium. | 3802 90 00 |
2147/2001 of 31.10.2001 (OJ L 288, 1.11.2001, p. 23) |
1 | Preparation, in the form of a solution, put up in aerosol-cans for retail sale, composed by weight as follows: (a) (insecticides) 1 % permethrine, 0,5 % malathion and 4 % piperonyl butoxide; (b) 94,5 % isododecane; and propellent (butane/propane). The preparation contains insecticides against head-lice and nits, and is sprayed on to the dry hair and scalp before shampooing. | 3808 91 10 |
267/2018 of 19.2.2018 (OJ L 51, 23.2.2018, p. 8-10) |
2 | A product (so-called 'masterbatch') in the form of thermoplastic pellets composed of: - permethrin (ISO), - thymol oil, - eugenol oil, - citral oil, - denatonium benzoate, - benzoic acid derivatives, - lidocaine (INN), - a polymer (Ethylene-Vinyl Acetate (EVA) or Low Density Polyethylene (LDPE)). The product is used as raw material for the incorporation of the insecticide during the plastic transformation process. The purpose is to prevent termites biting and damaging finished plastic products. |
3808 91 10 |
497/98 of 27.2.1998 (OJ L 62, 3.3.1998, p. 21) |
1 | Mixture of bromomethane (67 % by weight) and chloropicrin (33 %), used as a soil-fumigant prior to planting. | 3808 91 90 |
455/2007 of 25. 4. 2007 (OJ L 109, 26. 4. 2007, p.30) |
1 | A preparation in the form of an alcoholic solution put up in pipettes for retail sale.
The composition is as follows: - fipronil (ISO) 10 g; - butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA, E 320) 0,02 g; - butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT, E 321) 0,01 g ; - excipient q.s.p. 100 ml. The preparation, containing a substance showing an insecticide and acaricide activity against parasites such as fleas, ticks and lice, is used externally on pets (dogs and cats). |
3808 91 90 |
455/2007 of 25.4.2007 (OJ L 109, 26.4.2007, p. 30) |
2 | Preparation in the form of an alcoholic solution put up as a spray (sprayer, pump) for
retail sale. The composition is as follows: - fipronil (ISO) 0,25 g; - excipient q.s.p. 100 ml. The preparation, containing a substance showing insecticidal and acaricidal activity against parasites such as fleas, ticks and lice, is used externally on pets (dogs and cats). |
3808 91 90 |
1201/2001 of 18.6.2001 (OJ L 163, 20.6.2001, p. 8) |
1st. | Preparation, consisting of a suspension of zinc pyrithione (fungicide) in water, and containing by weight 24-26 % zinc pyrithione, 75-77 % water, 0,5 % antimicrobial preservatives, and 0,1 % surface-active agent. The preparation is presented in bulk and used in varying concentrations as the active ingredient (fungicide) in different products. | 3808 92 90 |
691/96 of 16.4.1996 (OJ L 97, 18.4.1996, p. 13) |
1 | Preparation, with a basis of amylaceous substances, obtained by the etherification of a wheat-flour and having a starch-content of approximately 61 % by weight, as determined by the method in Annex II to Commission Regulation (EEC) No 4154/87 (OJ L 392, 31.12.1987, p. 19). This is a preparation of a kind generally used in the paper-industry. | 3809 10 30 |
597/92 of 6.3.1992 (OJ L 64, 10.3.1992, p. 13) |
1 | Preparation consisting of wheat starch and a small amount of a-amylase (0,5 %). The starch-content is over 83 %. The product is used as a finishing agent in the paper industry. | 3809 10 90 |
142/2002 of 25.1.2002 (OJ L 24, 26.1.2002, p. 14) |
3 | Mixture, consisting of ethyl alcohol (78,2 %), isopropanol (12,4 %), n-propanol (8,1 %), and small quantities of other organic products. This mixture is a by-product from synthetic-gasoline manufacture. | 3814 00 90 |
1785/94 of 19.7.1994 (OJ L 186, 21.7.1994, p. 20) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Emulsifying agent, consisting of a mixture of mono- and diacetyl-tartaric-acid esters of mono- and diglycerides of fatty acids (E 472(e)). | 3824 90 55 |
3974/88 of 20.12.1988 (OJ L 351, 21.12.1988, p. 21) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Mixtures of clavulanic acid (INN) (50 % by weight), potassium salt, and microcrystalline cellulose, for incorporation into antibiotic-based medical products. | 3824 90 64 |
2084/91 of 12.7.1991 (OJ L 193, 17.7.1991, p. 16) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
5 | Intermediate product from the preparation of cholic acid from ox-bile, essentially consisting of mixed cholic and deoxycholic acids (about 80 % by weight), fatty acids and inorganic salts. | 3824 90 64 |
2015/1723 of 22.9.2015 (OJ L 252, 29.9.2015, p. 7) | 2 | A product with a non-stoichiometric composition with a magnesium content, calculated
as magnesium oxide, of approx. 20-35 % by weight and an aluminium content, calculated as
aluminium oxide, of approx. 58-78 % by weight. The product has the crystalline structure
of spinel, in form of irregular granules, lumps or powder. The product is used in the manufacture of refractory bricks and tiles used in the steel industry. The product is obtained from a chemical reaction between magnesium oxide and aluminium oxide by fusion in a rotary furnace. |
3824 90 96 |
2015/1723 of 22.9.2015 (OJ L 252, 29.9.2015, p. 7) | 3 | A product named 'fused magnesia chrome' in form of irregular grey granules, fragments
or powder of varying grain size, with a non-stoichiometric composition of magnesium oxide
and chromium oxide. The product has the crystalline structure of spinel and is used in the
manufacture of refractory bricks and tiles used in the steel industry. This product is obtained by fusion of magnesium oxide and chromium ore in an arc furnace. |
3824 90 96 |
2016/1140 of 8.7.2016 (OJ L 189, 14.7.2016, p. 1) | 1 | A product in the form of a self-heating patch to relieve pain. The patch is made of adhesive material intended for attaching to the skin (neck, wrist or shoulder). The product is made of a soft synthetic material conforming to the body's shape and contains a number of discs which, on exposure to the air, generate heat. The discs contain iron powder, charcoal, salt and water. When the individual packets containing the patch are opened and exposed to air, an exothermic reaction takes place. |
3824 90 96 |
2016/1140 of 8.7.2016 (OJ L 189, 14.7.2016, p. 1) | 2 | A product in the form of a self-heating belt to relieve pain. The belt is made of non-adhesive material, which is attached by means of a self-adhesive strip. The product is made of a soft synthetic material conforming to the body's shape and contains a number of discs which, upon exposure to air, generate heat. The discs contain iron powder, charcoal, salt and water. When the individual packets containing the belt are opened and exposed to air, an exothermic reaction takes place. |
3824 90 96 |
3402/82 of 17.12.1982 (OJ L 357, 18.12.1982, p. 16) amended by Reg. 2695/95, 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
Base-preparation for chewing-gum, in the form of cylindrical pieces, consisting by weight of 34 % butyl rubber, 15 % polyethylene, 13 % poly(vinyl acetate), 28 % vegetable-resin and 10 % calcium carbonate. | 3824 90 97 | |
2275/88 of 25.7.1988 (OJ L 200, 26.7.1988, p. 10) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
6 | Preparation, of the kind used as raw material in the production of cosmetics, having the following approximate composition by weight: 10 % animal-placenta extracts and 90 % maize-germ oil. | 3824 90 97 |
2275/88 of 25.7.1988 (OJ L 200, 26.7.1988, p. 10) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
7 | Preparation, of the kind used as raw material in the production of cosmetics, having the following approximate composition by weight: 3 % collagen, 44 % glycerol, 53 % water. | 3824 90 97 |
2275/88 of 25.7.1988 (OJ L 200, 26.7.1988, p. 10) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
8 | Preparation, of the kind used as raw material in the production of cosmetics, having the following approximate composition by weight: 5 % elastin, 45 % propane-1,2-diol, 50 % water. | 3824 90 97 |
3491/88 of 9.11.1988 (OJ L 306, 11.11.1988, p. 18) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
3 | Sodium dihydridobis(2-methoxyethanolato)aluminate, in solution (70 %) in toluene. | 3824 90 97 |
542/90 of 1.3.1990 (OJ L 56, 3.3.1990, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
1 | Aqueous emulsion based on carnauba wax, used as a release agent on sheets of plastics and similar materials. | 3824 90 97 |
2084/91 of 12.7.1991 (OJ L 193, 17.7.1991, p. 16) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
6 | Blend of adipic-acid esters of alcohols having mainly 12 and 13 carbon atoms, used principally in the manufacture of synthetic lubricants. | 3824 90 97 |
1533/92 of 12.6.1992 (OJ L 162, 16.6.1992, p. 5) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
6 | Solid extract from the residual material insoluble in aliphatic solvents, obtained during the extraction of rosin from wood, having the following characteristics: a resin-acid-content not exceeding 30 % by weight, an acid-number not exceeding 110, and a melting point of not less than 100° C. | 3824 90 97 |
2933/92 of 7.10.1992 (OJ L 293, 9.10.1992, p. 8) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
1 | Base-preparation for chewing-gum, in the form of plates or granules consisting mainly of: specially-purified elastomeric polymers, resins, refined waxes, glycerol esters of edible fatty acids, mineral fillers, and antioxidants. The preparation may also contain natural emulsifiers and natural gum. | 3824 90 97 |
691/96 of 16.4.1996 (OJ L 97, 18.4.1996, p. 13) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
2 | Mixture of carboxylic acids, containing approximately by weight: 79 % azelaic acid, 20 % other dibasic acids and 1 % monobasic acids. | 3824 90 97 |
1264/98 of 17.6.1998 (OJ L 175, 19.6.1998, p. 4) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
6 | Mixture of rape-oil (98 %) and petrol (2 %). | 3824 90 97 |
1264/98 of 17.6.1998 (OJ L 175, 19.6.1998, p. 4) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
7 | Mixture of rape-oil (98 %) and a mixture (2 %) consisting of diesel and other heavy oils. | 3824 90 97 |
169/1999 of 25.1.1999 (OJ L 19, 26.1.1999, p. 6) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
8 | Creamy-white powder, consisting of montmorillonite with about 30 % added stearylamine. It is an organophile, miscible with organic solvents, and displays a mass-loss of 35 % after being heated to 600 °C. | 3824 90 97 |
1694/2001 of 24.8.2001 (OJ L 229, 25.8.2001, p. 3) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
2 | Preparation, used as a base for the manufacture of non-alcoholic beverages and
consisting of the following by weight: - 40 % anhydrous phosphoric acid, - 30 % sulfite ammonia caramel (E 150d), - 10 % caffeine, and water. |
3824 90 97 |
1439/2007 of 5.12.2007 (OJ L 322, 7.12.2007, p. 8) |
1 | Set consisting of several plasters and pads which ontain the following ingredients (%
by weight): - Tourmaline 4; - Chitosan 5; - Wood vinegar 30; - Pearl powder 4; - Pure silica 4; - Glycolic acid 3; - Dextrin 50. According to the information on the package the roduct is intended to improve circulation of lood in the feet to activate the metabolism of he cellular tissue and detoxify the body. The pads are to be worn on the soles of the feet or 8-10 hours with the aid of the plasters upplied. The product is presented in a folding card pack for ndividual sale. |
3824 90 97 |
323/2008 of 8.4.2008 (OJ L 98, 10.4.2008, p. 3) |
1 | Spectacle-shaped supple plastic article containing a coloured liquid solution with the
following composition (by volume): - 60 % propylene glycol and - 40 % water. This product is designed to relieve headaches when applied to the face, having first been cooled in a refrigerator |
3824 90 97 |
1303/2011 of 9.12.2011 (OJ L 330, 14.12.2011, p. 17) |
Gel put up for the relief of pain containing the following ingredients: - isopropyl alcohol - water - herbal extract (Ilex paraguariensis) - acrylic acid polymers (carbomer) - triethanolamine - menthol - camphor - silicon dioxide - methylparaben - glycerine - propylene glycol - tartrazine (E102) - brilliant blue FCF (E133) The quantities of the ingredients are not indicated on the packaging of the product. The packaging advises that the product is used for the temporary relief of minor aches and pains of muscles and joints associated with arthritis pain, backache, strains and sprains. | 3824 90 97 | |
699/2013 of 19.7.2013 (OJ L 198, 23.7.2013, p. 23) |
1 | Cat litter composed of natural bentonite clay that has been dried and treated with an anti-bacterial agent and mixed with activated carbon to prevent the growth of bacteria and odour. The bentonite clay constitutes more than 94 % by weight of the product. The product is sold to consumers in various pack sizes. | 3824 90 97 |
699/2013 of 19.7.2013 (OJ L 198, 23.7.2013, p. 23) |
2 | Cat litter composed of round and oval shaped translucent granules of silicon dioxide (silica gel). The product includes a visible quantity of coloured granules. The coloured granules are obtained by the addition of a blue dye. The product is sold to consumers in various pack sizes. | 3824 90 97 |
2015/184 of 30.1.2015 (OJ L 31, 7.2.2015, p.7) | Silicon dioxide (also called 'silica gel') in the form of small transparent granules of 0,5 to 1,5 mm in diameter and packed in paper sachets or in plastic capsules that are water-vapour-permeable. The silicon dioxide absorbs moisture and is presented to be used, for example, to protect and preserve medicines or to keep goods dry during shipment. | 3824 90 96 | |
314/90 of 5.2.1990 (OJ L 35, 7.2.1990, p. 9) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
5 | Product for use as a component in lubricants, made of synthetic isoparaffinic
poly(alpha)olefins, having the following characteristics: - colourless, clear, low-viscosity oily liquid; - refractive index of 1,4563 at 20° C; - ashing none; - hetero-atoms (sulphur, halogen, nitrogen and phosphorus) negative; - bromine-value 0,3; - vacuum distillation (1,5 mbar) boiling point above 121° C; - IR-spectrum essentially displays bands of saturated aliphatic hydrocarbons; - density 0,8225 kg/l at 20° C. |
3902 90 90 |
825/2011 of 12.8.2011 (OJ L 211, 18.8.2011, p. 5) |
1 | Styrene-butadiene copolymer, in primary form. This copolymer is manufactured by mixing styrene butadiene rubber latex (SBR) with high styrene content resin. The final product consists of a mixture of styrene butadiene copolymers with a proportion of styrene of 65 % by weight or more. | 3903 90 90 |
594/2009 of 8.7.2009 (OJ L 178, 9.7.2009, p. 14) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Vinylidene fluoride and hexafluoropropylene copolymer in primary form. This material displays the stretching and recovery properties of elastomers but cannot be vulcanised with sulphur. In order to crosslink, this copolymer requires basic compounds or certain peroxides. | 3904 69 80 |
1214/91 of 7.5.1991 (OJ L 116, 9.5.1991, p. 44) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Saturated polyester, in granular form or in aqueous dispersion, of a kind used as a sizing-agent in the textile industry. | 3907 99 90 |
2016/1645 of 7.9.2016 (OJ L245, 14.9.2016, p. 3) | A product in the form of irregular, flat, brown, hard fragments (about 2 mm thick) or
flakes, manufactured of (% by weight): - pine resin (also called tall oil rosin or rosin) approx. 58-69, - maleic acid anhydride approx. 1-4, - various phenols approx. 11-24, - Formaldehyde approx. 5,5-9, - Pentaerythritol approx. 7-12. The product results from a multi-step process starting with rosin and maleic anhydride being transformed into a rosin adduct. After the addition of magnesium oxide (as a catalyst for the subsequent reactions), phenols and formaldehyde a polymerised resin is formed. Finally, free acid groups of the resin are esterified after the addition of pentaerythritol. The product at issue is used in the printing industry as an adhesive. |
3909 40 00 | |
1260/89 of 8.5.1989 (OJ L 126, 9.5.1989, p. 12) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
3rd | Solution in a volatile organic solvent (approximately 25 % by weight) of a triazine derivative (approximately 75 % by weight), formed by the reorganisation-polymerisation of hexamethylene diisocyanate (HMDI), in which the free isocyanate groups are protected. | 3911 90 19 |
1214/91 of 7.5.1991 (OJ L 116, 9.5.1991, p. 44) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
3 | Agarose. | 3913 90 00 |
597/92 of 6.3.1992 (OJ L 64, 10.3.1992, p. 13) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
2 | Iron(III)-dextran compound, containing by weight between 5 % and 20 % iron, in the form of powder in 50-kg sacks, or in the form of aqueous solution containing 0,5 % phenol (as preservative) in 10-litre to 200-litre containers. | 3913 90 00 |
738/2000 of 7.4.2000 (OJ L 87, 8.4.2000, p. 10) |
1 | Flexible product, for the temperature-controlled distribution of gases or liquids, consisting of the following components (from the inside outwards): a flexible plastic tube with a minimum burst-pressure of 27,6 MPa for transporting the fluid; an electrical heating-strip separated from the transport-tube by an aluminium plate; a layer of aluminium foil covering the transport-tube, the heating-strip and the aluminium plate; an insulated electric cable for controlling the heating-strip; a layer of fleece material; and a flexible outer covering of synthetic material. The product is presented in lengths without fittings. | 3917 31 00 |
1967/2005 of 1.12.2005 (OJ L 316, 2.12.2005, p. 7) |
2 | Medical grade plastic seamless flexible tubing, constructed from frosted Poly (vinyl chloride) (PVC) with a wall thickness of approximately 0,6 mm and an external diameter of 5,7 mm. It has a minimum bursting pressure of 27,6 MPa and is imported on rolls of approximately 1 200 m in length. The product is of a kind generally used for conveying, conducting or distributing gases or liquids. Although the tube, when cut to the appropriate length, can be used as a part for medical equipment, including that for anaesthesia, critical care systems, catheters and arterial systems, it has no specific use as a part of medical equipment. | 3917 31 00 |
1967/2005 of 1.12.2005 (OJ L 316, 2.12.2005, p. 7) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
3 | Heat-shrinkable plastic tube of Poly (vinylidene fluoride) (PVDF), seamless, not reinforced, with a burst pressure of less than 27,6 MPa, approximately 25 mm in length and 9 mm in diameter. When heat is applied they shrink to fit perfectly around any object that has been inserted into them. The product is generally used to protect electrical wires. | 3917 32 00 |
763/2002 of 3.5.2002 (OJ L 117, 4.5.2002, p. 13) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
Drip-irrigation tube, manufactured from a thin flexible plastic strip folded lengthways. The two edges are overlapped and joined together to form a flat perforated tube. The product is presented in rolls of various lengths. | 3917 32 00 | |
2016/2221 of 5.12.2016 (OJ L 336, 10.12.2016, p. 14) |
An article consisting of three flexible tubes joined together with a Y-shaped
connection piece. Each of the tubes has a Luer connector at the end. The article has a
total length of approximately 16 cm and the diameter of the tubes is approximately 4 mm.
The article is made of various plastics such as polyvinyl chloride and acrylic polymer. The Luer connector is used to connect the article to other tubes and/or devices (for example syringes) in a manner which prevents leakage. The article is used in various fields such as medical environment, laboratory work, research and other environments where a connection which prevents leaking is required. |
3917 33 00 | |
279/2013 of 19.3.2013 (OJ L 84, 23.3.2013, p. 15) |
1 | A box measuring approximately 33 x 10 x 10 cm, made of metal sheeting with a thickness of approximately 0,2 mm. The outside of the box bears a brand logo and name. Inside the box there is an easily detachable plastic inlay specially shaped to accommodate a bottle. The box is designed to be used as a package for a bottle of wine. The box is presented without the bottle. | 3917 39 00 |
276/2013 of 19.3.2013 (OJ L 84, 23.3.2013, p. 9) |
1 | Decking board made of wood composite, measuring approximately 0,15 x 0,02 x 3,7 m and composed of waste wood fibres (60 %), recycled plastics (HDPE) (30 %), non-plastic additives, filling agents, UV stabilisers and pigments (10 %). The board is manufactured by extrusion. It has a rectangular profile shape and a density of 1,20 g/cm 3 . The upper surface is grained and textured while the lower surface is ribbed. The board has grooves running the whole length along its side. It has the characteristics of a rigid inflexible plastics product, with wood waste forming the filler. It is a wood substitute and is used for making, for example, decks and walkways. | 3918 90 00 |
2017/183 of 27.1.2017 (OJ L 29, 3.2.2017, p. 16) |
An article (so-called 'tatami puzzle mat') made of EVA (Ethylene-vinyl acetate) in the
form of 100 x 100 cm tiles with non-slip surface, and of a thickness of approximately 3
cm. The tiles have an interlocking connecting system based on the principle of puzzles,
which are laid firmly on another surface and thus form a mat. The article is designed to absorb shocks generated during various sportive activities (for example yoga, gymnastics, or martial arts) through the cellular structure of the mat to protect the body. The 'tatami puzzle mat' is also designed as an insulator of noise, heat, and moisture. It serves thus as a protection against damage of the surface underneath and to protect people performing various other activities, for example, when used by nurseries or artists. |
3918 90 00 | |
336/2010 of 21.4.2010 (OJ L 102, 23.4.2010, p. 25) |
1 | Disc of a diameter of approximately 580 mm and a thickness of approximately 3 mm, consisting of 2 layers made of polyurethane, one of which has machined grooves, whereas the other has an adhesive coating protected by a detachable plastic sheet (so- called 'polymeric pad'). The article is used with machines for the manufacture of silicon and semiconductor wafers. It is fitted on the carrier head of an interchangeable tool of such machines and is used to planarise/ flatten and polish the wafers. | 3919 90 00 |
1224/2003 of 9.7.2003 (OJ L 172, 10.7.2003, p. 4) |
2 | Non-cellular plastic film of a total thickness of approximately 0,011 mm and consisting of a film of poly(ethylene terephthalate) (PET) metallised on one side with aluminium which is subsequently coated with a layer of alkylated melamine resin (lacquer). The predominant plastic is poly(ethylene terephthalate). The layer of metal is applied by vacuum deposition and the metallised film transmits light. The film can be used in the production of rescue blankets. | 3920 62 19 |
2141/89 of 14.7.1989 (OJ L 205, 18.7.1989, p. 22) |
1 | Lightweight panel of rectangular or square shape, made up of a layer of expanded polystyrene covered on both sides by a sheet of paper. The total thickness of the paper is less than 10 % of the total thickness of the article. | 3921 11 00 |
739/2006 of 17.5.2006 (OJ L 130, 18.5.2006, p. 3) |
1 | Plates of microporous cellular plastics, of ethylene-vinyl acetate copolymer, cut into rectangles (dimensions 15,5 x 10,5 x 0,75 cm) but not further worked. The plates are destined to be cut into smaller pieces and inserted into stamps, where they are used as an ink reservoir. | 3921 19 00 |
314/90 of 5.2.1990 (OJ L 35, 7.2.1990, p. 9) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
6 | Cellular sheet consisting of approximately 60 % ethylene-vinyl acetate copolymer (saturated product) and 40 % fillers and pigments. The sheet is rectangular in shape and may vary in thickness from 4 mm to 16 mm. | 3921 19 00 |
201/98 of 26.1.1998 (OJ L 21, 28.1.1998, p. 3) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
Microporous polytetrafluoroethylene foil, in the form of rectangles. The product is put up in sterile packaging and used in surgical operations to repair local lesions or separate organs to prevent them from fusing together. It must sometimes be cut to size before use. | 3921 19 00 | |
833/2008 of 20.8.2008 (OJ L 225, 23.8.2008, p. 3) |
Unassembled angle shower cabin consisting of: - a shower-bath of plastics with the following dimensions: 80 (W) x 80 (D) x 10 (H) cm, - an overall structure made of aluminium, - four panels of glass embedded in aluminium frames with the following dimensions: 40 (W) x 180 (H) cm. The overall structure is to be mounted on the shower-bath and attached to the walls. Two of the glass panels function as sliding doors. |
3922 10 00 | |
627/2003 of 4.4.2003 (OJ L 90, 8.4.2003, p. 34) |
4 | Rigid plastic container used in the transport, storage and handling of semiconductor wafers. The inner walls are grooved to form slots; the base and one side are open. | 3923 10 00 |
1302/2011 of 9.12.2011 (OJ L 330, 14.12.2011, p. 16) |
Plastic bottle made of polyethylene with stopper and a round base form. The product has a height of around 20 cm and a capacity of 0,5 litre. The product is designed for insertion into the holder for bottles on bicycles, and it is used for the conveyance of beverages. |
3923 30 10 | |
491/2012 of 7.6.2012 (OJ L 151, 12.6.2012, p. 5) |
Infant feeding bottle made of plastic (polypropylene) and graduated. The product has a height of around 20 cm and a capacity of 300 ml. The infant feeding bottle has a silicone nipple and a protector. | 3924 10 00 | |
1067/2010 of 19.11.2010 (OJ L 304, 20.11.2010, p. 11) |
1 | A product (so-called 'shower head') made of plastics with a nickel coating, used for distributing water by means of a nozzle. It is equipped with a non-return valve which prevents water from flowing back. However, the valve does not regulate the water flow. The flow of water from the nozzle is regulated by the tap to which the product is intended to be connected via a flexible hose. | 3924 90 00 |
1067/2010 of 19.11.2010 (OJ L 304, 20.11.2010, p. 11) |
3 | A product (so-called 'shower head') made of plastics with a nickel coating, used for distributing water by means of a nozzle without a non-return valve or a mechanism to change the type of water jet. The flow of water from the nozzle is regulated by the tap to which the product is intended to be connected via a flexible hose. | 3924 90 00 |
197/2014 of 28.2.2014 (OJ L 62, 4.3.2014, p. 1) |
1 | The product is a round, moulded bowl, of plastics. Its diameter is approximately 18,5 cm and its height is approximately 7 cm. The bowl holds approximately 700 ml. The bowl is a container for pet food to feed animals (for example, dogs). | 3924 90 00 |
2017/2245 of 30.11.2017 (OJ L 324, 12.8.2017, p. 6) |
An article (so-called 'bath board') of plastics with a non-slip surface, measuring
approximately 35 x 69 cm. The article has drainage holes, a handle and an integrated soap dish. On the underside it is fitted with four adjustable supports to fit the width of a bath. The bath board can assist the user to climb into and out of the bath and can also be used as a seat or as a tray for bath products. |
3924 90 00 | |
838/2018 of 31.5.2018 (OJ L 141, 07.6.2018, p. 4-6) |
A product consisting of a disposable liner, to be used in conjunction with a child's potty, composed of a plastic bag to which a multilayer absorbent pad made from paper and a superabsorbent polymer of polyacrylate in the form of granules is attached at the bottom of the bag. These superabsorbent polyacrylate granules are transformed into a gel when they come in contact with urine. | 3924 90 00 | |
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
1 | Ice-hockey glove, the upper part (back) of which is padded for protection and covered with non-woven fabric completely coated on both sides with plastic. The palm is composed of non-woven polyamide microfibres. The parts between the fingers (other than the thumb) are made from a single-coloured knitted fabric. | 3926 20 00 |
323/2008 of 8.4.2008 (OJ L 98, 10.4.2008, p. 3) |
2 | Envelope made of plastic sheets containing a mixture of water and oil for inserting in the cups of swimming suits or bras. | 3926 20 00 |
2016/283 of 24.2.2016 (OJ L 53, 1.3.2016, p. 1) |
1 | An article predominantly made of plastics, having the shape of a pointed cylinder
(so-called 'LED glitter lamp'), approximately 17 cm high. The article tapers to a point at
the top, with a broader base, and has a transparent plastic middle section. The middle
section is decorated inside with a stylised figure of a girl and is filled with a
transparent fluid which has glitter particles suspended in it. The base contains several battery-powered light-emitting diodes (LEDs). When the article is shaken, the middle section glows gently in different colours. The light is only emitted briefly, for about one minute, after shaking. |
3926 40 00 |
810/83 of 5.4.1983 (OJ L 90, 8.4.1983, p. 11) amended by Reg. 2080/91 |
4 | Plastic money-box, in the form of a penguin about 16 cm high, with a red scarf and a slot in the back for inserting coins. | 3926 40 00 |
2087/92 of 22.7.1992 (OJ L 208, 24.7.1992, p. 24) |
1 | Articles in the form of animals (horses and deer), made of plastic and covered with a layer of flock glued on. | 3926 40 00 |
1165/95 of 23.5.1995 (OJ L 117, 24.5.1995, p. 15) |
1 | Ornamental article ('luminous fountain' or 'running tap'), put up unassembled in packaging for retail sale. Assembled, the various plastic components (a base approximately 15 cm in diameter, incorporating a lighting system and an electric motor with a power-supply cable, and equipped with a switch, three basins, various pipe-connections, a tap, small figure of a dancer, artificial flowers and foliage, etc.) form one or other of the articles depicted (height between 30 cm and 40 cm). | 3926 40 00 |
2015/803 of 19.05.2015 (OJ L128, 23.05.2015, p. 4) | An article in the shape of a human skull made of plastics, measuring approximately 9 x 11 x 7 cm. It contains flashing light emitting diodes (LEDs) that are powered by a battery and are embedded in the eye sockets of the skull and can be turned on and off using a switch at the base of the article. | 3926 40 00 | |
981/98 of 7.5.1998 (OJ L 137, 9.5.1998, p. 9) |
1 | Photo-album, with a binding 12 cm wide, 16,5 cm long and 5,8 cm thick, composed of a cardboard base coated with cellular plastic, thin cardboard, coloured paper and plastic foil, and sixty plastic leaves with transparent-plastic pockets which are glued inside to the binding. | 3926 90 92 |
1218/1999 of 14.6.1999 (OJ L 148, 15.6.1999, p. 9) |
1 | Garden-canopy, of dimensions 3 x 3 m, consisting of a woven fabric made from polyethylene strip less than 5 mm wide, coated on both sides with plastic visible to the naked eye. The article is presented with metal uprights for the framework, and tensioning-devices for fixing it to the ground. | 3926 90 92 |
1201/2001 of 18.6.2001 (OJ L 163, 20.6.2001, p. 8) |
2nd. | Article, approximately 109 cm long, 45 cm wide and 15 cm deep, made from sheets of non-cellular plastic. The article has one transparent side, a full zip-closure, and folds out to form a large box-shape. It is used, for example, for the storage of clothing or household linen. | 3926 90 92 |
738/2000 of 7.4.2000 (OJ L 87, 8.4.2000, p. 10) |
2 | Flexible product, for the temperature-controlled distribution of gases or liquids, consisting of the following components (from the inside outwards): a bundle of flexible plastic tubes for transporting the fluid; an electrical heating-strip separated from the transport-tubes by an aluminium plate; a layer of aluminium foil covering the transport-tubes, the heating-strip and the aluminium plate; an insulated electric cable for controlling the heating-strip; a layer of fleece material; and a flexible outer covering of synthetic material. The product is presented in lengths without fittings. | 3926 90 97 |
471/2002 of 15.3.2002 (OJ L 75, 16.3.2002, p. 13) |
2 | Article made of cellular plastic, approximately 4 mm thick (measuring approximately 20 x 24 cm), nearly rectangular because of its rounded corners, covered on one side with a layer of approximately 0,2 mm of single-coloured knitted textile fabric (mouse-pads and similar articles). | 3926 90 97 |
687/2002 of 22.4.2002 (OJ L 106, 23.4.2002, p. 3) |
1 | Product (of dimensions L x W x H = 52,5 x 25 x 4,5 cm), designed to hold surgical instruments, consisting of two separate parts of moulded and perforated plastic. The two parts are held together, one on top of the other, with metallic clips on each side. The upper part has two metallic handles. The lower part incorporates compartments, specially shaped to hold the instruments. The product is presented without the surgical instruments. | 3926 90 97 |
2014/2002 of 7.11.2002 (OJ L 311, 14.11.2002, p. 11) |
Epoxide resin in the form of cylindrical tablets, the length of which does not exceed the diameter, composed of compressed powder. These plastics are used for the encapsulation of semiconductors and electronic integrated circuits. | 3926 90 97 | |
652/2007 of 8. 6. 2007 (OJ L 153, 14. 6. 2007, p.6) |
1 | A replica of a specific mobile phone (a socalled 'mock-up'). The product is made mainly of plastics. It has no electronic components. Its size, design and weight are identical to the characteristics of the specific model. It is equipped with buttons allowing the feeling of pushing real buttons. | 3926 90 97 |
1417/2007of 28.11.2007 (OJ L 316 , 04.12.2007 p. 4) | 1 | Set for nail decorating consisting of: 48 false nailsa small tube of gluea nail filea manicure stick anddecorating stickers for the nails. The false nails are moulded plastic and are present in a variety of sizes. The set is put up for retail sale. | 3926 90 97 |
1417/2007of 28.11.2007 (OJ L 316 , 04.12.2007 p.4) | 2 | Moulded plastic false nails. They are designed to be bound to the natural nail using an acrylic bonding solution. They are packaged in quantities of 50, of the same size. | 3926 90 97 |
475/2009 of 5.6.2009 (OJ L 144, 9.6.2009, p. 11) |
Article made of plastics (a so-called 'cable seal') with overall dimensions of approximately 1 cm (diameter) x 0,8 cm (length). The article has a central hole, and is fitted with ribs on the outer surface. It is designed for use with electrical connectors in motor vehicles, to protect the electrical connection from dust, moisture, oil and other elements ordinarily found in the environment of a car. | 3926 90 97 | |
594/2009 of 8.7.2009 (OJ L 178, 9.7.2009, p. 14) |
2 | Fluoroelastomer O-ring seals (vinylidene fluoride and hexafluoropropylene copolymer). The constituent material of this product (vinylidene fluoride and hexafluoropropylene copolymer) displays the stretching and recovery properties of elastomers, but cannot be vulcanised with sulphur. In order to crosslink, it requires basic compounds or certain peroxides. | 3926 90 97 |
674/2009 of 22.7.2009 (OJ L 196, 28.7.2009, p. 3) |
Plastic figurine used as a dispenser, with a height of 23 cm, having a round-shaped corpus with arms and legs constituting a football player, which is fixed on a pedestal. The product is destined to be filled with sweets. By moving one arm, the sweets come out through a round opening in the corpus. | 3926 90 97 | |
875/2011 of 27.7.2011 (OJ L 227, 2.9.2011, p. 9) |
1 | Underwater housing for digital cameras made mainly of plastic within the meaning of Note 1 to Chapter 39. The product consists of two transparent halves which are fitted with manually operated push buttons, control or operating knobs made of metal, and frames with clasps made of plastic. It can also be fitted with an anti-glare screen shield, a mount and an extra handgrip. The watertight housing has a hollow at the front to fit the lens, which consists of a glass window and metal surround with an internal thread for ancillary lenses. At the back there is a padded space for the camera viewfinder. The product is intended to hold a complete digital camera and enables the camera to be used in damp or dusty surroundings. | 3926 90 97 |
535/2013 of 7.6.2013 (OJ L 160, 12.6.2013, p. 2) |
1 | Half of a housing made of plastics, with various slots and fixings, specially moulded and shaped to clip on the other half, measuring approximately 7,5 x 5 cm. The article is designed to be used as a part of a cover of a locking mechanism of a safety seat belt buckle used, for example, in motor vehicles. | 3926 90 97 |
722/2013 of 25.7.2013 (OJ L 202, 27.7.2013, p. 6) |
A wheel with a diameter of approximately 20 cm and a width of approximately 5 cm, consisting of a plastic rim and a solid plastic tyre. The rim has a central hole and a ball bearing made of carbon steel. The wheel can be mounted on various articles such as carriages for disabled persons, walkers/ rollators and hospital beds. | 3926 90 97 | |
758/2014 of 10.7.2014 (OJ L 207, 15.7.2014, p.4) | A circular product made of silicone with a diameter of approximately 10 to 15 mm and a height of approximately 3 mm. The product has a cross-shaped incision in the centre. It has no mechanical components. The product is used together with a screw-on cap with a lid. It is placed inside the screw-on cap and the whole is screwed over a bottle- neck. The product prevents a semi-liquid substance, for example, mayonnaise or ketchup, flowing out of a bottle when the latter is turned upside down. When the lid is open and the bottle is turned upside down, the substance is dispensed via the cross-shaped incision if manual pressure is applied to the bottle. | 3926 90 97 | |
2015/2253 of 2.12.2015 (OJ L 321, 5.12.2015, p. 6) | An article (so-called 'draught excluder' or 'door bottom seal') consisting of an
aluminium base with dimensions of approximately 100 x 3 cm and plastic bristles of a
length of approximately 2 cm and with a cross-sectional dimension of more than 1 mm
attached to the base. The base is covered with a self-adhesive film on one side. The base is to be affixed to the bottom of a door by the adhesive film. The bristles bridge the gap between the underside of the door and the floor, preventing the entry of a current of air, dirt, etc. |
3926 90 97 | |
2017/182 of 27.2.2017 (OJ L 29, 3.2.2017, p. 13) | Articles (so-called 'thumb grips for a game console controller') measuring
approximately 20 mm in diameter and 6 mm in height made of elastic silicone (plastics)
with an anti-slip surface. They are equipped with a self-adhesive aluminium profile, cut to the design of the support. These grips are used as caps on the joysticks of a game console controller. The thumb grip caps are intended to protect the game controller against the sweat, wear and tear caused by intensive use, as well as to prevent fingers from slipping off the controller, by means of their anti-slip surface. |
3926 90 97 | |
2017/1168 of 26.6.2017 (OJ L 170, 1.7.2017, p. 53) |
An article (so-called 'steering wheel cover') made of plastics (polyvinyl chloride
(PVC)), forming a circle with a diameter of 38 cm. The article is designed to cover the steering wheel of a motor vehicle in order to improve its appearance, to protect the steering wheel against the sweat, wear and tear caused by its use and to protect hands from hot and cold extremes. |
3926 90 97 | |
603/2018 of 12.4.2018 (OJ L 101, 20.4.2018, p. 18-21) |
An inflatable cushion of plastics (so-called 'wheelchair cushion'), measuring
approximately 40 x 40 cm, consisting of two rectangular interconnected chambers filled
with air. Each chamber contains an air filled bag of plastics covered with a thin layer of
silicone. The cushion is adjustable according to the degree to which the two chambers are inflated, which causes the position of the bag of plastics in each chamber to shift when the user is sitting on the cushion. The cushion has a removable anti-slip cover of textile materials that has two 'velcro'-type straps attached to its underside. The article is intended to prevent the user developing pressure sores. It provides a relieving effect on the seat bones and improves the comfort of the user. |
3926 90 97 | |
542/90 of 1.3.1990 (OJ L 56, 3.3.1990, p. 5) |
2 | Chloroprene (chlorobutadiene) rubber, in one of the forms mentioned in Note 3(b) to Chapter 40, containing very small amounts of talc. The talc is added to the surface as an anti-tacking agent. | 4002 49 00 |
1703/2000 of 31.7.2000 (OJ L 195, 1.8.2000, p. 22) |
2 | Synthetic material, composed of block copolymers of styrene-ethylene/propylene-styrene or of styrene-ethylene/butylene-styrene, with a low degree of unsaturation (iodine-value between 4 and 7). | 4002 99 90 |
896/2011 of 2.9.2011 (OJ L 231, 8.9.2011, p. 7) |
1 | Retro-reflective tapes intended for application to safety clothing and uniforms by means of a heat activated adhesive. The product has a thickness of 140-155 mm (protective paper liner not included) and is composed of the following layers: - 60-70 mm of micro glass balls with a metallic mirror on one side, bound with an elastomer of poly(butadiene-co-acrylonitrile) (the thickness of that elastomer is 15-20 mm), - 80-85 mm of a heat activated polyester adhesive, and - a protective paper liner to be removed before use. The product is presented in individual strips or in rolls. | 4008 21 90 |
442/2000 of 25.2.2000 (OJ L 54, 26.2.2000, p. 33) |
1 | Track-chains, of vulcanised rubber reinforced with embedded metal bars and steel wires. They are used on e.g. construction-machinery, snowgroomers or agricultural machines. The metal parts serve only to reinforce and guide the track-chain. | 4016 99 91 |
400/2012 of 7. 5. 2012 (OJ L 124, 11. 5. 2012, p. 13) |
1 | An article having the shape of an almost square, stylised elephant, measuring approximately 32 x 48 x 24 cm, consisting of two halves that are made of moulded, rigid plastic. It has four wheels and a removable shoulder strap that can also be used to pull the article along. The two halves are held together by an integral hinged seam across the bottom and by two security snap closures at its opposite ends, which stop the article from opening immediately all the way. The hinges allow the two halves of the article to lie flat on the ground when opened. One half of the article is fitted with two textile straps forming an X when linked by a clip. It also has a small flat textile pocket attached on the inside. The other half of the article is fitted with a separation flap of textile material holding one flat pocket with a zip closure. The separation flap is fixed to the side of the article, where the hinges are, and can be attached to the opposite side of that half. (suitcase). | 4202 12 50 |
2017/1234 of 3.7.2017 (OJ L 177, 8.7.2017, p. 29) |
A composite product consisting of the following components: - a vertical aluminium column approximately 95 cm high, with an axle at the base and a plastic wheel affixed at either end of the axle, - a foldable, horizontal aluminium board designed for standing on, with a plastic wheel affixed at the far end with a brake mechanism attached to it, - a suitcase with an outer surface made of moulded plastic material, measuring approximately 55 cm x 30 cm x 20 cm and fixed to the vertical column by clamps which can be opened. The product is intended for use by anyone aged 8 or over. Its function as a means of transporting goods can be combined with its function as a scooter or, it can be drawn or pushed along in order to transport the s uitcase on the wheels, when the horizontal board is up. |
4202 12 50 | |
324/2007 of 23.3.2007 (OL L 85/5, 27.3.2007 p. 5) |
1 | Three items put together for retail sale, comprising: | |
a. a bag made of transparent plastic sheeting with a textile handle and 'Velcro' fastening; | 4202 22 10 | ||
b. a children's book with a paperboard cover, consisting of a 16 page story in the narrative, illustrated with coloured pictures on each page; | 4901 99 00 | ||
c. a doll representing a human being, wearing an outfit corresponding to the story described in the book. The doll is not fixed to the book and therefore it is possible to play with the doll without using the book. | 9503 00 21 | ||
56/2009 of 21.1.2009 (OJ L 19, 23.1.2009, p. 3) |
Bag made of fabric woven from polypropylene strip of less than 5 mm wide, cuboid in shape and measuring approx. 54,5 cm x 74 cm x 25 cm, with two strong handles made of the same material sewn on the two long sides of the bag, each going down to underneath the bottom of the bag. The bag is visibly coated with plastic sheeting on both surfaces, there are no compartments inside, and it can be closed on the top with a zip fastener. The edges are reinforced with a sewn-on band. (container similar to a shopping bag). | 4202 92 19 | |
1228/2013 of 28.11.2013 (OJ L 322, 3.12.2013, p. 6) |
1 | The article is a rectangular box made of solid paperboard with an outer surface of plastic sheeting not exceeding half of the total thickness. The box is constructed like a chest holding a single drawer which pulls away from inside the box and is designed to display a bottle when the box is opened. The drawer is made to hold a bottle of wine of specific dimensions. On the inside of the drawer a circular button is fixed to one wall and a ring-like structure is fixed to the opposite wall. The ring-like structure is designed to enclose the top of a bottle and the circular button to fit into the hollow part of the bottom of a bottle. Moreover, inside the drawer a paperboard sleeve is fixed to the side wall to hold a leaflet. | 4202 92 19 |
2015/2351 of 14.12.2015 (OJ L 331, 17.12.2015, p. 3) | A gardening kit presented in a plastic packing consisting of the following articles: | ||
a) 1 bag, made of woven textile fabric, with an outer surface of textile materials with 1 large internal and 4 smaller external pockets, | 4202 22 90 | ||
b) 1 pair of gloves, made primarily of woven textile fabric with a minor coating of cellular plastics on the palm side, | 6216 00 00 | ||
c) 1 pair of pruning shears of base metal, | 8201 50 00 | ||
d) 1 gardening trowel of base metal, | 8201 10 00 | ||
e) 12 plastic marker sticks, | 3926 90 97 | ||
f) 1 pencil with a lead of graphite. | 9609 10 10 | ||
3471/89 of 17.11.1989 (OJ L 337, 21.11.1989, p. 8) |
Rucksack made of woven fabric (100 % synthetic fibres), to which has been sewn a lightweight garment of woven fabric, of the anorak-type, which can be folded up into one of the three compartments of the rucksack. | 4202 92 91 | |
2855/2000 of 27.12.2000 (OJ L 332, 28.12.2000, p. 41) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
1 | Toilet-set, distributed by airlines to passengers (during the flight, or at
destination if the luggage is not available), consisting of a rectangular fabric-bag
(approximately 25 x 16 x 12 cm) coated inside with plastic and containing small
quantities, for limited use, of products such as: - 1 bottle (40 ml) liquid soap; - 1 bottle (40 ml) body milk; - 1 bottle (40 ml) eau de cologne; - 1 disposable razor, shaving-cream and after-shave, all in one case; - 1 toothbrush; - 1 tube of toothpaste; - 1 shoe-cleaner; - 1 sewing-kit; - 3 paperboard nail files; - 1 plastic comb; - 10 paper tissues; - 1 clothes-brush; - 1 plastic shoehorn; - 1 pair of knitted slippers (100 % cotton) without soles; - 1 toilet-glove of terry towelling or similar (100 % cotton); - 1 pair of knitted unisex pyjamas, consisting of a T-shirt (50 % polyester, 50 % acrylic) and a pair of shorts (100 % acrylic). |
4202 92 91 3401 20 90 3304 99 00 3303 00 90 9605 00 00 9603 21 00 3306 10 00 3405 10 00 9605 00 00 6805 20 00 9615 11 00 4818 20 10 9603 90 91 3926 90 97 6115 95 00 6302 60 00 6109 90 20 6104 63 00 |
2015/2318 of 8.12.2015 (OJ L 328 of 12.12.2015, p.57) | An article (so-called 'arm sleeve for smartphone') made predominantly of textile
material. It consists of a case for a mobile phone with an elasticated band, which serves
to attach it to the upper arm. The back of the case has a slit-type opening into which a mobile phone can be inserted. There is a rectangular transparent panel made of plastic sheeting on the front side of the article. The transparent panel is framed by cellular film of plastic, which also covers the front of the short end of the band. The back of the article and the fixed band consist of rubberised textile fabric (outer layers of textile material with a layer of cellular rubber between them). A Velcro-type strip is attached to the band, which is fed through two holes at the short end, and can thus be adjusted to fit the upper arm of the wearer. |
4202 92 98 | |
781/2006 of 24.5.2006 (OJ L 137, 25.5.2006, p. 15) |
1 | Solid paperboard box with separate lid (without hinges or fasteners), both components with an outer surface of paper. The box measures 5,5 cm (length) x 4,5 cm (width) x 3 cm (height). There is a decorative textile ribbon on the lid. There is a 1 cm thick removable synthetic sponge fitted in the box. The sponge is of cellular plastic the upper surface of which is covered with a layer of textile material covered with textile flock imitation pile. In the centre, there is a semi-circular incision, cut right through the sponge, which is designed to hold an article of jewellery, e.g. a ring. (jewellery box). | 4202 99 00 |
2518/98 of 23.11.1998 (OJ L 315, 25.11.1998, p. 3) |
1 | Article (organiser) of approximate dimensions: 10,5 cm wide, 14 cm long and 4 cm thick. It has a leather cover and comprises: a leather closing-strap with push-button, a leather pen-holder, three pockets for holding paper, four pockets for holding credit-cards, a fold-out pocket of transparent plastic, and a pocket with a zip. The cover is for regular use. The cover has a ring-binder mechanism for holding replaceable inner pages: a calendar for daily, weekly and yearly use, a register for telephone-numbers, eight plastic pockets for credit-cards, and cardboard dividers. | 4205 00 90 |
2087/92 of 22.7.1992 (OJ L 208, 24.7.1992, p. 24) |
2 | Beams of oak wood, cracked for the most part, of a length of 255 to 260 cm, a width of 26 to 28 cm, and a thickness of 15 to 17 cm, merely sawn on all sides, not impregnated and without holes. The form and dimensions of these beams correspond to those given in Notice No 863 of the International Union of Railways (UIC). | 4406 10 00 |
442/91 of 25.2.1991 (OJ L 52, 27.2.1991, p. 11) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Round coniferous timber, milled to a constant diameter along the entire length, cut across the grain, with one end which has been pointed, of the kind used in horticultural landscaping for the construction of garden fencing, enclosures, screens etc. | 4407 10 98 |
1509/97 of 30.7.1997 (OJ L 204, 31.7.1997, p. 8) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
1 | Door-facing, of fibreboard of a density exceeding 0,8 g/cm3, primed, moulded to the shape and style of a traditional internal panel-door. This door-facing is for fixing to a door inside. | 4411 92 90 |
1199/2005 of 22.7.2005 (OJ L 195, 27.7.2005, p. 3) |
1 | Flooring panel: the surface is a photographic image of wood on paper (simulating a parquet panel), with an overlay of melamine resin; the core is made of fibreboard of wood, of a density exceeding 0,8 g/cm3, and is tongued and grooved ('lock system'); the base is made of impregnated paper. | 4411 92 90 |
3829/86 of 15.12.1986 (OJ L 356, 17.12.1986, p. 5) amended by Reg. 2080/91 |
Seven-ply panel, from 1 981 to 2 400 mm long, from 762 to 1 220 mm wide, and about 44 mm thick, consisting of a blockboard-type core between two panels of three-ply plywood; the seven-ply panel, which has two long edges (possibly veneered) and one or both short edges possibly veneered consisting primarily of a single piece of timber known as a 'lipping', has not undergone any further working. | 4412 | |
1128/2012 of 1.26.11.2012 (OJ L 331, 1.12.2012, p.15) |
1 | A panel (so-called "waterproof plywood") made of thirteen sheets of wood glued together with a glue resistant to boiling water. The sheets are disposed so that the grains of successive layers are at an angle. The inner sheets are less than 2 mm thick. The two outer sheets are less than 1 mm thick and are made of poplar covered with a polymer coating for insulation. The panel's density is of 0,5 g/cm 3 . The panel is used in construction, for example, for concrete shuttering. | 4412 32 10 |
309/2010 of 9.4.2010 (OJ L 94, 15.4.2010, p. 25) |
A three-layered fir wood panel with overall dimensions of 1 000 x 500 x 27 mm. The outer layers are 8,5 mm thick and consist of timber pieces glued edge-to-edge running parallel to one another. The core layer, perpendicularly placed to the vein of the outer layers, is 10 mm thick and consists of timber pieces (blocks/laths) glued edge-to-edge running parallel to one another. The outer layers and the edges are coated with resin. | 4412 94 90 | |
1199/2005 of 22.7.2005 (OJ L 195, 27.7.2005, p. 3) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Flooring panel composed of three layers of wood (total thickness of 7 mm): the top layer is made of two rows of strips of oak with a thickness of 0,6 mm; the middle layer is made of high-density fibreboard, and is tongued and grooved ('lock system'); the base layer is made of coniferous wood (thickness 0,6 mm). | 4412 99 40 |
2017/1983 of 27.10.2017 (OJ L 287, 4.11.2017, p. 1) |
An article in a form of an unworked board with a width of approximately 125 cm, a
thickness of approximately 7,5 cm and a length of approximately 2 000 cm. It is made by
gluing together veneer layers of spruce, pine or mixtures of both types of wood layers. The veneer layers are positioned in such a way that the direction of the wood fibres is the same in all layers. Some layers may also be positioned perpendicularly. The individual layers are bonded together by a phenol-formaldehyde adhesive during a pressing operation at high temperature. Edges and ends of the surface are coated with wax. The veneer layers of wood used to manufacture the article have an initial thickness of 2,8 to 3,2 mm and a density of 445 kg/m3 (spruce veneer) and 500 kg/m3 (pine veneer). Following the pressing process (with a pressure of 2,8 N/mm2), the individual pressed layers in the final product have a thickness of approximately 2,75 mm and the density of the final product is typically between 540 kg/m3 (spruce veneer) and 620 kg/m3 (pine veneer). |
4412 99 85 | |
1199/2005 of 22.7.2005 (OJ L 195, 27.7.2005, p. 3) |
3 | Flooring panel composed of three layers of solid wood (total thickness of 14 mm): the top layer is made of three rows of strips of oak with a thickness of 3 mm; the middle layer (which is tongued and grooved) and the base layer are made of coniferous wood. | 4418 72 00 |
810/83 of 5.4.1983 (OJ L 90, 8.4.1983, p. 11) amended by Reg. 2080/91 |
5 | Painted wooden money-box, in the form of a stylised figure of a child about 16 cm high, consisting of a cylindrical container with a slot for inserting coins and surmounted by a wooden peg which can be taken out to remove the coins and which is secured to three spheres representing the arms and nodding head. | 4420 10 |
1655/2005 of 10.10.2005 (OJ L266, 11.10.2005, p. 50 |
1 | An unassembled article in the form of a reduced-size greenhouse, so-called 'mini-greenhouse', with approximate dimensions of 50 cm (length), 24 cm (width) and 25 cm (height). The frame is made of wood, the floor is in the form of a metal grill and the enclosing element is made of plastic. When assembled, the upper part of the 'minigreenhouse' can be opened. | 4421 90 98 |
774/2011 of 2.8.2011 (OJ L 201, 4.8.2011, p. 6) |
A product in the form of a set put up for retail sale, consisting of: - a wooden receptacle, of a square form and with a square-shaped recess to hold a candle without any fixture such as a spike for holding candles, and - a candle. The candle is shaped to be placed tightly and securely in the recess of the wooden receptacle. | 4421 90 98 | |
198/2009 of 10.3.2009 (OJ L 70, 14.3.2009, p. 6) |
Article measuring approximately 4 m x 30 m, made up of woven strands of plant material (sea-grass). The weft consists of two intertwined twisted strands of plant material (sea-grass) of a kind used primarily for stuffing cushions. The warp consists of one single twisted strand of spun natural textile fibres of plant material (sea-grass fibres) (the strand measures more than 20 000 decitex). The article has a cellular rubber backing. (sea-grass floor covering.) | 4601 94 10 | |
650/90 of 16.3.1990 (OJ L 71, 17.3.1990, p. 11) |
1 | Crown-shaped articles of different diameters (7 cm to 35 cm) consisting of whole osier canes, peeled and then twisted and interlaced. | 4602 19 90 |
442/91 of 25.2.1991 (OJ L 52, 27.2.1991, p. 11) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
3 | Crown-shaped articles consisting of osier canes, partly decorated with artificial flowers, artificial leaves, ribbons or small natural representations(such as a butterfly or chicken). | 4602 19 90 |
2141/89 of 14.7.1989 (OJ L 205, 18.7.1989, p. 22) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Lightweight panel of rectangular or square shape, made up of a layer of expanded polystyrene covered on both sides by a sheet of white kaolin-coated paper not containing fibres obtained by a mechanical process and of a weight of more than 150 g/m2. The total thickness of the paper is at least 10 % of the total thickness of the article. | 4810 14 00 arba 4810 19 00 |
2017/209 of 2.2.2017 (OJ L 33, 8.2.2017, p. 16) |
Three items packaged together for retail sale: a) a notepad consisting of approximately 75 blank sheets of paper (the rear sheet contains contact details where replacement notepads can be obtained) measuring approximately 8 x 14 cm. The sheets are bound by glue at the top, and are perforated to allow individual sheets to be removed. The back and a small part of the front are covered in cardboard; b) a notepad holder measuring approximately 32 x 10 cm, made of plastic sheeting reinforced with cardboard on the inside. The cardboard part of the notepad is inserted into an incision in the holder. The holder, which can be folded to cover the notepad, also includes a pocket of transparent plastics in the upper part and a loop of elasticated textile materials to hold a ballpoint pen; c) a thin ballpoint pen of plastic that is approximately 10 cm long is inserted into the textile loop. |
4820 10 30 | |
2338/96 of 5.12.1996 (OJ L 318, 7.12.1996, p. 3) |
1 | Coloured printed book, with a cardboard cover of dimensions 29,5 x 28,7 cm and fifty-four pages of dimensions 14 x 28 cm containing text and several illustrations. A blister-pack of dimensions 14 x 25 cm and containing various articles (e.g. magnet, plastic propeller, wire, light bulb) is glued to the inside of the back cover. The texts, illustrations and articles can be used for simple physics experiments (e.g. optics, magnetism and electricity). | 4901 99 00 |
2338/96 of 5.12.1996 (OJ L 318, 7.12.1996, p. 3) |
2 | Coloured printed book, with a cardboard cover of dimensions 29,5 x 28,7 cm and sixty-four pages of dimensions 14 x 28 cm containing illustrated instructions on how to apply make-up and to make costumes and accessories. A blister-pack, of dimensions 14 x 25 cm and containing six skin-paints, a simple paint-brush, a small round sponge, a narrow synthetic moustache and two plastic monster-eyes, is glued to the inside of the back cover. | 4901 99 00 |
618/96 of 3.4.1996 (OJ L 88, 5.4.1996, p. 3) |
1 | Monthly astrology-magazine, consisting of a single rolled-up sheet of paper of dimensions 79 x 505 mm, printed on both sides, and containing horoscopes (daily and monthly) and lucky numbers for games of chance, whether or not illustrated. The rolled-up magazine is protected by a tube of transparent plastic.Every month, four such magazines (identical in wording, illustration and colour) are put on sale, together, in a printed-cardboard presentation-pack illustrated in colour, with the indication of the relevant month. The presentation-pack is subdivided into twelve boxes, one for each sign of the zodiac. | 4902 90 00 |
618/96 of 3.4.1996 (OJ L 88, 5.4.1996, p. 3) |
2 | Children's picture-book (30 x 40 cm), made up of four thick cardboard pages and illustrated with pictures on a Christmas theme. The inside-pages include coloured Christmas pictures and musical and vocal scores on every double page. The last page (which serves as the cover), 1 cm thick, is illustrated on the recto with a Christmas tree decorated with multicoloured baubles, each containing a bulb. This page contains a tiny loudspeaker and an electronic module which triggers off the tunes and flashes the bulbs, when a key is pressed. | 4903 00 00 |
2518/98 of 23.11.1998 (OJ L 315, 25.11.1998, p. 3) |
2 | Children's colouring-book, consisting of a set with the following components: a booklet with removable cards which show the pictures to be made, as well as short instructions for use, ten plastic bottles containing coloured sand, a plastic pocket containing several coloured envelopes and cards (the cards have an adhesive layer in the design to be coloured with sand, protected by removable top-layer strips), and a printed cardboard cover to which the above items are glued. | 4903 00 00 |
859/2014 of 5.8.2014 (OJ L 235, 8.8.2014, p. 4) |
1 | Article consisting of a calendar of the perpetual type and a statuette of plastic in the form of an angel. The angel is sitting on a pedestal of plastics. The calendar is inserted in the pedestal and consists of wooden blocks and plates with the names of the months and the numbers of the days printed on them. The article is approximately 16 cm high. The statuette accounts for half of its height but is less in volume than the calendar-part of the article. | 4910 00 00 |
2016/934 of 8.6.2016 (OJ L 155, 14.6.2016, p.13) | A product consisting of the following components, packed as a set: - A rectangular cut-out (approx. 14 x 21 cm) made of a plastic film of two layers, printed on the front with black-and-white motifs. The cut-out is fitted with a self-adhesive strip on the back. From this cut-out, six pre-cut, raised stickers (the top plastic film is in relief) can be peeled off. - Three porous-tipped felt pens in different colours. The felt pens are packed together in a small plastic package. The stickers are to be coloured in with the felt pens and then used for decoration purposes. |
4911 91 00 | |
1440/2007 of 5.12.2007 (OJ L 322 , 07/12/2007 p. 10) | 2 | Printed page of advertising, of A4 format, partially or completely folded. The page is covered under the fold with a sample of perfume in the form of microcapsules, a paste or a powder. The fold is heat-sealed.The fold can be lifted to reveal the sample of perfume in a quantity insufficient to give fragrance when rubbed onto the wrists.The product is not intended for retail sale. It is intended to be placed within magazines and similar articles printed with images and text designed to advertise a specific perfume. | 4911 10 90 |
2087/92 of 22.7.1992 (OJ L 208, 24.7.1992, p. 24) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
3 | Publication containing information about castles in Belgium, Luxembourg and the Netherlands, and their suitability for sightseeing, receptions and conferences, and the availability of hotels, restaurants, apartments, golf courses and tourist attractions. The publication includes simple maps showing the location of the castles. | 4911 10 90 |
1111/2012 of 23.11.2012 (OJ L 329, 29.11.2012, p. 7) |
1 | An article in the form of nine cut-out printed stickers of paperboard, featuring various insects and other small creatures and decorated with artificial stones and glitter, on a sheet of plastic measuring approximately 30 x 30 cm. Each sticker is fitted with a self-adhesive strip and can be fixed to a chosen surface. It is possible subsequently to move the sticker to another surface. The stickers are used for decoration. | 4911 91 00 |
2015/2254 of 2.12.2015 (OJ L 321, 5.12.2015, p. 8) | A hard-covered bound article (so-called 'photo bookf') made of paper measuring approximately 21 cm x 31 cm, with full-colour printed personalised photographs and a short text referring to the activities, events, persons, etc. shown in the respective photographs. | 4911 91 00 | |
2338/96 of 5.12.1996 (OJ L 318, 7.12.1996, p. 3) |
3 | Reference-work used for the selection, specification and control of colours in the fields of fashion, architecture and interior design, consisting of a ring-binder of cardboard coated with printed plastic film. The ring-binder contains ninety-five colour-charts, an index and pages with instructions for use (in six languages), on paper. Each colour-chart consists of thirty-five perforated cards, each with different shades of a particular colour which is identified by a code. Each shade is also identified by a specific code. | 4911 99 00 |
2518/98 of 23.11.1998 (OJ L 315, 25.11.1998, p. 3) |
3 | Manual on cross-stitch embroidery, in the form of a folding cardboard pamphlet or of a carboard-covered booklet with paper pages inside. The cover is colour-printed and bears the price, the name of the author and the number of the series. Inside the pamphlet or on the pages of the booklet, there are mostly illustrations giving designs for the cross-stitch work, with some text to indicate the yarn and colours to be used, along with general explanations. | 4911 99 00 |
961/2000 of 5.5.2000 (OJ L 109, 6.5.2000, p. 16) |
1 | Dyed woven cross-twill fabric (60 % cotton, 40 % polyester), blue in colour, of a weight of 300 g/m2 and of a width of approximately 150 cm. It has a faded-green printed inscription showing a company logo, measuring approximately 4 cm in height and approximately 2 cm in width, situated approximately 13 cm from the selvedge and repeated at approximately 20-cm intervals along both edges. | 5211 32 00 |
1966/94 of 28.7.1994 (OJ L 198, 30.7.1994, p. 103) |
1 | Woven fabric (93 % polyester, 7 % viscose) in the piece, printed with decorative motifs of different colours, with added sequins and a number of flowers of synthetic woven textile material. The sequins are glued to the fabric. The flower-motifs are few in number (approximately, six to an area of 1,7 x 1,15 m) and are sewn loosely on to the fabric. | 5407 54 00 |
2174/93 of 2.8.1993 (OJ L 195, 4.8.1993, p. 20) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
Multiple (folded) yarn, bleached, of synthetic staple fibres (100 % polyester), with a final Z-twist, dressed and put up on a support, of a weight of 1 200 g, including the support. | 5509 22 00 | |
961/2000 of 5.5.2000 (OJ L 109, 6.5.2000, p. 16) |
2 | Dyed woven fabric (100 % polyester), light blue in colour, of a width of approximately 150 cm and made of staple fibres. The fabric has a yellow-coloured printed inscription ('DYED AND FINISHED IN THE UNITED KINGDOM A MEMBER OF THE EEC') measuring approximately 0,4 cm in height and situated approximately 1,2 cm from the selvedge. | 5512 19 90 |
961/2000 of 5.5.2000 (OJ L 109, 6.5.2000, p. 16) |
3 | Dyed woven cross-twill fabric (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton), blue in colour, of a weight of 245 g/m2, of a width of approximately 150 cm and made of staple fibres. It has a black printed inscription showing a company logo, measuring approximately 1,5 cm in height and approximately 3 cm in width, situated approximately 4,5 cm from the selvedge on one side and approximately 9 cm on the other side, and repeated at approximately 28-cm intervals along both edges. | 5514 22 00 |
961/2000 of 5.5.2000 (OJ L 109, 6.5.2000, p. 16) |
4 | Dyed woven fabric (65 % polyester, 35 % viscose), black in colour, of a weight of 320 to 340 g/m2, of a width of approximately 150 cm and made of staple fibres. The fabric has a yellow-coloured printed inscription ('...SHED IN THE UNITED KINGDOM A MEMBER OF THE EEC') measuring approximately 0,4 cm in height and situated approximately 0,5 cm from the selvedge, on one edge. | 5515 11 90 |
961/2000 of 5.5.2000 (OJ L 109, 6.5.2000, p. 16) |
5 | Dyed woven fabric (65 % polyester, 35 % viscose), black in colour, of a weight of 320 g/m2, of a width of approximately 150 cm and made of staple fibres. The fabric has a yellow-coloured printed inscription ('DYED AND FINISHED IN THE UNITED KINGDOM A MEMBER OF THE EEC') measuring approximately 0,4 cm in height and situated approximately 0,5 cm from the selvedge, repeated at approximately 17-cm intervals along both edges. | 5515 11 90 |
384/2013 of 22.4.2013 (OJ L 117, 27.4.2013, p. 7) |
1 | An article having the shape of a cylinder with a diameter of approximately 7 mm and a length of approximately 130 mm, consisting of an outer layer of paper that holds the following components in place: - three filters of cellulose acetate fibres with activated carbon (C), - four filters of cellulose acetate fibres also containing impregnated fibres (impregnated with an agglutinating substance that does not penetrate into the inner layers of the fibres) (I), - two filters of cellulose acetate fibres (A), - four components of flavourful oriental tobacco of the kind used in cigarettes (T). (…). The article is designed to be cut up and to be used in the production of filter cigarettes. It is not evident from the objective characteristics of the article how it will be cut up. | 5601 22 10 |
510/96 of 22.3.1996 (OJ L 76, 26.3.1996, p. 7) |
Acrylic-fibre rod, weighing more than 150 g/m and of a length not exceeding 50 cm. The rod consists of very fine fibres which have been laid out parallel to each other, bonded with gum and heated in a furnace to make a rigid cylinder. The rod is intended to be cut to length and machined, to form the tips for marker-pens. | 5603 94 90 | |
1458/97 of 25.7.1997 (OJ L 199, 26.7.1997, p. 11) |
1 | Non-woven (length: 180 to 220 cm; width: 70 to 160 cm; thickness: approximately 5 cm; weight: exceeding 150 g/m2), consisting of a web of several layers of coconut-fibres assembled throughout the thickness of the web by means of a bonding-substance (latex) and heat-treatment. | 5603 94 90 |
692/2010 of 30.7.2010 (OJ L 201, 3.8.2010, p. 23) |
1 | Thick semicircular article, with overall dimensions of approximately 75 cm in length x 45 cm in width, made of a woven textile fabric of spun coconut fibres, which forms the majority of the surface, with a rubber backing. The article is surrounded by a decorative rubber border (doormat). | 5702 20 00 |
1966/94 of 28.7.1994 (OJ L 198, 30.7.1994, p. 103) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Doormat, with an external surface consisting of tufts of coconut-fibres of about 1 cm in length and inserted directly into a layer of PVC mixed with a plasticiser. | 5705 00 80 |
692/2010 of 30.7.2010 (OJ L 201, 3.8.2010, p. 23) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Thick rectangular article measuring approx. 60 cm in length x 40 cm in width, made of coconut fibres forming a pile surface. The coconut fibres are bonded to a substrate of poly(vinyl chloride), which forms the backing. The mat is surrounded by a decorative poly(vinyl chloride)-border (doormat). | 5705 00 80 |
471/2002 of 15.3.2002 (OJ L 75, 16.3.2002, p. 13) |
3 | Rectangular, approximately 4 mm thick, cellular plastic (polyurethane) (measuring approximately 20 x 21 cm), covered on one side with a layer of approximately 0,2 mm of multi-coloured printed knitted textile fabric (mouse-pads and similar articles). | 5903 20 90 |
336/2010 of 21.4.2010 (OJ L 102, 23.4.2010, p. 25) |
2 | A disc of a diameter of approximately 580 mm and a thickness of approximately 2 mm, consisting of 2 layers of synthetic felt, one of them being impregnated with a polymeric binder (polyurethane) (so-called 'poromeric pad'). The other layer has an adhesive coating protected by a detachable plastic sheet. The article is used with machines for the manufacture of silicon and semiconductor wafers. It is fitted on the carrier head of an interchangeable tool of such machines and is used to planarise/ flatten and polish the wafers. | 5911 90 90 |
1458/97 of 25.7.1997 (OJ L 199, 26.7.1997, p. 11) |
2 | Looped-pile knitted tubing, of mixed synthetic and artificial filaments treated with polyglucolethylene. The product is put up in the piece, in rolls, of about 23 m in length and 7,5 cm in width when flat. After processing, the tubing may be used as a 'damping cover' or 'damping tube' for cylinders in printing machinery. | 6001 22 00 |
1796/91 of 24.6.1991 (OJ L 160, 25.6.1991, p. 40) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
1 | Warp-knit fabric, of the kind used for the manufacture of screens for greenhouses. The warp consists of white yarn forming the loops, and translucent strips of synthetic textile material of an apparent width not exceeding 5 mm. The weft is formed of white yarn. The yarns (warp and weft) of synthetic fibre represent 54 % by weight of the fabric. The translucent strips represent 46 % by weight of the fabric. | 6005 31 90 |
1796/91 of 24.6.1991 (OJ L 160, 25.6.1991, p. 40) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
3 | Warp-knit fabric, of the kind used for the manufacture of screens for greenhouses. The warp consists of white yarn forming the loops, translucent strips of synthetic textile material of an apparent width not exceeding 5 mm, and strips of synthetic material covered with aluminium of an apparent width not exceeding 5 mm. The weft is formed of white yarn. The yarns (warp and weft) of synthetic fibre represent 50 % by weight of the fabric. The translucent strips represent 33 % by weight of the fabric. The strips of synthetic material covered with aluminium represent 17 % by weight of the fabric. | 6005 31 90 |
1796/91 of 24.6.1991 (OJ L 160, 25.6.1991, p. 40) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
2 | Warp-knit fabric, of the kind used for the manufacture of screens for greenhouses. The warp consists of white yarn forming the loops, and strips of synthetic material covered with aluminium of an apparent width not exceeding 5 mm. The weft is formed of white yarn. The yarns (warp and weft) of synthetic fibre represent 36 % by weight of the fabric. The strips of synthetic material covered with aluminium represent 64 % by weight of the fabric. | 6005 90 90 |
1611/93 of 24.6.1993 (OJ L 155, 26.6.1993, p. 9) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
1 | Pieces of tubular weft-knitted or crocheted fabric, bleached, of various textile fibres, roughly cut. These pieces are approximately 65 cm in diameter, and vary between 2,5 m and 6 m in length. The pieces, some of which are creased or wrinkled, are put up in bales. | 6006 10 00 6006 21 00 6006 31 90 6006 41 00 6006 90 00 |
989/89 of 17.4.1989 (OJ L 106, 18.4.1989, p. 25) |
For the purposes of the classification of anoraks (including ski-jackets), wind-cheaters, wind-jackets and similar articles in CN-codes 6101, 6102, 6201 and 6202, the garments must have long sleeves. | 6101 6102 6201 6202 |
|
1054/97 of 11.6.1997 (OJ L 154, 12.6.1997, p. 14) |
1 | Unlined, single-coloured knitted garment (60 % wool, 40 % polyamide blend) of a thickness of 2,3 mm, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, with a collar with lapels. It has long sleeves and a V-neckline, and opens completely at the front with a button-fastening right over left. It has pockets below the waist, and is hemmed at the base. The garment is made up of six panels (two at the front, four at the back) sewn together lengthways. It has shoulder-pads, and two vertical darts starting at the chest (jacket). | 6104 31 00 |
1054/97 of 11.6.1997 (OJ L 154, 12.6.1997, p. 14) |
2 | Unlined, single-coloured knitted garment (70 % acrylic, 30 % wool blend) of a thickness of 2,1 mm, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the waist, with a turnover collar. It has long sleeves and a V-neckline, and opens completely at the front with a button-fastening right over left. It has pockets below the waist, and is hemmed at the base. The garment is made up of six panels (two at the front, four at the back) sewn together lengthways. It has shoulder-pads, and two vertical darts starting at the chest (jacket). | 6104 33 00 |
548/89 of 28.2.1989 (OJ L 60, 3.3.1989, p. 31) amended by Reg. 2197/1999 |
1 | Lightweight, loose-fitting, knitted garment (100 % cotton) intended to cover the upper part of the body, reaching down to mid-thigh. It has a rounded, loose-fitting neckline with short loose-fitting sleeves, and is hemmed at the base of the garment. There is knitted ribbing sewn on at the sleeve-ends. The garment also has a tie-string sewn into the left seam at the waist. | 6104 42 00 |
812/89 of 21.3.1989 (OJ L 86, 31.3.1989, p. 25) amended by Reg. 2197/1999 |
1 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton) reaching down to mid-thigh. It has a rounded neckline, short loose-fitting sleeves, and side-slits of approximately 12 cm in length at the bottom of the garment. The neckline, sleeve-ends and the bottom of the garment have been finished with a sewn-on band of knitted fabric approximately 1 cm in width. | 6104 42 00 |
812/89 of 21.3.1989 (OJ L 86, 31.3.1989, p. 25) amended by Reg. 2197/1999 |
2 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton) reaching down to mid-thigh. It has a rounded neckline, short loose-fitting sleeves, and side-slits of approximately 16 cm in length at the bottom of the garment. There is a sewn-on band of knitted fabric at the neckline, the sleeve-ends and the bottom of the garment. At the front, there is a sewn-on decorative motif. | 6104 42 00 |
812/89 of 21.3.1989 (OJ L 86, 31.3.1989, p. 25) amended by Reg. 2197/1999 |
3 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton) reaching down to mid-thigh. It has a rounded neckline, short loose-fitting sleeves, and side-slits of approximately 13 cm in length at the bottom of the garment. There is a band of knitted fabric at the neckline and at the sleeve-ends. The bottom of the garment is hemmed. | 6104 42 00 |
2949/92 of 9.10.1992 (OJ L 296, 13.10.1992, p. 5) |
1 | Lightweight loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton) of one colour, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to mid-thigh. It has a rounded, loose-fitting neckline with bands sewn on, and short sleeves. It is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and base (dress). | 6104 42 00 |
1966/94 of 28.7.1994 (OJ L 198, 30.7.1994, p. 103) |
3 | Lightweight loose-fitting garment made from two different knitted printed fabrics (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to mid-thigh. It has a rounded neckline with a partial opening with button-fastening right over left, short loose-fitting sleeves, printed decorated motifs and side-slits. There is a band of knitted fabric sewn on at the neckline and at the base. | 6104 42 00 |
511/96 of 22.3.1996 (OJ L 76, 26.3.1996, p. 9) |
1 | Lightweight loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to mid-thigh. It has a rounded neckline with a ribbed edge crossing left over right, with short wide-fitting sleeves, a decoration printed on the front, and side-slits at the hemmed base. It has a detachable hood, fastened by buttons at the neck (dress). | 6104 42 00 |
1218/1999 of 14.6.1999 (OJ L 148, 15.6.1999, p. 9) |
2 | Lightweight loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to mid-thigh (total length 90 cm), covered with printed decorative motifs. It has a rounded neckline with a welt of knitted fabric applied, and short sleeves. The sleeve-ends and the base are hemmed, and there are side-slits of approximately 10 cm at the base (dress). | 6104 42 00 |
1218/1999 of 14.6.1999 (OJ L 148, 15.6.1999, p. 9) |
3 | Lightweight loose-fitting sleeveless knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the knees (total length 120 cm), covered with printed decorative motifs. It has a low rounded neckline with a welt of knitted fabric applied. The base is hemmed and has side-slits of approximately 22 cm (dress). | 6104 42 00 |
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
2 | Lightweight loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to mid-thigh (total length 96 cm), single-coloured and straigth-cut. It has a rounded loose-fitting neckline and short sleeves. It is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and at the base, and has side-slits of an approximate length of 8 cm at the base. There is some embroidery at the front (dress). | 6104 42 00 |
2855/2000 of 27.12.2000 (OJ L 332, 28.12.2000, p. 41) |
2 | Single-coloured lightweight loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to mid-thigh (total length 90 cm), straight-cut and with short sleeves, with the words 'Don't wake the sleepy lion' printed on the front and with other decorative motifs printed on the front and sleeves. It has a rounded neckline with an applied welt of knitted fabric, without an opening. The sleeve-ends and the base are hemmed (dress). | 6104 42 00 |
2855/2000 of 27.12.2000 (OJ L 332, 28.12.2000, p. 41) |
3 | Single-coloured lightweight loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to mid-thigh (total length 90 cm), straight-cut and with short sleeves, with the words 'Good Night' and a decorative motif printed on the front. It has a rounded neckline without an opening, with a semi-circular insert of contrasting colour inside at the back; there is an applied welt of material of the same contrasting colour at the sleeve-ends There is a decorative seam at the neckline and the base (dress). | 6104 42 00 |
2855/2000 of 27.12.2000 (OJ L 332, 28.12.2000, p. 41) |
4 | Striped lightweight loose-fitting knitted garment (60 % cotton, 40 % polyester), intended to cover the upper and lower parts of the body and reaching down to the knees (total length 82 cm), straight-cut and with short sleeves, with the words 'Sleep Wear' and other decorative motifs embroidered on the front, for a child of a height greater than 86 cm (commercial size greater than 86). It has a rounded neckline with an applied welt of knitted fabric, with a partial opening with button-fastening right over left. The neckline, sleeve-ends and base have an applied welt of knitted fabric with a decorative border. The base is curved and has side-slits approximately 10 cm long (dress for girls). | 6104 42 00 |
548/89 of 28.2.1989 (OJ L 60, 3.3.1989, p. 31) amended by Reg. 2197/1999 |
2 | Lightweight, loose-fitting, knitted garment (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton) intended to cover the upper part of the body, reaching down to mid-thigh. It has a rounded, loose-fitting neckline and very short loose-fitting sleeves, and is hemmed at the base of the garment. There are knitted bands sewn on at the neckline and sleeve-ends. It also has a tie-string and loops sewn into the side-seams at the waist for the tie-string to pass through. | 6104 43 00 |
548/89 of 28.2.1989 (OJ L 60, 3.3.1989, p. 31) amended by Reg. 2197/1999 |
3 | Lightweight, loose-fitting, knitted garment of 100 % synthetic textile fibres intended to cover the upper part of the body, reaching down to mid-thigh. It has a rounded, loose-fitting neckline with very short loose-fitting sleeves, and is hemmed at the base of the garment. It also has knitted bands sewn on at the neckline and sleeve-ends. The garment also has a knitted tie-string sewn into the left seam at the waist. | 6104 43 00 |
347/2001 of 19.2.2001 (OJ L 52, 22.2.2001, p. 8) |
1 | Set of four items, packaged together for retail sale and consisting of: | |
(a) child's single-coloured knitted-net garment (100 % synthetic fibres), intended to cover the lower part of the body and reaching from the waist to the upper thigh, with an elasticated waist and two layers of trim attached to the waist-band, one of knitted net and the other of knitted synthetic fibres. The edges of the garment are unhemmed. There is a knitted-net flower-motif attached to the front for decoration (skirt); | 6104 53 00 | ||
(b) plastic wand, with a metallic star and feather-trim; | 9503 90 32 | ||
(c) pair of dancing slippers (toys), with textile uppers (with elastic around the upper edge and across the width of the slipper, trimmed with ribbon) and plastic soles. On the front of each slipper, there is a rosette of knitted net, and a bow of 100 % synthetic fibres; | 9503 90 37 | ||
(d) handbag (of dimensions 16 x 13,5 x 4,5 cm), of clear plastic, with a design printed on the front, with a zip-closure, non-adjustable shoulder-strap, and trim around the edges (handbag); | 4202 22 10 | ||
736/89 of 16.3.1989 (OJ L 80, 23.3.1989, p. 21) |
1 | Lightweight, loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton) with an average of ten or more stitches per linear centimetre in one direction, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, with a collarless rounded neckline partially opening at the front with a button-fastening left over right. It has loose-fitting short sleeves which are hemmed at the sleeve-ends. The base of the garment, which is hemmed, has side-slits of approximately 6 cm at each side. There is a band of knitted fabric at the neckline. There is also a semi-circular insert at the back extending down from the neckline. | 6105 10 00 |
2949/92 of 9.10.1992 (OJ L 296, 13.10.1992, p. 5) |
2 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, with a rounded neckline partially opening at the front with button-fastening left over right, and having short sleeves hemmed at the ends. The base is hemmed. At the level of the waist, a loop-wale yarn is sewn, through which is passed a thin cord. | 6105 10 00 |
736/89 of 16.3.1989 (OJ L 80, 23.3.1989, p. 21) |
2 | Loose-fitting knitted or crocheted garment (100 % cotton) with an average of ten or more stitches per linear centimetre in one direction, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist. It has a collarless rounded neckline partially opening at the front with a button-fastening right over left and has long sleeves. It is also hemmed at the neckline, sleeve-ends and at the base of the garment. | 6106 10 00 |
736/89 of 16.3.1989 (OJ L 80, 23.3.1989, p. 21) |
3 | Lightweight, loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton) of fancy design with an average of ten or more stitches per linear centimetre in one direction, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, with a collarless loose-fitting neckline partially opening at the front with a button-fastening right over left. It has loose-fitting short sleeves which are hemmed at the sleeve-ends. The garment is sleeveless and has knitted fabric sewn on at the neckline and armholesThe base of the garment is hemmed. | 6106 10 00 |
2403/89 of 31.7.1989 (OJ L 227, 4.8.1989, p. 30) |
1 | Lightweight, loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, collarless, with a ribbed band at the rounded neckline, partially opening at the front with a button-fastening right over left, with long hemmed sleeves. The base of the garment is hemmed and has two triangular inserts of ribbed knitted fabric at the sides. | 6106 10 00 |
2949/92 of 9.10.1992 (OJ L 296, 13.10.1992, p. 5) |
3 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton) with short sleeves, for a child of a height of more than 86 cm (commercial size more than 86 cm), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist; the sleeve-ends and base are hemmed. It has a rounded neckline with knitted ribbing sewn on, and a partial opening at the left shoulder which is fastened by means of two buttons.The garment has a printed decorative motif on the front (blouse). | 6106 10 00 |
1911/92 of 9.7.1992 (OJ L 192, 11.7.1992, p. 23) |
1 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton) of one colour, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, with long sleeves. It has a round, close-fitting neckline with high sewn-on ribbing (4 cm high). The garment has a partial opening at the front, beginning at the neckline, with a button-fastening right over left, pleats at the shoulders, and shoulder-pads. | 6106 10 00 |
893/93 of 13.4.1993 (OJ L 93, 17.4.1993, p. 5) |
1 | Single-coloured knitted garment (95 % cotton, 5 % elastomeric yarn) of fancy design, with long sleeves, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to just below the waist. It has a very low-cut V-neckline, with embroidery at the edge. The garment is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and base. | 6106 10 00 |
709/2000 of 4.4.2000 (OJ L 84, 5.4.2000, p. 3) |
1 | Single-coloured knitted garment (95 % cotton, 5 % elasthan), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist (59 cm), straight-cut, with more than ten stitches per linear centimetre in each direction counted on an area measuring at least 10 x 10 cm, with only one short sleeve. It has an asymmetric and very low-cut neckline, without an opening. On the front, it is decorated with a piece of embroidery inserted at the neckline and on the sleeve. It has woven bands sewn on at the neckline and at the sleeve-end, and is hemmed at the base (blouse). | 6106 10 00 |
3640/91 of 13.12.1991 (OJ L 344, 14.12.1991, p. 62) |
Set of two garments, packaged together for retail sale, consisting of: | ||
(a) a lightweight garment of synthetic knitted crocheted fabric (raschel lace bearing decorative motifs in which a metal thread is inserted), intended to cover the upper part of the body to just below the waist, with long sleeves, and hemmed at the sleeve-ends and at the base. The garment has a collar made of a strip of single-coloured raschel lace which, at the front, crosses right over left, forming a very low-cut V-neckline; and | (a): 6106 20 00 |
||
(b) briefs of the same fabric, composition and colour as the upper garment. | (b): 6108 22 00 |
||
350/93 of 17.2.1993 (OJ L 41, 18.2.1993, p. 7) |
1 | Lightweight knitted garment (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton) with long sleeves, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, made from a single-coloured fabric. It has a partial opening at the front, with button-fastening right over left, decorative knitted or crocheted open-work strips sewn on to the sleeve-ends, and two slits approximately 23 cm long at the front of the base (shirt-blouse). | 6106 20 00 |
350/93 of 17.2.1993 (OJ L 41, 18.2.1993, p. 7) |
2 | Lightweight knitted garment (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, without sleeves or collar, with a rounded loose-fitting neckline. It opens completely at the front, with a button-fastening right over left from the neckline to the waist. The front is longer than the back, and terminates below the waist in two points. | 6106 20 00 |
1529/1999 of 13.7.1999 (OJ L 178, 14.7.1999, p. 10) |
1 | Multicoloured garment of close-fitting cut, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, made of a velvet knitted fabric of man-made fibres (80 % viscose, 20 % polyester), with more than ten stitches per linear centimetre in each direction counted on an area measuring at least 10 x 10 cm. It has long sleeves and a close-fitting neckline with collar, and opens completely at the front with a button-fastening right over left. The sleeve-ends and the base are hemmed, and there is a pocket sewn on at the chest. There are side-slits approximately 8 cm long at the base (shirt-blouse). | 6106 20 00 |
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
3 | Lightly-pleated knitted garment (100 % polyester), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, single-coloured and with an average of more than ten stitches per linear centimetre. It is straight-cut, has short sleeves and is hemmed at the base. It has a crew-neck with a partial opening at the back with button-fastening (blouse). | 6106 20 00 |
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
4 | Lightweight loose-fitting pleated knitted garment (100 % polyester), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, in two colours. It has short sleeves and no collar.It has two front panels, connected by a gilded metal chain held in place by two decorative buttons. There is a partial opening at the back descending from the neckline, which fastens by means of a button. It has shoulder-pads and is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and at the base. Inside the full length of the front, there is a piece of knitted material, of a different colour from the rest of the garment, sewn on to form a rounded neckline (blouse). | 6106 20 00 |
437/2006 of 16.3.2006 (OJ L 80, 17.3.2006, p. 3) |
1 | Self-coloured lightweight garment made from knitted fabrics of man-made fibres (90 % polyamide, 10 % elastomeric yarn) intended to cover the lower part of the body from the waist to above the mid-thigh area, enclosing each leg separately, with an opening at the front without any closing system and without an opening at the waist. The garment has an elasticated waist band and is hemmed at the leg ends. There are patch pockets on both sides of the garment, having a zip fastening system and holding a mass-produced removable, oval insert. The inserts are made of a hard plastic material on the outside and are padded with foam on the inside. They are designed to prevent injuries to the hips in case of a fall. They absorb shocks to the hip area of the body (men's underpants). | 6107 12 00 |
350/93 of 17.2.1993 (OJ L 41, 18.2.1993, p. 7) |
3 | Unisex knitted briefs (95 % cotton, 5 % elastomeric), elasticated at the waist and at the legs, without an opening at the front. Because of the style of its cut and considerable elasticity, the crotch is sufficiently large to accommodate a nappy for incontinence-sufferers. | 6108 21 00 |
1176/91 of 6.5.1991 (OJ L 114, 7.5.1991, p. 27) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
1 | Set of two garments put up for retail sale, consisting of: (a) a lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body, printed with a multi-coloured pattern of motifs, with long sleeves and a close-fitting neckline which opens partially at the front and is button-fastened right-over-left. It has ribbing, of the same colour as the trousers, applied at the neckline, sleeve-ends and base; (b) a lightweight knitted pair of trousers (100 % cotton) of a single colour, reaching from the waist down to the ankles, and without an opening at the waist. The trousers are elasticated at the waist and have ribbing applied at the leg-ends. | 6108 31 00 |
1176/91 of 6.5.1991 (OJ L 114, 7.5.1991, p. 27) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
2 | Set of two garments put up for retail sale, consisting of: (a) a lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body, striped in two colours, with long sleeves and a loose-fitting round neckline without an opening. It has ribbing applied at the neckline, sleeve-ends and base, as well as a decoration applied to the front; (b) a pair of trousers made up of the same fabric as the top, reaching from the waist down to the ankles, and without an opening at the waist. The trousers are elasticated at the waist and have ribbing applied at the leg-ends. | 6108 31 00 |
1911/92 of 9.7.1992 (OJ L 192, 11.7.1992, p. 23) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
2 | Set of two garments, put up for retail sale, consisting of: (a) knitted-pile garment (80 % cotton, 20 % polyamide) in two colours (striped), intended to cover the upper part of the body, with long sleeves and a round neckline without an opening. The garment has ribbing applied at the neckline, sleeve-ends and base; (b) pair of trousers made up from a unicolour knitted-pile fabric (80 % cotton, 20 % polyamide) reaching from the waist to the ankles, without an opening at the waist. The waist is elasticated, and there is ribbing applied at the trouser-leg bottoms. | 6108 31 00 |
1936/90 of 4.7.1990 (OJ L 174, 7.7.1990, p. 25) |
1 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % synthetic fibres) with narrow shoulder-straps, covering the body to the crotch. This garment is elasticated at the back at the level of the waist and is fastened at the crotch by means of three press-studs. It is also edged with mechanically-made lace. | 6108 92 00 |
2049/2002 of 19.11.2002 (OJ L 316, 20.11.2002, p. 15) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
Set of two garments, put up for retail sale, comprising: | ||
(a) a self-coloured garment made of a lightweight knitted fabric (100 % cotton) intended to cover the upper part of the body, without an opening in the neckline, with short sleeves, a round neck with ribbed neckline, hemmed at the bottom of the garment and at the sleeve-ends. There is a printed design and text on the front of the garment (T-shirt); | (a): 6109 10 00 |
||
(b) a self-coloured garment made of a lightweight knitted fabric (100 % cotton) intended to cover the lower part of the body from the waist to above the knee, enclosing each leg separately, without an opening at the waist. The garment has an elasticated waist and is hemmed at the leg-ends. It also has a printed design on the lower left leg (shorts). | (b): 6104 62 00 |
||
2403/89 of 31.7.1989 (OJ L 227, 4.8.1989, p. 30) |
2 | Lightweight, sleeveless, knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the waist, collarless, having a low-cut rounded neckline without an opening. The base of the garment is hemmed and has two semi-circular inserts of ribbed knitted fabric. The neckline and armholes have sewn-on bands of knitted fabric. | 6109 10 00 |
1936/90 of 4.7.1990 (OJ L 174, 7.7.1990, p. 25) |
2 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton) with short sleeves, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist. It has a rounded neckline, internal epaulettes, and decoration in the form of five pleats sewn at the sleeve-ends. | 6109 10 00 |
2949/92 of 9.10.1992 (OJ L 296, 13.10.1992, p. 5) |
4 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton) of one colour, with short sleeves, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist. The garment has a rounded neckline with knitted bands sewn on, and is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and base. At the level of the waist, a loop-wale yarn is sewn, through which is passed a thin cord. | 6109 10 00 |
2949/92 of 9.10.1992 (OJ L 296, 13.10.1992, p. 5) |
5 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, sleeveless, collarless with a loose-fitting rounded neckline without an opening. The base is hemmed. There are knitted bands sewn on at the neckline and armholes. At the level of the waist, a loop-wale yarn is sewn, through which is passed a thin cord. | 6109 10 00 |
893/93 of 13.4.1993 (OJ L 93, 17.4.1993, p. 5) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
2 | Set of two garments, comprising: | |
(a) lightweight knitted garment (60 % cotton, 40 % polyester) with long close-fitting sleeves and made from a two-colour striped fabric, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist. It has a rounded ribbed neckline, and is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and at the base. The base has side-vents, of a length of about 6 cm, each with two decorative buttons. There is decorative embroidery at chest-level (T-shirt); | (a): 6109 10 00 |
||
(b) knitted trousers (60 % cotton, 40 % polyester) made from a single-coloured fabric, extending from the waist to the ankles, with an elasticated waist.The trouser-leg bottoms have decorative buttons similar to those on the upper garment. | (b): 6104 62 00 |
||
350/93 of 17.2.1993 (OJ L 41, 18.2.1993, p. 7) |
4 | Lightweight knitted garment (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton) with long sleeves, intended
to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist. It has a
V-neckline, with shoulderpads inside, decorative embroidery on the back and front, and
strips of embroidery ath the sleeve-ends and at the base. Lengvas megztas drabuzis (65 % poliesterio ir 35 % medvilnes) ilgomis rankovemis, skirtas virsutinei kuno daliai uzdengti ir siekiantis zemiau juosmens. Jis turi smaila trikampe iskirpte, vidinius petukus, dekoratyvini siuvinejima nugaroje ir priekyje bei siuvinetas juosteles prie drabuzio apacios ir rankoviu galu. |
6109 90 20 |
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
5 | Lightly-pleated knitted garment (100 % polyester), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, single-coloured and straight-cut. It has sleeveless, with rounded armholes. It has a rounded neckline, without an opening, and is bound round the neckline and armholes, and is hemmed at the base (vest). | 6109 90 20 |
2368/90 of 9.8.1990 (OJ L 219, 14.8.1990, p. 26) |
1 | Lightweight loose-fitting knitted garment (100 % cotton) with short sleeves, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist. At the level of the neckline, it has ribbing sewn on to form a high close-fitting collar without an opening. It also has decoration at the back and at the level of the chest, as well as a hem at the sleeve-ends and at the base. | 6110 20 99 |
1911/92 of 9.7.1992 (OJ L 192, 11.7.1992, p. 23) |
3 | Knitted garment (100 % cotton) intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching to below the waist, having a collar crossing right over left, with no opening, of ribbed knitted material, with short sleeves. The garment also has a decoration on the chest, and is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and base. | 6110 20 99 |
350/93 of 17.2.1993 (OJ L 41, 18.2.1993, p. 7) |
5 | Knitted close-fitting garment of ribbed velvet (90 % cotton, 5 % polyester, 5 % elastomeric), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, with long sleeves, an upright close-fitting collar and a partial opening at the back which is closed with a slide-fastener. The garment is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and at the base. | 6110 20 99 |
1458/97 of 25.7.1997 (OJ L 199, 26.7.1997, p. 11) |
3 | Non-lightweight multicoloured garment (55 % cotton, 45 % polyester), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, made of several thick knitted fabrics raised on the inside, of different thicknesses with more than ten stitches per linear centimetre, straight-cut. It has long sleeves, a close-fitting neckline with ribbing, and a partial opening at the front with a slide-fastener. It is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and base, and has decorative seams, with decorative motifs sewn on the front (garment similar to a pullover. | 6110 20 99 |
1054/97 of 11.6.1997 (OJ L 154, 12.6.1997, p. 14) |
3 | Lightweight unlined garment of fine T-shirt-like knitted fabric (100 % cotton), with stripes of two colours, straight-cut, without collar, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips. It has short sleeves and a round close-fitting neckline, and opens completely at the front with a button-fastening right over left. It is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and at the base, and has pockets below the waist. The garment has shoulder-pads (garment similar to a cardigan). | 6110 20 99 |
1054/97 of 11.6.1997 (OJ L 154, 12.6.1997, p. 14) |
4 | Unlined loose-fitting thick-ribbed knitted garment (60 % cotton, 40 % polyester blend) single-coloured and straight-cut, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, without a collar. It has long sleeves and a V-neckline, and opens completely at the front with a button-fastening right over left. It is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and at the base, and has pockets below the waist, as well as side-vents at the base (garment similar to a cardigan). | 6110 20 99 |
709/2000 of 4.4.2000 (OJ L 84, 5.4.2000, p. 3) |
2 | Single-coloured garment, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist (62 cm), made of thick knitted fabric and ribbed along its length (100 % cotton), straight-cut, with short sleeves. It has a V-neckline without an opening, and decorative embroidery on the front. The sleeve-ends, neckline and base are hemmed (garment similar to a pullover). | 6110 20 99 |
1054/97 of 11.6.1997 (OJ L 154, 12.6.1997, p. 14) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
6 | Set, put up for retail sale and consisting of: | |
(a) lightweight knitted pullover (80 % cotton, 20 % polyester) of two different fabrics (one coloured blue, the other red-and-white striped), intended to cover the upper part of the body, with no opening, with long single-coloured sleeves. It has ribbing at the sleeve-ends and base, and a close-fitting neckline with two bands of ribbing in different colours, and a decorative motif sewn on the front, with two decorative seams at the armholes; | (a): 6110 20 99 |
||
(b) pair of lightweight knitted trousers (80 % cotton, 20 % polyester) of the same two fabrics as the upper part, reaching from the waist to the ankles, without an opening at the waist.The garment is elasticated at the waist, and has ribbing at the trouser-leg bottoms. It has a strip of the striped material inserted lengthways down the side of the left leg, with two decorative seams along it. It has two loops at the waist for hanging it up. | (b): 6104 62 00 |
||
1054/97 of 11.6.1997 (OJ L 154, 12.6.1997, p. 14) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
5 | Set, put up for retail sale and consisting of: | |
(a) lightweight knitted pullover (80 % cotton, 20 % polyester) in one shade of red, intended to cover the upper part of the body, with no opening, with a close-fitting neckline and long sleeves. It has ribbing at the neckline, sleeve-ends and base, and a decorative motif sewn on the front. Inside, at the neckline, a piece of the same fabric as the trousers is sewn on; | (a): 6110 20 99 |
||
(b) pair of lightweight knitted trousers (80 % cotton, 20 % polyester) with multicoloured printed checks, reaching from the waist to the ankles, without an opening at the waist.The garment is elasticated at the waist, and has ribbing at the trouser-leg bottoms. It has two loops at the waist for hanging it up. | (b): 6104 62 00 |
||
2949/92 of 9.10.1992 (OJ L 296, 13.10.1992, p. 5) |
6 | Knitted garment (100 % synthetic fibres), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching to below the waist, with short sleeves; the sleeve-ends and the base are hemmed. The garment has a V-neck with a collar with edges crossing left over right, made from a different knitted fabric. | 6110 30 91 |
2949/92 of 9.10.1992 (OJ L 296, 13.10.1992, p. 5) |
7 | Loose-fitting knitted garment (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching to below the waist, with short sleeves; the sleeve-ends and the base are hemmed. The garment has a ribbed addition at the neckline, forming a close-fitting high collar with an opening at the front buttoning left over right. There is embroidery applied on the chest. | 6110 30 91 |
92/97 of 20.1.1997 (OJ L 19, 22.1.1997, p. 1) |
1 | Thick self-coloured knitted garment (100 % polyester), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, straight-cut and with a curved hemline, and with an average of less than ten rows of stitches per linear centimetre in either direction. The garment has long, cuffed sleeves, and a collar, and opens completely at the front with a button-fastening left over right. It has a pocket sewn on the front at the level of the chest (garment similar to a cardigan). | 6110 30 91 |
272/98 of 2.2.1998 (OJ L 27, 3.2.1998, p. 3) |
1 | Self-coloured garment, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, made of a thick (2,8 mm) knitted fabric, brushed inside and out, with more than ten stitches per linear centimetre (100 % polyester), and cut straight. The garment is shorter at the front than at the back. It has long cuffed sleeves and a turnover collar, and opens completely at the front with a button-fastening left over right. It has side-slits at the base. It has an embroidered breast-pocket sewn on (garment similar to a cardigan). | 6110 30 91 |
1559/2004 of 24.8.2004 (OJ L 283, 2.9.2004, p. 9) |
Single-coloured knitted garment, made of synthetic fibres (100 % polyester), sleeveless, for covering the upper part of the body. It has a V-neck and wide armholes, and opens completely at the front, fastening left-over-right by means of press-studs. It has no lining or pockets. There are two reflecting, horizontal strips all the way round the garment (waistcoat). | 6110 30 91 | |
1911/92 of 9.7.1992 (OJ L 192, 11.7.1992, p. 23) |
4 | Knitted garment (100 % synthetic fibres) intended to cover the upper part of the body, having a collar with no opening, with long sleeves and a hem at the base. The garment has a triangular ribbed knitted insert at the front of the neckline. | 6110 30 99 |
1966/94 of 28.7.1994 (OJ L 198, 30.7.1994, p. 103) |
4 | Sleeveless garment, made of stretch knitted ribbed fabric (100 % polyamide), intended to cover the upper part of the body to just below the waist. It has a collar and opens completely at the front, with press-stud fastening right over left, and has two pocket-flaps at chest-level. | 6110 30 99 |
1529/1999 of 13.7.1999 (OJ L 178, 14.7.1999, p. 10) |
2 | Single-coloured knitted garment (70 % acrylic, 30 % polyester), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist (66 cm), straight-cut, with long sleeves. It has a rounded neckline without an opening. It is bound round the neckline (garment similar to a pullover). | 6110 30 99 |
709/2000 of 4.4.2000 (OJ L 84, 5.4.2000, p. 3) |
3 | Multicoloured garment, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, made of a velvet knitted fabric of man-made fibres (80 % viscose, 20 % polyester, with more than ten stitches per linear centimetre in each direction counted on an area measuring at least 10 x 10 cm, with a close-fitting cut. It has long tight-fitting sleeves, a rounded neckline without an opening, and a decorative motif on the front. The neckline and sleeve-ends are bound with an applied welt of knitted fabric, and the base is hemmed (garment similar to a pullover). | 6110 30 99 |
709/2000 of 4.4.2000 (OJ L 84, 5.4.2000, p. 3) |
4 | Close-fitting striped sleeveless knitted garment (70 % acrylic, 30 % polyester), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the waist (51 cm), of a thickness of 1,5 mm. It is ribbed along its length and has a reounde neckline without an opening. It is bound round the neckline and armholes (garment similar to a pullover). | 6110 30 99 |
812/89 of 21.3.1989 (OJ L 86, 31.3.1989, p. 25) |
4 | Set of two garments put up for retail sale and consisting of: (a) knitted unlined blouson (100 % cotton) with a collar, fully opening at the front with a zip-fastening, with long sleeves. There is knitted ribbing at the base of the garment and the sleeve-ends. A band of woven fabric of another colour has been sewn onto the outside length of the sleeves and around the armholes. The two front panels of the Garment are fully covered with an applique-ed, woven, multi-coloured, printed-patterned fabric. There are two zipped pockets above the waist; (b) knitted unlined pair of trousers (100 % cotton) reaching from the waist to the ankles, tightened at the waist by means of elastication and a drawstring. This garment has two zipped pockets, but no opening at the waist. There is knitted ribbing at the bottom of the trouser-legs. A woven band of fabric of another colour is sewn on the outer side of the trouser-legs, extending from the top of the trousers to the knitted ribbing at the leg-ends. |
6112 11 00 |
350/93 of 17.2.1993 (OJ L 41, 18.2.1993, p. 7) |
6 | Set of two garments made from three knitted fabrics of different colours (100 %
synthetic fibres), consisting of: (a) unlined windjacket with a collar, completely open at the front with a slide-fastener, and with long sleeves. The sleeve-ends and the base are tightened; it has two internal pockets above the waist, and embroidered or printed decorations on the back and sleeves. There are pieces of woven fabric of different colours sewn on to the sides and part of the sleeves; (b) unlined pair of trousers reaching from the waist to the ankles, tightened and with a drawstring at the waist which has no opening. The outsides of the legs are covered from the waist to mid-thigh with pieces of woven fabric sewn on, the same as the jacket. The garment has two internal pockets, and embroidered or printed decorations on one of the hips and on one of the trouser-leg bottoms. |
6112 12 00 |
424/89 of 20.2.1989 (OJ L 49, 21.2.1989, p. 18) |
For the purposes of the classification of tracksuits in 6112 or 6211, where the garment intended to cover the upper part of the body has a complete opening at the front, this must be fastened by means of a zip-fastener, press-studs or velcro. Where, however, the opening at the front is only partial, it may also be fastened by any type of buttons, provided that the opening is no longer than one-third of the length of the garment measured from the neckline. | 6112 6211 |
|
651/2007 of 8.6.2007 (OJ L 153, 14.6.2007, p. 3) |
1 | Lightweight garment for women, intended to cover the body and reaching down to the
crotch, made of a knitted self-coloured fabric of synthetic fibres (80 % polyamide and 20
% elastane). The fabric does not contain any rubber thread. The garment is fitted with 8-mm wide strips of vulcanised rubber (heading 4008) which are added by stitching them into the neckline, armholes and leg openings. The garment has under-wired bra-style shaped cups, a lined gusset, adjustable straps and high-cut openings for the legs (swimsuit). |
6112 41 90 |
1911/92 of 9.7.1992 (OJ L 192, 11.7.1992, p. 23) |
5 | Garment, made of cellular rubber covered on both sides by knitted fabric, intended to cover the lower part of the body from the waist to the knees, enveloping the legs separately, without an opening. The seams of the garment are covered by an elastic tape (shorts). | 6113 00 10 |
2345/2003 of 23.12.2003 (OJ L 346, 31.12.2003, p. 41) |
Unlined close-fitting garment, covering the whole body from the shoulder to the ankle and enveloping each leg separately, with long sleeves, hemmed at the ends of the sleeves and legs, with a partial opening at the back reaching down to the waist fastened by a zip, with a tight-fitting collar fastened at the rear by a velcro-type strap. The garment is made up of several panels sewn together. The garment is made mainly from cellular rubber panels covered on both faces with a layer of single-coloured knitted textile fabric (synthetic fibres). A small chest-panel, two of the four back-panels and the panels of the lower sleeves are made of an embossed cellular rubber covered on only one face (on the inside of the garment) with a layer of single-coloured knitted textile fabric (surf/diving suit). | 6113 00 10 | |
1584/89 of 7.6.1989 (OJ L 156, 8.6.1989, p. 15) |
2 | Lightweight, knitted, sleeveless garment (100 % cotton) for women or girls, designed to be worn next to the body, falling well short of the waist, covering the chest and with a low-cut neckline at the front and back. This garment has two darts at the front, of approximately 5 cm, extending from the base which is slightly gathered and has an elastic band (approximately 1,5 cm wide). | 6114 20 00 |
350/93 of 17.2.1993 (OJ L 41, 18.2.1993, p. 7) |
7 | Lightweight knitted garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, with no sleeves and no collar, with a rounded loose-fitting neckline, and made from a two-coloured fabric. There is a partial opening at the front, with button-fastening left over right. There is decorative loop-wale yarn edging the neckline and armholes. | 6114 20 00 |
1584/89 of 7.6.1989 (OJ L 156, 8.6.1989, p. 15) |
1 | Set of garments for women or girls, put up for retail sale, and consisting of: | |
(a) a lightweight knitted garment (55 % man-made fibres and 45 % cotton) designed to be worn next to the body, which falls well short of the waist, covers the chestand the upper part of the back, has no sleeves and has a low-cut neckline at the front. this garment has an elastic band (2,5 cm in width) at the base; | (a): 6114 30 00 |
||
(b) briefs of the same fabric, compsition and colour as the upper garment. | (b): 6108 22 00 |
||
893/93 of 13.4.1993 (OJ L 93, 17.4.1993, p. 5) |
3 | Lightweight knitted garment (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton) of a single colour, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, with short sleeves and a hood with a drawstring. It has a rounded neckline with a ribbed edge, and is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and at the base. | 6114 30 00 |
1911/92 of 9.7.1992 (OJ L 192, 11.7.1992, p. 23) |
6 | Knitted stocking-type footwear of textile fibres (85 % acrylic, 13 % nylon, 2 % other fibres), without applied soles, with anti-skid PVC-strips on the sole to aid walking on polished or slippery surfaces. | 6115 96 99 |
1564/2000 of 18.7.2000 (OJ L 180, 19.7.2000, p. 5) |
1 | Knitted cotton glove, the outer surface of which is covered by dipping it in natural rubber (latex), for domestic use. | 6116 10 20 |
272/98 of 2.2.1998 (OJ L 27, 3.2.1998, p. 3) |
2 | Goalkeeper's glove for ice-hockey or street-hockey composed of the glove and the blocking-pad stitched to it at five points. It is for a right-handed goalkeeper, for the hand holding the stick.The blocking-pad (of dimensions 37 x 20 x 3 cm) forming the back of the glove is made of rigid cellular plastic entirely covered with mainly fabric of man-made fibres. Its main purpose is to stop the ball (or puck, in ice-hockey) when shot at goal, and protects the hand. The other part resembles a normal glove, with the back of knitted fabric and the front made of non-woven polyamide microfibres, so that the goalkeeper can hold and handle the stick. | 6116 93 00 |
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
6 | Ice-hockey glove, the back of which is padded for protection. The outer layer is made of knitted fabric of synthetic fibres (polyester), and the palm is made of non-woven polyamide microfibres. | 6116 93 00 |
926/2004 of 26.4.2004 (OJ L 163, 30.4.2004, p. 105) |
1 | Made-up article consisting of a tubular, knitted, elasticated fabric (man-made fibres) combined with rubber thread, in the form of a loop (hairband). | 6117 80 10 |
645/89 of 14.3.1989 (OJ L 71, 15.3.1989, p. 17) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Set of two garments, put up for retail sale, consisting of: | |
(a) a lightweight woven windjacket (100 % synthetic fibres), consisting of three different-coloured fabrics. It has a collar which has a drawstring through it, and a close-fitting neckline partially opening at the front with a zip-fastening. This opening has a protective flap with press-studs, fastening left over right. The garment has long loose-fitting sleeves which are elasticated at the ends. There is elastication at the base. There is a hood which can be tucked into a pouch in the collar, and a pouch with a protective flap at the front of the garment. Both pouches have zip-fastening; | (a): 6201 93 00 |
||
(b) a lightweight woven pair of trousers (100 % synthetic fibres) of one colour, reaching from the waist to the ankles, tightened at the waist by means of elastication and a drawstring. The trouser-leg bottoms have zip-fastenings and can be tightened by velcro-strips. The garment has two interior pockets. | (b): 6204 63 18 |
||
1218/1999 of 14.6.1999 (OJ L 148, 15.6.1999, p. 9) |
4 | Garment of single-coloured woven fabric (100 % polyamide) of a thickness of 0,1 mm, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips (total length 75 cm), coated on the inside with non-cellular plastic (polyurethane) and with quilted lining. It has a double collar, one of which is made of knitted brushed-pile fabric. The garment opens completely at the front, with press-stud fastening left over right. It has long sleeves with zips at the ends, and two inset pockets at waist-level. It can be tightened at the bottom (garment similar to an anorak). | 6201 93 00 |
2855/2000 of 27.12.2000 (OJ L 332, 28.12.2000, p. 41) |
5 | Set of three garments, put up for retail sale and comprising: | |
(a) single-coloured woven garment of synthetic fibres (100 % polyamide), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips (total length 67 cm), with a knitted lining. It has a high-fitting collar with an integrated hood, and opens completely at the front with a zip-fastening protected by a flap with a press-stud fastening left over right. It has long sleeves with elastication and velcro-type tightening at the sleeve-ends. There is a drawstring at the collar, and elastic at the base. It has two inside-pockets above the waist with zip-fastening, and two outside-pockets below the waist with protective flaps fastened by press-studs. There are storm-flaps on the front and back, and a facility for attaching a buoyancy-device (anorak); | (a): 6201 93 00 |
||
(b) single-coloured knitted garment of man-made fibres, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to just below the waist (total length 65 cm), with long sleeves; the front and sleeves are partially lined. It has a high-fitting collar, and opens completely at the front with a zip-fastening. The sleeve-ends are elasticated, and there is a drawstring at the base. It has two pockets inserted at the front at waist-level, with zip-fastening. It is made up of cut-and-sewn panels (wind-jacket); | (b): 6102 30 90 |
||
(c) pair of single-coloured woven trousers of synthetic fibres (100 % polyamide), intended to cover the lower part of the body and reaching down to the ankles, with a woven lining and two inserted pockets. It has a partial opening at the front with a zip-fastening, and a covering flap with press-stud fastening left over right. Both legs have zip-fastening over the whole length, covered by a protective flap with velcro-type fastening, and can be tightened at the leg-bottoms by a velcro-type strip (trousers). | (c): 6203 43 19 |
||
3694/91 of 17.12.1991 (OJ L 350, 19.12.1991, p. 17) |
Set of two garments, put up for retail sale, consisting of: | ||
(a) a lightweight, loose-fitting, woven windjacket (100 % synthetic fibres), lined in the upper part of the garment and composed of two different coloured fabrics. It has a collar and opens fully at the front with a zip-fastening. The opening has a protective flap, fastening with press-studs left over right. It has loose-fitting long sleeves, elasticated at the ends. There is elastication at the base of the garment. There is a hood which can be tucked into a pouch in the collar; the hood has a drawstring, and the pouch has a zip-fastening.There are two internal pockets at the waist, with protective flaps; | (a): 6201 93 00 |
||
(b) a lightweight woven pair of trousers (100 % synthetic fibres) of one colour, reaching from the waist to the ankles, and tightening at the waist by means of elastication and a drawstring. The trouser-leg bottoms have zip-fastenings and can be tightened by means of velcro strips. The garment has two internal pockets. | (b): 6204 63 18 |
||
1458/97 of 25.7.1997 (OJ L 199, 26.7.1997, p. 11) |
4 | Loose-fitting woven garment (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton), intended to cover the lower part of the body and reaching from the waist to the ankles, enveloping each leg separately and with a fly at the front with a button-fastening left over right and a flap. There are two pockets sewn on at the front, two pockets inserted at the rear, and two pockets sewn on at the sides at thigh-level. It has pieces of the same fabric at the knees and in the seat. The trouser-leg bottoms have a seam threaded with a drawstring, for tightening (leisure-trousers). | 6203 43 19 |
511/96 of 22.3.1996 (OJ L 76, 26.3.1996, p. 9) |
2 | Set of two garments made up of the same lightweight slightly-pleated fabric (100 %
viscose), with identical multicoloured motifs printed on both garments. It is put up for
retail sale and consists of: (a) a short-sleeved garment, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to just below the waist. It has a wide neckline without an opening. There is elastication at the neckline and at the sleeve-ends. Every 2 cm from the chest to the waist inside the garment, there are elastic threads sewn, emphasisng the pleating-effect (smocks) (blouse); (b) a loose-fitting garment, intended to cover the lower part of the body and reaching from the waist to above the knees. The waist is elasticated and has a drawstring (skirt). |
6204 29 18 |
3295/93 of 26.11.1993 (OJ L 296, 1.12.1993, p. 43) |
1 | Loose-fitting woven judo-jacket (100 % cotton), unbleached, made up from two heavyweight fabrics of different construction, openeing fully at the front and with no fastening. It has long sleeves, side-vents at the base, and an internal reinforcement in the form of a partial lining. There is external reinforcement in the form of a third woven fabric around the collar and along the full length of the opening. The garment consists of two panels sewn together widthwise, the upper panel being sewn lengthwise under the arms. | 6204 32 90 |
272/98 of 2.2.1998 (OJ L 27, 3.2.1998, p. 3) |
3 | Unlined close-fitting garment of denim fabric (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the waist, with turnover collar. It has long sleeves with buttoned cuffs and a close-fitting collar, and opens completely at the front with a slide-fastener. It has breast-pockets, and a lightly-shaped hem at the base. It is made up of ten panels (six at the front, four at the back) sewn together lengthways, with decorative seams. | 6204 32 90 |
2507/91 of 20.8.1991 (OJ L 233, 22.8.1991, p. 9) |
1 | Woven one-piece garment (100 % cotton), sleeveless, intended to cover both the upper part of the body and the lower part, to just below the knees, enveloping each leg separately.It has inset pockets at hip-level. The garment, which is cut fully from the waist, has a partial opening at the front, with button-fastening right over left. | 6204 42 00 |
92/97 of 20.1.1997 (OJ L 19, 22.1.1997, p. 1) |
2 | Lightweight loose-fitting sleeveless garment of plain fabric (100 % cotton), intended to cover both the upper and lower parts of the body and reaching down to the ankles (approximately 122 cm long). At the front, it has a low-cut neckline and opens completely with button-fastening right over left, with pockets sewn on below the waist. It has side-vents starting 4,5 cm below the waist, approximately 73 cm in length. It has motifs embroidered at chest-level on the front, and on the pockets. Two strips of the same fabric are sewn on to the back of the waist, for tying (dress). | 6204 42 00 |
347/2001 of 19.2.2001 (OJ L 52, 22.2.2001, p. 8) |
2 | Set of three items, packaged together, as a fancy-dress set for a child, for retail
sale and consisting of: (a) child's woven dress (100 % synthetic fibres), with a V-neckline without an opening, and short sleeves. The bodice has applied knitted lace covering the woven fabric. The sleeve-ends are elasticated. The dress is unhemmed at the neckline, sleeve-ends and base; (b) two knitted accessories, consisting of a knitted veil and a textile bouquet (100 % synthetic fibres) (dress). |
6204 43 00 |
2949/92 of 9.10.1992 (OJ L 296, 13.10.1992, p. 5) |
8 | Loose-fitting woven garment (100 % artificial fibres), intended to cover the lower part of the body and reaching to below the knees. Rising from the waist is a section made from the same fabric, with wide braces. The garment opens fully at the front, and is fastened by buttoning right over left (skirt). | 6204 59 10 |
1308/96 of 4.7.1996 (OJ L 167, 6.7.1996, p. 19) |
1 | Woven garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the lower part of the body and reaching from the waist to above the knee, enveloping each leg separately, without an opening, and with pockets inserted at the sides. It is tightened at the waist by an elastic strip and a band sewn on to the front which can be adjusted by means of a buckle on the left. The garment has a false fly (sewn up), with a left-over-right flap (simulated fastening) (shorts). | 6204 62 90 |
350/93 of 17.2.1993 (OJ L 41, 18.2.1993, p. 7) amended by Reg. 2126/2005 |
8 | Garment made from three woven fabrics of different colours (100 % polyamide, intended to cover the lower part of the body from the waist to the mid-thigh area, enveloping each leg separately, and with no opening at the waist. The waist is elasticated and has a drawstring. It has an internal pocket at each side, and knitted briefs (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton) sewn to the inside of the waist. | 6204 63 90 |
1176/91 of 6.5.1991 (OJ L 114, 7.5.1991, p. 27) |
3 | Lightweight garment made up of two woven fabrics (100 % cotton) of a different colour, intended to cover the upper part of the body, of a straight cut, with a close-fitting round neckline, with short sleeves, two pockets at the level of the chest and a hood with a drawstring. It has a full-length opening at the front, with a button-fastening left over right, and the sleeve-ends and base are hemmed (leisure-shirt). | 6205 20 00 |
1176/91 of 6.5.1991 (OJ L 114, 7.5.1991, p. 27) |
4 | Lightweight woven garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body, of a straight cut, with a close-fitting round neckline, with long sleeves with cuffs, two pockets at the level of the chest and a hood with a drawstring. It has a full-length opening at the front, with a button-fastening left over right; there are decorations applied to the pockets and printing on the back; the base is hemmed (leisure-shirt). | 6205 20 00 |
1966/94 of 28.7.1994 (OJ L 198, 30.7.1994, p. 103) |
5 | Garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the body to the crotch. The upper part is woven, with a collar, long loose-fitting sleeves fastening at the wrist by means of press-studs, and two patch-pockets at the level of the chest. The garment has an opening at the front from the neckline to the waist, with press-stud fastening left over right. The lower part from the waist to the crotch is made of elasticated knitted fabric with a fastening at the crotch by means of press-studs. | 6205 20 00 |
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
7 | Loose-fitting woven garment (100 % cotton), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, of chequered design and straight-cut. It has short sleeves and a collar with lapels of a different material. It is hemmed at the sleeve-ends and at the base. There is a thin cord through the hem at the base. The garment opens completely at the front with a button-fastening left over right, and there are breast-pockets inserted with slide-fasteners. There are two side-slits approximately 7 cm in length (shirt). | 6205 20 00 |
1012/90 of 20.4.1990 (OJ L 105, 25.4.1990, p. 5) |
1 | Lightweight, sleeveless woven garment (100 % cotton) intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, of a fancy design and manufactured from a single-coloured fabric. It has a rounded neckline without an opening and an exterior pocket at the level of the chest. | 6206 30 00 |
1012/90 of 20.4.1990 (OJ L 105, 25.4.1990, p. 5) |
2 | Lightweight woven garment (100 % cotton) with very short sleeves intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, of a fancy design and manufactured from a single-coloured fabric. It has a rounded neckline with a partial opening on the left shoulder which is closed with a button-fastening. | 6206 30 00 |
1012/90 of 20.4.1990 (OJ L 105, 25.4.1990, p. 5) |
3 | Lightweight woven garment (100 % cotton) with very short sleeves intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, of a fancy design and manufactured from a single-coloured fabric. It has a rounded neckline without an opening, and, on the front, a series of decorative pleats made by stitching. | 6206 30 00 |
1012/90 of 20.4.1990 (OJ L 105, 25.4.1990, p. 5) |
4 | Lightweight, sleeveless woven garment (100 % artificial fibres), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, of a fancy design and made of fabric with printed motifs in different colours. It has a rounded neckline without an opening. | 6206 40 00 |
1012/90 of 20.4.1990 (OJ L 105, 25.4.1990, p. 5) |
5 | Lightweight, sleeveless woven garment (100 % artificial fibres), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, of a fancy design and manufactured from a single-coloured fabric. It has a rounded neckline without an opening and has two side-vents at the base. | 6206 40 00 |
350/93 of 17.2.1993 (OJ L 41, 18.2.1993, p. 7) |
9 | Lightweight woven garment (100 % polyester), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to below the waist, with long sleeves, and made from multi-coloured fabric. It has a collar and a V-neckline, and opens completely at the front, with button-fastening right over left.There are three decorative buttons at each of the sleeve-ends, and elastication on both sides at waist-level. | 6206 40 00 |
728/2004 of 15.4.2004 (OJ L 113, 20.4.2004, p. 3) |
Set of two garments, put up for retail sale, consisting of: | ||
(a) a lightweight garment of a woven, shiny, self-coloured fabric (100 % polyester), with a close-fitting mandarin-style collar, and with a partial front-opening crossing from centre-neck to the left armpit and fastened right-over-left by buttons and loops. These buttons are bulky and consist of rolled, narrow woven fabric. Bound at the sleeve-ends, at the collar, at the front-opening and at the base, the base and the sleeve-ends are curved and have side-vents.The garment is cut straight and intended to cover the upper part of the body as far as the hips. It has an embroidered motif on the front (blouse); | (a): 6206 40 00 |
||
(b) a loose-fitting lightweight garment made of a woven, shiny, printed fabric (100 % polyester), intended to cover the lower part of the body reaching from the waist to the ankles, enclosing each leg separately and of a straight cut. It has an elasticated waist without an opening. The ends of the legs are bound in plain fabric, are curved and have side-vents (trousers). | (b): 6204 63 18 |
||
511/96 of 22.3.1996 (OJ L 76, 26.3.1996, p. 9) |
3 | Set of two garments made up of a lightweight slightly-pleated fabric (100 % viscose), with non-identical multicoloured motifs printed on both garments. It is put up for retail sale and consists of: | |
(a) a short-sleeved garment, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to just below the waist. It has a wide neckline without an opening. There is elastication at the neckline and at the sleeve-ends. Every 2 cm from the chest to the waist inside the garment, there are elastic threads sewn, emphasisng the pleating-effect (smocks) (blouse); | (a): 6206 40 00 |
||
(b) a loose-fitting garment, intended to cover the lower part of the body and reaching from the waist to above the knees. The waist is elasticated and has a drawstring (skirt) | (b): 6204 59 10 |
||
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
8 | Lightweight very-loose-fitting garment, intended to cover the upper and lower parts of the body and reaching down to above the knees (total length 95 cm), made from a printed woven shiny 'satin' fabric (87 % polyester, 13 % cotton) of a thickness of 0,2 mm. It is straight-cut with a curved hemline at the base, and has a collar with lapels. It has long wide sleeves and a V-neckline, and opens completely at the front with a button-fastening right over left.There is a breast-pocket sewn on, and pieces of single-coloured woven shiny 'satin' fabric at the collar, at the sleeve-ends and above the breast-pocket (nightdress). | 6208 22 00 |
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
9 | Set of two garments, packaged for retail sale, consisting of: (a) lightweight very-loose-fitting garment, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips (total length 76 cm), made from a printed woven shiny 'satin' fabric (83 % polyester, 17 % cotton) of a thickness of 0,5 mm. It is straight-cut, and has a collar with lapels. It has long wide sleeves and a V-neckline, and opens completely at the front with a button-fastening right over left.There is a breast-pocket sewn on, and pieces of single-coloured woven shiny 'satin' fabric at the collar, at the sleeve-ends and above the breast-pocket; (b) pair of lightweight loose-fitting trousers, intended to cover the lower part of the body and reaching from the waist to the ankles, made from a printed woven shiny 'satin' fabric (83 % polyester, 17 % cotton) of a thickness of 0,5 mm. It is straight-cut, with no opening at the waist; the waist is elasticated, and the trouser-leg bottoms are hemmed (pyjamas). |
6208 22 00 |
1911/92 of 9.7.1992 (OJ L 192, 11.7.1992, p. 23) |
7 | Set of made-up textile articles of terry-towelling fabric (100 % cotton), put up for retail sale, containing: | |
(a) article to be worn by a baby, consisting of a rectangular shape with a hood at one side bearing an applied decorative motif. At two corners, are two strips to be tied at the waist (bathrobe); | (a): 6209 20 00 |
||
(b) rectangular mitt-type flannel; | (b): 6302 60 00 |
||
(c) bib with two strips to be tied round the neck. | (c): 6209 20 00 |
||
1308/96 of 4.7.1996 (OJ L 167, 6.7.1996, p. 19) |
2 | Two garments packaged for retail sale, consisting of: | |
(a) a lightweight loose-fitting garment made from two differently-coloured fabrics (100 % nylon, coated with plastic visible to the naked eye), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to above the mid-thigh. It opens completely at the front, with a slide-fastener and a protective cover with press-stud fastening left over right. The garment has a high collar sewn on, a hood with a drawstring which can be stored in a pocket in the collar, long sleeves tightened at the ends, and two pockets with slide-fasteners inserted at the front. It can be tightened by drawstrings at the collar, waist and base, and has velcro-tapes at the collar and sleeve-ends, a partial lining (100 % nylon) in the upper part of the garment, a decoration sewn on the left sleeve and a logo embroidered on the chest; | (a): 6210 40 00 |
||
(b) a loose-fitting garment made from two differently-coloured fabrics (100 % nylon),
intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to above the mid-thigh. It
opens completely at the front, with a slide-fastener. It has long sleeves with knitted
ribbing at the ends, a collar of velour fabric sewn on, and two pockets with
slide-fasteners inserted at the front. It has a logo embroidered at the front, a
tightening facility with drawstring at the waist, and quilted lining with an
inside-pocket. The two garments may be used separately, and can be combined by means of velcro-tapes at the collar, press-studs inside the sleeve-ends, and slide-fastener at the opening at the front. |
(b): 6202 93 00 |
||
1458/97 of 25.7.1997 (OJ L 199, 26.7.1997, p. 11) |
5 | Garment, made from single-coloured woven fabric (100 % polyester) of a thickness of 0,3 mm, intended to cover the lower part of the body and reaching from the waist to the ankles, with a black lining, with a slide-fastener at the front protected by a flap button-fastening left over right. The garment has braces, and two devices for tightening it at the waist. There is an opening at each trouser-leg bottom, fitted with a slide-fastener and velcro-fastening. The fabric has a printed motif low down on the front of one leg and below the back-pocket. The fabric is covered on the inside with a sheet of cellular plastic visible to the naked eye (ski-trousers). | 6210 40 00 |
298/2012 of 2.4.2012 (OJ L 99, 5.4.2012, p. 12) |
Made-up article in the form of a sleeveless garment, intended to cover the upper part of the body, reaching down to below the hips. The article is made up of three panels, assembled by sewing. Each panel is made of three layers, two outer layers of woven textile fabric of man-made fibres (nylon) and an inner layer, that serves as protection against radiation, made from a mixture of antimony powder, tungsten powder and a polymer. The three layers are stitched together along all the edges with an applied ribbon. The two front panels overlap each other entirely, left over right. The two front panels are fastened together by two broad long vertical 'Velcro'-type strips down the front and two shorter 'Velcro'- type strips at the shoulders. The front fastening is assisted on the right side by three snap-fit closings. The article has a round neckline, a breast pocket on the left side and padded shoulders. (protective industrial and occupational clothing). | 6211 33 10 | |
2507/91 of 20.8.1991 (OJ L 233, 22.8.1991, p. 9) |
2 | Woven one-piece garment (100 % cotton), gathered at the waist, intended to cover both the upper part of the body and the lower part, to just above the knees, enveloping each leg separately.It has short sleeves, two inset pockets at hip-level and one breast-pocket stitched on. The garment has a collar and a partial opening at the front, with button-fastening right over left. | 6211 42 90 |
651/2007 of 8.6.2007 (OJ L 153, 14.6.2007, p. 3) |
2 | Padded textile article composed of two layers of woven textile material (100 %
cotton), assembled with padding by stitching. The made-up article is assembled by sewing, and shows the following characteristics: the article is approx. 90 cm long and has a close-fitting neckline. It has an opening at the front with a zip-fastener of a length of approximately 68 cm. There is an elastic tightening element at the waist. The upper part of the article has armholes, and the sides and the base are completely closed. The cut of the upper part gives the garment its body-shape (romper bag for children). |
6211 42 90 |
2507/91 of 20.8.1991 (OJ L 233, 22.8.1991, p. 9) |
3 | Woven one-piece garment (100 % synthetic fibres), intended to cover both the upper part of the body and the lower part, to the ankles, enveloping each leg separately, with short sleeves and with inset pockets at hip-level. The garment has a collar and a partial opening at the front, with button-fastening right over left. The garment is accompanied by a tie-belt of the same material. | 6211 43 90 |
1218/1999 of 14.6.1999 (OJ L 148, 15.6.1999, p. 9) |
5 | Sleevless woven garment, intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the hips, made of two-tone synthetic fabric (100 % nylon). It has a V-neckline, opens completely at the front with a zip-fastening and is elasticated at the base. The lower parts of the large armholes are partially elasticated. There is a pocket outside with velcro-fastening, and the garment has belt-loops and an adjustable fabric-belt with a fastening device. The garment is entirely lined, and contains two panels at the front and one at the back, all of which are made of cellular plastic (other garment). | 6211 43 90 |
2064/2001 of 22.10.2001 (OJ L 278, 23.10.2001, p. 3) |
Single-coloured flimsy see-through lightweight woven garment of synthetic fibres (100 % polyester), intended to cover the upper part of the body and reaching down to the calves (length approximately 128 cm at the back). It is unlined, has a collar with lapels and long narrow sleeves, and opens completely at the front, with a button-fastening right over left from the collar to near the waist. The fabric has been turned up and sewn to create a straight hem and cuffs. The garment consists of three panels (two at the front and one at the back) sewn together lengthways, and has two darts at the back from the shoulder-blades to the waist, and another two at the front from the chest to the waist (other garment). | 6211 43 90 | |
471/2002 of 15.3.2002 (OJ L 75, 16.3.2002, p. 13) |
4 | Self-coloured lightweight knitted article for women or girls (86 % nylon, 14 % elastane), to be worn next to the skin, reaching down to just below the bust, with narrow adjustable shoulder-straps. It has a low-cut neckline at the front and back, without opening. There are bands of knitted fabric sewn onto the neckline and the armpits. There are knitted side-panels of varying elasticity on the article, as well as an elasticated reinforcement at the front. There is stitching just below the bust, reinforced on the inside, following the natural shape of the bust. There is an elasticated band of a width of about 2 cm on the lower edge of the article, to make sure that the article clings to the body (brassiere). | 6212 10 90 |
1178/2007 of 5.10.2007 (OJ L 264, 10.10.2007, p. 3) |
Article made up of two knitted fabrics of different colour, of man-made fibres. The
fabrics are suitable for swimwear. The article is to be worn next to the skin, reaching
down to just below the bust, with two preformed cups being thinly padded and wired for
support. The article has narrow removable shoulder straps. It is fastened at the back by means of a clip. The part of the article reaching around the back has adhesive strips, on the inside, clinging to the back of the wearer and holding the article in place together with the shoulder straps and the wired preformed cups. (brassiere designed like a bikini top). |
6212 10 90 | |
155/2008 of 21.2.2008 (OJ L 48, 22.2.2008, p. 12) |
Article consisting of two preformed soft cellular plastic cups covered on both surfaces with knitted fabric. Knitted bands are sewn on to the edges of the cups to reinforce their oval shape. The cups are joined together with a magnetic metal clasp. The inside of each cup is coated with an adhesive which is protected by a plastic film. Following removal of the plastic film, the adhesive enables the cups to adhere to the breasts when in direct contact with the skin. The article is designed to be worn next to the skin (brassiere). | 6212 10 90 | |
1028/2008 of 19.9.2008 (OJ L 278, 21.10.2008, p.3) | Article made up of knitted fabric of different colour, of man-made fibres. The fabric is suitable for swimwear. The article is to be worn next to the skin, reaching down to just below the bust. Two triangle-shaped pieces of textile fabric form cups for the breasts, when the article is worn. Each of the two triangles is lined with a single-coloured knitted fabric and is hemmed at the three edges. The hem at the lower edge forms a tunnel through which an elastic textile string is passed. An elastic textile string is sewn on the pointed upper edge of each triangle. The two vertical elastic strings are tied behind the neck and the horizontal elastic string is tied at the back of the wearer (brassiere). | 6212 10 90 | |
2017/1167 of 26.6.2017 (OJ L 170, 1.7.2017, p. 50) |
A knitted brassiere (61 % nylon, 20 % elastane, 12 % cotton, 7 % viscose), with
adjustable broad padded shoulder straps, centrally positioned over the breasts, with
shaped cups and elastication at the back part of the base. There is an embroidered design on the shoulder straps and cups and a decorative bow at the centre front. The article is closed by means of an adjustable 'hook and eye fastening'. The brassiere has a lining in the cups, with side openings for the insertion of padding for the enhancement of breasts (aesthetic purposes) or for the insertion of breast forms following a mastectomy. |
6212 10 90 | |
1611/93 of 24.6.1993 (OJ L 155, 26.6.1993, p. 9) |
2 | Lightweight knitted garment (85 % polyamide, 15 % elastomeric yarn) with narrow adjustable shoulder-straps, intended to cover the upper part of the body down to the crotch.The front of the garment is of open-work knitted fabric, and the garment is elasticated around the legs and at the back. The crotch has a knitted-cotton lining and is fastened by means of three press-studs. The upper part of the garment resembles a brassiere and is wired for support. | 6212 90 00 |
559/95 of 13.3.1995 (OJ L 57, 15.3.1995, p. 51) |
Rectangular piece (105 x 180 cm) of lightweight fabric (100 % cotton), of which two edges are hemmed and two are selvedged. It has multicoloured motifs printed over the main surface, with a narrow border of plain print along the selvedged edges (shawl). | 6214 90 00 | |
516/1999 of 9.3.1999 (OJ L 61, 10.3.1999, p. 16) |
10 | Goalkeeper's glove for ice-hockey or street-hockey, usually worn on the left hand. It is a mitt, used by the goalkeeper for catching the ball (or puck). It is padded on both sides and has a separate section inside for the fingers. The thumb and forefinger are separated by a webbing of laces (CN-heading 5607). The back of the hand is made of knitted man-made fibres. The palm is made of non-woven polyamide microfibres coated with plastic on the outer surface. | 6216 00 00 |
1196/2005 of 22.7.2005 (OJ L 194, 26.7.2005, p. 9) |
Glove made mainly of woven fabric. The majority of the glove's surface area [which comprises the back of the glove (except the back of the fingers), the wrist, the parts between the fingers, a part of the thumb, and the sides of the hand] is of woven fabric coated on its inner side with a layer of non-cellular plastic. The palm, the front of the thumb, and the sides of the fingers facing the palm, as well as the four fingertips, are of knitted fabric coated on the outside with non-cellular plastic. The backs of the fingers and the outside of the thumb are made of cellular plastic combined with knitted textile fabric on both faces. There are pieces of rubber on the backs of the fingers and thumb, in the area of the knuckle, and a thin blade of rubber along the outside of the index finger. There is an elasticated band and a velcro-type tightening system at the wrist-area, and a drawstring tightening system at the end of the glove. | 6216 00 00 | |
926/2004 of 26.4.2004 (OJ L 163, 30.4.2004, p. 105) |
2 | Made-up article sewn together to form a loop, consisting of an elasticated band which is completely covered by a woven textile fabric (hairband). | 6217 10 00 |
2018/77 of 15.1.2018 (OJ L 14, 19.1.2018, p. 3) |
A cuboid textile article (so-called 'mattress cover') made of printed woven textile
fabrics of man- made fibres (100 % polyester) which is a washable fabric, of a measurement
of approximately 200 x 60 x 8 cm. The article has a zip closure along one of the long sides to enable a mattress to be inserted. On one of the long sides a textile handle is attached. |
6302 22 90 | |
338/2006 of 24.2.2006 (OJ L 55/ 25.2.2006, p 3) | Made-up article of woven textile fabric (100 % cotton), unbleached, rectangular, measuring approximately 180 x 90 cm, with hemmed edges across the width and selvedges along the length. (bed linen). | 6302 31 00 | |
1966/94 of 28.7.1994 (OJ L 198, 30.7.1994, p. 103) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
7 | Rectangular article, of very-tightly woven single-coloured fabric (100 % cotton). The edges are reinforced with woven fabric and hemmed. The surface is overstitched to form internal compartments. On one side, the article has two openings of approximately 10 cm in length, to allow it to be filled with feathers, down or other materials (duvet or quilt-tick). | 6302 31 00 |
1020/2003 of 13.6.2003 (OJ L 147, 14.6.2003, p. 10) |
Self-coloured cover, suitable for laundering (approximately 73 cm x 42 cm), made from a multilayer quilted textile product, with the outer layer consisting of a woven fabric (65 % polyester, 25 % cotton and 10 % polypropylene), the middle layer of wadding, and the inner layer of a self-coloured nonwoven fabric (100 % polypropylene). It has a zip fastener, to allow it to be filled (pillowcase). | 6302 32 90 | |
546/91 of 5.3.1991 (OJ L 60, 7.3.1991, p. 12) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
1 | Set consisting of: a rectangular article (183 x 274 cm) made up of woven fabric (100 % cotton) with well-finished scalloped-edging; in its central section and in each corner, it is decorated with inlaid crocheted lace, as well as having applique and embroidery of different colours (tablecloth); twelve square articles (46 x 46 cm) made up of the same woven fabric; these articles are hemmed and bear the same embroidery-design as the tablecloth, in one corner (napkins). | 6302 51 00 |
546/91 of 5.3.1991 (OJ L 60, 7.3.1991, p. 12) |
2 | Set consisting of: a rectangular article (243 x 279 cm) made up of woven fabric (100 % linen) with well-finished scalloped-edging; it has embroidery over the entire surface, a large proportion of which is open work (tablecloth); twelve square articles (41 x 41 cm) made up of the same woven fabric; these articles have well-finished scalloped-edging, as well as the same open-worked embroidery as the tablecloth, in one corner (napkins). | 6302 59 10 |
92/97 of 20.1.1997 (OJ L 19, 22.1.1997, p. 1) |
3 | Friction-sponge, in the form of a parallelepiped (14 x 9 x 5 cm), consisting of sponge-plastic encased in knitted sisal with a tab for hanging, for use for massaging the body (toilet linen). | 6302 99 90 |
92/97 of 20.1.1997 (OJ L 19, 22.1.1997, p. 1) |
4 | Friction-pad, consisting of sponge-plastic covered on one side with knitted sisal and on the other with knitted terry fabric (cotton), for use for massaging the body. It has an elasticated strap for use in the hand (toilet linen). | 6302 99 90 |
92/97 of 20.1.1997 (OJ L 19, 22.1.1997, p. 1) |
5 | Friction-strap (60 x 12 x 2 cm), consisting of knitted ramie (predominating in weight) and cotton with an intermediate layer of sponge-plastic, for use for massaging the body. The strap has a textile cord at either end enabling it to be used (toilet linen). | 6302 99 90 |
1054/97 of 11.6.1997 (OJ L 154, 12.6.1997, p. 14) |
7 | Friction-strap (70 x 12 x 1 cm) made of knitted sisal, with a wooden handle at either end enabling it to be used to massage the body (toilet linen). | 6302 99 90 |
2016/137 of 26.1.2016 (OJ L 27, 3.2.2016, p. 1) | 1 | An article consisting of a rectangular piece of transparent textile material made of
knitted closed weave fabric of synthetic fibres, a plastic rail and a roller mechanism of
platics and metal. On one end, the textile fabric is fixed to the roller mechanism that is designed to be fixed permanently into the door panel of a specific model of a motor vehicle. On the other end, the textile fabric is fixed to the plastic rail that has a fixture mechanism allowing it to be attached to the frame of the window of the motor vehicle when the textile fabric is unrolled providing protection against the sun. The article does not cover the window pane completely. |
6303 12 00 |
297/2012 of 2.4.2012 (OJ L 99, 5.4.2012, p. 9) |
A rectangular article measuring approximately 60 x 300 cm, composed of two different layers (one layer of textile fabric and one layer of paper) glued together and having a total thickness of approximately 0,26 mm. The layer of textile fabric consists of non- woven synthetic (polyester) fibres with a thickness of approximately 0,18 mm and a weight of approximately 48,3 g/m 2 . The layer of paper has a thickness of approximately 0,08 mm and a weight of approximately 20,9 g/m 2 . The visible side of the paper layer is slightly patterned and has four textile cords of cotton (in the form of twine) glued vertically along the whole length. On the same side, thin bamboo sticks run horizontally across the full width at approximately 4 cm-intervals. The article can be used for several purposes, for example as a panel curtain, as a room divider, to hide open storage or to replace a door. | 6303 92 10 | |
2015/2320 of 8.12.2015 (OJ L328, 12.12.2015, p. 62) | An article consisting of shiny woven transparent fabric (100 % polyester), with a
machine embroidered decoration on it, presented on 300 cm long support rolls. One of the two long edges of the article is trimmed with an interlock stitch having a fabric covered lead cord inserted in the stitching tunnel. The opposite edge has a densely woven selvedge to prevent the fabric from unravelling and the weft ends exceed the fabric in the form of fringes. The length of the fabric that is cut off the roll corresponds to the width of a future curtain. This fabric is converted into a curtain by simply cutting it at the edge of the densely woven selvedge to the required length of the curtain and by hemming this side and the two sides that had been cut off the roll. The edge trimmed with the interlock stitch constitutes the bottom of the curtain and remains as it was on the roll. |
6303 92 90 | |
3295/93 of 26.11.1993 (OJ L 296, 1.12.1993, p. 43) |
2 | Curtain, made up of a ground-fabric (accounting for 90,2 % of the total weight and consisting of 52,7 % linen and 47,3 % cotton), with embroidery (100 % cotton) on it (accounting for 9,8 % of the total weight). | 6303 99 90 |
651/2007 of 8.6.2007 (OJ L 153, 14.6.2007, p. 3) |
3 | Furnishing article of textile materials, to be used in motor-cars. It is intended to be placed on seats of motor vehicles, and consists of a multi-layered material, the outer layers of which are made of a woven material (cotton) and the middle layer of a non-woven material, which serves as padding (seat-cover). | 6304 92 00 |
1562/95 of 29.6.1995 (OJ L 150, 1.7.1995, p. 16) |
Large flat sheet of heavyweight woven cotton canvas, waterproofed, lightly shaped at the front and rear, intended to cover the top of a vehicle-trailer. The article is hemmed along all of the sides, and has straps and hooks for attaching it to the trailer. It has side-flaps of 16 cm (tarpaulin). | 6306 19 00 | |
652/2007 of 8.6.2007 (OJ L 153, 14.6.2007, p. 6) |
2 | So-called 'self-inflatable mattress' intended for outdoor use, with the following
dimensions: 185 cm (L) x 66 cm (W) x 3,8 cm (H). The outer surface of the article consists of a textile fabric of synthetic fibres coated on the inside with plastic. It incorporates a sheet (of a thickness of approximately 3,5 cm) of polyurethane foam with open cells. The outer surface of the article increases the friction with other products (for example, sleeping bags) and is durable, resistant to dirt, dampness and puncture. It has a valve which allows air to go in when the mattress is being unrolled, and out when being rolled up. |
6306 40 00 |
1218/1999 of 14.6.1999 (OJ L 148, 15.6.1999, p. 9) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
6 | Garden-canopy, of dimensions 3 x 3 m, consisting of a covering of thick woven fabric (100 % cotton), presented with metal uprights for the framework, and tensioning-devices for fixing it to the ground. The fabric forms a roof, covering the four uprights. | 6306 90 00 |
471/2002 of 15.3.2002 (OJ L 75, 16.3.2002, p. 13) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
5 | Rectangular-shaped made-up article (measuring 110 x 160 cm) of woven textile fabric (100 % cotton), attached on the two short sides of the woven fabric to each edge of a wooden pole (length: approximately 110 cm) by means of braided cords. Due to the different lengths of the cords, the woven textile fabric obtains an asymmetric shape. Above the wooden pole, there is a fixing device consisting of two braided cords and a metal ring, which allows the article to be fixed e.g. to a hook. The article does not have a defined seating-area (article similar to a hammock). | 6306 90 00 |
670/2013 of 9.7.2013 (OJ L 193, 16.7.2013, p. 2) |
1 | An article made from several panels of close-woven textile fabric (canvas), sewn together to form a three-dimensional 'shape', measuring approximately 2,70 x 2,70 x 1,60 m, with a decorative overhang on all sides with a sewn-on welt along the edge. At each corner on the inside there is a small pocket for holding the article in place on a frame. It also has fabric ties along the seams to attach it to a frame. The article is presented without a frame, poles or accessories. | 6306 90 00 |
1017/2002 of 13.6.2002 (OJ L 155, 14.6.2002, p. 23) |
1 | Thin knitted non-run interlock wiper of 100 % polyester, measuring approximately 21 x 21 cm. All four edges are heat-sealed (cleaning cloth). | 6307 10 10 |
873/2011 of 27.7.2011 (OJ L 227, 2.9.2011, p. 5) |
1 | A composite good made up of a sponge of cellular plastic (polyurethane) (11,5 cm x 8,2 cm x 1,1 cm), and a cloth of knitted polyester fabric which encloses the sponge. The fabric is made of textured yarn of polyesters and aluminium-covered polyester fibres (produced through a vapour metalising process) knitted together. The sponge is fully inserted into the fabric (cleaning cloth). | 6307 10 10 |
1911/92 of 9.7.1992 (OJ L 192, 11.7.1992, p. 23) |
8 | Item made up of knitted elasticated fabric, intended to encase the ankle and part of the foot, with an aperture for the heel. The ends and the edges of the aperture are fitted with rubber strips for tightening (ankle-support). | 6307 90 10 |
1911/92 of 9.7.1992 (OJ L 192, 11.7.1992, p. 23) |
9 | Item made up of cellular rubber covered on both sides with knitted fabric, intended to encase the knee and part of the leg, with an aperture for the kneecap. An elastic tape covers the seam at the back (knee-support). | 6307 90 10 |
834/95 of 12.4.1995 (OJ L 84, 14.4.1995, p. 1) |
Made-up article (knee-pad) of rubberised knitted fabric, intended to cover the knee and part of the leg, with an opening for the knee-cap and a smaller opening behind the knee. Small metal plates sheathed in leather at each side act as a hinge. The knee-pad is adjustable, by means of two velcro strips. | 6307 90 10 | |
1564/2000 of 18.7.2000 (OJ L 180, 19.7.2000, p. 5) |
2 | Made-up textile article, in the shape of a stylised cat's head, with rounded corners and measuring approximately 44 x 39 cm, used as a sun-shield. It is made from transparent knitted close-weave fabric, printed with a cat-motif, stretched over a flexible wire-frame and stitched onto it.In the middle of the fabric, there is a plastic suction-cap, by means of which the the sun-shield can be attached to a windowpane (other made-up articles). | 6307 90 10 |
471/2002 of 15.3.2002 (OJ L 75, 16.3.2002, p. 13) |
1 | Article made of cellular plastic, approximately 4 mm thick (measuring approximately 20 x 24 cm), nearly rectangular because of its rounded corners, covered on one side with a layer of approximately 0,2 mm of multi-coloured printed knitted textile fabric (mouse-pads and similar articles). | 6307 90 10 |
1171/2012 of 3.12.2012 (OJ L 337, 12.11.2012, p. 9) |
1 | Made-up textile article for the storage of small items. The article is made of two nearly rectangular, equal-sized knitted pieces of textile fabric, which are superimposed and sewn together at three sides. At the top end, the edges are turned and sewn as to form a tunnel, with a drawstring and a cord stopper as tightening element. At the bottom end, it has two rounded edges. When tightened, the article obtains the shape of a bag, of a length of approximately 12,5 cm and a width, measured at the bottom, of approximately 6,5 cm and which becomes narrower towards the top. | 6307 90 10 |
671/2013 of 9.7.2013 (OJ L 193, 16.7.2013, p. 4) |
1 | An article consisting of flat cloth, measuring approximately 26 cm x 32 cm, composed of various textile materials, in the shape of a bird. The main part of the article is made of a single layer of long-looped pile fabric with a sewn-on crown-shaped wing of woven textile material on one side. On the other side, the long-looped pile fabric is bordered by a sewn-on ribbon of woven textile material. A piece of triangular shaped woven fabric is sewn on to the long-looped pile fabric and represents the beak. The eyes are printed on looped tabs and two pieces of woven textile fabric cut in the form of feet are sewn on to the pile fabric. A textile material decoratively cut represents the tail. Varicoloured numbered tabs, loops and strips of woven textile material are attached to the upper edge of the pile fabric. | 6307 90 10 |
2015/676 of 23.04.2015 (OJ L111, 30.04.2015, p.18) | An article in the form of a sleeve, approximately 20 cm long, made of knitted textile material with thin foam padding on the palm surface. It includes one slightly curved palmar aluminium splint of approximately 2 cm width, which can be manually bent, and two flexible dorsal stabilisers made of plastic of approximately 1 cm width. The splint and the stabilisers go through stitched-on tunnels of a contrasting material which run the entire length of the article and they can be removed. At both ends of the article there are two 'velcro-type' straps of 2 cm width to adjust the article to the hand and to the wrist. In the middle of the article there is a wider textile strap of 5 cm width with a 'velcro-type' fastening which is wrapped around the wrist to achieve the desired limitation of the movement of the wrist. The textile straps together with the bendable aluminium splint make the movement of the wrist more difficult. The flexibility of the wrist depends on the tightness of the straps. The article is presented as a wrist stabiliser. | 6307 90 10 | |
894/2012 of 6.8.2012 (OJ L 264, 29.9.2012, p. 3) |
1 | Made-up article consisting of 10 rectangular strips each approximately 25 cm long and 2 cm wide, of nonwovens of synthetic filaments (polyethylene) solidified with a binder. The strips are linked to each other along the length by perforation points. The main part of one side of the strips is single coloured. The ends and the reverse of the strips are white. One end of each strip holds the closing mechanism consisting of zigzag embossing on the front side and, on the back, a layer of glue which is covered with anti-adhesive paper to be removed on closure. On the front side of each strip, just before the closing system but on the white background a sequential number measuring 5 mm is printed in black. After separation from each other along the perforation points, when closed each strip is a tear resistant bracelet. | 6307 90 98 |
3176/94 of 21.12.1994 (OJ L 335, 23.12.1994, p. 56) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
Rectangular article, not suitable for regular laundering, made up of very-tightly woven single-coloured fabric (100 % cotton). The edges are reinforced with woven fabric and hemmed. The surface is overstitched to form internal compartments. On one side, the article has openings, to allow it to be filled with feathers, down or other materials (eiderdown- or duvet-tick). | 6307 90 98 | |
1529/1999 of 13.7.1999 (OJ L 178, 14.7.1999, p. 10) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
3 | Carrying-device, made of aluminium tubing and pieces of knitted and woven fabrics (synthetic fibres) sewn together, consisting of a child's seat with padding at the side and at head-height, retaining- and carrying-straps and, underneath, storage-space for small objects. The surface of the seat (including the seat-back), the integral hood, small pocket-like receptacle under the seat, and the carrying-, lap- and other straps are made of textile material (other made-up textile articles - baby-carrier). | 6307 90 98 |
1017/2002 of 13.6.2002 (OJ L 155, 14.6.2002, p. 23) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Woven, five-pointed star, containing metallised yarn and other yarns, stuffed with a synthetic material and measuring approximately 8 x 8 cm. There is a loop for hanging it, made from metallised thread, attached to one of the points (other made-up articles - articles for decoration). | 6307 90 98 |
1229/2013 of 28.11.2013 (OJ L 322, 3.12.2013, p. 8) |
1 | Article consisting of a wooden platform (measuring approximately 40 to 40 cm) covered
on the upper and edges with a felt lined woven fabric of synthetic fibres (polypropylene).
The fabric has a backing of cellular plastic. In the centre of the platform, there is a 60 cm high tube made of cardboard, with a cover on both ends. The cover at the bottom end is made of hard plastic, and a screw is passed through the wooden platform into that plastic cover in order to attach the platform to the tube. The cover at the top end of the tube consists of a round piece of wooden material having a diameter of approximately 12 cm and being covered with a woven pile fabric (a plush of 60% polyacryl and 40% polyester). The tube is covered with a sisal mat glued to it and fixed to it by staples. The sisal mat consists of a latex backing applied to a woven fabric of spun vegetable fibres of sisal. The spun strings of sisal fibres measure more than 20 000 decitex each. |
6307 90 98 |
349/2014 of 3.4.2014 (OJ L 104, 8.4.2014, p. 1) |
A soft reversible textile article in the form of a basket, measuring approximately 35 cm x 25 cm, with stuffed edges (height 10 cm) and a stuffed bottom. One of the outer sides of the article is made of woven fabric (100 % polyester), the other side is made of knitted plush fabric (100 % polyester). The article is for use by small pets. | 6307 90 98 | |
350/2014 of 3.4.2014 (OJ L 104, 8.4.2014, p. 1) |
Article consisting of a wooden box covered on the inside and outside with textile fabric. The box has an opening in the front allowing a cat to enter it and is big enough for a cat to sleep in it. On top of the box a paperboard tube is mounted vertically. The tube is covered with a cord of sisal fixed to it. The cord is made of spun sisal fibres and measures more than 20 000 decitex. The tube is sustaining a wooden platform covered with textile fabric. The platform is big enough to allow a cat to lie on it. A wooden tube covered in textile fabric on the inside and outside is fixed to the bottom of the platform. The tube is wide enough to allow a cat to crawl into it. The textile fabric used is a woven pile fabric (plush of polyester). The total surface of the textile fabric is bigger than the surface of the sisal material. | 6307 90 98 | |
874/2014 of 8.8.2014 (OJ L 240, 13.8.2014, p. 4) |
Ring shaped textile cover of woven polyester fabric to be used on tyres of specific car types in order to enhance the function of the tread of the tyre when driving on snow. The inside of the central part of the article is made of threads of strong continuous polyester fibres giving resistance to the structure. The outside of the central part of the article is made of threads of discontinuous polyester fibres of two different dimensions assuring absorption and adherence through the roughness of the surface of the article. Therefore, the central part of the article which covers the part of the tyre making contact with the ground is more tear resistant and has better absorption and adherence features than the other parts. The other parts of the article are covering parts of the sides of the tyre and are constructed in a way to hold the article in place when driving. All parts are assembled by sewing to each other. On one side of the article four stripes of woven polypropylene are attached, functioning as handles to be used when attaching the article to the tyre. | 6307 90 98 | |
2015/804 of 19.05.215 (OJ L128, 23.05.2015, p. 7) | A textile article designed to hold a person in a sitting position when being lifted by a hoist. The article consists of a woven textile fabric (polyester), essentially in the shape of a rectangle. One of the two short sides of the rectangle has two flap-like extensions, which function as a seat. The rest of the fabric supports the back and the sides of the person. Some parts of the fabric are padded (inserts of polypropylene foam). Several textile straps are sewn to the edges of the fabric, so that the article can be attached to the hoist and be lifted. | 6307 90 98 | |
2015/1385 of 10.08.2015 (OJ L 214, 13.08.2015, p. 6) |
An article to be used for supporting the cultivation of plants indoors and stimulating their growth. | The article measures approximately 80 x 80 x 160 cm and consists of a frame of hollow steel tubes and sides, top and bottom made of a textile material that can be closed completely and that has a coating that reflects light on the inside. The textile material has openings for ventilation, water and electricity and is waterproof, airtight and light-tight. Zips are stitched on the textile material to allow for access to the inside of the article from all sides. | 6307 90 98 | |
1796/91 of 24.6.1991 (OJ L 160, 25.6.1991, p. 40) |
4 | Pieces of non-wovens and of stitch-bonded goods, of various textile fibres, of small dimensions, roughly cut into squares or rectangles (generally, 30 to 35 cm) or irregular shapes. The pieces, some of which are worn, soiled or torn, are put up, unsorted, in bales (rags). | 6310 90 00 |
1796/91 of 24.6.1991 (OJ L 160, 25.6.1991, p. 40) |
5 | Pieces of non-wovens and of stitch-bonded goods, of various textile fibres, of small dimensions, roughly cut. The pieces, some of which are worn, soiled or torn, are put up, unsorted, in bales. The bales contain small irregularly-shaped pieces (approximately 30 to 35 cm) and a negligible quantity of larger dimensions (rags). | 6310 90 00 |
440/89 of 22.2.1989 (OJ L 51, 23.2.1989, p. 8) |
Skating-boots without the skates attached, essentially of plastic but with minor components of textile and other materials. | 6402 19 00 | |
3801/92 of 23.12.1992 (OJ L 384, 30.12.1992, p. 9) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
4 | Training-shoes which cover the ankles, with outer soles of coarsely-patterned rubber, and uppers of plastic (79 %) and leather (21 %), completely covering the inner textile shell which serves as a lining on to which the leather and plastic are sewn. | 6402 91 90 |
849/2002 of 22.5.2002 (OJ L 135, 23.5.2002, p. 10) |
Footwear with an outer sole and upper of plastics, with sole and heel combined having a height of less than 3 cm. A single piece of material is used to form the sole and a part of the upper (raised side-parts). The other part of the upper consists of a plastic strap that is attached across the foot to the aforementioned side-parts by four horizontal plugs. | 6402 99 39 | |
3801/92 of 23.12.1992 (OJ L 384, 30.12.1992, p. 9) |
2 | Training-shoes, with outer soles of rubber, insoles of a length of 27 cm, and uppers of plastic on which strips or pieces of leather are sewn, covering about 40 % of the surface. | 6402 99 93 |
266/2005 of 17.2.2005 (OJ L 47, 18.2.2005, p. 3) |
Footwear, with leather upper lined with a textile fabric and an outer sole of leather, with insoles of a length of less than 24 cm. It is for covering the toes and the ball of the foot, leaving the heel and more than half of the foot exposed, and is attached to the foot by means of two elasticated bands which go round the heel (shoe for rhythmic gymnastics). | 6403 59 91 | |
3801/92 of 23.12.1992 (OJ L 384, 30.12.1992, p. 9) |
5 | Training-shoes which cover the ankles, with outer soles of coarsely-patterned rubber, insoles of a length of 24 cm or more, and uppers of leather (84 %) and plastic (16 %) completely covering an inner textile shell which itself is insubstantial enough to serve as the outer part of the uppers; the leather and plastic are sewn on to the inner shell. | 6403 91 13 |
895/2009 of 23.9.2009 (OJ L 256, 29.9.2009, p.3) |
Boot which covers the ankle. The sole of the boot is made of rubber, yet the majority of the outer sole is cut away and allows inserts holding different outer soles to be inserted into the hollowed out area of the sole. The boots are put up in a set for retail sale together with two pairs of inserts, each holding different outer soles, and a metal tool needed to attach the inserts. One pair of inserts holds outer soles of rubber which have a deeply carved sole typical for trekking boot soles. The other pair of inserts holds outer soles of textile material (approximately 8 mm of felt), which can be used when walking in shallow water according to the importer's documentation. The sole of the boot retains a small part of the outer sole, an almost continuous rim around the edge of the sole. This small part of the outer sole is of rubber matching the trekking sole insert. The footwear cannot be used without the inserts. The insoles have a length of more than 24 cm. The upper of the boot is made up of different leather pieces sewn together leaving "windows" into which nine metallic-mesh pieces and four textile pieces are sewn. The leather makes up the greater part of the external surface area of the upper. The inside of the boot is lined with textile material. The boot is neither waterproof nor water resistant. The footwear can be used by men and women. (trekking boot). | 6403 91 13 | |
347/2001 of 19.2.2001 (OJ L 52, 22.2.2001, p. 8) |
3 | Sandals, with outer soles of rubber, with the sole and heel combined having a height of less than 3 cm, and with insoles of a length of 24 cm or more. The majority of the uppers consists of leather-straps lined with woven man-made fibre fabric. Three straps of textile material fasten across the forefoot with a velcro-type fastening. | 6403 99 33 |
1324/1999 of 23.6.1999 (OJ L 157, 24.6.1999, p. 31) |
Footwear, of the moccasin-type, with uppers of leather, and with outer soles of plastic covered with a layer of textile material which makes direct contact with the ground. | 6403 99 91 | |
289/2000 of 3.2.2000 (OJ L 33, 8.2.2000, p. 3) |
Leisure-wear shoe, with a plastic sole having a hard plastic plate attached by screws under the arc of the shoe and with an upper made of leather (making up the greater part of the external surface, plastic and man-made fibre, with a whole vamp, without metal protectors at the front, not covering the ankles, and with an insole of 24 cm or more. The shoe is not recognisable as a man's or a woman's shoe. | 6403 99 93 | |
650/90 of 16.3.1990 (OJ L 71, 17.3.1990, p. 11) |
2 | Sports shoes (boots), with outer soles of rubber and uppers wholly of textile material on which pieces of leather and decorative pieces of plastic-covered textile material are sewn externally. Leather covers approximately 59 % of the external surface-area, while textile material covers approximately 41 %. | 6404 11 00 |
3801/92 of 23.12.1992 (OJ L 384, 30.12.1992, p. 9) |
1 | Training-shoes, with outer soles of coarsely-patterned rubber or plastics, and uppers of textile material, on the outside of which strips of leather and/or plastic are sewn in various combinations, covering up to approximately 70 % of the surface. | 6404 11 00 |
3801/92 of 23.12.1992 (OJ L 384, 30.12.1992, p. 9) |
3 | Training-shoes, with outer soles of plastic, and uppers of textile on which pieces of leather (65 %) and plastic (18 %) are sewn at various points. | 6404 11 00 |
757/2011 of 27.7.2011 (OJ L 199, 2.8.2011, p. 37) |
Footwear not covering the ankle and not identifiable as men's or women's footwear, with insoles of a length of more than 24 cm. The outer sole is made of rubber and the mid-sole of low-density polymers. The upper consist of pieces of textile, leather and plastics. Grey textile material covers the whole surface of the upper with the exception of a piece of white textile (felt) [2 (*)] at the heel of the footwear. This white textile material is covered by several pieces of grey leather. It is covered mainly by one piece on the heel, and partly by two pieces along both sides of the shoe, and two pieces curved around the instep. At the furthest end of the heel this white textile material is covered by a piece of black impermeable textile material and a piece of dark grey plastic sewn on top. The black textile is visible through small openings in the plastic piece. Abovementioned grey textile materials are sewn to each other and attached to the sole. On one side of the shoe two pieces of grey textile are assembled with a zigzag stitching supplemented by a saddle stitch on both sides of the zigzag stitching. The same saddle stitches are fixing a textile strip underneath the two textile pieces to reinforce the assemblage. In the front of the shoe a piece of grey plastic is covering the grey textile material underneath. On both sides of the shoe pieces of grey leather are attached to the textile material and, on top of the leather/grey textile material, four vertical straps of textile have been added, as well. In addition one textile strap is attached as a loop to the textile material at the heel of the footwear (training shoe). | 6404 11 00 | |
489/89 of 24.2.1989 (OJ L 57, 28.2.1989, p. 16) |
Slippers with textile uppers and outer applied-soles of cotton fabric coated, on the surface in contact with the floor, with a visible layer of plastics. | 6404 19 10 | |
1165/95 of 23.5.1995 (OJ L 117, 24.5.1995, p. 15) |
2 | Slippers, consisting of outer soles of plastic (approximately, 1 cm thick) and textile uppers. The sole is entirely covered with a very thin layer of textile material with poor wearing properties stuck along the edges. | 6404 19 10 |
292/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 43, 14.2.2001, p. 7) |
Slipper, consisting of a textile (towelling material) upper, and an outer sole of plastic with a thin layer of textile covering the central area. On this textile layer which covers 58 % of the outer sole, there are raised PVC-dots. | 6404 19 10 | |
3801/92 of 23.12.1992 (OJ L 384, 30.12.1992, p. 9) |
6 | Hiking-/trekking-boots (footwear which covers the ankles), with outer soles of coarsely-patterned rubber, and uppers of textile material on which are sewn pieces of leather covering about 80 % of the surface. | 6404 19 90 |
2518/98 of 23.11.1998 (OJ L 315, 25.11.1998, p. 3) |
4 | Footwear, with uppers of textile, and with plastic outer soles covered with a layer of woven textile material of a thickness of approximately 1 mm and which has poor wearing properties. The woven textile material makes direct contact with the ground. | 6404 19 90 |
2343/2003 of 23.12.2003 (OJ L 346, 31.12.2003, p. 36) |
Children's leisure-footwear which covers the ankle, with an outer sole of rubber and an upper consisting of a sheet of plastic covered on the external surface area with textile fibres of a length not exceeding 5 mm glued to it and combined on the inside with a thin layer of woven fabric. It has a textile lining. | 6404 19 90 | |
872/2009 of 18.9.2009 (OJ L 249, 23.9.2009, p.3) |
Footwear with outer soles of plastics and a vamp made of straps, attached to the sole at three points. The vamp extends from the left side of the sole to the right side. The arch formed by this part of the vamp is also attached to the sole by means of a strap extending from the middle of the arch down into the sole separating the toes. The vamp of the footwear in question is made up of several layers of different materials. The two straps forming the arch consist of a layer of textile (textile straps T1 and T2 in the photos) on top of which a layer of leather is sewn (two leather straps C1 in the photos). On top of this leather another smaller layer of leather is sewn (two leather straps C2 in the photos) with a brightly coloured textile thread. In between the textile layer (T1/T2) and the leather layer (C1) two non-visible straps (of plastic) (strap A in the photo 646 D) are inserted, one on each side of the arch. In the centre of the arch the two textile straps (T1 and T2) and the four leather straps (C1 and C2) are sewn together with one single thread (see photo 646 C). In the centre of the arch the textile strap separating the toes encircles all before-mentioned materials of the arch by forming a loop around them (textile strap T3 in the photos). The textile strap is partly exposed. On top of this textile loop, in the centre of the arch, there is a rectangular piece of leather sewn onto the textile loop and the aforementioned materials of the arch (rectangular piece of leather C3 in the photos). On the left and right side of the arch, at the point where it is fixed to the sole, several of the straps forming the arch are inserted and glued into the sole. Whereas the leather straps C1 are inserted in the sole with barely 1 cm of their length and the leather straps C2 are inserted only with approximately 5 mm of their length, the textile straps T1 and T2 are inserted into the sole with 5 cm of their length (see photo 646 E). ("thong" sandal). | 6404 19 90 | |
347/2001 of 19.2.2001 (OJ L 52, 22.2.2001, p. 8) |
4 | Indoor footwear, with knitted uppers of pile fabrics, with an applied ribbing covering the ankle, with an animal-head (monkey) made of the same material as the remainder of the upper sewn to the vamp. The sole consists of soft cellular plastic inserted between two textile layers. The outer textile layer is made of resistant textile material and has applied PVC-dots. The outer textile material (approximately 80 % of the surface of the outer sole) and the PVC-dots (approximately 20 % of the surface of the outer sole) make direct contact with the ground. | 6405 20 91 |
2018/1209 of 27.8.2018 (OJ L 220, 30.8.2018, p. 7) |
Footwear (so-called 'dancing shoe') covering the foot but not the calf, open at the
vamp. The footwear is made of one piece of textile material sewn together at the sole and the heel counter and has a textile lining. The sole has two leather pieces sewn on, one at the ball of the foot and the other at the heel part. The front textile part of the sole is raffled to create the round shape for the toes. The textile part of the sole between the two leather pieces is raffled and elasticated by means of an elastic band sewn on the inside of the footwear. It serves to tighten the sole from toes to heel when dancing. The footwear has two pieces of cellular foam covered with textile material sewn on the inside above the leather pieces, which are slightly larger than the leather, yet smaller than the sole making contact with the ground when the footwear is in use. The opening of the footwear can be tightened by an elastic string. Two elastic bands are fixed in the quarter area in order to secure the footwear to the foot. When the footwear is in use (worn while standing on the ground) the part of the footwear that does not cover the sides and top of the foot and that makes contact with the ground consists of approximately 33 % leather and approximately 67 % textile materials. |
6405 20 99 | |
696/2012 of 25. 7. 2012 (OJ L 203, 31. 7. 2012, p. 30) |
Insoles consisting of a flexible forked spring section made of steel and an
interchangeable cushioned pad made of various materials. The insoles are assembled according to the customer's footprint and bodyweight. The insoles are designed to reduce the burden on the feet and the whole body. The three-point support system of the insole is designed to support, move and strengthen ligaments, tendons and muscles. It provides shock absorption, distributes body weight evenly along the entire foot and may compensate the adverse effects of existing flat-footedness. The cushioned pad massages the foot. |
6406 90 50 | |
401/2012 of 7. 5. 2012 (OJ L 124, 11. 5. 2012, p. 16) |
1 | A conical shaped article (approximately 40 cm high), made by sewing 2 nonwoven triangle shaped panels of red textile material together, with an applied trim of white colour at the base, and a white bobble at the top (headgear). | 6505 00 90 |
1155/2010 of 1.12.2010 (OJ L 324, 9.12.2010, p. 42) |
Composite goods made up of an artificial cherry tree branch and an electric lighting fitting with an electrical transformer. These components are attached to each other to form a practically inseparable whole. The artificial branch resembles the natural product (a cherry tree branch with blossoms), made by assembling various parts (brown paper to imitate the twigs, wires to support them, adhesive bands to hold them together, white textile fabric imitating the petals of the blossoms and small plastic parts sustaining the blossoms). The parts are bound, glued and fitted together. An electric light chain holding 60 micro electric bulbs is integrated into the artificial branch. The light bulbs represent the pistils of the blossoms. Due to their size the light bulbs give little illumination effect. The electric wire of the light chain holding the micro light bulbs is completely covered by the branch. The remaining, several metre long, electric wire leaves the main branch and ends in an electrical transformer. The article is neither self-standing nor does it have any means by which it can be hung. It is designed to be placed in a vase. (artificial cherry tree branch). | 6702 90 00 | |
554/2012 of 19.6.2012 (OJ L 166, 27.6.2012, p.20) |
1 | A decorative sprig consisting of artificial flowers (poinsettias), foliage and fruit (conifer twigs and berries). It is made of brocaded textile material, plastics and a metal wire. The product is to be used as a candle decoration. It is presented without the candle and candle holder. | 6702 90 00 |
1170/2012 of 3.12.2012 (OJ L 337, 11.12.2012, p.6) |
1 | An article consisting of a garland of artificial flowers of different colours, an imitation of a so-called 'lei'. Each flower consists of two single coloured pieces of woven textile material cut in the form of flower petals. Each flower is separated from the next flower by a transparent plastic tube imitating the flower-stem. A thin thread links the plastic tubes and the flowers to form a circle with a diameter of approximately 30 cm imitating a circular flower garland. | 6702 90 00 |
729/2004 of 15.4.2004 (OJ L 173, 7.5.2004, p. 9) |
1 | Egg-shaped finial, made up of a mixture of 75 % crushed natural stone and 25 % polyester, with a metal ring at one end to enable a curtain rail to be inserted into it. It is encrusted, over 18 % of its surface, with round pieces of buffalo bone, for decorative purposes. | 6810 99 00 |
679/72 of 29.3.1972 (OJ L 81, 5.4.1972, p. 1) amended by Reg. 2080/91 |
'Vitreous china' or 'semi-vitreous china' which are ceramic products that have been
vitrified to a greater or lesser extent of slightly greyish-white or artificially coloured
ceramic material which is smooth to the tongue, shall, as appropriate, be classified under
headings or subheadings Nos 69.09 A, 69.11, 69.13 B or 69.14 A of the Common Customs
Tariff where, simultaneously, they have the following properties: (a) a degree of porosity (coefficient of water absorption) not exceeding 3 %, measured according to the method set out in Annex I; (b) a density of 2,2 or more: (c) translucency, where the thickness is of not more than approximately 3 mm, measured according to the method set out in Annex II. The latter criterion shall not apply, however, where the ceramic material is coloured in the body or is coated with coloured or opaque varnish or enamel. |
5909 11 00 6911 6913 10 00 6914 10 00 |
|
166/2007 16.02.2007 (OJ L 52, 21.02.2007, p. 5) |
1 | A set of toilet articles put up for retail sale, consisting of: - a beaker, - a soap dish, - a cylindrical toothbrush holder, and - a liquid soap dispenser. The liquid soap dispenser consists of an earthenware container equipped with a plastic pump. The other articles are made of earthenware. All articles have the same design. They are for use as toilet articles. |
6912 00 50 |
729/2004 of 15.4.2004 (OJ L 173, 7.5.2004, p. 9) |
2 | Hand-operated mill, weighing less than 10 kg, for grinding grains of salt for the seasoning of food. The grains of salt are held in a spherical plastic container and are ground by a small ceramic grinding plate. | 6912 00 90 |
810/83 of 5.4.1983 (OJ L 90, 8.4.1983, p. 11) amended by Reg. 2080/91 |
1 | Ceramic money-box, in the form of a pig about 15 cm long and 9 cm high, with a floral motif, having a slot in the back for inserting coins and with a stopper of soft rubber set into a round hole in the base through which the coins can be removed. | 6913 |
810/83 of 5.4.1983 (OJ L 90, 8.4.1983, p. 11) amended by Reg. 2080/91 |
2 | Ceramic money-box, in the form of a figurine of an elderly man (beggar) about 18 cm high, with face and clothes painted on, having a slot for inserting coins and with a stopper of soft rubber set into a round hole in the base through which the coins can be removed. | 6913 |
810/83 of 5.4.1983 (OJ L 90, 8.4.1983, p. 11) amended by Reg. 2080/91 |
3 | Ceramic money-box, in the form of a penguin about 30 cm high, with both a slot in the back for inserting coins and a padlock at the base. | 6913 |
1462/2006 of 2.10.2006 (OJ L 272, 3.10.2006, p. 13) |
An article, in the form of a sheep, measuring approximately 10 cm in height. A knitted fabric, representing the fleece, covers most of the ceramic body leaving part of the head and four hoofs visible. The fabric is glued on the ceramic body. | 6913 90 10 | |
305/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 44, 15.2.2001, p. 22) |
1 | Square ceramic pot (100 % common pottery), of a single colour and of a height of 15 cm. The pot has an enamelled surface inside and out. On the outside, it has abstract or realistic decorative motifs. | 6913 90 10 |
305/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 44, 15.2.2001, p. 22) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Circular ceramic flower-pot (100 % common pottery), multi-coloured, of a height of 38 cm with a diameter of 38 cm. It has a small opening in the bottom, and, on the outside which is enamelled, it has abstract or realistic decorative motifs. | 6914 90 00 |
650/90 of 16.3.1990 (OJ L 71, 17.3.1990, p. 11) |
3 | Sheets of drawn glass of rectangular (including square) shape, known as 'horticultural glass', one of the edges of which has been simply smoothed, normally used in the construction of greenhouses. | 7004 90 80 |
1735/96 of 4.9.1996 (OJ L 225, 6.9.1996, p. 1) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
Glass-fronted clip-frame, of dimensions 30 x 40 cm, consisting of a sheet of mechanically-gathered glass with worked edges, a sheet of printed paper, and a piece of hardboard to support the picture, all held together by four clips of base metal. | 7013 99 00 | |
1509/97 of 30.7.1997 (OJ L 204, 31.7.1997, p. 8) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
3 | 'Musical snowstorm globe', consisting of a mechanically-gathered-glass globe fixed to a plastic base containing a music-box. The globe is filled with a liquid and contains figurines and artificial snowflakes. When the globe is shaken, the flakes simulate a snowstorm. | 7013 99 00 |
141/2002 of 25.1.2002 (OJ L 24, 26.1.2002, p. 11) |
1 | Crackled-glass receptacle with three glass feet, of a height of approximately 9 cm, with, at the top, a circular opening of a diameter of approximately 7,5 cm. A candle can be placed in the receptacle. The receptacle is presented without a candle. | 7013 99 00 |
141/2002 of 25.1.2002 (OJ L 24, 26.1.2002, p. 11) |
2 | Three articles, put up in a set in a cardboard box for retail sale, consisting of: a colourless-glass receptacle, of a height of approximately 15 cm, with, at the top, a circular opening of a diameter of approximately 11 cm; a cylindrical candle, of a height of approximately 4,5 cm and a diameter of approximately 5 cm; and approximately 150 g of fine sand contained in a plastic bag. The candle is to be placed on the sand in the bottom of the receptacle. | 7013 99 00 |
300/2012 of 2.4.2012 (OJ L 99, 5.4.2012, p. 17) |
A stand of rectangular shape measuring approximately 55 x 31 cm, made of glass of fused silica, of a thickness of 8 mm. The stand includes a 5 cm high glass cylinder with a diameter of 5,5 cm and a specially designed mounting bracket. A console made of plastics of rectangular shape measuring approximately 17 x 10 x 2,5 cm is attached to the mounting bracket. The stand is used as a support for a television set to be placed, for example, on a table. | 7020 00 10 | |
2016/1962 of 7.11.2016 (OJ L 303, 10.11.2016, p. 1) |
Unassembled shower doors, designed to be mounted and fixed to the wall, consisting of
the following components: - two panels, made of single-pane-security glass (ESG EN 12150), measuring 2 100 x 860 x 6 mm (pivoting panel functioning as a door) and 2 100 x 810 x 6 mm (fixed/non pivoting panel), - two aluminium profiles to be fixed on one side of each panel, measuring 2 100 x 25 mm containing rails, a plastic seal and four screw holes, - knobs, beams, plates, hinges, clamps and other fixing devices made of high-grade steel, - crews, hex keys, plugs and anchors, - seals (a magnetic seal, for closing the door panels, and a bellows seal for sealing between fixed and movable parts). The glass possesses a protection, having been soaked and processed, against lime, dirt and cleaning agent sediment. |
7020 00 80 | |
3558/81 of 8.12.1981 (OJ L 356, 11.12.1981, p. 28) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
Stud-earrings, whether or not put up in sterile packaging, made of gold- or silver-plated steel, consisting of a shank with a decorative head and a 'butterfly' fastening, the shank being used to pierce the ear by means of a special device, which secures it in the ear-lobe. | 7117 19 00 | |
902/96 of 20.5.1996 (OJ L 122, 22.5.1996, p. 1) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
4 | Ferro-alloy (ferro-silicon), containing approximately by weight: 40 % iron, 47 % silicon, 5 % magnesium and a total of 8 % calcium, aluminium and rare-earth metals. | 7202 29 10 |
407/2018 of 14.3.2018 (OJ L 74, 16.3.18, p. 6-8) |
A product named 'brown fused alumina slag' which is a by-product obtained during the
production of ordinary electro-corundum in electric furnaces. The product is composed of
the following ingredients (% by weight): - iron 75 - silicon 15 - titanium 5 - aluminium 3 - other metals 2 The product is used for concentrating metal ores by selective flotation in the gravimetric separation process. |
7202 29 90 | |
707/2013 of 23.7.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p. 8) |
Welded pipes of non-alloy steel, of circular cross-section of a length of 3 or 6 m, wall thickness of 2,6 to 3,6 mm and an external diameter of 33,7 to 114,2 mm, with grooves at both ends. They are intended to be used as pipes in sprinkler systems. | 7306 30 77 | |
2015/23 of 5.1.2015 (OJ L 4, 2015 1 8, p. 15) |
'T' shaped article of steel. The external diameter of the shoulders is 23 mm and the largest diameter of the central part of the article is 40 mm. Its lateral endings are bevelled, suitable for butt welding, and its third ending is threaded on the inside. The lateral endings are to be welded in between the panels of the radiator. The third ending is used for installing either a vent valve or a regulating valve, or for connecting the radiator with a pipe that connects it to, for example, a boiler. | 7307 93 19 | |
1509/97 of 30.7.1997 (OJ L 204, 31.7.1997, p. 8) |
4 | Stall-flooring for livestock, made from plastic-coated expanded steel sheet with worked edges, and with supports underneath. The flooring is designed to facilitate cleaning. | 7308 90 59 |
762/2011 of 29.7.2011 (OJ L 200, 3.8.2011, p. 4) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
A hollow, non-threaded cylindrical article of steel, other than stainless steel, plated with zinc (so-called "express nail"). It has a complete opening along one side. One of the ends is slightly curved outwards. The other end has a sharp, cutting edge. The article is used as a fastener, by hammering it into a drilled hole for, for example, quick installations of battens onto concrete walls. The sharpened end provides for greater ease in driving it in. Its hollow construction, the opening along one side and the outwardly curved end provide for increased holding power when it is hammered in entirely. | 7317 00 80 | |
540/2013 of 11.6.2013 (OJ L 162, 14.6.2013, p. 3) |
A screw made of stainless steel, measuring approximately 2 cm. The head of the screw comprises a recessed socket drive. The shank has a partial thread of a regular form. The pointed tip has a notch and it is not bifurcated. The article is designed for use in wood and wood panels. | 7318 12 10 | |
553/2012 of 19.6.2012 (OJ L 166, 27.6.2012, p.18) |
An unthreaded article of steel, other than stainless steel, with a hexagon head, a tensile strength of 1 040 MPa and dimensions of 160 mm (length), 32 mm (head size) and 16 mm (shank diameter). It is to be further worked into finished goods of heading 7318, after presentation. | 7318 15 89 | |
2016/1759 of 28.09.2016 (OJ L 269, 4.10.2016, p.4) |
An article consisting of a threaded shank with a metric thread made of zinc plated
steel and a head made of plastics. The threaded shank is manufactured by rolling and is of
a length of 23 mm with a diameter of 6 mm. The round head has a diameter of 14,5 mm and
has no slot or recess for tools. The article is presented to be used as a 'stand/foot' for items of furniture (it can however also be used with other items that are to be placed on the floor) and serves to adjust the height of the item as required by screwing the threaded part into the item. |
7318 15 90 | |
602/2011 of 20.6.2011 (OJ L 163, 23.6.2011, p. 8) |
A product comprising a bolt with a washer, an expandable anchor sleeve and a nut, all made of stainless steel. The bolt has a hexagonal head, is 55 mm long, threaded throughout and has a tensile strength of 490 MPa. The anchor sleeve is 42 mm long with an external diameter of 10 mm when not expanded. It is not threaded. The product is used for fixing articles to a hard substance, such as a concrete wall, by first inserting the anchor sleeve, with the nut inside, in a drilled hole and then inserting and fastening the bolt. As the bolt is fastened, the nut is drawn towards to head of the bolt, causing the anchor sleeve to expand, securing the article firmly to the hard substance. | 7318 19 00 | |
646/2014 of 12.6.2014 (OJ L 178, 18.6.2014, p. 2) |
1 | A product of steel with a body which is partially threaded and partially lined with
plastic. It has a slotted head with a cross slit. It is neither tapered nor pointed at the
end. It has a length of approximately 45 mm and an external diameter of approximately 7
mm. This product is designed to be a part of a mounting suitable for furniture. The threaded end of the product is to be screwed into a predrilled hole in one part of the furniture. The head is to be inserted into a predrilled hole in another part of the furniture. The two parts of the furniture are joined together by locking the head into the slot of the other part of the mounting (not included upon presentation). |
7318 19 00 |
2184/97 of 3.11.1997 (OJ L 299, 4.11.1997, p. 6) |
1 | Barbecue for using once only, put up in a package for retail sale and consisting of an aluminium tray (weighing 35 g), a wire-grill and a wire-stand made of steel (weighing 105 g), charcoal briquettes and three firelighters. | 7321 19 00 |
2017/1232 of 3.7.2017 (OJ L 177, 8.7.2017, p. 23) |
A circular article with a diameter of approximately 500 mm and a weight of
approximately 23 kg. It is made of a spheroidal graphite cast iron (ductile iron,
EN-GJS-500-7). The article is painted with black bitumen for protection against corrosion. The article is certified according to EN 124 standard (gully tops and manhole tops for vehicular and pedestrian areas) and it is used as a sewer cover (for example, for rainwater sewers). |
7325 99 10 | |
1030/86 of 8.4.1986 (OJ L 95, 10.4.1986, p. 13) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
Key-ring, consisting of a small nickel-plated steel chain approximately 3 cm in length, with, at one end, a ring of the same metal which can be opened and closed and, at the other, a small protective cover of plastic (approximately 5 x 2,5 cm) containing a miniature address-book, the cover of which bears a promotional message. | 7326 20 00 | |
2017/2248 of 30.11.2017 (OJ L 324, 8.12.2017, p. 14) |
An article (so-called 'guy grip dead end') made of 6 wires, each having a thickness of
3,25 mm. The wires are of galvanised cold drawn carbon steel. The wires run parallel to each other and are covered by a zinc coating. They are loosely twisted throughout their length and are bent to form a 'U' shape. After presentation, the article is used as 'guying' for wooden telegraph poles i.e. the wire is closely twisted together to become stranded wire. |
7326 20 00 | |
2016/614 of 19.4.2016 (OJ L 105, 21.4.2016, p. 11) |
An article (so-called 'hobby greenhouse'), measuring approximately 140 x 140 x 200 cm, comprising a frame made of steel. The frame also contains racks consisting of eight shelves, four on both sides, made of metal wire, measuring approximately 58 x 28 cm. The frame is covered on all sides by a flexible plastic sheeting with a rolling opening in the front measuring approximately 86 x 145 cm. The opening can be closed by a 'Velcro' fastening. The structure can be entered by a person. Its purpose is long or short term (for example, on markets) storage of plants. | 7326 90 98 | |
810/83 of 5.4.1983 (OJ L 90, 8.4.1983, p. 11) amended by Reg. 2080/91, 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
6 | Metal money-box, in the form of a miniature letter-box about 12 cm high and with a base about 5 x 6 cm, painted red, having a hole in the back for hanging it on a wall, a slot at the front for inserting coins, and a small door with a lock. | 7326 90 98 |
732/2010 of 11.8.2010 (OJ L 214, 14.8.2010, p. 4) |
A product in the form of a steel disc, cut from a flat hot-rolled plate, with a diameter of approximately 187 cm and a thickness of approximately 1,5 cm, with a stamped small hole and larger oval-shaped hole. After presentation, it is to be further processed (milling and drilling of additional holes, mounting of a steel rim and a surface treatment and coating) prior to being used. It is to be used together with a similar disc of a thickness of approximately 2,5 cm to connect one blade to the blade bearing in the nacelle of a so-called 'wind turbine' (a wind engine integrated with a generator). | 7326 90 98 | |
1108/2012 of 23.11.2012 (OJ L 329, 29.11.2012, p. 1) |
A galvanised article consisting of a steel U-shaped bolt threaded at both ends, two hexagon nuts and a cast steel clamp with two holes for the passage of the bolt. The article is used for holding, for example, two or more wires together by placing the wires in the U-bolt, fitting the clamp over the wires and tightening the nuts. | 7326 90 98 | |
278/2013 of 19.3.2013 (OJ L 84, 23.3.2013, p.13) | 1 | A box measuring approximately 33 x 10 x 10 cm, made of metal sheeting with a thickness of approximately 0,2 mm. The outside of the box bears a brand logo and name. Inside the box there is an easily detachable plastic inlay specially shaped to accommodate a bottle. The box is designed to be used as a package for a bottle of wine. The box is presented without the bottle. | 7326 90 98 |
728/2013 of 25.7.2013 (OJ L 203, 30.7.2013, p.1) | A castor consisting of: - a rectangular stainless steel plate with dimensions of approximately 14 x 10 cm with 4 screw holes, - a fork-shaped stainless steel housing with a swivel bearing that rotates through 360°, - a rubber tyre with a diameter of approximately 13 cm and a width of approximately 4 cm, - a plastic rim with a bearing. The castor can be mounted on various articles, such as trolleys, hospital beds and other furniture. | 7326 90 98 | |
757/2014 of 10.7.2014 (OJ L 207, 15.7.2014, p.1) | A box of steel with dimensions of approximately 22,5 x 16,5 x 5,5 cm, with a wall thickness of more than 0,5 mm and of a capacity of less than 50 l. The box has a lid that is fixed to it by means of hinges and a closing system on the other side of the hinges. On the side of the closing system the box has a handle. There are relief-like images of biscuits and cartoon animals on the lid and the bottom of the box. The box has no internal fitting. | 7326 90 98 | |
2147/2004 of 16.12.2004 (OJ L 370, 17.12.2004, p. 19) |
1 | Unalloyed aluminium wire with an aluminium content of 99,5 %, of a diameter of between 9 and 14 mm and a length per wire of 500 to 600 m, put up in rolls with a width of about 1,5 m and a weight of 1,5 tonnes. The aluminium wire rolls have been partly damaged and deformed. | 7605 11 00 |
2147/2004 of 16.12.2004 (OJ L 370, 17.12.2004, p. 19) |
2 | Rolls of unalloyed aluminium wire, cut partially along the side from each end of the roll by means of hydraulic shears. The wire has an aluminium content of 99,5 %, a diameter of between 9 mm and 14 mm and a length per wire of 500 m to 600 m. The rolls have a width of about 1,5 m and a weight of 1,5 tonnes. The product consists of considerable lengths of aluminium wire. | 7605 11 00 |
647/2014 of 12.6.2014 (OJ L 178, 18.6.2014, p. 5) |
A cylindrical hollow product of aluminium, tapered at one end (nipples) and equipped
with a lever lock ring. The product is presented as a coupling for hoses. |
7609 00 00 | |
2016/935 of 8.6.2016 (OJ L 155, 14.6.2016, p. 16) |
A product consisting of a metallised polyethylenterephthalate ('PET') film used as a
raw material source to manufacture an aluminium pigment, having the following
characteristics: - at least eight layers of aluminium of a purity of 99,8 % or more, - the optical density of each aluminium layer is not more than 3,0 D, - neach aluminium layer is separated by an acrylate polymer layer, - the thickness of each aluminium layer is up to 30 nanometres (0,03 mm), - the aluminium and acrylate polymer layers are on a PET (polyethylenterephthalate) carrier film having a thickness of 12 mm. The product is presented on rolls of up to 50 000 metres in length. |
7616 99 90 | |
2016/613 of 19.4.2016 (OJ L 105, 21.4.2016, p. 8) |
1 | An article (so-called 'monitor arm') made of aluminium, consisting of two arms,
movable joints, and an attaching part at each end of the article. It is designed to be fixed onto a wall, a desk or a rail at one end and to a monitor at the other. The article allows height/width/depth adjustment of the monitor fixed to it. The monitor can be moved in all directions as required by the user. Simultaneously the cables can be neatly concealed in the article. The article can also be adapted for use with tablets, telephones, etc. |
7616 99 90 |
615/2013 of 24.6.2013 (OJ L 175, 27.6.2013, p. 9) |
A cylindrical article made of aluminium alloy, with holes and recesses, of a length of approximately 8 cm and a diameter of approximately 4 cm. The article is used as a part of the retracting unit of a safety seat belt used, for example, in motor vehicles, speed boats and chair lifts for stairs. | 7616 99 90 | |
2017/2244 of 30.11.2017 (OJ L 324, 8.12.2017, p. 3) |
A product consisting of two horizontal rails and two vertical rails of extruded
aluminium, which together constitute a frame designed to be fixed to the wall by means of
screws. The product is designed to serve for the attachment of wall-tile panels. The design of the horizontal rails enables the panels to be slid into them, which facilitates the removal and replacement of the panels when needed. |
7616 99 90 | |
1200/2001 of 19.6.2001 (OJ L 163, 20.6.2001, p. 6) |
1. | Zinc, in the form of balls of a diameter of approximately 5 cm, containing by weight 97,5 % or more but less than 98,5 % zinc, with a rough surface. | 7901 12 90 |
1200/2001 of 19.6.2001 (OJ L 163, 20.6.2001, p. 6) |
2. | Zinc, in the form of pieces of a length of 2 to 2,5 cm, containing by weight 97,5 % or more but less than 98,5 % zinc, with an irregular-fracture surface made by being cut from bars, rods or profiles. | 7901 12 90 |
641/2013 of 24.6.2013 (OJ L 186, 5.7.2013, p. 1) |
1 | A set put up for retail sale, so- called 'fireside companion set', consisting of: - a floor standing cast iron tool holder, - a poker, - a shovel, - tongs. It is designed for handling coal, logs and ash at a fireplace. |
8205 51 00 |
641/2013 of 24.6.2013 (OJ L 186, 5.7.2013, p. 3) |
2 | A set put up for retail sale, so- called 'fireside companion set', consisting of: - a floor standing stainless steel tool holder, - a poker, - a shovel, - a brush, - tongs. It is designed for handling coal, logs and ash at a fireplace. |
8205 51 00 |
858/2014 of 4.8.2014 (OJ L 235, 8.8.2014, p. 1) |
1 | An article (so-called manual knife sharpener) with measurements of approximately 27 x 14 x 19 cm, consisting of a handle and a support containing a two-stage (sharpening and polishing) grinding system with micron size diamond abrasives. | 8205 51 00 |
1288/91 of 14.5.1991 (OJ L 122, 17.5.1991, p. 11) |
1 | Small plate for an interchangeable tool, consisting of a compact layer of synthetic diamond permanently attached to a metal-carbide substrate. | 8207 90 10 |
729/2004 of 15.4.2004 (OJ L 173, 7.5.2004, p. 9) |
3 | Hand-operated mill, weighing less than 10 kg, for grinding peppercorns for the seasoning of food. The peppercorns are held in a spherical plastic container and are ground by a small grinding plate of base metal. | 8210 00 00 |
729/2004 of 15.4.2004 (OJ L 173, 7.5.2004, p. 9) |
4 | Set, put up for retail sale, consisting of a hand-operated pepper mill and a hand-operated salt mill, for the seasoning of food. The peppercorns and grains of salt are held in separate spherical plastic containers and are ground by small grinding plates. The grinding plate in the pepper mill is made of base metal, while that in the salt mill is made of ceramic material. | 8210 00 00 |
2017/1472 of 11.8.2017 (OJ L 210, 15.8.2017, p. 1) |
A rod of aluminium (so-called 'shower curtain rod') which is used for hanging a
curtain. It consists of two hollow aluminium tubes. The smaller tube fits into the broader
tube. The rod is extendable and contains a spring mechanism of steel inside the broader
tube that is designed to press the two tubes towards a wall. The article is presented without a curtain or curtain-rings. |
8302 41 90 | |
2017/636 of 30.3.2017 (OJ L 91, 5.4.2017, p. 4) |
A pair of buckles to be used as a locking mechanism for safety seat belts. Each buckle
consists of a metal locking mechanism, a plastic housing, a textile strap, metal
connecting elements, and an electric sensor which generates an audio signal when the
vehicle safety seat belts are supposed to be, but are not, coupled. In the total composition of the product by weight, carbon steel represents 56 %, plastics 21 %, textiles 13 % and other materials 10 %. It is an element of a seat belt assembly used, for example, for seats of a motor vehicle. |
8308 90 00 | |
1035/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 3) |
1 | A turbine wheel of a nickel-based alloy comprising radially arranged blades and a central hub to be placed on the shaft of an exhaust-gas turbocharger. The wheel is the component of a turbine which transforms the energy of the incoming motor exhaust-gas into a rotational movement for driving the compressor wheel of the turbocharger. | 8411 99 00 |
1035/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 3) |
2 | A turbine housing of base metal consisting of a cavity for the turbine wheel, an opening for the inlet exhaust-gas pipe and an opening for the outlet exhaust-gas pipe. The housing is the component of a turbine which contains the turbine wheel enabling it to transform the incoming motor exhaust-gas energy into a rotational movement for driving the compressor wheel of the turbocharger. | 8411 99 00 |
43/2013 of 17.1.2013 (OJ L 18, 22.1.2013, p. 5) |
1 | An electric breast vacuum pump consisting of: - a housing with an integrated pump driven by an electric motor, a battery and controls to adjust suction strength and rhythm, - a suction bonnet with a funnel-shaped suction attachment, - a plastic adaptor for attaching a milk bottle. The pump exercises a rhythmic vacuum on a woman's breast to extract the milk. | 8414 10 89 |
873/2014 of 8.8.2014 (OJ L 240, 13.8.2014, p. 2) |
1 | An article consisting of a round part with a diameter of approximately 15 cm and a tube-like extension, approximately 20 cm long. On the upper side of the article is a circular hole allowing the inflow of air. The bottom side has a plastic valve towards the end of the extension. The outer surface is made of two parts of textile material coated on the inner side and glued together. On the inside, there is a round cylinder of plastic foam with a cut-out in the middle. By covering the circular hole on the upper side and exerting pressure, the air is transported via the extension and the valve to inflate a specific air mattress. The article is presented as a mini-pump. | 8414 20 80 |
873/2014 of 8.8.2014 (OJ L 240, 13.8.2014, p. 2) |
2 | A kidney-shaped article (measuring approximately 35 cm x 17 cm), with a tube-like extension (approximately 25 cm long) which has three valves. On the bottom of the article there is a valve allowing the inflow of air. The upper side has two plastic valves towards the end of the extension, situated side by side. The outer surface is made of two parts of textile material coated on the inner side and glued together. On the inside, there is an oval-shaped piece of plastic foam with a cut-out. This cut-out is fitted with a valve on the bottom. By covering the valve on the bottom side and exerting pressure, the air is transported via the extension and the outermost valve to inflate a specific air mattress. The article is presented as a mini-pump. It can also be used as a pillow as by inserting one of the valves on the extension into the other, the article is prevented from deflating. | 8414 20 80 |
614/2004 of 1.4.2004 (OJ L 98, 2.4.2004, p. 4) |
7 | Goods-management system for the dissemination of instructions to staff (in warehouses,
for example) and for the transfer of data about packaging to automatic data-processing
machines, both by radio transmission within a 400-metre range and by wire. The system
consists of: - a network controller - a radio-link controller - a wireless gateway - a hand-held terminal - a hand-held terminal with bar-code reader The data are sent by radio from the hand-held terminals, either to the radio-link controller or to the wireless gateway, and transferred from there by wire via the network controller to automatic data-processing machines (not components of the system). The system is made up from varying assortments of the components. |
8471 80 00 8525 20 99 8525 20 99 8525 20 99 8525 20 99 |
1655/2005 of 10.10.2005 (OJ L 266, 11.10.2005, p. 50) |
2 | Household-type combined refrigerator-freezer of a capacity of 579 litres, fitted with two separate external doors. The overall dimensions are 180,8 cm (height), 92,5 cm (width) and 81,6 cm (depth). The weight is 112 kg. The capacity of the refrigerator is 368 litres and the capacity of the freezer is 211 litres. The refrigerator has tempered glass shelves, two vegetable drawers and, on the inside of the door, space for storing bottles, etc. The freezer has three drawers. | 8418 10 20 |
455/2014 of 29.4.2014 (OJ L 133, 6.5.2014, p. 31) |
1 | A floor standing apparatus for dispensing cold water (so-called 'water cooler') with a height of approximately 124 cm and a weight of approximately 100 kg. It comprises a cooling system consisting of a compressor and a condenser. It has a storage capacity of 150 l and a nominal cooling capacity of 150 l/h allowing up to 750 glasses of water to be dispensed per hour. It operates with a voltage of 220 V AC. | 8418 69 00 |
1215/2014 of 11.112014 (OJ L 329, 14.11.2014, p. 11) |
A solar panel with dimensions of approximately 2 x 2 m, consisting of 25 glass vacuum tubes mounted in parallel and interconnected via a collector pipe. Each vacuum tube is constituted by two concentric pipes, containing heat transfer fluid. The inner pipe of each tube is coated with an absorption layer. The solar energy is absorbed by the layer on the inner pipe of the tubes and converted into heat energy. The heat is then transferred to the heat transfer fluid, which turns into gas, rises and transfers the heat to the collector pipe (a copper manifold). The heat is subsequently transferred from the collector pipe to a water storage tank by way of a tubing system containing heat transfer fluid circulating by means of a pump managed by a controller. The pump, controller, tubing system and water storage tank are not included upon presentation. The solar panel is used in solar water heating systems and is intended to be mounted on the roof. | 8419 19 00 | |
2016/665 of 26.4.2016 (OJ L 115, 29.4.2016, p. 22) |
A hand-held electric apparatus (so-called 'glue gun') designed to apply hot melted
glue to wood and other materials. The body of the apparatus is made of plastics and has an
interchangeable nozzle made of base metal. The nozzle is adjustable so the flow of the
glue can be regulated. When the apparatus is turned on, a delivery tube controlled by a thermostat is heated which in turn heats a replaceable glue stick (with a maximum temperature of 207 °C). The glue becomes soft and can be applied to the materials to be glued. It is designed to be used mainly by professionals, for example, in the packaging industry, the furniture industry, or a stand assembly. |
8419 89 98 | |
1125/2012 of 26.11.2012 (OJ L 331, 1.12.2012, p. 9) |
1 | A microprocessor-controlled hand-held machine (so-called "electronic hot air blowing gun"), for generating temperatures of between 50 and 630 °C, with a maximum output power of 2 000 W and dimensions of approximately 26 x 20 x 9 cm. The machine comprises: - a heating element, - a fan with a motor for blowing air at 3 different speeds, - a display for indicating the temperature. The machine is for use by craftsmen, for example, in stripping paint, shrinking tubing on cables, forming PVC, soft soldering, welding and joining plastic, welding plastic pipes and rods and foil welding. | 8419 89 98 |
2015/387 of 5.03.2015 (OJ L 65, 10.3.2015, p. 7) |
An electrical apparatus, consisting of a cylindrical metal housing incorporating a lamp that emits ultraviolet (UV) radiation and an electronic module with light indicators for the status of the apparatus. The power of the UV light varies from 14 to 39 W. The apparatus is supplied with a standard voltage of 220 V. It is presented to be used for the photochemical purification of water. The purification is performed by the UV irradiation of the passing water, thereby destroying bacteria, viruses and other micro-organisms therein. It is presented to be used in household, medical or industrial environment. | 8421 21 00 | |
109/2010 of 5.2.2010 (OJ L 36, 9.2.2010, p. 7) |
An article consisting of: - a cylindrical container of steel approximately 33 cm high and of a diameter of approximately 29 cm, - a steel lid with two circular openings of a diameter of approximately 5 cm and 6 cm respectively, - a cylindrical grid of steel approximately 8 cm high and of a diameter of approximately 12,5 cm, - a flexible steel tube, and - a suction nozzle. The steel grid is fitted on the underside of the lid under one of the openings. The tube with the suction nozzle is fitted to the other opening. The article is intended for cleaning, for example, fire places, using it together with a vacuum cleaner when the vacuum cleaner hose is connected on the upper side of the lid to the opening with a grid. When vacuuming, coarse particles stay at the bottom of the container whereas airborne particles are filtered out of the air stream by the grid. | 8421 39 20 | |
273/2013 of 19.3.2013 (OJ L 84, 23.3.2013, p. 1) |
1 | An electronic apparatus (so-called 'body composition analyser') incorporating an indicator panel with dimensions of approximately 30 x 30 x 4 cm, comprising the following main components: - for weighing: a load cell and hardware for processing and displaying the weight, - for measuring: 2 electrodes on the scale upper surface, control buttons and hardware for processing and displaying the measurements. Through the 2 electrodes in contact with the feet, the apparatus sends electrical currents which, using bioimpedance characteristics, allow the apparatus to determine, for example, the percentage of body fat, the percentage of muscle, the bone mass, the body water. The apparatus can also be used as a scale only. The apparatus can store data for 10 users. It can display values from 2 measurements per user. The apparatus is designed for domestic use. | 8423 10 90 |
1067/2010 of 19.11.2010 (OJ L 304, 20.11.2010, p. 11) |
A product (so-called 'shower head') made of plastics with a nickel coating, used for distributing water by means of a nozzle. It is equipped with a button connected to a valve which prevents water from flowing back and also changes the type of water jet ('rain' or 'massage'). However, the valve does not regulate the water flow. The flow of water from the nozzle is regulated by the tap to which the product is intended to be connected via a flexible hose. | 8424 89 00 | |
220/2018 of 09.2.2018 (OJ L 43, 16.2.2018, p. 3-5) |
A mechanical appliance (so-called 'manual spreader') consisting of a steel structure,
a plastic tank with a canvas lining of a volume of approximately 60 litres, a rotation
spreader at the bottom, and two pneumatic tyres. It is designed for distribution (spreading/dispersing through rotation) of fertilisers, sand, seeds, salt etc. The distribution volume can be adjusted by the grip. It is suitable for regular maintenance of large areas. |
8424 89 70 | |
1248/2011 of 29.11.2011 (OJ L 319, 2.12.2011, p.37) |
A machine for use with lifts, with dimensions of approximately 83 x 70 x 30 cm and a weight of 418 kg (so-called 'gearless traction machine'), consisting of: - a permanent magnet synchronous electric motor with a power of 3,4 kW, - a pulley on the shaft of the motor, - a braking system, and - a signal generator for determining the correct position of the cables (safety monitoring system). The machine is installed in a lift shaft for lifting and lowering the cabin. | 8425 31 00 | |
738/2000 of 7.4.2000 (OJ L 87, 8.4.2000, p. 10) |
4 | Vehicle fitted with a hydraulic lifting-device with a work-platform and forks. It has a battery-powered electric motor, for operating the lifting-device and for moving the vehicle. The controls for the lifting-device are mounted on the work-platform. The vehicle is not designed for use on the public highway. The lifting-device has a maximum height of 2,5 m, and can lift up to 1 200 kg. | 8427 10 10 |
738/2000 of 7.4.2000 (OJ L 87, 8.4.2000, p. 10) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
5 | Vehicle fitted with a hydraulic lifting-device with a work-platform. It consists of a flat surface on which are mounted a lifting-device and an electric motor to power the lifting-device and the vehicle; the controls for the lifting-device are mounted on the work-platform. The vehicle has four large wheels (12,5 x 16"), a gradeability of 25 %, and a maximum speed of 4,3 km/h. It is not designed for use on the public highway, unless towed by another vehicle. The lifting-device is permanently fixed and consists of a telescopic jib, moving vertically and horizontally; it has a work-platform (0,66 x 1,5 m) with safety-railing. The lifting-device has a maximum height of 15,5 m, and can lift up to 227 kg. | 8428 90 90 |
738/2000 of 7.4.2000 (OJ L 87, 8.4.2000, p. 10) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
6 | Hydraulic lifting-device, with four wheels and fitted with a work-platform. The lifting-device has a motor for operating the the lifting-jib only; the controls of the telescopic jib are mounted on the work-platform. The lifting-device has four retractable stabilising-legs which are in contact with the ground when the lifting-device is in use. It does not have a motor for self-propulsion and is not designed for use on the public highway. The lifting-device consists of a telescopic jib, moving vertically it has a work-platform (0,66 x 0,66 m) with safety-railing. The lifting-device has a maximum height of 12,8 m, and can lift up to 160 kg. | 8428 90 90 |
2016/2225 of 5.12.2016 (OJ L 336, 10.12.2016, p. 25) |
A cylindrical article predominantly made of steel (other than of cast steel) of a
length of approximately 35 cm and a diameter of approximately 19 cm at its widest point
(so-called 'track roller'). It consists of the following main components: a cylindrical
shell with a graduated cage for the chain guide; a highly polished shaft, and two bronze
bushings and collars at both ends. The article is designed for use with the track chain of a crawler type excavator in conjunction with other similar track rollers for longitudinal and lateral guidance of the track chain. |
8431 49 80 | |
3417/88 of 31.10.1988 (OJ L 301, 4.11.1988, p. 8) |
1 | Electromechanical food-processor, with a total weight of 9 kg, power-input of 1 kW and bowl of capacity 3,5 l. | 8438 80 99 |
105/2012 of 7.2. 2012 (OJ L 36, 9.2.2012, p. 21) |
A multifunctional machine, with dimensions of approximately 62 x 76 x 98 cm and a weight of approximately 153 kg, comprising a scanner and an electrostatic print engine. It has a 150-page automatic page feeder for two- sided originals to be copied, 2 paper feeder trays, a control panel for the user, a RAM memory of 2,5 GB and an in-built hard disk of 80 GB. It is equipped with Ethernet, WLAN and USB interfaces. The machine is capable of performing the following functions: - scanning, - printing and - digital copying. The machine can also send scanned documents via the Internet (so-called "e-mail/Internet faxing"). The machine is capable of reproducing up to 51 A4 pages per minute. It can also reduce or enlarge the images it scans (zoom 25 - 400 %). It has a scanning speed of 70 images per minute. It has a print resolution of 1 200 x 1 200 dpi for text only and 600 x 600 dpi for images. The copy resolution is 600 x 600 dpi. The machine operates either in an autonomous form as a copier, by scanning the original and printing the copies by means of the electrostatic print engine, or when connected to a network or an automatic data-processing machine as a printer, a scanner and for Internet faxing. | 8443 31 80 | |
1165/95 of 23.5.1995 (OJ L 117, 24.5.1995, p. 15) |
6 | Laser copier, comprising mainly a device for scanning (scanner), a digital image-processing device, and a printing device (laser printer), contained in a housing. The scanner uses an optical system consisting of a lamp, mirrors, lenses and photocells, to scan the original image line-by-line. The copies are produced electrostatically via a drum on the laser printer by the indirect process. The laser copier has several additional features for altering the image, e.g. reduction, enlargement, shading. | 8443 39 10 |
2016/1354 of 5.8.2016 (OJ L 215 of 10.8.2015, p.1) | An article (so-called 'toner cartridge'), consisting of a rectangular plastic recipient with dimensions of approximately 11 cm x 11 cm x 7 cm filled with toner. On the outside the cartridge is provided with sprocket wheels specifically designed to be used in connection with certain mechanical parts of a specific printer. Inside, the cartridge is equipped with a rotating mechanism that works in conjunction with the sprocket wheels. When the toner cartridge is placed in a printer, the rotation prevents the toner from agglomerating. The cartridge has the capability of releasing the toner by electrostatic attraction. | 8443 99 90 | |
2015/2317 of 8.12.2015 (OJ L 328 of 12.12.2015, p.55) | A free arm sewing machine of the household type with a built-in electric motor of an
output of 70 watts, equipped essentially with a needle plate, a presser foot, a bobbin
case, controls, a built-in light, a cabled foot pedal and various accessories (e.g.
bobbins, guide rails, a set of needles, double needles, etc.). It weighs approximately 7
kg (including the motor) and offers over 24 sewing programmes. It has a value of more than
EUR 65. The sewing machine works with an upper and a lower thread. One thread is inserted on the needle and the other is carried underneath by a shuttle (lock-stitch technique). The sewing machine can produce various types of stitches, however all these stitches are based on the principle described above. The machine can only imitate the over-lock stitch and is unable to cut off protruding material in the same operation. |
8452 10 11 | |
2015/2316 of 8.12.2015 (OJ L 328 of 12.12.2015, p.52) | A cylindrical-shaped, battery-operated article made of plastics with a lid (so-called
'electronic money box'), of a height of 17 cm and a diameter of 12 cm. The lid includes a small LCD display and a slot to put coins (for example, euros) in. When a coin is manually inserted into the slot, a mechanism in the lid (the calculating device) recognises the diameter of the coin, and its value is displayed. When more coins are inserted one by one, the recognised values are added to the existing amount and the total sum is shown on the LCD display. No subtraction takes place when coins are removed from the money box. |
8470 90 00 | |
2015/1800 of 6.10.2015 (OJ L 263 of 8.10.2015, p.16) | A portable electronic apparatus, with measurements of 7 x 60 x 110 mm and a weight of
100 g, consisting of the following main components in a single plastic housing: - a colour LED display with touch screen with a diagonal measurement of the screen of 8,9 cm (3,5 inches) and a resolution of 960 x 640 pixels, - a central processing unit, - a RAM memory of 256 MB, - a storage capacity of 32 GB, - a module for wireless connection to other apparatus and to the internet, - a rechargeable lithium battery, - a loudspeaker, - a microphone, and - a camera for capturing video and still images. It has the following interfaces: - a connector to charge the apparatus and to connect it to other apparatus such as an automatic data processing (ADP) machine, and - a 3,5 mm jack plug. The apparatus allows the user, inter alia, to connect to the internet, to download, execute and modify software applications, to receive and send e-mails, to play games, and to download, record and reproduce music, video and photos. |
8471 30 00 | |
754/94 of 30.3.1994 (OJ L 89, 6.4.1994, p. 2) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Product, known as a 'graphics tablet' or 'digitising tablet', consisting of a flat plastic housing containing electronic and electrical components, such as processors, printed-circuit board and interface-circuitry. The uppermost surface, with an active area of approximately 28 x 28 cm, is fitted with a menu-overlay. There is a stylus with the tablet, for linking by a cable directly to the central processing unit of an automatic data-processing machine. | 8471 60 70 |
2017/1971 of 26.10.2017 (OJ L 281, 31.10.2017, p. 11) |
An electronic apparatus (so-called 'Solid State Drive (SSD)') with dimensions of
approximately 100 x 70 x 7 mm, a 2,5 inch form factor and a storage capacity of 128 GB. It is a semiconductor based electronic storage device, built on solid state architecture, with flash memory to store non-volatile data and Dynamic Random Access Memory (DRAM). It has a Serial Advanced Technology Attachment (SATA) interface which permits integration in an automatic data-processing machine and is used as an internal data storage device. |
8471 70 98 | |
1165/95 of 23.5.1995 (OJ L 117, 24.5.1995, p. 15) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 705/2005 |
3 | Automated cartridge-system, in a casing, consisting essentially of: (a) one or more library-storage modules (each containing cartridge-storage cells and a microprocessor-controlled robot, and having one or more attached cartridge-drive frames and control units); and (b) a library-management unit with integral software (which acts as the link between the library-storage modules and one or more central processing units). This system is designed specifically for the automatic loading, processing, storage and unloading of magnetic-tape cartridges for automatic data-processing purposes. | 8471 80 00 |
2564/95 of 27.10.1995 (OJ L 262, 1.11.1995, p. 25) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Reader for a microprocessor-card ('smart-card'), housed in a plastic or metal casing with a slot for inserting the smart-card, a liquid-crystal screen, and a keyboard (with ten number-keys, four function-keys, one validation-key and one correction-key). The reader may be held in the hand, placed on a surface or attached to a wall, etc. It may be used on its own or as a peripheral unit for the processing of data, such as in banking, business or medical areas, in controlling access to vehicles, or in working-time management, with or without being connected to an automatic data-processing machine. | 8471 90 00 |
1386/2003 of 1.8.2003 (OJ L 196, 2.8.2003, p. 19) |
1 | Digital stencil duplicator, with a scanner for the digitisation and electronic processing of the text and images to be reproduced. The apparatus uses a stencil (master) consisting of a vegetable-fibre film with a plasticised coating on which the data are burned by means of a thermal head. The burned stencil is conveyed to a printing drum and fixed there. The paper sheets for printing are held against the drum under the pressure of a roller.The apparatus has a multi-speed printing system (60, 80, 100 and 120 copies per minute). It is equipped with a control panel incorporating a liquid crystal display, an automatic sorter, paper-trays, and a receiving tray with side-guides.The machine functions as a stand-alone apparatus, but can be connected to an automatic data-processing machine. | 8472 10 00 |
2016/1760 of 28.9.2016 (OJ L 269, 4.10.2016, p. 6) |
1 | An apparatus consisting of a bank note validator and cash boxes (so called 'note float
unit') with total dimensions of approximately 10 x 24 x 44 cm. The bank note validator uses optical scanning technology to check the authenticity of bank notes according to predefined specifications. Bank notes that are approved by the validator pass to a cash box. When this cash box has reached its capacity (generally 30 bank notes), the bank notes are automatically sorted and distributed towards other cash boxes with a capacity of generally 300 bank notes. The apparatus is used, for example, in gaming, vending, parking machines etc. to pay for the service or for the product obtained. The apparatus is also capable of dispensing bank notes. The apparatus is always connected to a so-called 'host-controller' (not present upon presentation) which regulates the predefined bank note specifications and the bank note flow to the different cash boxes. |
8472 90 70 |
3272/94 of 27.12.1994 (OJ L 339, 29.12.1994, p. 58) |
1 | Steel ball, coated with silicon-rubber and meeting the following specifications: shore-hardness (A-type) of 70 +/- 5, raised moulding parting-line not exceeding 0,05 mm, diameter not exceeding 22 mm, and total weight of 31 g (+/- 1 g), designed for use in the manufacture of a pointing-device (so-called 'computer mouse'). | 8473 30 80 |
759/2014 of 10.7.2014 (OJ L 7, 15.7.2014, p. 7) |
A non-self-propelled machine (so-called 'beach rake machine') for cleaning sand beaches with dimensions of approximately 4 x 2,3 x 2,3 m. It is used for sifting and cleaning sand of impurities, such as glass, plastic, cigarette butts, straws, cans, stones, sea grass, seaweed, small pieces of wood. The machine levels the sand surface by means of a mouldboard deflector plate. The sand is then sifted through hundreds of stainless steel spring-loaded tines. Finally, the impurities are separated from the sand and carried on a conveyor into a hopper. | 8479 10 00 | |
1400/2001 of 10.7.2001 (OJ L 189, 11.7.2001, p. 5) |
1 | Liquid-soap dispenser, in the form of a base-metal container, on top of which is mounted a push-button-operated piston-pump consisting of a plunger-spring, a sealing-plunger, a rod and a plunger-tube. | 8479 89 97 |
315/2011 of 30.3.2011 (OJ L 86, 1.4.2011, p. 59) |
Electromechanical machine (so-called 'vibrating platform'), comprising a steel platform and a central column equipped with a handle and a control panel. The machine measures approximately 80 x 80 x 120 cm and weighs 34 kg. The control panel has a keypad and buttons for starting, repeating or interrupting the training programmes encoded. The platform is powered by a motor, which makes the platform oscillate from side to side relative to the central column, reproducing movements similar to fast walking. The oscillating movement is transmitted to the feet of the person standing on the platform (and then upwards to the muscles) at a frequency of between 30 Hz and 50 Hz. The machine acts as a stimulator to muscle contraction and is for use, for example, in medicine, physiotherapy and well-being. | 8479 89 97 | |
1200/2011 of 18.11.2011 (OJ L 305, 23.11.2011, p. 6) |
A hand-operated mechanical apparatus for dispensing a liquid into a container for titrimetric analyses (so-called "digital titrator"). The apparatus comprises an adjustable mechanical feeder with a space for a cartridge, a delivery knob, a mechanical counter, a counter reset knob and a hand grip. The titrator is a precision dispensing apparatus which, by each turning step of the delivery knob, releases a drop of the titrant being used into the liquid to be analysed (the analyte). The drop contains a specific volume of the titrant. The number of drops dispensed by the titrator is displayed on the counter. The analytic result is determined by the reaction of the analyte to the quantity of titrant dispensed. The quantity of titrant is determined by multiplying the number of drops with the specific volume of the titrant used. | 8479 89 97 | |
2015/2255 of 2.12.2015 (OJ L 321, 5.12.2015, p. 10) | An article in the shape of a circle (so-called 'coin vibration motor') with a diameter
of 9 mm and a thickness of 4 mm with an inbuilt 4 V DC, 1 W electrical motor. The article is designed to be used in tablets, mobile phones etc. to create a vibration effect. That effect is the result of the rotation of the shaft of the motor due to the presence of a non-symmetric mass attached to the shaft. For mounting purposes the article is provided with self-adhesive tape on one side. |
8479 89 97 | |
761/2011 of 29.7.2011 (OJ L 200, 3.8.2011, p. 1) |
A connector consisting of a plastic casing with openings on both sides for the inflow and outflow of liquids. It is fitted with a screw cap and a fastening in the form of a check (non- return) valve. The connector is used in medical infusion sets. One side is to be connected to a tube and the other to a syringe or an infusion line. The fastening opens when the connector is attached to the syringe or infusion line and closes when it is removed, thus preventing the escape of liquid and the entry of air during the infusion. The connectors are presented in sterile or unsterile packs. | 8481 30 99 | |
1141/2008 of 13.11.2008 (OJ L 308, 19.11.2008, p.9) | 1 | Linear motion system comprising a slide mechanism with two grooves and a rectangular casing enclosing bearing balls. The casing moves along the grooves in the slide mechanism by means of the bearing balls. The linear motion system is used with different kinds of machines, for example, goods handling equipment, machine tools or DVD players. | 8482 10 90 |
1452/2007 of 7.12.2007 (OJ L 325 , 11/12/2007 p.66) | 1 | A slewing ring, consisting of two concentric forged steel rings, one of which has teeth cut into it. The rings are capable of rotation when separated by rows of steel ball bearings. The steel ring with teeth provides rotational torque transfer. This product is designed to be incorporated in an excavator. | 8483 90 89 |
2015/2319 of 8.12.2015 (OJ L 328 of 12.12.2015, p.60) | An article (so-called 'adapter' or 'rectifier') designed to convert AC current (100 -
220 V) into DC current (12 V, 3,7 A); in a plastic housing with dimensions of
approximately 14 x 6 x 5 cm. The article can be connected via a cable with a connector to the AC socket and via another cable with a specific connector to a specific game console of heading 9504. |
8504 40 82 | |
2016/666 of 26.4.2016 (OJ L 115, 26.4.2016, p. 25) |
A static converter in a plastic housing (a so-called 'AC/DC adapter') designed to
convert alternating current (AC) (100-240 V) into direct current (DC) (12 V, 1,5 A). The housing is equipped with a plug to connect to the AC and with an electrical cable of 1,5 m fitted with a DC-connector which enables the AC/DC adapter to be connected to different apparatus. The AC/DC adapter is presented to supply power to a set-top box (STB). It can also be used for supplying power to a variety of other apparatus, for example, telecommunication apparatus, automatic data-processing machines, audio/video recording or reproducing apparatus, household appliances and radio navigational aid apparatus. |
8504 40 82 | |
1110/2012 of 23.11.2012 (OJ L 329, 29.11.2012, p. 5) |
1 | A charger of the direct current converter type (so-called 'Universal dual-port car charger') comprising a car cigarette adapter, two USB interfaces and a light indicator. The charger has a voltage input of 12 V DC, a voltage output of 5 V DC and a current output of 500 mA or 2 x 250 mA. The charger is used for supplying power to charge various apparatus, such as mobile phones, PDA, GPS, cameras, MP3 and MP4 players. | 8504 40 90 |
2016/1957 of 4.11.2016 (OJ L 301, 9.11.2016, p. 6) |
An article comprising electronic components; a starter, an actuator, a regulator and a
stop unit (so-called 'electronic control unit (ECU)') contained in a rectangular housing
of aluminium with measurements of 98 x 74 x 20 mm and a weight of 160 g. The article supplies power to the xenon headlights of motor vehicles. When the headlights are turned on the article firstly converts direct current (DC) 12 V from the on-board electrical system into 1 200 V DC and transmits it to the igniter (not present upon presentation). Secondly, the article converts the DC into alternating current (AC) to light the lamps and continuously generates the voltage required (85 V) to keep the lights burning sufficiently. |
8504 40 90 | |
2017/1465 of 9.8.2017 (OJ L 209, 12.8.2017, p. 5) |
A device (so-called 'wireless charging plate') consisting of an adapter with a cable
of a length of approximately 180 cm and a charging plate. The cable has a connector to
connect to the charging plate. The plate is circular shaped with a height of approximately
8 mm, a diameter of approximately 80 mm and a weight of 51 g. The adapter converts (rectifies) alternating current (AC - 240V) into direct current (DC - 12V) and transfers this to the plate. In the plate this DC is converted (inverted) into AC and then that AC is converted into an electromagnetic field. The device is designed to charge apparatus wirelessly. Both the plate and the apparatus being charged are equipped with 'Qi' technology, which is the standard for the wireless charging of apparatus. Wireless charging is performed via an electromagnetic field. |
8504 40 90 | |
1076/2010 of 22.11.2010 (OJ L 308, 24.11.2010, p. 3) |
An article (so-called 'common mode choke') with dimensions of approximately 3 x 3 x 2 cm (including the base plate), consisting of two coils of insulated copper wire wound on a circular ferrite core, with a ratio of 1:1. The differential mode current (signal), flowing in opposite directions through the coils, creates equal and opposite magnetic fields which cancel each other out. This results in the article presenting zero impedance to the differential mode current, which passes through unaltered. The common mode current (interference), flowing in the same direction through the coils, creates equal and in-phase magnetic fields which add together. This results in the article presenting high impedance to the common mode current, which passes through attenuated. | 8504 50 95 | |
2015/388 of 5.03.2015 (OJ L 65, 10.3.2015, p. 9) |
A plastic sheet with dimensions of 62 cm x 52 cm x 150 mm containing 24 antennae. Each antenna is constituted of copper wires in the form of windings of a planar rectangular shape and is connected with two interface pads. The antennae are presented in an array of 8 x 3 and are glued alongside each other on the plastic sheet. The plastic sheet does not contain electronic chips. The antennae are presented to be used as parts of smart cards. | 8504 50 95 | |
428/2011 of 27.4.2011 (OJ L 133, 3.5.2011, p. 6) |
1 | A battery-powered apparatus in the form of a cylinder with dimensions of approximately 21 cm in height with a diameter of 9 cm and a weight of approximately 310 g (so-called 'aerosol dispenser') specifically designed to be used together with an interchangeable aerosol can. The apparatus comprises: - an electromechanical system for the activation of the spraying mechanism of the aerosol can, - a sensor and buttons for activation of the electromechanical system, and - a plastic housing with an aperture enabling the dispersal of aerosol when the electromechanical system is activated. The apparatus, when equipped with an aerosol can, is capable of freshening air within a limited space inside a building by dispersing portions of fragrance, either when the sensor detects the presence of a person, or at regular pre-set intervals. | 8509 80 00 |
428/2011 of 27.4.2011 (OJ L 133, 3.5.2011, p. 6) |
2 | A set put up for retail sale consisting of: - an electromechanical appliance (so-called 'aerosol dispenser'), and - an interchangeable aerosol can. The 'aerosol dispenser' is a battery-powered apparatus in the form of a cylinder with dimensions of approximately 21 cm in height with a diameter of 9 cm and a weight of approximately 310 g comprising: - an electromechanical system for the activation of the spraying mechanism of the aerosol can, - a sensor and buttons for activation of the electromechanical system, and - a plastic housing with an aperture enabling the dispersal of aerosol when the electromechanical system is activated. The aerosol can contains a prepared room deodoriser, perfumed, of CN code 3307 49 00. The 'aerosol dispenser', when equipped with an aerosol can, is capable of freshening air within a limited space inside a building by dispersing portions of fragrance, either when the sensor detects the presence of a person, or at regular pre-set intervals. The aerosol can is consumable goods which can be replaced when empty by another aerosol can of the same dimensions. | 8509 80 00 |
603/2011 of 20.6.2011 (OJ L 163, 23.6.2011, p. 10) |
An article specifically designed to be mounted into the signalling equipment of a specific model of a motor vehicle. The article is in the form of two interconnected printed circuit assemblies, each containing passive components (capacitors and resistors) and active components (diodes, light emitting diodes (LEDs), transistors and integrated circuits). One assembly is equipped with an interface for connecting to the motor vehicle light system. The LEDs provide the signalling effect. | 8512 90 90 | |
455/2014 of 29.4.2014 (OJ L 133, 6.5.2014, p. 31) |
2 | A floor standing apparatus for dispensing hot or cold water (so-called 'water dispenser') with a height of approximately 97 cm and a weight of approximately 15 kg. The heating function is performed by an integrated electric heating resistor and the cooling function by a cooling system consisting of a compressor and a condenser. The water is supplied from a bottle which is not included upon presentation. The apparatus has the capacity to dispense hot water at a rate of 5 l/h with a temperature range of 85-92 °C. It has the capacity to dispense cold water at a rate of 2 l/h with a temperature range of 4-8 °C. The apparatus operates with a voltage of 220 V AC and a power of 100/550 W. | 8516 10 11 |
776/2011 of 2.8.2011 (OJ L 201, 4.8.2011, p. 10) |
An apparatus for cooking food, with dimensions of approximately 31 x 47 x 40 cm and a capacity of 25 litres. It has a housing of stainless steel, a turntable, a safety child lock feature, control buttons and a clock. The apparatus comprises: - a microwave oven with 5 power levels, a maximum power output of 900 watts and a timer. It has pre-set cooking and defrosting programmes, and - a quartz griller with a maximum power output of 1 000 watts. The apparatus is designed to cook food by means of the microwave oven. It also cooks, browns and crisps food by means of the griller. | 8516 50 00 | |
166/2007 16.02.2007 (OJ L 52, 21.02.2007, p. 5) |
2 | An article consisting of - a plastic lavatory seat with cover, - an electro-mechanical movable sprayer and, - an electrothermic device. The product performs several functions such as heating water, spraying water and drying the area. |
8516 79 70 |
1231/2007 of 19.10.2007 (OJ L 279, 23.10.2007, p. 3) |
1 | Infrared, home sauna, intended to be incorporated into a building, designed to hold up to two persons, consisting of: - six 'ready to assemble' prefabricated wooden panels, - a bench, - ventilation equipment, - an air-ioniser. Some of the panels are equipped with: - a door with a window, - a ceramic far-infrared heater, - digital controllers or, - loudspeakers. The wavelength of the rays generated by the ceramic far-infrared heater is 5,6-15 mm. The product combines the functions of a sauna and an infrared heat-therapy device. It provides recreational and relaxing treatment. | 8516 79 70 |
2017/2247 of 30.11.2017 (OJ L 324, 8.12.2017, p. 11) |
An article (so-called 'heating mat') with dimensions of approximately 190 x 80 x 4 cm
and a weight of approximately 11,5 kg. It is padded and contains a heating element (grid
coated with a thin layer of a fabric). The lower part of the mat (below the heating
element) is made up of a 1 cm thick layer of foam. The upper outer side of the mat is
fitted with a layer of flat and smooth artificial stones containing tourmaline. The
article's surface is rigid and bumpy. The article is equipped with a controller connected by a cable and a power connection. The controller has a display showing the set temperature, various indicators, a button for setting the desired temperature and an on/off button. It is designed for heat treatment of various parts of the human body. It can be laid on or sat on. Temperature can be selected in a range of 30-70 °C. The artificial stones emit (after heating them) far infrared rays. |
8516 79 70 | |
1288/91 of 14.5.1991 (OJ L 122, 17.5.1991, p. 11) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
4 | Heating-strips, for automatically controlling the temperature of fluids, consisting of a copper conductor of a cross-section of 1,9 mm2, a self-regulating conductor-filament, an insulating sleeve of fluoropolymer, a tinned copper braid of a cross-section of 2,8 mm2 and an outer sleeve of fluoropolymer covering the braid. The heating-strips vary the heating power at each point of the circuit, depending on the temperature encountered. They are generally used for lagging pipes. | 8516 80 80 |
717/2009 of 4.8.2009 (OJ L 205, 7.8.2009, p. 3) |
1 | Handheld, battery-operated apparatus, foldable, with overall dimensions of approximately 8,7 cm (L) x 5,4 cm (W) x 1,8 cm (D), in a single housing having: - an alphanumeric keyboard of a kind used in cellular phones; - one colour display of the liquid crystal device (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 5 cm (2 inches); - a second rectangular colour display of the LCD type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of 2 cm (0,8 inch); - a 2 megapixel digital camera with a digital zoom; - a slot for a solid state non-volatile storage card not exceeding 4 GB; and - a USB (Universal Serial Bus) port for recharging the battery, for data-exchange and for connecting external earphones. The apparatus comprises: - a microprocessor; - microphone and loudspeaker; - an in-built memory of 128 MB; and - a television receiver of the DVB-T type. The apparatus has an integrated operating system for mobile telephony over the cellular network which can be activated when a SIM card is inserted into the apparatus. The apparatus has the following functions: - mobile-phone communication over the cellular network; - wireless transmission and reception of images or other data (such as SMS (Short Message Service), MMS (Multimedia Messaging Service), e-mail, etc.); - recording and reproducing of sound as well as still and video images; and - reception of television signals (DVB-T). The apparatus also functions using other wireless communication protocols such as 'Bluetooth'. | 8517 12 00 |
717/2009 of 4.8.2009 (OJ L 205, 7.8.2009, p. 3) |
2 | Handheld, battery-operated apparatus, foldable, with overall dimensions of approximately 10,9 cm (L) x 5,9 cm (W) x 1,9 cm (D), in a single housing having: - a colour display of the liquid crystal device (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 7 cm (2,8 inches), which incorporates an alphanumeric keyboard of the touch-screen type; - a 1,92 megapixel digital camera with an optical zoom; - a slot for a solid state non-volatile storage card not exceeding 4 GB;- a USB (Universal Serial Bus) port; and - a port for recharging the battery. The apparatus comprises: - a microprocessor; - microphone and loudspeaker; - an in-built random-access memory with a storage capacity of 64 MB; - an in-built electrically erasable, programmable, read-only memory with a storage capacity of 256 MB; - an antenna for the reception of radio-navigational signals from satellites, and - a GPS (Global Positioning System) module. The apparatus has an integrated operating system for mobile telephony over the cellular network which can be activated when a SIM card is inserted into the apparatus. The apparatus has the following functions: - mobile-phone communication over the cellular network; - wireless transmission and reception of images or other data (such as SMS (Short Message Service), MMS (Multimedia Messaging Service), e-mail, etc.); - personal digital assistant; - recording and reproducing of sound as well as still and video images; and - a radio navigation satellite system in the form of a Global Positioning System (GPS). The apparatus also functions using other wireless communication protocols such as 'Bluetooth' and wireless LAN (local area network) (802.11b + g). | 8517 12 00 |
717/2009 of 4.8.2009 (OJ L 205, 7.8.2009, p. 3) |
3 | Handheld, battery-operated apparatus, with overall dimensions of approximately 11,1 cm (H) x 6,18 cm (W) x 0,85 cm (D), in a single housing having: - an alphanumeric keyboard of a kind used in cellular phones of the touch-screen type; - a color display of the liquid crystal device (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 8,9 cm (3,5 inches) and a wide screen format; - a 2 megapixel digital camera; - a USB (Universal Serial Bus) port; and - a port for recharging the battery. The apparatus comprises: - a microprocessor; - microphone and loudspeaker; - an in-built flash memory of 16 GB; and - an antenna for the reception of radio-navigational signals from satellites. The apparatus has an integrated operating system for mobile telephony over the cellular network which can be activated when a SIM card is inserted into the apparatus. The apparatus has the following functions: - mobile-phone communication over the cellular network; - wireless transmission and reception of images or other data (such as SMS (Short Message Service), MMS (Multimedia Messaging Service), e-mail, etc.); - recording and reproducing of sound as well as still and video images; and - a radio-navigation satellite system in the form of a Global Positioning System (GPS). The apparatus also functions using other wireless communication protocols such as 'Bluetooth' and wireless LAN (local area network) (802.11b + g). | 8517 12 00 |
754/94 of 30.3.1994 (OJ L 89, 6.4.1994, p. 2) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
3 | Battery-powered modem, contained in a housing of dimensions 10,2 x 6,1 x 2,5 cm, fitted with four LEDs which indicate call-status, speed, carrier-frequency and battery-status. It has a data-connector, a telephone-connector, an acoustic-coupler connector and a standard miniature telephone-jack. The modem is used for asynchronous data-transmission between automatic data-processing machines, via telephone-lines, in full-duplex and acoustic-coupler modes at a speed of 300 or 1 200 bits per second. | 8517 62 00 |
964/1999 of 6.5.1999 (OJ L 119, 7.5.1999, p. 28) |
1 | Optoelectronic transmitter, capable of converting radio-frequency signals into optical signals. The apparatus transmits these optical signals through a fibre-optic cable trunk-system by means of a laser using carrier-current technology. It is located in the transmission-network of a cable-TV system. | 8517 62 00 |
964/1999 of 6.5.1999 (OJ L 119, 7.5.1999, p. 28) |
2 | Optoelectronic receiver, capable of converting optical signals into radio-frequency (RF) signals after transmission by means of carrier-current technology through a fibre-optic cable trunk-system. It is located in the transmission-network of a cable-TV system. The RF-output is used to serve several trunk-lines in the local fibre service-area. | 8517 62 00 |
2184/97 of 3.11.1997 (OJ L 299, 4.11.1997, p. 6) |
4 | Articles put up in a set for retail sale, enabling an automatic data-processing
machuine to perform the additional function of video-telephony and comprising: (a) an audio-unit with telephone-handset, a telecommunication-card, a video-camera for connection to the computer, and a network-connection unit; (b) two diskettes with video-telephony-application software. |
8517 62 00 |
646/2001 of 30.3.2001 (OJ L 91, 31.3.2001, p. 42) |
Product, known as a 'portable baby-monitoring device', in the form of a set put up for retail sale and consisting of: a radio-transmitter/receiver with built-in microphone and loudspeaker, a portable radio-transmitter/receiver with built-in microphone and loudspeaker, and two mains-adaptors. The radio-transmitter/receiver can be battery- or mains-powered, and can be used for intercommunication. The portable radio-transmitter/receiver is rechargeable, can be used while recharging and can be used for intercommunication. The device serves mainly to convey the sounds made by a baby in the vicinity of the device, but it can also be used to communicate with the baby. The device has a range of about 100 m. | 8517 62 00 | |
614/2004 of 1.4.2004 (OJ L 98, 2.4.2004, p. 4) |
2 | Network controller with a built-in radio-transceiver unit, in a housing of dimensions of 355 x 285 x 115 mm, with a liquid crystal display (4 lines x 20 characters) and a keyboard with four control buttons. The apparatus is based on a microprocessor and also contains a parameter-memory, a programme-memory and a disc-drive. The radio-transceiver unit consists of a high-frequency component (HF component) with an aerial, filter, amplifier, oscillator and frequency synthesiser. This unit transmits, within the frequency range from 402 to 512 MHz, to up to 20 programmable channels within a range of 400 metres. The apparatus has up to eight multi-function interfaces, for configuration and network-connection. The apparatus processes signals, and re-formats data for transmission between an automatic data-processing machine and a radio transceiver on a wired network. | 8517 62 00 |
614/2004 of 1.4.2004 (OJ L 98, 2.4.2004, p. 4) |
3 | Radio-link controller, in a housing of dimensions of 279 x 224 x 89 mm, with eight selection buttons and an aerial. The apparatus consists of a microprocessor, a programme-memory and a radio transceiver. The radio transceiver transmits and receives data on up to eight channels within the frequency range from 403 to 512 MHz within a range of 400 metres. The device has an interface which enables it to receive data from wireless terminals and to transmit them to the network via a network-controller. It is also connected to an automatic data-processing machine. | 8517 62 00 |
614/2004 of 1.4.2004 (OJ L 98, 2.4.2004, p. 4) |
4 | Wireless gateway, in a housing of dimensions of 292 x 292 x 70 mm, with an aerial. The apparatus consists of a microprocessor, programme memories and a radio transceiver. The radio transceiver transmits and receives data on up to eight channels within the frequency range from 403 to 512 MHz within a range of 400 metres. The device has an interface which enables it to receive data from wireless terminals and to transmit them directly to the network. It is also connected to an automatic data-processing machine. | 8517 62 00 |
614/2004 of 1.4.2004 (OJ L 98, 2.4.2004, p. 4) |
5 | Hand-held device consisting of a microprocessor, a liquid crystal display, a keyboard with keys for data-input and control, a radio transceiver and an interface for a bar-code reader. The data are put manually into the device, the function of which is to exchange data with an automatic data-processing machine via a wireless gateway or a network-controller. | 8517 62 00 |
614/2004 of 1.4.2004 (OJ L 98, 2.4.2004, p. 4) |
6 | Hand-held device consisting of a microprocessor, a liquid crystal display, a keyboard with keys for data-input and control, a radio transceiver and a bar-code reader. Either manually or via the bar-code reader, the data are put into the device, the function of which is to exchange data with an automatic data-processing machine via a wireless gateway or a network-controller. | 8517 62 00 |
2016/2224 of 5.12.2016 (OJ L 336, 10.12.2016, p. 22) |
An electrical apparatus (so-called 'wireless speaker adapter') in housing with
dimensions of approximately 52 x 52 x13 mm and a weight of 26 g. The wireless speaker adapter consists of: - a built-in rechargeable battery, - a digital/analogue converter, - a Bluetooth technology based transmitter and receiver (Advanced Audio Distribution Profile (A2DP), - a USB port for charging, and - a 3,5 mm audio port, for connection to a speaker system (not present upon presentation to customs). The apparatus allows the user to listen to music from a smartphone or similar portable device on a home audio system or via separate loudspeakers. The audio signal is sent wirelessly via Bluetooth from the smartphone to the apparatus. In the apparatus, the digital signal is converted to an analogue signal and sent by cables to the home audio system or to separate loudspeakers. The apparatus has a pause/play button that allows stopping and starting the music, but does not allow for selection of music or volume control. |
8517 62 00 | |
2184/97 of 3.11.1997 (OJ L 299,4.11.1997, p. 6) |
2 | Video-conferencing system, consisting of the following components linked by cable: a colour monitor with built-in loudspeakers, a cabinet acting as a stand for the monitor and containing the telecommunication-circuitry for the system, a video-camera with control- and zoom-functions, and a telephone-keypad (with built-in microphone) which also controls the system. | 8517 69 10 |
754/94 of 30.3.1994 (OJ L 89, 6.4.1994, p. 2) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
6 | Components of a 'radio-conferencing' apparatus not presented together in a single package for retail sale, consisting of: | |
(a) transmitter-microphone containing a transmitter for radio-communications with highly-sensitive built-in microphone, and an aerial; | 8517 69 39 | ||
(b) one or more receivers, comprising devices for radio-communications with frequency-modulation, and a plug for connecting to an earphone, whether or not incorporating a directional microphone. | 8518 10 95 | ||
710/2013 of 24.7.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p. 14) |
A device (so-called 'Traffic Message Channel (TMC) receiver') comprising an FM receiver, an aerial cable (antenna) and a power supply. It is equipped with a USB-connector. The device receives telemetric signals containing traffic information using a traffic message channel through FM radio broadcast band. The device is to be connected with a USB- connector to a global positioning system (GPS) receiver, which processes the telemetric signals received and displays the traffic information on the screen. The device does not receive sound broadcast signals. | 8517 69 39 | |
305/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 44, 15.2.2001, p. 22) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
3 | A product described as a baby-monitoring device, put up in a set for retail sale,
consisting of - a transmitter for radio telephony, with a built-in microphone - a portable receiver for radio-telephony combined with a loudspeaker in a housing - two mains adaptors Both the transmitter and the receiver can operate using either betteries or mains adaptors The device serves to transmit noises made by a baby in the vicinity of the transmitter and is used to monitor babies within a range of roughly 300 metres. |
8517 69 90 |
2018/1207 of 27.8.2018 (OJ L 220, 30.8.2018, p. 1) |
An article made of hot rolled non-alloy steel with a coating made of nickel silver
alloy. It is presented in the shape of a round cap (diameter 2,7 cm) with slightly lowered centre, turned down into a hole, with small air gaps inside the turned down part. The cap is connected to a hollow threaded shank (diameter 0,5 cm). The total length of the article is 2,5 cm. The article is designed to be used as a tuning element in a specific bandpass filter (the bandpass filter is used in cellular network base stations to transmit signals of certain frequencies) filtering out the upper and lower frequencies, by screwing it into the bandpass filter chassis. It is an essential part in the process of tuning. In the tuning process the round cap acts as a resonator. In case of any damage to the surface of this round cap there will be a distortion of the radio frequency waves. |
8517 70 00 | |
701/1999 of 31.3.1999 (OJ L 89, 1.4.1999, p. 23) |
1 | Electronic assembly, so-called 'Call Processor Pack', consisting of a printed-circuit board equipped with a processor, memory-modules and other electronic components. The assembly contains a front-panel with press-buttons and an LCD-display. It is designed for use as a main module in an automatic telephone-exchange system, having special plug-connectors for this purpose and customised components (ASICs) which contain specific software. | 8517 70 90 |
701/1999 of 31.3.1999 (OJ L 89, 1.4.1999, p. 23) |
2 | Electronic assembly, so-called 'Core to Network Interface Pack' (CNI), consisting of a printed-circuit board equipped with electronic components. The assembly contains a front-panel with press-buttons and an LCD-display. It is designed for use as an interface between a Call Processor Pack and the network-cards in an automatic telephone-exchange system, having special plug-connectors and customised components (ASICs) which contain specific software. | 8517 70 90 |
701/1999 of 31.3.1999 (OJ L 89, 1.4.1999, p. 23) |
3 | Electronic assembly, so-called 'Input-Output Processor', consisting of two interconnected printed-circuit boards equipped with a processor, RAM-memories, EPROM and other electronic components. The assembly contains a front-panel with press-buttons and an LCD-display. It is designed for use as an interface between the special connectors of an automatic telephone-exchange system and standard SCSI/RS232/IEEE interfaces, having special plug-connectors and customised components (ASICs) which contain specific software The assembly contains a floppy-disc drive and a hard-disc drive. | 8517 70 90 |
1578/2006 of 19.10.2006 (OJ L 291, 21.10.2006, p. 13) |
1 | Keypad membrane (dimensions: approximately 65 x 40 x 1 mm) made of polycarbonate, without any electric conductive elements. The product has moulded keys on one side and non-conductive contact pins on the other side. The product has printed keycaps constituting an alpha/numeric keyboard, call buttons and other features typical of mobile telephones. | 8517 70 90 |
697/2012 of 25. 7. 2012 (OJ L 203, 31. 7. 2012, p. 32) |
1 | An article (so-called 'transformer module with RJ 45 plug') with connecting pins in a housing with dimensions of approximately 2 x 1,5 x 1,5 cm. The article comprises a printed circuit board equipped with four transformers, a capacitor and four resistors. It also incorporates two light emitting diodes which are not connected to the other components. The article is specifically designed for a 10/100 BASE-T Ethernet network and is for placement onto a printed circuit board for the purposes of connecting machines within a local area network for signal transmission and reception. It also provides for galvanic separation and protection of signals against over-voltage and common mode noise. | 8517 70 90 |
714/2012 of 30. 7. 2012 (OJ L 210, 7. 8. 2012, p. 3) |
1 | A product consisting of a flexible keypad membrane made of silicone with 19 incorporated keycaps and with dimensions of approximately 65 x 40 x 1 mm. The product has printed keycaps representing an alpha/numeric keyboard, call buttons and other buttons typical of mobile phones. Underneath each keycap there is an electrical contact element made of silicone impregnated with carbon. The product has a specific shape and design and is intended for incorporation in a particular model of a mobile phone. | 8517 70 90 |
714/2012 of 30. 7. 2012 (OJ L 210, 7. 8. 2012, p. 3) |
2 | A product (so-called 'keyboard flex assembly'), the main body of which has dimensions of approximately 56 x 42 x 1 mm and which comprises two membranes constituting a switching device: - an upper membrane of polyimide containing 24 copper contact points on the bottom side, - a lower membrane of polyimide containing a printed circuit with 24 copper contact points on the upper side. Over the upper membrane there is a protective transparent plastic sheet printed with an image representing a mobile phone keyboard, and under the lower membrane a protective paper sheet. The following components are connected to the main body of the product: - two flat electrical conductors with connectors, - two printed circuit assemblies containing active and passive components, a light sensor and a 'Hall effect' switch for controlling the lighting system of the keyboard. The product has a specific shape and design and is intended for incorporation in a particular model of a mobile phone. | 8517 70 90 |
1165/95 of 23.5.1995 (OJ L 117, 24.5.1995, p. 15) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
5 | Miniature electro-acoustic receiver (earphone), in a housing of external dimensions not exceeding 7 x 7 x 5 mm. The receiver comprises a magnet, a coil, and a diaphragm which vibrates when electrical signals are received, thus producing audible sound. The receiver may be used, together with an amplifier, as a hearing-aid. | 8518 30 95 |
955/98 of 29.4.1998 (OJ L 133, 7.5.1998, p. 12) |
1 | Wireless stereo-headphone set, consisting of battery-powered headphones with built-in high-frquency radio-receiver, a high-frequency radio-transmitter with three channels with a range of 100 m, and an adaptor to connect the transmitter to various audio-devices. | 8518 30 95 |
634/2005 of 26.4.2005 (OJ L 106, 27.4.2005, p. 7) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Audiofrequency amplifier, incorporating a digital sound-decoder, a digital sound-processor (to produce a multi-channel (surround) sound-effect), and circuitry for video/sound synchronisation. The device can receive signals from various sources (e.g., DVD-player, satellite tuner, cassette-player, video recorder). The signals are decoded by digital-to-analogue converters before being amplified. | 8518 40 80 |
1488/1999 of 7.7.1999 (OJ L 172, 8.7.1999, p. 25) |
1 | Battery-powered cassette-player, in the form of a cylinder like a beverage-can approximately 10 cm high with a diameter of 7 cm, not incorporating a sound-recording device, but with an analogue reading-system, and lightweight stereo-headphones connected by cable. It has several press-buttons for operating it, a volume-control, a carrying-strap and a belt-clip. | 8519 81 25 |
311/2014 of 25.3.2014 (OJ L 91, 27.3.2014, p. 12) |
1 | A machine with sound reproducing and editing functions in a housing with dimensions of
approximately 43 x 15 x 8 cm. It is equipped with a CD reader and an audio output. It has knobs, push-buttons, sliders and a small liquid crystal display (LCD) indicator. The machine is capable of editing sound: it is equipped with seamless loop points, stutter starts, a beats per minute (BPM) counter and a fader. The machine is intended to be used for sound reproducing and editing in a non-professional environment. |
8519 81 35 |
883/94 of 20.4.1994 (OJ L 103, 22.4.1994, p. 7) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Portable battery-powered audio-cassette tape-recorder/player, in a housing of coloured plastic, with large control-buttons, and a microphone attached, to enable the user to broadcast through the built-in loudspeaker, with or without the audio-cassette playing. | 8519 81 55 |
400/2006 of 8.3.2006 (OJ L 70, 9.3.2006, p. 9) |
1 | A set put up for retail sale consisting of: - a portable battery-operated digital sound recording and reproducing apparatus, containing the following components in a single housing: a signalling electronic system with a digital/analogue converter, a flash memory, control buttons, a battery compartment, a USB plug and a connector for headphones; - a battery- operated radio-broadcast receiver with earphones with a connecting cable, - USB cable, - a CD-ROM and - a manual. The digital sound recording and reproducing apparatus records sound in the MP3 format and can be connected to an automatic dataprocessing machine through a USB port in order to download or upload MP3 or other formats. It can also record voice. The storage capacity is 128 MB. The radio-broadcast receiver can function independently. | 8519 81 95 |
69/2013 of 23.1.2013 (OJ L 26, 26.1.2013, p. 1) |
3 | An apparatus for the reception and processing of audio (so-called 'digital audio streamer') with overall dimensions of approximately 19 x 9 x 8 cm. The apparatus incorporates: - a microprocessor, - a vacuum fluorescent display with a resolution of 320 x 32 grayscale pixels, - an on-screen clock with alarm, - an infrared receiver for the remote control. It is equipped with the following interfaces: - Ethernet, - wireless Ethernet, - digital optical, digital coaxial and analogue audio outputs, - a headphone jack. It is supplied with a remote control. The apparatus can function either in a stand alone mode connecting to an internet network (without an automatic data- processing (ADP) machine) or with software running on an ADP machine. It is capable of reproducing audio files stored on the ADP machine or any internet radio. | 8519 89 19 |
305/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 44, 15.2.2001, p. 22) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
4 | Electro-mechanical assembly, consisting of two elements presented together: | |
(a) electro-mechanical assembly for a video-recorder, in the form of a printed circuit with the following components: a decoder, processor and generator of red, green and blue signals for a cathode-ray tube, an audio-signal processor, a chassis-control system with a microcontroller, a VHS-signal processor, a tape-loading/unloading unit, a unit with audio-, video- and control-heads, and a metal support for attaching the second element; | 8521 10 20 | ||
(b) electronic assembly for a television-receiver, comprising a switching-mode
power-supply, a deflection-signal generating unit, and a high-voltage transformer. There is no tuner incorporated in either assembly. These assemblies are designed to be built into a television-receiver combined with a video-recorder using a tape-width of 1,265 cm and a tape-speed not exceeding 23,39 mm per second. |
8529 90 65 | ||
1056/2006 of 12.7.2006 (OJ L 192, 13.7.2006, p. 6) |
1 | A portable battery-operated digital sound and video recording and reproducing apparatus containing the following main components in a single housing: - a hard disk with a storage capacity of 30 GB, - a colour display with a diagonal measurement of 6,35 cm (2,5 inches), - a microphone, and - a radio broadcast receiver. The apparatus supports the following formats: MPEG1, MPEG2, MPEG4, DivX, XviD, WMV, MJPEG, MP3 and WMA. It can be connected to an automatic dataprocessing machine through a USB port in order to download or upload the media files. It is also connectable to various apparatus through an audio/video (A/V) interface. It can record up to 15 000 songs or 120 hours of digital video, or store up to 25 000 photos. If can also record voice. | 8521 90 00 |
1231/2007 of 19.10.2007 (OJ L 279, 23.10.2007, p. 3) |
2 | Stand-alone device for recording digital code representing video on a digital versatile disc (DVD) from a video camera recorder. The device is equipped with a USB interface for connecting it to a video camera recorder or to an automatic data-processing machine. When the device is connected to the video camera recorder, the video recording is controlled by the latter apparatus and records only in a video format. The device can also be used as a storage device for data on a DVD when it works in conjunction with an automatic data-processing machine. | 8521 90 00 |
295/2009 of 18.3.2009 (OJ L 95, 9.4.2009, p. 7) |
1 | Set put up for retail sale consisting of digital apparatus in its own housing for the recording and reproducing of sound and images in various formats, capable of receiving data from various sources (for example, satellite television receivers, automatic data-processing machines, video camera recorders) and of various elements such as connector cables, a CD-ROM, a manual, screws and a screwdriver. The apparatus incorporates a printed circuit board with active and passive elements (necessary for sound and video recording and reproducing), including a microprocessor. It is equipped with the following interfaces: - a USB port, - VGA, and - audio and video ports. It is also equipped with control buttons (power, play, pause, volume) and an infra-red receiver for a remote control. The apparatus is designed to incorporate a hard disk. | 8521 90 00 |
754/94 of 30.3.1994 (OJ L 89, 6.4.1994, p. 2) |
4 | Multi-media interactive system, in a single housing of dimensions 43,8 x 31,75 x 9,4 cm, capable of reproducing, on a monitor, loudspeakers or headphones, the audio, graphics, text or video-data recorded on a compact disc (CD). An infra-red remote-controller is provided for the system's special audio- and video-unit functions. [By adding other accessories (e.g., disc-drive, keyboard and mouse), it may be used as a personal computer.] The housing comprises: printed-circuit board with a digital processing unit (CPU, 1 MB RAM, and S12 KB ROM), graphics-component, video-component, sound-component with its own CD-audio unit, as well as a CD-ROM (for data-, sound- and picture-reproduction from 5" compact discs only). The system is capable of providing approximately 70 minutes of high-fidelity music and high- and low-resolution graphics, while video-reproduction is limited to sequential still images for approximately 5 minutes. | 8521 90 00 |
754/94 of 30.3.1994 (OJ L 89, 6.4.1994, p. 2) |
5 | CD-interactive system, in a single housing, for the reproduction of digitally-recorded pictures and sound for television by means of a laser optical-reading device. It is supplied with a mouse and an infra-red remote-controller. It contains a control-unit which processes signals from the playing unit (or the mouse or the remote-controller) to the television's display- and loudspeaker-units, enabling interaction with the picture and the sound. | 8521 90 00 |
129/2005 of 20.1.2005 (OJ L 25, 28.1.2005, p. 37) |
1 | Product put up in a set for retail sale, consisting of: - a composite machine (amplifier, AM/FM-radio-broadcast receiver, and DVD/CD player), - a subwoofer, - five speakers, and a - remote control. The product, known as a "home cinema system", is designed to provide audio- and video-entertainment in the home, mainly by reproducing sound and images stored on a DVD |
8521 90 00 |
129/2005 of 20.1.2005 (OJ L 25, 28.1.2005, p. 37) |
2 | Product put up in a set for retail sale, consisting of: - an AM/FM-radio-broadcast receiver with an amplifier, - a DVD/CD player, - a subwoofer, - five speakers, and - a remote control. The product, known as a "home cinema system", is designed to provide audio- and video-entertainment in the home, mainly by reproducing sound and images stored on a DVD. |
8521 90 00 |
731/2010 of 1.8.2010 (OJ L 214, 1.8.2010, p. 2) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | A video-sound installation consisting essentially of the following components: - 10 video reproducing apparatus of the digital versatile disc (DVD) type, - 10 projectors using matrix liquid crystal display (LCD) technology, of a kind also capable of displaying digital information generated by an automatic data-processing machine, - 10 single self-powered loudspeakers, mounted in their enclosures, and - 20 digital versatile discs (DVDs) containing recorded works of 'modern art' in the form of images accompanied by sound. The appearance of the video reproducing apparatus, the projectors and the loudspeakers has been modified by an artist with a view to appear as a work of 'modern art' without altering their function. The installation is presented disassembled. |
8521 90 00 8528 69 10 8518 21 00 8523 49 51 |
146/2012 of 16.2.2012 (OJ L 48, 21.2.2012, p. 5) |
An apparatus in a single housing with dimensions of approximately 42 x 25 x 6 cm,
comprising the following components: - two microprocessors, one of which is dedicated only for the Blu-Ray reader, - a dual DVB-S/DVB-T digital tuner, - a built-in hard disk of 250 GB, - a Blu-Ray 2D and 3D reader, - an SD card reader, and - a "smart card" reader for conditional access to a service provider. The apparatus is equipped with the following interfaces: - two RF inputs, - an Ethernet (RJ-45), - a USB, - an HDMI, - a SCART, - two RCA for audio output, and - an S/PDIF (optical digital audio output). Upon presentation, the apparatus is capable of receiving and decoding digital television signals (both free channels and programmes from the service provider). It is also capable of connecting to the Internet via the Ethernet interface. The apparatus is capable of receiving and decoding audio/video files from: - apparatus within a local area network via a so-called "home gateway" and - external sources via the USB interface (such as a hard disk, a USB memory, video recorders, digital cameras, camcorders) or via the SD card reader. The apparatus is capable of recording and reproducing the digital television signals received as well as any video files received through the SD card reader or the USB interface. The apparatus is capable of reproducing files from external media such as DVD, Blu-Ray 2D and 3D and CD via the integrated Blu-Ray reader. |
8521 90 00 | |
69/2013 of 23.1.2013 (OJ L 26, 26.1.2013, p. 1) |
1 | An apparatus for the reception, recording or reproducing of audio and video (so-called
'digital media receiver') of a cylindrical shape with overall dimensions of approximately
13 (diameter) x 19 (height) cm. The apparatus incorporates: - a microprocessor, - a hard disk drive of 500 GB, - an alphanumeric display, - an infrared receiver for the remote control. It is equipped with the following interfaces: - USB, - Ethernet, - HDMI, S-video, composite and component video outputs, - digital optical, digital coaxial and analogue audio outputs. It is also equipped with control buttons and supplied with a remote control. The apparatus is capable of receiving audio and video signals in digital format from an external source (for example, a router, an automatic data-processing machine, a digital camera, a USB memory). The data may be stored on its hard disk. The data is reproduced on a monitor, a television set or through a stereo system. The apparatus cannot gain access to the internet. |
8521 90 00 |
69/2013 of 23.1.2013 (OJ L 26, 26.1.2013, p. 1) |
2 | An apparatus for the reception or reproduction of audio and video (so-called 'digital media receiver') of a cylindrical shape with overall dimensions of approximately 13 (diameter) x 19 (height) cm. The apparatus incorporates: - a microprocessor, - an infrared receiver for the remote control, - an alpha-numeric display. It is equipped with the following interfaces: - USB, - Ethernet, - HDMI, S-video, composite and component video outputs, - digital optical, digital coaxial and analogue audio outputs, - a slot for a hard disk. It is also equipped with control buttons and supplied with a remote control. The apparatus is capable of receiving audio and video signals in digital format from an external source (for example, a router, an automatic data-processing machine, a digital camera, a USB memory). The data may be stored on a hard disk inserted after importation. The data is reproduced on a monitor, a television set or through a stereo system. The apparatus cannot gain access to the internet. | 8521 90 00 |
869/94 of 18.4.1994 (OJ L 101, 20.4.1994, p. 1) |
1 | Pre-formatted magnetic floppy disc, for use in automatic data-processing machines. | 8523 29 15 |
3272/94 of 27.12.1994 (OJ L 339, 29.12.1994, p. 58) |
2 | Magnetic floppy disc, on which an analogue (wave-form) signal has been recorded during manufacture, solely for the purpose of checking the disc's magnetic coating. | 8523 29 15 |
1056/2006 of 12.7.2006 (OJ L 192, 13.7.2006, p. 6) |
2 | An article made up of: - a ball-point pen with a replaceable cartridge, and - a flash memory with a capacity of 128 MB and a USB interface that can be plugged into the USB port of an automatic dataprocessing machine. The components can be used independently. |
8523 51 10 |
1056/2006 of 12.7.2006 (OJ L 192, 13.7.2006, p. 6) |
3 | An article made up of: - a watch with a mechanical display only, and - a flash memory with a capacity of 128 MB and a USB interface that can be plugged into the USB port of an automatic dataprocessing machine. The components can be used independently. |
8523 51 10 |
2015/20 of 5.1.2015 (OJ L 4, 2015 1 8, p. 7) |
An electronic apparatus (so-called 'media server') comprising a built-in flash memory of 2 TB, a hard disk with a storage capacity of 4 TB and a MPEG processor for various video, picture and audio formats. The apparatus is equipped with, amongst others, the following interfaces: - two 1Gbe (GigaBit ethernet) copper ingest ports, used for reception, - two 10Gbe SFP type, (Small Form-factor Pluggable) streaming ports, used for transmission, - two 1Gbe copper management ports for the management of the apparatus, - two USB ports. The apparatus uses the following media formats: - MPEG-2 TS and MPEG-4 (H.264), - Variable Bitrate (VBR) and Constant Bitrate (CBR), -High-Definition (HD) and Standard-Definition (SD). The apparatus is able to provide up to 2 500 streams with a speed of 3,75 Mbps. The apparatus is used by cable or internet television providers for distributing on demand multimedia products to consumers. Multimedia products, such as video sequences, pictures, data and sound are exchanged (received and transmitted) among media servers, installed within the providers' network. The apparatus records the received content and transmits it on demand via OTT (Over the Top Technology) streaming to the clients' terminal equipment, for example, television sets, automatic data-processing machines, game consoles or mobile phones. | 8525 60 00 | |
1655/2005 of 10.10.2005 (OJ L266, 11.10.2005, p. 50) |
3 | Set put up for retail sale comprising: - a television camera in a casing in the form of a plastic brick; - a kit made up of bricks and assembling components of plastic and -a CD-ROM. The camera cannot store images but transmits them to an automatic data-processing machine via a USB cable. The kit of bricks and the assembling components are used for constructing a tripod. The CD-ROM contains recorded programmes, data, video and sound files. |
8525 80 19 |
476/2009 of 5.6.2009 (OJ L 144, 9.6.2009, p. 13) |
1 | System consisting of the following components: - a high-resolution television camera mounted onto a submersible vehicle (a so-called 'Remote-Operated Vehicle (ROV)'), - a control device, incorporating a display, for the remote control of the vehicle and of the camera, for example by means of a joystick, and the visualisation of the images captured by the camera, - an electric cable. The first component weighs approximately 3,6 kg. The total weight of the system is approximately 32 kg. The system is used for underwater operations involving the capture of images and their transfer by cable to the display on the control device. It is operational up to a depth of approximately 90 m. | 8525 80 19 |
1004/2001 of 22.5.2001 (OJ L 140, 24.5.2001, p. 8) |
1st. | Modular linear camera, with a single-channel video-output. The circuitry within the camera is comprised of differential line-drivers, timing-control logic, CCD linear-imaging sensor, DC-restoration, video-combining and output-gain and -buffering. The camera is designed for incorporation into electro-optical measurement and control systems. | 8525 80 19 |
2016/2223 of 5.12.2016 (OJ L 336, 10.12.2016, p. 19) |
An article (so-called 'digital microscope') in cylindrical form with a length of
approximately 10 cm and a diameter of approximately 3 cm. The digital microscope is
equipped with four light emitting diodes, a complementary metal- oxide-semiconductor
(CMOS) sensor and a cable with a USB connector. The article functions only in conjunction
with an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine and has no inbuilt recording capabilities. The article is capable of magnifying objects in a range of 10-200 times by means of an optical lens and capturing still images as well as video images that can subsequently be recorded on an ADP machine using dedicated software. |
8525 80 19 | |
1231/2007 of 19.10.2007 (OJ L 279, 23.10.2007, p. 3) |
3 | Digital camera for capturing and recording images onto an internal storage device with a capacity of 22 MB or onto a memory card of a maximum capacity of 1 GB. The camera is equipped with a 6 megapixels charge-coupled device (CCD) and a liquid crystal device (LCD) with a diagonal measurement of 6,35 cm (2,5 inches) that can be used as a display when capturing images or as a screen for displaying pre-recorded images. The maximum resolution of the still images is 3 680 x 2 760 pixels. Using this highest resolution and the 1 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording approximately 290 still images. Using the resolution of 640 x 480 pixels and the 1 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording approximately 7 550 still images. The maximum resolution of the video is 640 x 480 pixels. Using this highest resolution and the 1 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording approximately 11 minutes of video at 30 frames per second. The camera offers an optical zoom function which cannot be used during video recording. | 8525 80 30 |
1231/2007 of 19.10.2007 (OJ L 279, 23.10.2007, p. 3) |
4 | Digital camera for capturing and recording images onto a memory card of a maximum capacity of 1 GB. The camera is equipped with a 6 megapixels charge-coupled device (CCD) and a foldable viewfinder of a liquid crystal device (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of 5,08 cm (2,0 inches) that can be used when capturing images or as a screen for displaying pre-recorded images. The maximum resolution of the still images is 3 680 x 2 760 pixels. Using this highest resolution and the 1 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording approximately 300 still images. Using the resolution of 640 x 480 pixels and the 1 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording approximately 7 750 still images. The maximum resolution of the video is 640 x 480 pixels. Using this highest resolution and the 1 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording approximately 42 minutes of video at 30 frames per second. The camera offers an optical zoom function which can be used during video recording. | 8525 80 30 |
1231/2007 of 19.10.2007 (OJ L 279, 23.10.2007, p. 3) |
5 | Digital video camera for capturing and recording images onto a memory card of a maximum capacity of 2 GB. The camera is equipped with a 5 megapixels charge-coupled device (CCD) and a foldable viewfinder of an organic light-emitting diode (OLED) device type with a diagonal measurement of 5,59 cm (2,2 inches) that can be used when capturing images or as a screen for displaying pre-recorded images. It is equipped with a microphone input, and an audio-video output. The maximum resolution of the video is 1 280 x 720 pixels. Using this highest resolution and the 2 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording approximately 42 minutes of video at 30 frames per second. Using the resolution of 640 x 480 pixels and the 2 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording two hours of video at 30 frames per second. The maximum resolution of the still images is 3 680 x 2 760 pixels. Using this highest resolution and the 2 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording approximately 600 still images. Using the resolution of 640 x 480 pixels and the 2 GB memory of the card, it is capable of recording approximately 15 500 still images. The camera offers an optical zoom function which can be used during video recording. | 8525 80 91 |
458/2014 of 29.4.2014 (OJ L 133, 6.5.2014, p. 39) |
1 | A digital apparatus with the design of a traditional video camera recorder for capturing and recording still and video images onto an internal memory or a memory card. The apparatus is equipped with a 0,8 megapixels charge-coupled device (CCD) and a foldable viewfinder of the liquid crystal display (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of approximately 7 cm (2,7 inches) that can be used when capturing images or as a screen for displaying recorded images. The apparatus has the following interfaces: - a slot for memory cards, - composite video out, - audio output, - USB. The maximum resolution of the still images is 1 600 x 1 200 pixels (1,92 megapixels). The apparatus can record video at 50 frames per second with a maximum resolution of 720 x 576 pixels. The apparatus offers an optical zoom function during video recording. Upon presentation files cannot be transferred to the apparatus from an automatic data-processing machine via the USB interface. | 8525 80 91 |
2016/1761 of 28.9.2016 (OJ L 269, 4.10.2016, p. 9) |
A battery operated apparatus (so-called 'video inspection scope'), consisting of: - a control unit incorporating a joystick, a recording device, a memory card slot and a LCD display with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 9 cm (3,5 inches), - a flexible electrical cable of a length of 3 m with a diameter of approximately 7 mm, - a camera, - LED lights. The apparatus is designed to be mainly used for technical inspections of cavities. It is capable of capturing and recording video images. The images can be viewed in real time. |
8525 80 91 | |
2016/664 of 26.4.2016 (OJ L 115, 29.4.2016, p. 19) |
A portable battery-operated apparatus for capturing and recording video images, with
dimensions of approximately 10 x 5 x 2 cm, of a weight of approximately 120 g, comprising: - camera lens, - an LCD display with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 5 cm (2 inches), - a microphone, - a loudspeaker, - a processor, - an internal Li-ion battery, - an internal memory with a capacity of up to 8 GB, - a built-in ('flip out') USB connector, - an HDMI output, - a built-in CMOS image sensor. The apparatus offers a 2-step digital zoom function. It is capable of recording video images at a resolution of 1 280 x 720 pixels at a rate of 30 frames per second for a maximum of 2 hours. It is not capable of capturing still images. Video images recorded by the apparatus can be either transferred to an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine via the in-built USB interface or to a television set via a micro HDMI cable. Upon presentation, video files can also be transferred to the apparatus from an ADP machine via the in-built USB interface. The apparatus can also be used as a removable storage device. |
8525 80 99 | |
458/2014 of 29.4.2014 (OJ L 133, 6.5.2014, p. 39) |
2 | A digital apparatus with the design of a traditional video camera recorder for capturing and recording still and video images onto an internal memory or a memory card. The apparatus is equipped with a 0,8 megapixels charge-coupled device (CCD) and a foldable viewfinder of the liquid crystal display (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of approximately 7 cm (2,7 inches) that can be used when capturing images or as a screen for displaying recorded images. The apparatus has the following interfaces: - a slot for memory cards, - composite video out, - audio output, - USB. The maximum resolution of the still images is 1 600 x 1 200 pixels (1,92 megapixels). The apparatus can record video at 50 frames per second with a maximum resolution of 720 x 576 pixels. The apparatus offers an optical zoom function during video recording. Upon presentation files can be transferred to the apparatus from an automatic data-processing machine via the USB interface. | 8525 80 99 |
1249/2011 of 29.11.2011 (OJ L 319, 2.12.2011, p.39) |
1 | A portable battery-operated apparatus for capturing and recording video, with dimensions of approximately 10 x 5,5 x 2 cm (so-called 'pocket sized video recorder') comprising: - a camera lens and a digital zoom, - a microphone, - a loudspeaker, - an LCD display with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 5 cm (2 inches), - a microprocessor, - a memory of 2 GB, and - USB and AV interfaces. The apparatus is only capable of capturing and recording video files in the form of sequences of images in MPEG4-AVI format. Video is recorded in a resolution of 640 x 480 pixels at 30 frames per second for a maximum of 2 hours. Video sequences recorded by the apparatus can either be transferred to an automatic data- processing (ADP) machine, via the USB interface, without modifying the format of the video files, or to a digital video recorder, a monitor or a television set via the AV interface. Video files can be transferred to the apparatus from an ADP machine, via the USB interface. | 8525 80 99 |
1231/2007 of 19.10.2007 (OJ L 279, 23.10.2007, p. 3) |
6 | Portable device consisting of a global positioning system (GPS) receiver, with integrated antenna and a personal digital assistant (PDA) with operating system in a single housing. The overall dimensions are: 11,2 (length) x 6,9 (width) x 1,6 (depth) cm. It is equipped with: - a memory card slot, - a 8,9-cm (3,5") LCD colour touch screen, - an LED backlight, - a 32-MB Flash memory, - a GPS built-in module with separate antenna, - a voice recorder, - an MP3 Playback support with built-in loudspeaker, - interfaces for headphone, USB, cradle, etc., and, - buttons to access the tasks, calendar, notes, contacts. | 8526 91 20 |
687/2002 of 22.4.2002 (OJ L 106, 23.4.2002, p. 3) |
2 | Hand-held global-positioning device (of dimensions H x W x D = 8 x 17,3 x 6,5 cm), with a 16-colour LCD-display (of a diagonal screen measurement of 10,4 cm) and several control buttons. The device has a 12-parallel-channel receiver capable of continuously tracking and using twelve satellites to compute and update positions, as well as a detachable antenna, and operates using either batteries or a 10 to 35 V DC-adaptor. It is supplied with the following accessories: yoke mount, a low-profile remote antenna, a cigarette-lighter adaptor, a cable to update data, a manual and a carrying-case. | 8526 91 90 |
400/2006 of 8.3.2006 (OJ L 70, 9.3.2006, p. 9) |
2 | A portable battery-operated apparatus for the reception of radio-broadcasts combined
in the same housing with sound recording or reproducing apparatus. It contains the
following elements: - a flash memory, - a microprocessor in the form of integrated circuits (chips), - an electronic system, including an audiofrequency amplifier, - an LCD display, - a radio tuner and - control buttons. The microprocessor is programmed for the use of the MP3 format. The device has stereo-, head- and earphone connectors and a remote control connector. It can be connected to an automatic dataprocessing machine through a USB port in order to download or upload MP3 or other formats. It can also record voice. The storage capacity is 128 MB. |
8527 13 99 |
883/94 of 20.4.1994 (OJ L 103, 22.4.1994, p. 7) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
4 | Portable battery-powered long-wave/FM radio-receiver and audio-cassette recorder/player, in a housing of coloured plastic, with large control-buttons, telescopic aerial, built-in microphone and loudspeaker. | 8527 13 99 |
299/2012 of 2.04.2012 (OJ L 99, 4.5.2012, p. 15) |
A portable battery-operated multifunctional electronic apparatus in a single housing, measuring approximately 10 x 9,5 x 10,5 cm, equipped with: - a liquid crystal colour display with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 9 cm (3,5 inches), an aspect ratio of 4:3 and a resolution of 320 x 240 pixels, - loudspeakers, - a microphone, - an alarm clock, - a memory of 2 GB, - a memory card reader, - a USB interface, - an interface for an FM antenna, - control buttons. The apparatus is capable of performing the following functions: - radio-broadcast reception, - voice recording, - sound reproduction, - still and video image reproduction, - alarm clock. | 8527 13 99 | |
1126/2012 of 1.26.11.2012 (OJ L 331, 1.12.2012, p. 11) |
1 | A portable battery-operated multifunctional apparatus with dimensions of approximately 9 x 5 x 1 cm, comprising: - a colour liquid crystal display with a resolution of 320 x 240 pixels and a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 5 cm (2,2 inches), - a microphone, - a built-in memory of 4 GB, - a FM tuner, - a USB interface, - a connector for headphones, - control buttons. The apparatus is capable of performing the following functions: - radio-broadcast reception, - sound recording and reproducing, - video recording and reproducing, - voice recording, - displaying still and video images. The apparatus supports the following formats: MP3, WMA, WAV, WMV and JPEG. The apparatus can be connected to an automatic data-processing machine for downloading or uploading files. | 8527 13 99 |
883/94 of 20.4.1994 (OJ L 103, 22.4.1994, p. 7) |
5 | Portable battery-powered long-wave/FM radio-receiver, in a housing of coloured plastic, with large control-buttons, and a microphone attached, to enable the user to broadcast through the built-in loudspeaker, with or without the radio playing. | 8527 19 00 |
2017/200 of 1.2.2017 (OJ L 32, 7.2.2017, p. 15) |
An electrical apparatus using Digital Audio Broadcasting (DAB) and Frequency
Modulation (FM) technology for radio broadcast reception. Its overall dimensions are
approximately 115 x 180 x 120 mm and it is capable of operating without an external source
of power. The apparatus is equipped with a built-in loudspeaker, Bluetooth/Advanced Audio Distribution Profile (A2DP) (which allows the apparatus to make sound audible wirelessly from sound-reproducing devices (e.g. MP3 players) that are also equipped with Bluetooth/A2DP profile), a socket for connection to headphones, and a socket for connection to an external power adaptor. |
8527 19 00 | |
215/2009 of 18.3.2009 (OJ L 73, 19.3.2009, p. 17) |
1 | So-called 'radio tuner module', designed to be incorporated in radio-broadcast receivers of the kind used in motor vehicles, together with other components such as a power supply unit, signal processors, audio amplifiers and channel-memorisation circuits. The module consists of a radio-frequency block, an intermediate frequency block and AM/FM demodulation circuits. The module isolates radio frequency and demodulates the audio signal without any further processing. | 8527 29 00 |
1718/98 of 31.7.1998 (OJ L 215, 1.8.1998, p. 56) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
1 | Device for receiving digital satellite-signals with thirty audio-channels, for the transfer of signals by cable to other apparatus. The signals are received by aerial. The device is not capable of producing an audible audio-programme as output. | 8527 99 00 |
634/2005 of 26.4.2005 (OJ L 106, 27.4.2005, p. 7) |
2 | Apparatus consisting of an AM/FM radio-broadcast receiver, a multi-channel amplifier, and a digital sound-processor. It is designed for the purposes of home entertainment, and is presented with a remote control. | 8527 99 00 |
634/2005 of 26.4.2005 (OJ L 106, 27.4.2005, p. 7) |
3 | Apparatus consisting of an AM/FM radio-broadcast receiver, a multi-channel amplifier, a digital sound-processor, and circuitry for video/sound synchronisation. It is designed for the purposes of home entertainment, since it can receive signals from various sources (e.g., DVD-player, satellite tuner, cassette-player, video recorder), and is presented with a remote control. The signals are decoded by digital-to-analogue converters before being amplified. | 8527 99 00 |
166/2007 of16.02.2007 (OJ L 52, 21.02.2007, p. 5) |
3 | Apparatus consisting of:an AM/FM radio-broadcast receiver,seven-channel amplifier section,a digital sound processor,a video converter, anda remote control.The product is designed to provide audio and video entertainment in the home.The device is capable of receiving signals from different sources (e.g., DVD player, satellite receiver, cassette player, video recorder).The sound signals may be decoded and passed to digital/analogue converters before being amplified.The video signals are synchronised with the sound signal. They may also be amplified to provide an improved picture quality. | 8527 99 00 |
111/2014 of 4.2.2014 (OJ L 38, 7.2.2014, p. 16) |
An apparatus combining a colour monitor of the liquid crystal display (LCD) type and a touch-sensitive surface (so-called 'monitor with touch screen') with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 38 cm (15 inches) with: - a native resolution of 1 024 x 768 pixels, - supported resolutions of 640 x 350, 720 x 400, 640 x 480, 800 x 600 and 1 024 x 768 pixels, - an aspect ratio of 4:3, - a pixel pitch of 0,297 mm, - a brightness of 250 cd/m 2 , - a horizontal viewing angle of 120° and a vertical viewing angle of 100°, - a response time of 17 ms, - a contrast ratio of 400:1, - power and control buttons. It is equipped with the following interfaces: - a D-Sub, - a USB and a RS-232 for connecting the touch-sensitive surface to an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine. It has a stand with a tilt and swivel mechanism and a glare free surface. The monitor is presented for use, for example, in point of sale/customer information point terminals. The touch-sensitive surface enables the users to input data into these terminals. The monitor is capable of displaying signals from ADP machines. | 8528 51 00 | |
310/2014 of 25.3.2014 (OJ L 91, 27.3.2014, p. 10) |
A colour monitor of the liquid crystal display (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement
of the screen of approximately 48 cm (19 inches) with dimensions of approximately 46 x 37
x 21 cm with: - a native resolution of 1 440 x 900 pixels, - supported resolutions of 640 x 480, 800 x 600, 1 024 x 768 and 1 280 x 1 024 pixels, - an aspect ratio of 16:10, - a pixel pitch of 0,285 mm, - a brightness of 300 cd/m2, - a contrast ratio of 500:1, - a response time of 8 ms, - two loudspeakers, - power and control buttons. It is equipped with the following interfaces: - a DVI-D, - two VGA. It has a stand with a tilt mechanism. The monitor is presented for use with automatic data-processing (ADP) machines. |
8528 51 00 | |
112/2014 of 4.2.2014 (OJ L 38, 7.2.2014, p. 18) |
A colour monitor of the liquid crystal display (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 75 cm (30 inches) with dimensions of approximately 71 x 45 x 11 cm with: - a native resolution of 1 280 x 768 pixels, - supported resolutions of 640 x 480, 800 x 600, 1 024 x 768 and 1 280 x 768 pixels, - supported TV standards: NTSC, PAL and SECAM, - supported video modes: 480i, 480p, 576i, 576p, 720p and 1 080i, - an aspect ratio of 15:9, - a pixel pitch of 0,5025 mm, - a response time of 25 ms, - a brightness of 450 cd/m 2 , - a contrast ratio of 350:1, - a horizontal and vertical viewing angle of 170°, - picture-in-picture (PIP) capability, - a built-in audio amplifier, - power and control buttons. It is equipped with the following interfaces: - a DVI-D, - a D-Sub mini, - BNC (analogue RGB), - composite RCA or S-Video, - component BNC, - 2 sets RCA stereo and 1 mini stereo, - external speaker jacks, - a RS-232 for control input. It has a fixed stand without a tilt and swivel mechanism and is presented with a remote control. The monitor does not incorporate a video tuner or other electronics for processing television signals. The monitor is presented for use in information display applications, such as public information access points, retail signage, financial exchanges, airports and trade show exhibits. For performing this function, the monitor is capable of displaying signals from both automatic data-processing (ADP) machines and other video sources. | 8528 59 31 | |
114/2014 of 4.2.2014 (OJ L 38, 7.2.2014, p. 22) |
A colour monitor of the liquid crystal display (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 54 cm (21 inches) with dimensions (without stand) of approximately 37 x 47 x 7 cm with: - a resolution of 1 200 x 1 600 pixels, - an aspect ratio of 3:4, - a pixel pitch of 0,270 mm, - a horizontal scanning frequency of 31 to 76 kHz, - a vertical scanning frequency of 49 to 61 Hz, - a maximum brightness of 250 cd/m 2 which can be calibrated, - a total viewing angle, horizontal and vertical, of 170°, - a contrast ratio of 550:1, - a response time of 30 ms, - power and control buttons, including calibration mode selection. It is equipped with the following interfaces: - a DVI-I, - a D-Sub mini, - 1 upstream USB and 2 downstream USB. It has a pivot function of 90°. It has a stand with a tilt and swivel mechanism and a glare-free surface. It can also be mounted on a wall. The product conforms to 'Digital Imaging and Communications in Medicine' (DICOM) standards, including Part 14, allowing the user to set extremely precise gamma, brightness and colour temperature values and enabling the monitor to display colour and greyscale gradations of images with the accuracy required for medical diagnostics. The monitor is presented for use in medical systems for displaying radiographic images for clinical diagnostics. | 8528 59 31 | |
1196/2011 of 16.11.2011 (OJ L 303, 22.11.2011, p. 12) amended by Reg. 459/2014 |
1 | A portable, battery-powered electronic eyewear apparatus for displaying images (so-called "video glasses") with dimensions in a folded state of approximately 15 x 3,5 x 2,5 cm. The electronic eyewear apparatus consists of two liquid crystal device (LCD) screens, each with a resolution of 640 x 480 pixels (virtual equivalent of an 80 inch screen viewed 2 meters away) and sound-processing circuits, mounted in a frame similar to a frame for spectacles. The apparatus can be connected to an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine and to apparatus such as video reproducers, television receivers or game consoles. It displays virtual 3-dimensional (3D) video images for entertainment purposes. | 8528 59 31 |
877/2014 of 8.8.2014 (OJ L 240, 13.8.2014, p. 15) |
An apparatus (so-called 'LCD video wall display') comprising a colour monitor of the LCD technology and an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine, with dimensions of approximately 91 x 53 x 12 cm. The monitor with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 102 cm (40 inches) has the following characteristics: - a native resolution of 1 920 x 1 080 pixels, - an aspect ratio of 16:9, - a pixel pitch of 0,46125 mm, - a response time of 8 ms, - a maximum brightness of 700 cd/m2, - a typical contrast ratio of 3 000:1, - a horizontal and vertical viewing angle of 178°, - picture-in-picture (PIP) capability. The built-in ADP machine comprises a microprocessor, a memory of 1 GB and a hard disk drive of 40 GB. The apparatus also comprises an audio amplifier, two loudspeakers and power and control buttons and is presented with a remote control. The apparatus has the following interfaces: VGA In, DVI-D In/Out, HDMI, CVBS (AV), RS232C In/Out, Audio In/Out and LAN. The apparatus is presented for use as a component in LCD video walls. The integrated ADP machine is used as a video wall processor for providing video wall control over a network of up to 5 x 5 video wall configurations. The apparatus can work autonomously as a monitor or as an ADP machine. | 8528 59 31 | |
103/2012 of 7.2. 2012 (OJ L 36, 9.2.2012, p. 17) amended by Reg. 2015/712 |
A modular screen panel (so-called "LED wall") comprising several modules made of tiles, each tile measuring approximately 38 x 38 x 9 cm. Each tile contains red, green and blue light emitting diodes and has a resolution of 16 x 16 pixels, a dot pitch of 24 mm, a brightness of 2 000 cd/m 2 and a refresh rate of more than 300 Hz. They also contain drive electronics. The panel is presented together with a processing system comprising: - a video processor accepting various signal inputs (such as CVBS, Y/C, YUV/RGB, (HD-) SDI or DVI) and allowing the scaling of an image/video to the screen panel size, and - a signal processor allowing the pixel mapping of the input signal to the screen panel. The processed signal is sent from the signal processor to a data distributor using optical fibre cables. The data distributor sends in turn the data to the various tiles of the screen panel. The panel is not designed for viewing at close distance. It is used for sport/entertainment events, retail signage, etc. | 8528 59 39 | |
698/2012 of 25. 7. 2012 (OJ L 203, 31. 7. 2012, p. 34) amended by Reg. 459/2014 |
1 | A multifunctional apparatus (so-called 'multimedia centre for motor vehicles') of a kind used in motor vehicles, consisting of two main components: - a reception apparatus for radio-broadcasting combined with a CD/DVD player, - a detachable colour liquid crystal display (LCD) of the touch screen type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 17,5 cm (7 inches) and an aspect ratio of 16:9. The apparatus is equipped with connectors enabling the reception of video signals from external sources such as a rear-view camera. The apparatus is presented with a remote control. An additional display can be connected to the apparatus. | 8528 59 70 |
698/2012 of 25. 7. 2012 (OJ L 203, 31. 7. 2012, p. 34) amended by Reg. 459/2014 |
2 | A multifunctional apparatus (so-called 'multimedia centre for motor vehicles') of a kind used in motor vehicles measuring approximately 17 x 5 x 16 cm. It combines, in the same housing, a reception apparatus for radio-broadcasting, a sound and a video reproducing apparatus and a colour liquid crystal display (LCD) with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 8 cm (3,5 inches). The apparatus is equipped with connectors enabling the reception of video signals from external sources such as a rear-view camera. The apparatus can also reproduce sound and images from a USB memory stick. The apparatus is presented with a remote control. An additional display can be connected to the apparatus. | 8528 59 70 |
698/2012 of 25. 7. 2012 (OJ L 203, 31. 7. 2012, p. 34) amended by Reg. 459/2014 |
3 | Classification is determined by General Rules 1, 3(c) and 6 for the interpretation of the Combined Nomenclature and by the wording of CN codes 8528, 8528 59 and 8528 59 40. The apparatus consists of components capable of performing various functions (sound reproduction, video reproduction, radio navigational aid, radio-broadcasting, displaying video), none of which, in view of its design and concept, gives the apparatus its essential character. By application of GIR 3(c), the apparatus is therefore to be classified under CN code 8528 59 40 as other colour monitors with a screen of the LCD technology. | 8528 59 70 |
1156/2008 of 20.11.2008 (OJ L 310 21.11.2008, p.9) amended by Reg. 441/2013 amended by Reg. 459/2014 |
1 | An apparatus for the recording, reproducing and displaying of still images (so-called 'digital photo frame'), with overall dimensions 17 (L) x 12,9 (W) x 12,3 (D) cm, consisting of the following main components in a single housing:- a colour display of the liquid crystal device (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of 13 cm (5,1 inches) and a resolution of 320 x 240 pixels, - a slot for a Subscriber Identity Module (SIM) card, - an infra-red interface, - an internal memory, and - control buttons The images are transferred to the internal memory of the apparatus from a compatible device (such as a mobile phone, automatic data-processing machine or digital camera) via an infra-red signal or with an SIM card through Multimedia Messaging Service (MMS). The images can also be transferred from the apparatus via the infra-red signal to a compatible device. The apparatus supports JPEG and GIF formats with a maximum resolution of 1 024 x 728 pixels. The images can be displayed in either single image or slideshow mode. Its internal memory can store up to 50 images. | 8528 59 70 |
1156/2008 of 20.11.2008 (OJ L 310 21.11.2008, p.9) amended by Reg. 441/2013 amended by Reg. 459/2014 |
2 | An apparatus for the recording, reproducing and displaying of still and video images,
as well as for the recording and reproducing of sound (so-called 'digital picture frame'),
with overall dimensions 33 (W) x 24,1 (H) x 4,1 (D) cm, consisting of the following main
components in a single housing: - a colour display of the liquid crystal device (LCD) type, with a diagonal measurement of the screen of 25,4 cm (10 inches) and a resolution of 800 x 480 pixels, - an internal memory with a storage capacity of 128 MB, - memory card slots, - built-in loudspeakers, - two USB interfaces, and - control buttons. It supports the following formats:- audio: MP3, - still image: JPEG, GIF, - video: MPEG1, MPEG4, MOV, AVI. Different types of solid-state non-volatile storage devices can be inserted into the memory card slots. The images may be displayed in single image, slideshow or thumbnails mode. The apparatus can be connected to a compatible apparatus, for example, a digital camera, a printer or an automatic dataprocessing machine. |
8528 59 70 |
1172/2008 of 25.11.2008 (OJ L 317 25.11.2008, p.4) amended by Reg. 441/2013 amended by Reg. 459/2014 |
1 | A battery-operated apparatus consisting of alaser reading system for video reproducing
and a colour monitor (so-called 'portable DVD player'). Its overall dimensions are 19 (L) x 14,2 (W) x 3,7 (H) cm and the weight is 800 grams. The monitor is of the liquid crystal device (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of 21,6 cm (8,5 inches). The apparatus can be folded and its monitor rotated. The apparatus is equipped with built-in loudspeakers. It has the following interfaces: - memory card expansion slots, - a USB port, - composite video in and out, and - headphone jacks. It can read optical media (for example, CD, DVD) and semiconductor media (for example, USB flash memory) in various audio and video formats. |
8528 59 70 |
2184/97 of 3.11.1997 (OJ L 299, 4.11.1997, p. 6) |
5 | Projector operating by means of a flat-panel display (liquid-crystal device), for the projection in colour of data received directly from automatic data-processing machines (e.g. text, graphics), as well as still images or moving images from still-image video-cameras or other video-camera recorders, video-recording or -reproducing apparatus, television-receivers, etc. The apparatus incorporates loudspeakers. | 8528 69 10 |
1849/2004 of 21.10.2004 (OJ L 323, 26.10.2004, p. 3) |
1 | Desktop-projector, for projecting data and images at a distance onto a large screen or wall, operating by means of a liquid-crystal device. It can be connected to an automatic data-processing machine.It has a video input, for reproducing images from sources such as a video recorder or video camera. | 8528 69 10 |
2564/95 of 27.10.1995 (OJ L 262, 1.11.1995, p. 25) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
4 | Tuner-card, for insertion into an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine to permit reception of televised broadcasts. The electronic card consists of a printed-circuit board comprising various integrated circuits and other electronic components. Together with appropriate software and an aerial, the tuner-card allows the ADP-machine to make an automatic search of the channels, receive the programmes and record the images broadcast. | 8528 71 11 |
144/2012 of 16.2.2012 (OJ L 48, 21.2.2012, p. 1) |
An apparatus in a single housing with dimensions of approximately 31 x 20 x 5 cm, comprising the following components: - a microprocessor, - a dual DVB-S/DVB-T digital tuner, - a flash memory, and - a "smart card" reader for conditional access to a service provider. The apparatus is equipped with the following interfaces: - a satellite RF input, - a terrestrial RF input, - a terrestrial RF output, - an Ethernet (RJ-45), - two USB, - an HDMI, - two SCART, - two RCA for audio output, - an S/PDIF (optical digital audio output), and - a slot for a hard disk. An interchangeable hard disk can be clipped in after presentation. The hard disks can be retained for viewing the files recorded at a later stage only on this apparatus. Upon presentation, the apparatus is capable of receiving and decoding digital television signals (both free channels and programmes from the service provider). It is also capable of connecting to the Internet via the Ethernet interface. The apparatus is capable of receiving and decoding audio/video files from an automatic data - processing machine via a so-called "home gateway". The apparatus is capable of reproducing audio/video files from external media (such as a hard disk or a USB memory) via a USB interface. The apparatus is capable of recording and reproducing the digital television signals received. | 8528 71 15 | |
145/2012 of 16.2.2012 (OJ L 48, 21.2.2012, p. 3) |
An apparatus in a single housing with dimensions of approximately 27 x 15 x 6 cm, comprising the following components: - a microprocessor, - two cable digital tuners, - a cable modem, - a flash memory, and - a "smart card" reader for conditional access to a service provider. The apparatus is equipped with the following interfaces: - an RF input and an RF output, - two Ethernet (RJ-45), - two USB, - an HDMI, - a SCART, - six RCA for audio and video output, - an S/PDIF (optical digital audio output), and - a slot for a hard disk. The housing of the apparatus can be opened and a hard disk can be inserted after presentation. Upon presentation, the apparatus is capable of receiving and decoding digital television signals. It is also capable of connecting to the Internet via the modem. The apparatus is capable of receiving and decoding audio/video files from apparatus within a local area network via a router. The apparatus is capable of reproducing audio/video files from external media (such as a hard disk or a USB memory) via a USB interface. The apparatus is capable of recording and reproducing the digital television signals received from the service provider. | 8528 71 15 | |
701/1999 of 31.3.1999 (OJ L 89, 1.4.1999, p. 23) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
4 | Satellite receiver, which receives scrambled and digitalised MPEG satellite television-broadcast signals (images and sound), converts them into analogue signals, and transfers them in a usable form to a television-receiver, video-monitor or data-monitor. The apparatus consists of: a 950 to 2 050 MHz tuner, a unit to decompress and de-scramble the MPEG signals into analogue video-signals and to transmit the converted signals, and a front-panel with keypad and LCD-display. | 8528 71 19 |
701/1999 of 31.3.1999 (OJ L 89, 1.4.1999, p. 23) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
5 | Integrated receiver/decoder (addressable converter), capable of receiving and decoding scrambled signals through a cable-network and converting them into radio-frequency signals. It includes a tuner, filters, modulators, audio/video-processor, microprocessor with memory, FM-receiver, return-path transmitter and smart-card reader, as well as a keypad and remote-control for selecting channels. It has control- and communication-functions, e.g. downloading billing-data, event-purchasing, polling, etc. The apparatus will de-scramble only those encoded signals assigned to a particular subscriber. | 8528 71 19 |
883/94 of 20.4.1994 (OJ L 103, 22.4.1994, p. 7) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
6 | Printed-circuit board, for incorporation into a video-cassette recorder, consisting, inter alia, of a tuner-block and an intermediate-frequency-block which, together, isolate and modulate the video-signal, prior to further conversion of the signal by additional processes so that it can be used directly by the video-head. | 8528 71 19 |
884/94 of 20.4.1994 (OJ L 103, 22.4.1994, p. 10) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Satellite receiver which converts the high-frequency television-signals received by the satellite dish and transfers them in a usable form to the colour television connected. The satellite receiver may incorporate the means for selecting the channels (by keyboard or remote control). | 8528 71 19 |
1216/2014 of 11.11.2014 (OJ L 329, 14.11.2014, p. 14) |
An electronic apparatus with dimensions of approximately 10 x 4 x 1 cm, comprising, amongst others, the following components: - a processor, - a system memory of 1 GB, - an internal memory of 4 GB, - a built-in module for wireless connection to the internet. It is equipped with the following interfaces: - HDMI, - USB, - micro USB, - micro SDHC. The apparatus does not incorporate a video tuner. When connected to a television set or a monitor, the apparatus enables the user to access the internet, for example, for exchanging e-mails, watching videos, playing games or downloading software applications. It also is able to reproduce multimedia files such as video, photo and music from memory cards or USB memories. | 8528 71 91 | |
1203/2011 of 18.11.2011 (OJ L 305, 23.11.2011, p. 12) |
1 | A set put up for retail sale consisting of: - apparatus A: a wireless transmitter for audio/video signals (television) with a built-in wireless receiver for radio remote control signals incorporating an infrared transmitter and two separate antennas, and - apparatus B: a wireless receiver for audio/video signals (television) with a built-in wireless transmitter for radio remote control signals incorporating an infrared receiver and two separate antennas. The set is designed for transmission of an audio/video signal from an external source such as a satellite receiver or a DVD player connected to apparatus A, to another audio/video apparatus such as a monitor or a television set connected to apparatus B, within a range of 400 m. The audio/video signals transmitted from apparatus A to apparatus B at a frequency of 2,4 GHz are in the form of television signals. The signals transmitted from apparatus B to apparatus A at a frequency of 433 MHz are initiated by an infrared remote control device. These signals function independently of the signals for audio/video transmission. The remote control device is used for controlling the external source connected to the audio/video transmitter (apparatus A). | 8528 71 99 |
1172/2008 of 25.11.2008 (OJ L 317, 27.11.2008, p. 4) |
2 | 'Laptop style' battery-operated apparatus consisting of a laser reading system for video reproducing and a colour monitor with a TV tuner (so-called 'portable DVD player'). Its overall dimensions are 19,5 (L) x 14,9 (W) x 3,1 (H) cm and the weight is 800 grams. The monitor is of the liquid crystal device (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of 17,8 cm (7 inches) and it can be folded. The product is equipped with: - built-in loudspeakers, and - DVB-T (Digital Video Broadcasting Terrestrial) and analogue video tuner. It has the following interfaces: - memory card expansion slots, - a USB port, - composite video in and out, and - headphone jacks. It can read optical media (for example, CD, DVD) and semiconductor media (for example, USB flash memory) in various audio and video formats. It can also be used as a digital radio-broadcast receiver or as a video game player. | 8528 72 20 |
113/2011 of 7.2.2011 (OJ L 34, 9.2.2011, p. 37) |
1 | Product (so-called 'video surveillance system for babies') presented in a set put up for retail sale consisting of: - a wireless television camera incorporating a microphone, a video signal transmitter and an antenna; the camera is equipped with an output interface for audio/video; - a wireless colour monitor of the liquid crystal display (LCD) type with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 14 cm (5,6 inches) and an aspect ratio of 4:3, incorporating a loudspeaker, a video signal receiver and an antenna; the monitor is equipped with an input interface for audio/video; - two adaptors; and - an audio/video cable. Signals are transmitted from the camera to the monitor at a frequency of 2,4 GHz within a range of 150 metres. The set is used for monitoring babies from a distance. | 8528 72 40 |
1156/2013 of 14.11.2013 (OJ L 306, 16.112013, p. 8) |
1 | An incomplete colour television of the liquid crystal display (LCD) type, without a so-called 'tuner', with a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 81 cm (32 inches) and with dimensions (without stand) of approximately 75 x 44 x 5 cm with: - a native resolution of 1 920 x 1 080 pixels, - an aspect ratio of 16:9, - a pixel pitch of 0,369 mm, - two loudspeakers of 10 W, - power and control buttons, including channel selection buttons, - a slot for incorporating a so-called 'tuner' in the form of a module comprising radio frequency circuits (RF block), intermediate frequency circuits (IF block) and demodulation circuits (DEM block). After incorporation of the tuner module the apparatus can receive digital television signals. It is equipped with the following video interfaces: - two HDMI, - a composite IN, - a component IN. The apparatus is also equipped with a MPEG decoder for decompressing digital video signals and with electronics for controlling the channel selection (tuning) and memorisation. It has a fixed stand without tilt and swivel mechanism and is presented with a remote control. | 8528 72 40 |
336/2014 of 28.3.2014 (OJ L 99, 2.4.2014, p. 1) |
A set put up for retail sale (so-called 'wireless rear-view camera system') for installation in motor vehicles comprising the following components: - a day and night television camera with a CMOS sensor and a 2,4 mm lens, - a wireless video signal transmitter with an antenna, - a 2,4 GHz wireless receiver for video signals with a colour liquid crystal display (LCD) with a diagonal measurement of the screen of 17,8 cm (7 inches) and a resolution of 480 x 240 pixels. It is equipped with function buttons and an AV interface for connecting external audio or video apparatus. The television camera does not capture sound. The product is designed for use in, for example, cars, coaches or trailers, and allows the driver to see what is behind. | 8528 72 40 | |
113/2014 of 4.2.2014 (OJ L 38, 7.2.2014, p. 20) |
A rectangular shaped apparatus (so-called 'high speed camera') comprising a lens and electronic circuitry with dimensions of approximately 12 x 12 x 11 cm. It incorporates a volatile internal memory of 2 GB able to temporarily store images in a sequence with a maximum duration of 1,54 seconds at 1 000 frames per second (fps) at full resolution. The captured images are lost when the camera is switched off. Connection by a cable to an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine is necessary for operating the camera and recording the images into the ADP machine. It is equipped with a CMOS sensor with a global electronic snapshot shutter, also known as 'short duration flash' or 'stroboscopic imaging'. The camera is designed to capture a sequence of images at a shutter rate from 60 up to 1 000 fps at a full resolution of 1 024 x 1 024 pixels or 109 500 fps at a lower resolution of 128 x 16 pixels. The captured images may be viewed individually or played back as video, for example, in slow motion. The images may be subject to analysis in a laboratory or a similar environment for studying, for example, ultra-high speed phenomena such as automotive crash tests. | 8528 80 19 | |
1036/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 6) |
A printed circuit assembly presented for incorporation into a reception apparatus for television incorporating a LCD screen and a video reproducing apparatus. The assembly comprises the following interfaces for connecting with external apparatus: - VGA input, - HDMI inputs (HDCP supported), - RGB video inputs (SCART connectors), - video component input, - CVBS video input and output, - audio input and output, - loudspeaker output, - USB socket. The assembly also comprises several internal interfaces, for example, a low-voltage differential signalling (LVDS) interface for connecting with a LCD screen and an interface to the internal power supply. The assembly does not incorporate a so-called 'tuner' comprising radio frequency circuits (RF block), intermediate frequency circuits (IF block) and demodulation circuits (DEM block), for the reception of digital television signals. The LCD screen is not included upon presentation. The assembly performs several functions, for example, analogue-digital conversion, video decoding (for example, MPEG4), scaling, audio decoding, audio amplification, HDMI receiver and LVDS output transmitter for an LCD screen. In addition to standard video or television signals, the scaler is also able to process several incoming resolutions of the automatic-data processing (ADP) machine type (up to 1 920 x 1 080 pixels) into the native resolution of a LCD screen. The assembly is able to reproduce images and sound from an USB memory. | 8529 90 65 | |
957/2006 of 28.6.2006 (OJ L 175, 29.6.2006, p. 45) |
3 | A product, known as an 'LCD module', in the form of an active matrix liquid crystal device with a backlight unit, inverters and printed circuit boards with control electronics for pixel addressing only. The module is based on thin-film transistor (TFT) technology. It has overall dimensions of 75,9 (W) x 44,9 (H) x 4,9 (D) cm, a diagonal screen measurement of 81,6 cm (32 inches) and a resolution of 1 366 x 768 pixels. The module does not incorporate any other electronic components (for example, a power supply, a video converter, a scaler, a tuner, etc.) or interfaces for connection to other apparatus. | 8529 90 92 |
2147/2004 of 16.12.2004 (OJ L 370, 17.12.2004, p. 19) |
3 | 42-inch plasma screen with format 16:9 and resolution of 852 x 480 pixels. It consists of an aluminium frame containing a layer of plasma cells between two glass plates, with address- and display-electrodes. It is equipped with flat cabling, but no other electronic components (such as drivers or a power supply) or interface for connecting up to other apparatus. It is for use in the manufacture of a video monitor. | 8529 90 92 |
1201/2011 of 18.11.2011 (OJ L 305, 23.11.2011, p. 8) |
1 | A liquid crystal display (LCD) panel (so-called "LCD module"), with a diagonal measurement of approximately 66 cm (26 inches), consisting of an active matrix liquid crystal layer sandwiched between two sheets of glass, fitted with connectors. Between the first sheet of glass and the layer of liquid crystal there is a thin film transistor (TFT) matrix that provides the appropriate voltage to the pixels. Between the layer of liquid crystal and the second sheet of glass there is an RGB filter that controls the colours of the picture displayed. Several connectors in the form of straps are attached to the panel. Each connector consists of miniature integrated circuits (so-called "source drivers IC") on flexible printed circuits. Printed circuit boards (PCBs) are connected to the "source drivers IC". The "source drivers IC" allow power and control signals to pass through, as well as convert and transmit data from the PCBs to the individual pixels of the active liquid crystal matrix. The module is used in the manufacture of monitors or reception apparatus for television of heading 8528. | 8529 90 92 44 |
1202/2011 of 18.11.2011 (OJ L 305, 23.11.2011, p. 10) |
1 | A liquid crystal display (LCD) panel (so-called "LCD module"), with a diagonal measurement of approximately 66 cm (26 inches), consisting of an active matrix liquid crystal layer sandwiched between two sheets of glass, fitted with connectors. Between the first sheet of glass and the layer of liquid crystal there is a thin film transistor (TFT) matrix that provides the appropriate voltage to the pixels. Between the layer of liquid crystal and the second sheet of glass there is an RGB filter that controls the colours of the picture displayed. Several connectors in the form of straps are attached to the panel. Each connector consists of miniature integrated circuits (so-called "source drivers IC") on flexible printed circuits. The "source drivers IC" allow power and control signals to pass through, as well as convert and transmit data from the printed circuit boards (connected after importation) to the individual pixels of the active liquid crystal matrix. The module is used in the manufacture of monitors or reception apparatus for television of heading 8528. | 8529 90 92 44 |
1109/2012 of 23.11.2012 (OJ L 329, 29.11.2012, p. 3) |
An electronic device (so-called 'CCD area image sensor') in a 60-pin ceramic package consisting of: - 3 charge coupled device (CCD) chips linearly arranged with an X-ray sensitive active area of approximately 220 x 6 mm. Each CCD chip has 1 536 x 128 pixels with a pixel size of 48 x 48 mm, - 3 fibre optic plates with scintillators mounted on each CCD chip. The device has an output of integrated circuits. The device is installed in X-ray cameras to generate images. The fibre optic plates with scintillators convert the X-rays into visible light which is projected onto the CCD sensor. The CCD sensor converts the light into an electrical signal which is processed into an analogue or digital image. The device is designed for X-ray imaging. | 8529 90 92 | |
274/2013 of 19.3.2013 (OJ L 84, 23.3.2013, p. 5) |
1 | A colour liquid crystal display (LCD) module with a diagonal measurement of the screen of 16,5 cm (6,5 inches) with mounting devices on the side, an aluminium heat sink on the back, with dimensions of approximately 16 x 10 x 2 cm. The module comprises a low-voltage differential signalling (LVDS) receiver, a light emitting diode (LED) backlight with integrated brightness control, a LED driver circuit, printed circuit boards with control electronics for pixel addressing only comprising a microcontroller, and a 10-pin LVDS interface. The display has the following characteristics: - a resolution of 400 x 240 pixels, - an aspect ratio of 16:9, - a dot pitch of 0,1195(*3) x 0,3305 mm. The module does not incorporate any video signal processing assembly, for example, a video converter, a scaler or a tuner. The module is designed for incorporation into a dashboard of a motor vehicle for displaying video signals. | 8529 90 92 |
875/2014 of 8.8.2014 (OJ L 240, 13.8.2014, p. 9) |
An article (so-called 'LED tile') in an aluminium housing with dimensions of approximately 40 x 40 x 7 cm, including the following components: - light emitting diodes (LED) mounted on a printed circuit board with a pixel density of 72 x 72 and a brightness of 2 000 cd/m2, - connectors for the power supply (in and out), - connectors for the data input (in and out), - brackets and holes for mounting several tiles together. The article is presented for use in a modular LED video wall. It does not include a video processor. The LED tile, whether or not connected to other tiles, cannot display video images directly originating from a video source. It can only display signals originating from a dedicated video processor (so-called 'digitiser'), which processes the signals and divides them over the total number of tiles in the LED video wall. The tile, when connected to the video processor, has the capability to display images in a large number (281 trillion) of colours. | 8529 90 92 | |
957/2006 of 28.6.2006 (OJ L 175, 29.6.2006, p. 45) |
1 | A graphic and alpha-numeric display based on the monochrome passive matrix liquid crystal display technology. The display consists of a liquid crystal layer sandwiched between two sheets or plates of glass with a number of dots (presented in 64 lines and 240 columns) and an electronic interface board of C-MOS technology. It can be incorporated with other products. It is unable to display video images. | 8531 20 95 |
48/90 of 9.1.1990 (OJ L 8, 11.1.1990, p. 16) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
2 | Dot-matrix display consisting of a layer of liquid crystal between two glass sheets or plates with a number of dots (presented in lines and columns), and an electronic interface board of C-MOS technology. | 8531 20 80 |
48/90 of 9.1.1990 (OJ L 8, 11.1.1990, p. 16) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
3 | Indicator-lamp, fitted with two connector-pins, and consisting of a coloured (translucent) plastic casing (30 mm long and 8 mm in diameter), enclosing a light-source consisting of a discharge lamp and two resistances. It is intended to be fitted into household electrical appliances, in order to indicate that the appliance is connected to the mains power supply. It may be used for 220 V or 380 V installations. | 8531 80 95 |
1217/2014 of 11.112014 (OJ L 329, 14.11.2014, p. 17) |
1 | An article (so-called 'electrical filter') constituted by a multilayer ceramic capacitor of the surface mount feedthrough type, with dimensions of approximately 8 x 3 x 3 mm. It is presented as a low pass filter for use as an electromagnetic interference (EMI) filter in, for example, power amplifiers, power supplies, temperature and motor controls and driver circuits. | 8532 24 00 |
709/2013 of 24.07.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p.12) |
A product (so-called 'exhaust gas temperature sensor') consisting of: - a thermistor with a power handling capacity not exceeding 20 W, in its own housing, - a fixing bolt, - a shaft facilitating fixation inside a vehicle's exhaust system, - an electrical cable, with a heat resistant sleeve, which connects the product to a plug and which, in turn, enables connection to the vehicle's engine management system. Depending on the temperature, the thermistor changes its resistance. When connected, this change of resistance produces a change of electrical current, which is transmitted to the engine management system. The product cannot convert the electrical current output into a temperature measurement or display the temperature. | 8533 21 00 | |
717/2010 of 6.8.2010 (OJ L 210, 11.8.2010, p. 24) |
1 | A product (so-called 'exhaust gas temperature sensor') consisting of: - a thermistor with a power handling capacity not exceeding 20 W, in its own housing, - a fixing bolt, - a shaft facilitating fixation inside a vehicle's exhaust system, and - an electrical cable, with a heat resistant sleeve, which connects the product to a plug and which, in turn, enables connection to the vehicle's engine management system. Depending on the temperature, the thermistor changes its resistance. When connected, this change of resistance produces a change of electrical current, which is transmitted to the engine management system. The product cannot convert the electrical current output into a temperature measurement or display the temperature. | 8533 40 10 |
1964/90 of 6.7.1990 (OJ L 178, 11.7.1990, p. 5) |
5 | Socket for cathode-ray tubes (CRT), consisting of two interlocking plastic components, one of which houses several metallic conducting-terminals. The socket is for attachment to the base of the CRT, so that the CRT can be connected easily to the electronic circuitry of the television-receiver. | 8535 90 00 |
1123/2012 of 26.11.2012 (OJ L 331, 1.12.2012 p.5) | 1 | An apparatus (so-called "passive infrared detector") consisting of a printed circuit assembly in a plastic housing with dimensions of approximately 11 x 7 x 4 cm. The printed circuit assembly is equipped with an infrared sensor, passive elements (capacitors, resistors), active elements (transistors, integrated circuits) and a light emitting diode. It is also equipped with a dual in-line package switch, an anti-tamper switch, a block of screw terminal connectors and an output of semiconductor relay type. The housing comprises a reflecting surface and a lens. The apparatus has an output signal of up to 30 V DC, 50 mA. The apparatus is designed to send an electrical signal to an apparatus, such as an alarm system or an electric door, when a movement is identified by detecting changes in temperature. | 8536 50 19 |
550/2014 of 20.5.2014 (OJ L 155, 23.5.2014, p.15) |
An apparatus (so-called 'flame detector') consisting of passive infra-red and ultra-violet sensors, an optical filter, an evaluation unit, three output relays (fire alarm, fault and auxiliary relay) and a three colour status LED (indicating normal operation, fire and fault condition), in a cylindrical housing with a diameter of approximately 12 cm and a length of approximately 25 cm. Its operating range is 18 to 30 V DC. The apparatus is a component of a fire alarm system. The sensors simultaneously detect the infra-red and ultra-violet radiation emitted by a fire. If the radiation emitted is above a certain threshold, the apparatus sends an electrical signal via the fire alarm relay to a fire alarm apparatus. The fire alarm apparatus is not included upon presentation. | 8536 50 19 | |
456/2014 of 29.4.2014 (OJ L 133, 6.5.2014, p. 33) |
A product (so-called 'radio-controlled socket set') in a package containing two remote controlled switches and a remote control. Each remote controlled switch is in an individual housing consisting of a plug, a socket, a learning button, a switch and a radio receiver and is designed for a voltage of 230 V and a maximum current of 10 A. The learning button is used for identification between the switch and the remote control. It can also be used as a manual switch. The remote control works within a transmission frequency range of 433,05 - 434,79 MHz over a distance of approximately 30 m and controls both switches independently of each other. The product is used for switching on and off, by remote control, equipment connected to the sockets. | 8536 50 80 | |
457/2014 of 29.4.2014 (OJ L 133, 6.5.2014, p. 38) |
3 | An apparatus with four High-Definition Multimedia Interfaces (HDMI) inputs and one HDMI output (so-called 'passive HDMI switch') in a housing with dimensions of approximately 18 x 12 x 3 cm. It incorporates a so-called 'multi-station push button switch' with four push buttons (one per input) which are rigidly attached to each other. Upon selection of one of the inputs, the others are automatically switched off. The apparatus is used for selecting, by pushing one of the buttons, one HDMI input to be connected to the HDMI output. It allows the selection of HDMI signals originating from different sources (for example, a DVD player, a set-top box) to be connected to one apparatus, for example, a television set. | 8536 50 80 |
115/2014 of 4.2.2014 (OJ L 38, 7.2.2014, p. 24) |
An electric control apparatus for a voltage not exceeding 1 000 V incorporating a liquid crystal display (LCD) with a touch screen. The display has a diagonal measurement of the screen of 30,5 cm (12 inches) and a resolution of 800 x 600 pixels in a housing with dimensions of approximately 30 x 23 x 6 cm. The apparatus incorporates an automatic data processing (ADP) machine presented with an operating system. The apparatus is equipped with the following interfaces: - a compact flash memory slot, - two USB connectors, - two RJ-45 connectors, - a RS-232 connector, - a RS-485 connector, - a memory expansion slot, - an expansion bus for expansion cards for controlling, for example, proprietary input/ output (I/O) units. It is also equipped with several built-in drivers for connecting with different types of automation devices and is able to execute and display desktop software programs, such as word processor and spreadsheet applications. The apparatus is presented to be used for electric control of machines in industrial processes in applications using programmable automation controllers or programmable logic controllers. | 8537 10 10 | |
706/2013 of 23.07.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p.6) |
A control unit consisting of a printed circuit assembly containing integrated circuits (for example, a controller obtained by semiconductor technology), passive elements (for example, resistors, capacitors and inductors), active elements (for example, diodes and transistors) and a heat sink for a voltage not exceeding 1 000 V, in a housing with dimensions of approximately 24 x 13 x 5 cm. After the installation of the appropriate software, the control unit is incorporated in a washing machine whose functions it is intended to control (for example, starting and stopping the motor and the water heating system, opening and closing the water valves). | 8537 10 91 | |
2016/615 of 19.04.2016 (OJ L 105, 21.4.2016, p. 14) |
1 | An apparatus (so-called 'smartphone docking station') consisting of the following
components: - a 29,5 cm colour LCD screen, - a hinged casing with two USB ports, - a keyboard with a touchpad, - a dock for a smartphone, - a power supply socket using a voltage not exceeding 1 000 V, - built-in loudspeakers. When the smartphone is docked, its battery is charged and, simultaneously, the apparatus serves as an input/output unit to perform all the functions of the docked smartphone. As the apparatus is not equipped with a signal converter, all the signals are received unaltered from the docked smartphone. The apparatus is not suitable for connection to an automatic data- processing machine. |
8537 10 99 |
3180/92 of 28.10.1992 (OJ L 317, 31.10.1992, p. 64) |
1 | Sub-assembly, for incorporation into a microwave oven, consisting of a printed circuit board which incorporates power supply and logic functions in a single unit. The power supply includes a transformer and voltage-rectifier and -regulation circuit. The board also drives temperature-sensing circuitry and an audio timing-device. The unit has a clock, and is encased in a metal chassis providing thermal and electrical protection as an integral part of the oven itself. | 8537 10 99 |
704/2013 of 23.07.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p.1) |
1 | An electronic control unit for a working voltage not exceeding 1 000 V (so-called "Body Control Module"), designed as a component of the electronic control system of a motor vehicle with dimensions of approximately 16 x 13 x 3 cm, comprising: - a programmable memory controller with active and passive components, for example, transistors, diodes, a processor, resistors, capacitors and inductors, - a built-in receiver and an attached antenna. The unit receives signals from manually operated buttons and from sensors (for example, rain sensors and photo sensors), processes them and on this basis controls various devices in the vehicle, for example, windscreen wipers, window heating, interior lighting, front and rear fog lamps, daytime running lights. It also controls the activation of signalling devices, for example, seatbelt reminder and over speed warning. It receives signals from the key remote control enabling the vehicle doors to be locked or unlocked. | 8537 10 99 |
704/2013 of 23.07.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p.1) |
2 | An electronic control unit for a working voltage not exceeding 1 000 V (so-called "Automatic transmission" (ATM)), designed as a component of the electronic control system of a motor vehicle, with dimensions of approximately 8 x 6 x 3 cm. It comprises a controller with active and passive components, for example, transistors, diodes, a processor, resistors, capacitors and inductors. The controller is not programmable. The unit receives signals from sensors recording the position of the gear lever, processes them and on this basis controls the engagement of the appropriate gear of the automatic transmission of a motor vehicle. | 8537 10 99 |
704/2013 of 23.07.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p.1) |
3 | An electronic control unit for a working voltage not exceeding 1 000 V (so-called "Smart Key"), designed as a component of the electronic control system of a motor vehicle with dimensions of approximately 15 x 12 x 4 cm, comprising: - a programmable memory controller with active and passive components, for example, transistors, diodes, a processor, resistors, capacitors and inductors, - a built-in receiver for transponder communication (localization of the key) between the key and the unit. The unit is connected to antennae already incorporated in the vehicle allowing the detection of the presence of the key near the vehicle. The unit receives signals from manually operated buttons and from the antennae, processes them and on this basis controls devices, for example, locks or unlocks the vehicle doors, starts up the engine. It also controls the activation of signalling devices, for example, the control functions for key- free access including acoustic warning when the electronic key has left the vehicle. | 8537 10 99 |
705/2013 of 23.07.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p.4) |
A handheld device (so-called "Aircraft passenger handset") comprising a control unit incorporating a microphone and a loudspeaker, various buttons on the front and back, a display, a magnetic card-reader and a connection socket, for a voltage not exceeding 1 000 V, with dimensions of approximately 16 x 4 x 2,5 cm. The device is designed to be installed into the passenger seat of an aircraft for performing the following functions: - acting as a switch and control device for various external devices, for example, audio/video equipment, game consoles or other on-board services, - making telephone calls through the public on-board communication network as it converts audio-frequency pulses into sound waves and vice versa, - reading data from swipe cards. The device cannot connect directly to a communication network. | 8537 10 99 | |
2016/1958 of 4.12.2016 (OJ L 301, 9.11.2016, p.6) |
An article consisting of 27 sockets in a housing (a so-called 'power distribution
unit') with dimensions of approximately 5 x 8 x 173 cm. The housing is fitted with an
electrical cable of a length of approximately 3 m, and a plug for connection to an
electrical power mains socket. It is presented to be used for supplying electricity of 230 V to various rack-mounted components in a cabinet. The article is mounted in a vertical position in standard network enclosures. The article also logs and transmits internal data (such as electricity, voltage, output and usage) and alarm messages (if values go above or below certain thresholds) via the included communication card. |
8537 10 99 | |
1247/2011 of 29.11.2011 (OJ L 319, 2.12.2011, p.34) |
1 | An article in the form of a module in its own housing with dimensions of approximately 11 x 7 x 5 cm (so-called 'analogue input module'). The module consists of two printed circuit boards comprising an input interface with four channels, an analogue-to-digital converter, a processor and a bus interface for connection to a programmable logic controller (PLC). The module has an input voltage range from 0 up to 10 V DC. The module receives analogue signals representing, for example, measurements of temperature, speed, flow or weight from various external devices. The module converts and processes these signals before sending them to the PLC. | 8538 90 99 |
1247/2011 of 29.11.2011 (OJ L 319, 2.12.2011, p.34) |
2 | An article in the form of a module in its own housing with dimensions of approximately 11 x 7 x 5 cm (so-called 'discrete output module'). The module consists of a printed circuit board comprising a bus interface for connection to a programmable logic controller (PLC), a processor, a digital-to- analogue converter and an output interface with 8 connecting points. The output connecting points are relays of the electromagnetic type with an output voltage range from 0 up to 250 V AC and a load current per point up to 0,17 A. The module processes and converts discrete signals representing an On/Off signal (for example, 1/0 or True/False) before sending them to various external devices, such as contactors, relays and indicator lamps. | 8538 90 99 |
716/2010 of 6.8.2010 (OJ L 210, 11.8.2011, p. 22) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | A product comprising: - a high pressure mercury vapour discharge lamp with a non-sealed beam reflector, - cabling, - ventilation slots, - an installation frame with a holder, and - a socket. The product is designed to be used in projectors. | 8539 32 20 |
1037/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 9) |
1 | A semiconductor component (so-called 'LED module') comprising a LED chip connected in parallel with a Zener protection diode, presented in a plastic housing with a domed transparent plastic cover, with dimensions of approximately 7 x 7 x 5 mm, without connecting pads. The physical construction of the component is indivisible in the sense that, although some of the elements could theoretically be removed and replaced, this would be a long and delicate task which would be uneconomic under normal manufacturing conditions. The LED module is designed to be assembled onto printed circuit boards by using, for example, surface-mount device (SMD) soldering techniques. It is presented for use in illumination applications such as mobile phone flash, automotive lighting, projectors, traffic signals, and household appliances. | 8541 40 10 |
1037/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 9) |
2 | A semiconductor component comprising a LED module mounted by soldering on a metal-core printed circuit board, with a height of approximately 7 mm and a diameter of approximately 21 mm. The LED module comprises a LED chip connected in parallel with a Zener protection diode, presented in a plastic housing with a domed transparent plastic cover. The metal-core printed circuit board is specifically designed as a heat sink; it contains soldering pads for connecting the power supply and is shaped for final application in lighting fitting articles. It is presented for use in illumination applications such as mobile phone flash, automotive lighting, projectors, traffic signals, and household appliances. | 8541 40 10 |
1037/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 9) |
3 | A semiconductor component (so-called 'LED package') comprising four LED chips, each one connected in parallel with a Zener protection diode, presented in a plastic housing with a transparent glass window on top and eight contact pads on the back, with dimensions of approximately 6 x 5 x 1 mm. The physical construction of the component is indivisible in the sense that, although some of the elements could theoretically be removed and replaced, this would be a long and delicate task which would be uneconomic under normal manufacturing conditions. The LED chips are not interconnected. The interconnections between the LED chips and the Zener diodes are made by wire bonding. The LED package is designed to be assembled onto printed circuit boards by using, for example, SMD soldering techniques. It is presented for use in illumination applications such as stage and entertainment lighting, mood lighting and architectural lighting indoor and outdoor. | 8541 40 10 |
1037/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 9) |
4 | A semiconductor component (so-called 'LED array') comprising 156 LED chips presented in a circular plastic housing with a transparent plastic cover and two electrical contact pads on top and a metallic heat sink on the back, with a height of approximately 2 mm and a diameter of approximately 49 mm. The physical construction of the component is indivisible in the sense that, although some of the elements could theoretically be removed and replaced, this would be a long and delicate task which would be uneconomic under normal manufacturing conditions. The LED chips are interconnected in a series- parallel array with the interconnections made by wire bonding. The LED array is designed to be assembled by screwing it to the final product. It is presented for use in general illumination applications such as retail and hospitality lighting, commercial and office lighting, residential and consumer lighting, industrial lighting, street and exterior area lighting and retrofit lamps. | 8541 40 10 |
2016/663 of 26.4.2016 (OJ L 115, 29.4.2016, p. 16) |
An electronic machine functioning as an audio interface or a sound mixer (so-called
'mixer-converter analogue/digital pre-amplifier device'), with dimensions of approximately
48 x 18 x 9 cm. It consists of sound and effects processors, an analogue-to-digital and
digital-to-analogue converter and a microphone amplifier, in a housing with operating and
display elements and various analogue, optical and digital inputs and outputs as well as
FireWire ports. It has the following main technical features: - hybrid FireWire/USB2 connectivity (capability to be connected to an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine), - 28-input mixer with digital signal processing effects; - special mixing software, - separate front-panel headphone jacks, each with independent volume control, and - front panel LED status clock. The machine is designed for use in digital music productions in sound studios or live on stage. It can operate in two modes: in conjunction with an ADP machine or in a stand-alone mode. When the machine is used in conjunction with an ADP machine, it serves for converting and processing audio signals supplied from external audio sources and for the pre-amplification of microphone signals. In stand-alone mode, the machine can be used as a mixer with integrated effects. |
8543 70 90 | |
888/2006 of 16.6.2006 (OJ L 165, 16.6.2006, p. 6) |
1 | A security device designed to gain access to records stored on an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine. It consists of a liquid crystal display (LCD), a printed circuit assembly and a battery encased in a plastic case which can be put on a keyring. The device generates a sequence of six digit numbers, being specific to a particular user, and allows the user access to the records stored on an ADP machine. The device cannot be connected to an ADP machine and functions independently of such a machine. | 8543 70 90 |
3272/94 of 27.12.1994 (OJ L 339, 29.12.1994, p. 58) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
3 | Junction-box, for use in cable-television systems, consisting of a metal box (approximately, 10 x 10 x 7 cm) fitted with inputs for cables and terminals. The box contains an electric circuit with a number of electric components (such as coils, transformers, resistors and capacitors) and connections. The junction-box's function is to reduce the signal-voltage fed through the cable to the television-receivers and, by means of a filter, to prevent the supply-voltage for the amplifiers from reaching the television-receivers. | 8543 70 90 |
1307/96 of 4.7.1996 (OJ L 167, 6.7.1996, p. 17) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
1 | Electrical apparatus, for the ionisation of air in a room, incorporating a centrifugal fan, a negative-ion generator and a three-stage filtration system (pre-filter for large particles, electrified main filter of textile fibre, and a deodorising filter of activated carbon). | 8543 70 90 |
1386/2003 of 1.8.2003 (OJ L 196, 2.8.2003, p. 19) |
2 | Muscle-exercise kit, presented in a plastic carrying-case, consisting of a battery-operated electronic unit with cables, eight electrodes and two adjustable elasticated straps. The electrodes are held in place on the human body by the straps, and are connected by cables to the electronic unit. Electric impulses are transmitted through the electrodes, to stimulate repeated contraction of the muscles. The strength of the impulses can be increased or decreasedl | 8543 70 90 |
119/2008 of 7.2.2008 (OJ L 36, 9.2.2008, p. 3) |
1 | Hair-removal and skin-treatment apparatus working by means of intense pulsed light (IPL) technology, with the following dimensions: 34,5 (H) x 30,5 (W) x 50,5 (D) cm and a weight of 25 kg. The apparatus is designed for hair removal and for skin treatment, ranging from purely cosmetic rejuvenation to removing age spots, uneven pigmentation and thread veins. It is used in beauty parlours. The apparatus contains an electric motor for cooling; the motor does not play a role in the hair-removal or skin-treatment process. | 8543 70 90 |
1143/2008 of 13.11.2008 (O J L 308, 19.11.2008, p.13) | 1 | A set put up for retail sale consisting of: - a device with electronic components having the shape of a cigarette; - two cartridges; - two rechargeable lithium batteries; and - a battery charger. The device consists of a stainless steel shell with a microelectronic circuit, a high-sensibility sensor, a chamber for batteries and a chamber for placing a cartridge. Each cartridge is composed of an inhaler and an ampoule. The ampoule contains nicotine, a smell compound for cigarettes and ordinary food additives. Both the inhaler and the ampoule are disposable. The electronic circuit, when activated by the inhalation, starts the atomisation of the nicotine diluent and the creation of atomised 'smoke' to be inhaled by the smoker. |
8543 70 90 |
455/2010 of 26.5.2010 (J (OJ 455, 27.5.2010, p. 3) |
1 | An apparatus consisting of an interchangeable ultra-violet (UV) light source, a reflector, a shutter, an intensity control and a shutter-timer in a casing (so-called 'UV spot light source') with overall dimensions of 311 x 160 x 227 mm. The casing is equipped with a carrying handle, controls and fixed light guide. The apparatus is used in a photochemical process, so-called 'UV curing', for surface treatment of various photosensitive materials with UV radiation, in particular for the non-mechanical hardening of different materials and coatings, via controlled emissions of UV light. | 8543 70 90 |
763/2011 of 29.7.2011 (J (OJ 200, 29.7.2011, p. 6) |
1 | A portable battery operated apparatus (so- called "E-book") for recording and reproducing various types of text files (for example, PDF, WOL and HTML), still image files (for example, JPEG) and audio files (for example, MP3), with dimensions of approximately 18 x 12 x 1 cm and a weight of approximately 220 g. The apparatus is equipped with: - a monochrome display (using electronic-ink technology with 4-level grayscale) with dimensions of approximately 12 x 9 cm, a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 15 cm (6 inches) and a resolution of 600 x 800 pixels, - a USB interface, - a connector for earphones, - a memory card slot, - control/navigation buttons, - a 200 MHz processor, and - an internal memory of 512 MB. The apparatus can be connected to an automatic data-processing machine for the purpose of transferring files. The apparatus can reproduce text, still images and audio by processing data stored either on the internal memory or on a memory card. The apparatus does not have translation or dictionary functions. | 8543 70 90 |
1089/2012 of 19.11.2012 (J (OJ 323, 22.11.2012, p. 10) |
1 | An electronic apparatus (so-called 'multi-switch') in a housing with dimensions of approximately 26 x 12 x 7 cm, equipped with the following interfaces: - four intermediate frequency inputs with level adjuster for low noise block (LNB) down-converters, - one input with level adjuster for terrestrial TV aerials, - four outputs for connection of satellite receivers. It has a built-in amplifier for compensating cable loss. The apparatus is designed for use in multi-subscriber systems for television reception via satellite, such as 'quad LNB' systems. It enables several satellite receivers to receive different television signals via one satellite dish, but does not convert nor modify the signals. The apparatus also allows distribution of one terrestrial TV signal. | 8543 70 90 |
311/2014 of 25.3.2014 (OJ L 91, 27.3.2014, p. 12) |
2 | A machine with sound reproducing and editing/mixing functions (so-called 'disc jockey
multi player') in a housing with dimensions of approximately 40 x 32 x 10 cm. It is equipped with a CD reader and has various interfaces (USB, audio outputs, SD card reader). It has knobs, push-buttons, sliders and a 6,1 inches liquid crystal display (LCD) indicator. The machine is capable of editing and mixing sound. For those purposes it is, inter alia, equipped with: - an auto beats per minute (BPM) counter; - a fader start and back cue; - a track hot cue; - a loop; - a 4 beat loop; - cue point setting. The machine is intended to be used by professional disc-jockeys for reproducing, editing and mixing sound. The sound files that are reproduced, edited and mixed can come from various sources (CD-reader, automatic data-processing (ADP) machine, USB memory or SD card). The machine can operate stand-alone or in conjunction with an ADP machine. |
8543 70 90 |
457/2014 of 29.4.2014 (OJ L 133, 6.5.2014, p. 35) |
1 | A digital electronic apparatus with one High- Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) input and eight HDMI outputs (so-called 'active HDMI splitter') in a housing with dimensions of approximately 12 x 6 x 2 cm. It supports the High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection (HDCP) protocol and is supplied with 5 V DC. The apparatus is used for simultaneously splitting, without loss of quality, one HDMI input signal into eight HDMI output signals with the same technical characteristics as the original input signal. It allows a HDMI signal originating from one source (for example, a set-top box) to be simultaneously distributed to several apparatus (for example, television sets). | 8543 70 90 |
457/2014 of 29.4.2014 (OJ L 133, 6.5.2014, p. 33) |
2 | A digital electronic apparatus with four High- Definition Multimedia Interfaces (HDMI) inputs, one HDMI output and a button for selecting the input (so-called 'active HDMI switch'). It incorporates an amplifier for regenerating weak signals, 4 LEDs for indicating the selected input and is supplied with 5 V DC. The apparatus supports full 1080p video signals with a data transfer up to 2,5 Gbps and the High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection (HDCP) protocol. The apparatus is used for selecting one HDMI input to be connected to the HDMI output. It allows the selection of HDMI signals originating from different sources (for example, a DVD player, a set-top box) to be connected to one apparatus, for example, a television set. | 8543 70 90 |
2017/1166 of 26.6.2017 (OJ L 170, 1.7.2017, p. 47) |
An electrical apparatus (so-called 'video converter'), rectangular shaped, with
dimensions of approximately 17 x 14 x 4 cm. The apparatus has the following sockets: - a Serial Digital Interface (SDI), - a High Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI), - an RJ-45 interface, and - a power connector. The apparatus is designed to convert video signals from SDI format to HDMI format. The RJ-45 interface serves to connect the apparatus to the Ethernet only for the software updates and to get electric power needed for those updates (Power over Ethernet ('PoE')). |
8543 70 90 | |
1204/2011 of 18.11.2011 (OJ L 305, 23.11.2011, p. 14) |
1 | A handheld, interchangeable device comprising a flash lamp, a lens, a trigger button and an indicator light (so-called "intense pulse light (IPL) handpiece"). The device generates intense pulsed light at different pulse widths of up to 100 ms, a wavelength of 650-1 200 nm, a spot size of 16 x 46 mm and a maximum fluence of 45 J/cm 2 . It works only in conjunction with a machine (the "base unit") from which it receives power, control signals and cooling fluid. The "base unit" comprises a power supply, a control unit with a display and a cooling unit and it is also able to work with "laser handpieces". When connected to the "base unit", the device is used for specific cosmetic treatments, for example, permanent hair removal. | 8543 90 00 |
1204/2011 of 18.11.2011 (OJ L 305, 23.11.2011, p. 14) |
2 | A handheld, interchangeable device comprising a solid state laser, a lens, a spot size selection switch and a trigger button (so- called "laser handpiece"). The device generates laser light at different pulse widths of up to 100 ms, a wavelength of 1 064 nm, adjustable spot sizes with a diameter of 1,5, 3, 6 and 9 mm and a maximum fluence of 700 J/cm 2 . It works only in conjunction with a machine (the "base unit") from which it receives power, control signals and cooling fluid. The "base unit" comprises a power supply, a control unit with a display and a cooling unit and it is also able to work with "intense pulse light (IPL) handpieces". When connected to the "base unit", the device is specifically used for cosmetic treatment of leg veins. | 8543 90 00 |
2017/635 2017 03 30 (OJ L 91, 2017 04 05, p. 1) | An article in the form of an empty cylindrical cartridge made of clear plastic
approximately 44 mm long and sealed with a removable plastic stopper at the lower end as a
protective cap. The upper part of the cartridge is shaped like a mouthpiece and has a
small hole through which vapour can be inhaled. The user fills the empty cartridge with a special liquid called 'e-liquid' and the cartridge is then inserted into the e-cigarette. The same cartridge can be refilled and reused for smoking between 10 and 20 times before being disposed of as waste. The mouthpiece plays the role of the filter on conventional tobacco cigarettes. When the cartridge is inserted in the e-cigarette, the user places the mouthpiece end in the mouth and inhales. This causes the atomiser in the e-cigarette to convert the liquid into a gentle stream of mist which is then released through the mouthpiece into the user's mouth. |
8543 90 00 | |
1142/2008 of 13.11.2008 (OJ L 308, 19.11.2008, p. 11) | 1 | A cable, approximately 250 cm in length, of a kind used solely with a video game machine of heading 9504. The cable is fitted with one specifically designed connector for the video game machine at one end and five connectors for connection to a monitor or a television set at the other end. Data can be transferred from the video game machine to the monitor or the television set via the cable and the data may, depending on the content, be visualised as a video game, video or still image or reproduced as sound. | 8544 42 90 |
727/2010 of 6.8.2010 (OJ L 213, 13.8.2010, p. 31) |
1 | An electrical extension cord comprising: - an electrical cable of a length of approximately 2 m, - a plug for connecting to an electrical power mains socket, and - a plastic housing with 5 sockets, a power switch and a fuse. The product is designed to be used for the transport of electrical power of 220 V within a local area (for example, a room) to various apparatus. The switch disconnects the electrical power and the fuse protects against overloads. | 8544 42 90 |
1112/2012 of 23.11.2012 (OJ L 329, 29.11.2012, p. 9) |
1 | An insulated cable (so-called 'USB cable') with a length of 1 m which consists of insulated twisted wires and is fitted with USB connectors at both ends. The cable makes it possible to transfer data between different types of apparatus. It also makes it possible to supply electrical power to those apparatus or to charge them. | 8544 42 90 |
2015/2315 of 8.12.2015 (OJ L328, 12.12.2015, p. 50) | An article consisting of a plastic housing containing 4 metal terminals, diodes and
cables with connectors (so-called 'Photovoltaic (PV) junction box'). The PV junction box is a device for transmitting (by cable) electricity, not exceeding 1 000 V and generated by a solar panel, to another PV module or PV inverter. The function of the diodes is only to protect the article against overvoltage (so-called 'hot spots'). |
8544 42 90 | |
277/2013 of 19.03.2013 (OJ L 84, 23.3.2013 p.11) | A product made of plastics with several small openings. It constitutes an insulating body of a connector. It does not contain metal contacts, terminals or any other conductive materials. The product is intended to isolate and hold in place electric wires with connections (terminals) or contact elements at the ends. The wires are to be inserted into the holes of the body of the connector. The product protects and isolates the conductive contacts from each other, preventing a short circuit, and from the external environment, to prevent the ingress of, for example, dirt. | 8547 20 00 | |
957/2006 of 28.6.2006 (OJ L 175, 29.6.2006, p. 45) |
2 | A product, known as an 'LCD module (touch screen type)', in the form of an active matrix liquid crystal device with a backlight unit, inverters and printed circuit boards with control electronics for pixel addressing only. The liquid crystal device consists of a liquid crystal layer sandwiched between two sheets of glass. The outer layer of the glass cells is coated with a thin metallic electrically conductive and resistive layer. The module is based on thin-film transistor (TFT) technology. It has overall dimensions of 34,5 (W) x 35,3 (H) x 16,5 (D) cm and a diagonal screen measurement of 38,1 cm (15 inches). The module does not incorporate any other electronic components (for example, a power supply, a video converter, a scaler, a tuner, etc.), or interfaces for connection to other apparatus. | 8548 90 90 |
312/2011 of 30.3.2011 (OJ L 86, 1.4.2011, p. 53) |
1 | An article (so-called 'ultrasonic transmitter') consisting of a piezo- electric element in the form of a ceramic disc to which a metal membrane with a radially orientated cone is attached. The whole is fixed to a base plate and is fitted into a plastic casing with connecting pins. Alternating current causes the piezo- electric element to oscillate, creating ultrasonic waves (inaudible to the human ear) that are transmitted through the air. The article thus converts electrical signals into ultrasonic waves. The article is used for a variety of purposes including distance measurement in parking aids, space monitoring in car burglar alarms, and liquid level measurement in certain products. | 8548 90 90 |
312/2011 of 30.3.2011 (OJ L 86, 1.4.2011, p. 53) |
2 | An article (so-called 'ultrasonic receiver') consisting of a piezo-electric element in the form of a ceramic disc to which a metal membrane with a radially orientated cone is attached. The whole is fixed to a base plate and is fitted into a plastic casing with connecting pins. Ultrasonic waves (inaudible to the human ear) cause the piezo-electric element to oscillate and to convert the waves into electrical signals. The article is used for a variety of purposes including distance measurement in parking aids, space monitoring in car burglar alarms, and liquid level measurement in certain products. | 8548 90 90 |
275/2013 of 19 03 2013 (OJ L 84, 19 3 2013, p.7) | 1 | A colour liquid crystal display (LCD) module with a diagonal measurement of the screen of 16,5 cm (6,5 inches) with mounting devices on the side, an aluminium heat sink on the back, with dimensions of approximately 16 x 10 x 2 cm. The module comprises a low-voltage differential signalling (LVDS) receiver, a light emitting diode (LED) backlight with integrated brightness control, a LED driver circuit, printed circuit boards with control electronics for pixel addressing only comprising a microcontroller, and a 10-pin LVDS interface. The display has the following characteristics: - a resolution of 400 x 240 pixels, - an aspect ratio of 16:9, - a dot pitch of 0,1195(*3) x 0,3305 mm. The module does not incorporate any video signal processing assembly, for example, a video converter, a scaler or a tuner. The module is designed for incorporation into a dashboard of a motor vehicle for displaying video signals. | 8548 90 90 |
1217/2014 of 11.112014 (OJ L 329, 14.11.2014, p. 17) |
2 | An article (so-called 'electrical filter') constituted by a capacitor and two ferrite beads, with dimensions of approximately 7 x 2 x 2 mm. The equivalent electrical circuit comprises two inductors, one for each ferrite bead, placed in series to the DC current pathway and attached to the conductor at the left and right side of a surface mount feedthrough capacitor. The two ferrite beads act as inductors and their function is minimising resonance with surrounding circuits for suppressing high frequency electrical currents. It is presented for use as an electromagnetic interference (EMI) filter in, for example, automotive and industrial applications. | 8548 90 90 |
1620/81 of 15.6.1981 (OJ L 160, 18.6.1981, p. 21) amended by Reg. 646/89 |
1 | Self-propelled machines for forestry use, which are capable of being fitted with various attachments, enabling the machines to perform a number of operations on timber, such as lifting, handling, hauling, pushing, loading, unloading, de-barking and cutting to length. | 8701 90 |
902/96 of 20.5.1996 (OJ L 122, 22.5.1996, p. 1) |
3 | Lawnmower, consisting essentially of the following presented together: | |
(a) small tractor powered by a motor of up to 18 kW fitted with a hydraulic system (power take-off) to which various accessories can be connected; | (a): 8701 90 11 |
||
(b) cutting device as interchangeable equipment, designed to be connected to the power take-off of the tractor. | (b): 8433 19 90 |
||
1051/2009 of 3.11.2009 (OJ L 290, 6.11.2009, p. 57) |
1 | A new four-wheeled vehicle (so-called "All Terrain Vehicle") with a
spark-ignition internal combustion piston engine with a power of approximately 15 kW, and
a dry weight of approximately 310 kg. The vehicle has the following characteristics: - a single seat of a length of approximately 600 mm accommodating the driver only, - motorcar type steering system based on the Ackerman principle controlled by a handlebar, - brakes on the front and rear wheels, - an automatic clutch and reverse gear, - an engine specially designed for use in difficult terrain and capable in low ratio of delivering sufficient power, - a power transmission shaft drive to the rear wheels, - tyres with a deep tread design for off-road use, - a hole with fittings for attaching various coupling devices, - a towing capacity of approximately 1170 kg (non-braked), and - a permanently attached winch suitable for hauling logs. The vehicle is constructed essentially for carrying out forestry work. The various coupling devices are presented together with the vehicle. |
8701 90 11 |
1231/2007 OF 19.10.2007 (OJ L 279, 23.10.2007, p. 3) |
7 | Four-wheeled motor vehicle fitted with a diesel engine with a capacity of 132 kW and a maximum speed of 40 km/h. The vehicle has a fully automatic transmission, four forward gears and one reverse gear, and an enclosed cab with a seat for the driver only. The chassis is fitted with a 'fifth wheel'. The fifth wheel has a lift height of 60 cm and a maximum load-bearing capacity of 32 000 kg. Its purpose is to enable a trailer to be connected to it. The vehicle is specifically designed for use in distribution centres handling trailers. | 8701 90 90 |
718/2009 of 4.8.2009 (OJ L 205, 7.8.2009, p. 7) |
1 | Four-wheeled vehicle with an electric motor powered by two rechargeable 12 V batteries. It is approximately 48 cm wide, 99 cm long and 58 cm high (with the backrest folded down), with a total weight without batteries of approximately 34,5 kg. The maximum load is approximately 115 kg. The vehicle has the following characteristics: - a horizontal platform connecting the front and rear sections, - small wheels (approximately 2,5 x 19,0 cm) with anti-leak tyres, - an adjustable seat without armrests and grips whose height can be set in one of two positions, and - a steering column that can be folded down. The steering column has a small control unit including a contact switch, a horn, a battery output display and a button to set the maximum speed. The vehicle has two thumb-operated levers for accelerating, braking and reversing. There are anti-tip wheels at the back of the vehicle to prevent it from tipping over. It has an electronic dual braking system. When its batteries are fully charged, it has a maximum range of approximately 16 kilometres and can reach a maximum speed of approximately 6,5 km/h. The vehicle can be disassembled into four light components. It is designed for use at home, on footpaths and in public spaces, for activities such as shopping trips. | 8703 10 18 |
718/2009 of 4.8.2009 (OJ L 205, 7.8.2009, p. 7) |
2 | Three-wheeled vehicle with an electric motor powered by two rechargeable 12 V batteries. It is approximately 61 cm wide, 120 cm long and 76 cm high (with the backrest folded down), with a total weight without batteries of approximately 46 kg. The maximum load is approximately 160 kg. The vehicle has the following characteristics: - a horizontal platform connecting the front and rear sections, - small wheels (approximately 8,9 x 25,4 cm) with anti-leak tyres, - an adjustable seat with armrests and grips whose height can be set in one of three positions, and - a steering column that can be folded down. The steering column has a small control unit including a battery meter, a contact switch, buttons to activate lights, a horn and a button to set the maximum speed. The vehicle has two thumb-operated levers for accelerating, braking and reversing. There are anti-tip wheels at the back of the vehicle to prevent it from tipping over. It has an electronic dual braking system. When its batteries are fully charged, it has a maximum range of approximately 40 kilometres and can reach a maximum speed of approximately 8 km/h. The vehicle can be disassembled into seven light components. It is designed for use at home, on footpaths and in public spaces, for activities such as shopping trips. | 8703 10 18 |
883/94 of 20.4.1994 (OJ L 103, 22.4.1994, p. 7) |
7 | New, four-wheeled vehicle (all-terrain), with a single-cylinder four-stroke 348 cm3 spark-ignition internal-combustion piston-engine, a gearbox with five forward speeds and one reverse, and twin hydraulic front brakes. There is room on the single seat for the driver and one passenger, and the controls are mounted on the handle-bar. It is fitted with a towing hook. Dimensions: (a) 185 x 110 x 115 cm; unladen weight 260 kg; maximum load 190 kg; (b) 187 x 107 x 115 cm; unladen weight 240 kg; maximum load 210 kg. | 8703 21 10 |
301/2012 of 2.4.2012 (OJ L 99, 5.4.2012, p. 17) |
New three-wheeled motor vehicle, rear wheel driven, for the transport of persons, with spark- ignition internal combustion reciprocating piston engine of a cylinder capacity of 998 cm 3 . The front wheels are approximately 130 cm apart. The vehicle does not have a differential. The vehicle has a motor car type steering system. It steers using the handlebar with two grips incorporating the controls. The vehicle has five forward gears and a reverse gear. | 8703 21 10 | |
1452/2007 of 7.12.2007 (OJ L 325 , 11.12.2007 p. 66) | 2 | A three-wheeled vehicle, so-called "Trike", with spark-ignition internal combustion reciprocating piston engine of a cylinder capacity of 1584 cm3.The vehicle has no bodywork and is designed to transport two persons.It is equipped with a handle-bar and a motorcycle-type steering mechanism.The vehicle is also equipped with a gearbox having four forward gears, a reverse gear, and a differential. | 8703 23 19 |
1034/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 1) |
A new motor vehicle of the pick-up type, with a compression-ignition internal
combustion piston engine of a cylinder capacity of 2 179 cm3, a five-speed manual gearbox
and one reverse gear. Its total gross weight is approximately 2 950 kg and its total load
capacity is approximately 1 000 kg. The length of its wheelbase is 3 150 mm. The motor
vehicle consists of two separate areas: - a four-door cabin, all doors are equipped with windows, and five seats, including the driver's seat, in two rows (two front seats and three back seats). The cabin has a standard interior with manually operated air conditioning, standard seats with adjustable three-point seat belts, adjustable front seat headrests, an adjustable steering column and lighting for the passenger space. It is equipped with a radio broadcast receiver, - an open load space with a length of 1 429 mm, equipped with a set of anchors to attach a load. |
8703 32 19 | |
2017/1233 of 3.7.2017 (OJ L 177, 8.7.2017, p. 26) |
A new, four-wheel drive multipurpose motor vehicle (of the van-type). The vehicle has
a compression-ignition internal combustion piston engine of a cylinder capacity exceeding
1 500 cm3 but not exceeding 2 500 cm3. Its total gross weight is approximately 2 800 kg. The vehicle has two rows of seats, the first row with two seats (a driver's seat and a 'bench seat' to be used by two passengers) and a second row with three seats. There are doors with a window on both sides of the first row of seats and, in respect of the second row of seats, a window on the left side and a sliding door with a window on the right side. Behind the second row of seats there is a permanent barrier (partition grille) dividing the passenger area from an area for the transport of goods. There are neither safety belts nor fittings for their installation in the area for the transport of goods. There is a back door of a swing-out type but no windows in the area for the transport of goods. The vehicle has comfort features and interior finish and fittings which are associated with the passenger areas of vehicles. The area for the transport of goods is of a length of approximately 1,9 m and of a load capacity of- 4,4 m3. |
8703 32 19 | |
2015/22 of 5.1.2015 (OJ L 4, 2015 1 8, p. 13) |
A used, four-wheel drive compact sport utility motor vehicle (SUV) with a diesel engine of a cylinder capacity of 2 000 cm3, a five-speed manual gearbox and one reverse gear. Its total gross weight is approximately 2 330 kg; its total load capacity is approximately 700 kg. It has a single integrated space for the transport of both persons and goods. The cabin has one row of two seats (including the driver's seat) and five doors with window panels (the back door being of a swing-out type). The floor of the cargo area is equipped with carpeting; the entire interior of the vehicle has side and roof upholstery. It is equipped with a mechanism for raising and lowering both the front and rear side windows. The vehicle is adapted to the transport of goods by having the second row of seats removed, the anchor points for fixing the rear seats and the security belts covered and the cabin separated by a net barrier. The anchor points for fixing the rear seats and the safety belts were not removed or rendered permanently unusable. | 8703 32 90 | |
316/2011 of 30.3.2011 (OJ L 86, 1.4.2011, p. 61) |
1 | A used pick-up vehicle, with an unfolding load- carrying platform, for the transport of persons and goods (so-called 'multipurpose vehicle'), with a diesel engine of a cylinder-capacity of 3 200 cm3, an automatic gearbox, four-wheel drive (4 x 4), and a wheelbase length of 320 cm. It consists of: - a four-door cabin equipped with two rows of seats for 5 persons, including the driver. The cabin has a luxurious interior, with electrically adjustable leather seats, three- point safety belts behind the driver's seat, electrically operated windows and air-conditioning. It is equipped with a radio- broadcast receiver, a radio navigation system and a CD/DVD player, - an open load space of an inner length of 156 cm. The sides and tailgate of the load space have a height of 50 cm. The sides are equipped with catches to attach the load. The length of the load space can be extended to 206 cm by opening the tailgate and mounting an element in the form of a barrier. | 8703 33 90 |
396/92 of 18.2.1992 (OJ L 44, 20.2.1992, p. 9) amended by Reg. 705/2005 |
3 | Vehicle (length 180 cm, breadth 87 cm, height 100 cm) with a single-cylinder, four-stroke petrol engine (400 cm3 cylinder-capacity), consisting essentially of a reinforced hopper with a payload of 400 kg , and equipped with manual tipping-device, controls and rubber tracks. It has an unladen weight of 250 kg, a top speed of 6,8 km/h, and develops 5,37 kw. The vehicle has three forward-speeds and one reverse. It is intended for transporting and dumping earth, sand, etc., mainly on building-sites. | 8704 10 10 |
1114/2012 of 23.11.2012 (OJ L 329, 29.11.2012, p. 12) |
A track-laying vehicle for the transport of goods (so-called 'minitrac'), with a compression-ignition internal combustion piston engine of a cylinder capacity of 479 cm 3 , a gross vehicle weight of 2 085 kg and measuring approximately 265 x 95 x 202 cm. The vehicle consists of a chassis with a tippable flat bed with three sides that open, and an open cab with a seat for the driver. The unladen weight of the vehicle is 840 kg, its maximum load capacity is 1 200 kg. The maximum speed of the vehicle is approximately 6 km/h. The vehicle, which is intended for the transport and dumping of excavated or other materials over short distances on rough terrain, is not intended for use on the public highway. | 8704 10 10 | |
799/1999 of 16.4.1999 (OJ L 102, 17.4.1999, p. 8) |
2 | New four-wheeled vehicle, with a diesel engine of a cylinder-capacity of 928 cm3, a gross vehicle weight of approximately 1 800 kg and approximate dimensions 2,7 m long by 1,4 m wide. It has an open cabin, a bench-seat for two persons (including the driver), and an open load-area with the approximate dimensions 1,2 m long by 1,4 m wide. The load-capacity is approximately 900 kg. The load-area has tilting-hydraulics. The vehicle has a device for towing trailers, and a power-take-off. The area for the persons is smaller than the load-area. | 8704 21 91 |
2147/2004 of 16.12.2004 (OJ L 370, 17.12.2004, p. 19) |
5 | New four-wheeled vehicle with a compression-ignition internal combustion engine of a cylinder capacity of 954 cm3. The gross vehicle weight is approximately 1 800 kg (unladen weight of 720 kg and a load capacity of 1 080 kg). The vehicle is approximately 2,9 m long by 1,4 m wide, and equipped with two seats. The area behind the seats is approximately 1,2 m long by 1,4 m wide and fitted with tilting hydraulics, for the purpose of mounting a rear box, mechanical appliance or similar equipment. The seating area is smaller than the area behind. The vehicle is not fitted with the rear box or such accessory at the time of presentation. | 8704 21 91 |
2127/2005 of 22.12.2005 (OJ L 340, 23.12.2005, p. 35) |
1 | An incomplete and unassembled new fourwheeled vehicle, of the 'pick-up' type with a diesel engine of a cylinder-capacity of 2 500 cm3, a gross vehicle weight of 2 650 kg and a total cargo-capacity of 1 000 kg. The vehicle has one row of seats for two persons (including the driver) and an open cargo area with a length of 2,28 m. All parts are presented and declared to customs at the same place and time. The radiator, windows, tyres, battery, shock absorbers, seat and door upholstery are not present. | 8704 21 91 |
2015/221 of 10.2.2015 (OJ L 37, 13.2.2015, p. 1) |
A new, four-wheel drive utility vehicle with a compression-ignition internal combustion piston engine (diesel) of a cylinder capacity of 720 cm3, with a net weight (including fluids) of approximately 630 kg, an unbraked towing capacity of 750 kg and with dimensions of approximately 300 x 160 cm. The vehicle has an open cabin with two seats (including the driver) fitted with a full roll-over protection frame, a cargo bed constructed of a strong steel frame with a sturdy flat-bed tipping body, with a manual tipper and of a capacity of 0,4 m3 or, approximately, 400 kg. It has a high ground clearance (27 cm) and a wheel base of 198 cm. It is equipped with off-road earth moving tyres, wet-type disc brakes, a coupling device and a front hitch. The vehicle has a limited speed of 25 km/h, and a high brake capacity. The vehicle is designed for off-road use, particularly in very rough terrain. The vehicle is presented to be used for a range of functions, for example, pushing, hauling trailers, moving animals, transporting plants, boxes, water and equipment, carrying munitions and transporting feed for animals. | 8704 21 91 | |
1386/2003 of 1.8.2003 (OJ L 196, 2.8.2003, p. 19) |
3 | New, articulated vehicle, designed for off-highway use for the transport of timber, both on rough ground and on forest tracks. It has a maximum gross vehicle weight of 19,7 tonnes, and a load-capacity of 8,5 tonnes. The vehicle consists of a four-wheeled towing unit with a diesel engine, a driver's cabin, and a permanently fixed hydraulic crane for handling loads, as well as a four-wheeled load-unit for the transport of tree trunks, permanently connected to the towing unit by a special coupling. | 8704 22 91 |
883/94 of 20.4.1994 (OJ L 103, 22.4.1994, p. 7) |
8 | New motor-vehicle (so-called 'crane-undercarriage' vehicle), consisting of a lorry-chassis with a cab, a compression-ignition internal-combustion piston-engine, gears, brakes, steering-gear and electrical equipment, and of a gross vehicle-weight exceeding 20 tonnes. | 8704 23 91 |
166/2007 16.02.2007 (OJ L 52, 21.02.2007, p. 5) |
4 | A new three-wheeled motor vehicle with a compression-ignition internal combustion piston engine and a gross vehicle weight of more than 20 tonnes. The vehicle consists of a motor chassis fitted with a cabin. It is not fitted with transport construction equipment or agricultural machinery when presented. | 8704 23 91 |
442/2000 of 25.2.2000 (OJ L 54, 26.2.2000, p. 33) |
2 | New three-wheeled vehicle, with a two-stroke 49,8 cm3 spark-ignition internal-combustion piston-engine, gearbox with four forward speeds plus revers, and a differential. It has a cabin, with a seat for the driver only, and controls mounted on the handle-bar. It is equipped with a load-bin which may be open or enclosed, to carry a maximum load of 200 kg. | 8704 31 91 |
1386/2003 of 1.8.2003 (OJ L 196, 2.8.2003, p. 19) |
4 | New, four-wheeled motor vehicle, with a spark-ignition internal combustion piston engine of a cylinder-capacity of 286 cm3, a gross weight of approximately 620 kg, and approximate dimensions of 263 cm long, 122 cm wide and 122 cm high. The vehicle's load-capacity is approximately 364 kg. The dimensions of the open load-area are 96 x 115 cm. The vehicle has a maximum speed of 24,1 km/h. It has an open cabin, and a bench-seat for two persons (including the driver). It has a tilt cargo box with a flip-down tailgate. | 8704 31 91 |
1386/2003 of 1.8.2003 (OJ L 196, 2.8.2003, p. 19) |
5 | Four-wheeled motor vehicle, driven by a battery-powered (48 volt) electric motor, having a gross weight of approximately 620 kg, and approximate dimensions of 263 cm long, 122 cm wide and 122 cm high. The vehicle's load-capacity is approximately 364 kg. The dimensions of the open load-area are 96 x 115 cm. The vehicle has a maximum speed of 24,1 km/h. It has an open cabin, and a bench-seat for two persons (including the driver). It has a tilt cargo box with a flip-down tailgate. | 8704 90 00 |
400/2006 of 8.3.2006 (OJ L 70, 9.3.2006, p. 9) |
3 | A motorised golf cart, with a tubular aluminium frame, on wheels, a seat for use while the cart is not in motion, and a handlebar. It is pedestrian-controlled. The controls for operating the golf cart are located on the handlebar. The golf cart has a maximum speed of 6,5 km/h and is equipped with a 24 volt batteryoperated motor. It is designed for carrying one bag of golf clubs. | 8704 90 00 |
166/2007 16.02.2007 (OJ L 52, 21.02.2007, p. 5) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
5 | A new three-wheeled motor vehicle with a compression-ignition ternal combustion piston engine and a gross vehicle weight of more than 20 tonnes. The vehicle consists of a motor chassis fitted with a cabin. A spreader for solid substances (working machinery) for agricultural purposes is mounted on the chassis. The vehicle may also be driven on the public road. | 8705 90 80 |
738/2000 of 7.4.2000 (OJ L 87, 8.4.2000, p. 10) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
3 | Vehicle fitted with a hydraulic lifting-device with a work-platform. It consists of a lorry-chassis with a cabin for the driver and passengers, powered by a diesel engine and designed for independent use on the public highway. The lifting-device is permanently fixed and consists of a telescopic jib, moving vertically, which can rotate; it has a work-platform (0,6 x 1,2 m) with safety-railing. The controls for the lifting-device are mounted on the work-platform. The vehicle has four retractable stabilising-legs which are in contact with the ground when the lifting-device is in use. The lifting-device has a maximum height of 12 m, and can lift up to 325 kg. | 8705 90 80 |
902/96 of 20.5.1996 (OJ L 122, 22.5.1996, p. 1) |
1 | Clutch-release mechanism, with only one end-stop for automotive clutches of lightweight design, having a steel-plate guide-sleeve incorporating a ball-thrust bearing and a steel-plate outer casing which may have sprung-steel strips, snap-on connectors or metal throw-out pins. | 8708 93 10 or 8708 93 90 |
902/96 of 20.5.1996 (OJ L 122, 22.5.1996, p. 1) |
2 | Clutch-release mechanism, with only one end-stop for automotive clutches of lightweight design, having an aluminium or cast-iron guide-sleeve or sliding sleeve and a metal ring incorporating a ball-thrust bearing. | 8708 93 10 or 8708 93 90 |
604/2011 of 20.6.2011 (OJ L 163, 23.6.2011, p. 12) |
1 | A cylindrical container made of steel, with a length of approximately 30 cm and a diameter of approximately 3 cm (so-called 'airbag inflator'). The device comprises electrical contact pins, an igniter, a chamber with pyrotechnic generant, a chamber with a mixture of gases, filters and a gas discharge nozzle. The mixture of gases is composed of nitrous oxide, argon and helium. When an electrical signal from a motor vehicle sensor system activates the igniter, a process starts during which the pyrotechnic generant burns and as a result, the gases are heated creating a high pressure. Subsequently, the gases are expelled through the nozzle, filling the airbag. The device is designed for incorporation into the safety airbag system of a motor vehicle. | 8708 95 99 |
604/2011 of 20.6.2011 (OJ L 163, 23.6.2011, p. 12) |
2 | A cylindrical container made of steel, with a length of approximately 21 cm and a diameter of approximately 5 cm (so-called 'airbag inflator'). The device comprises electrical contact pins, an igniter, a chamber with pyrotechnic generant, an expansion chamber, filters and a gas discharge nozzle. When an electrical signal from a motor vehicle sensor system activates the igniter, a process starts during which the pyrotechnic generant burns and as a result, the expansion chamber is filled with gases creating a high pressure. Subsequently, the gases are expelled through the nozzle, filling the airbag. The device is designed for incorporation into the safety airbag system of a motor vehicle. | 8708 95 99 |
1130/2012 of 1.26.11.2012 (OJ L 331, 1.12.2012, p.19) |
1 | A cycle with three wheels, a frame, a seat, two footrests and two handlebars. The handlebars are used for steering and as hand operated pedals being directly connected to crank gears and derailleur gears. The seat comprises a flat platform with a raised section to support the cyclist's back and head. | 8712 00 70 |
104/2012 of 7.2. 2012 (OJ L 36, 9.2.2012, p. 19) |
A so-called "bicycle set", consisting of the following components: | ||
(a) a frame, | a) 8714 91 10 | ||
(b) a front fork, and | b) 8714 91 30 | ||
(c) two rims. The components are presented for customs clearance at the same time, but are packaged separately. |
c)8714 92 10 | ||
2015/232001 of 8.12.2015 (OJ L328, 12.12.2015, p. 65) | A cassette of base metal sprocket wheels (so-called 'free hub cassette') without a
free-wheel mechanism. The free hub cassette consists of seven sprocket-wheels fixed
together, two separate sprocket-wheels and a washer. The smallest sprocket-wheel has 11
teeth and the largest 32 teeth. The free hub cassette is designed to be placed over the free-wheel mechanism (integrated in the hub body). Thereafter, the drive shaft of the rear wheel can be disconnected from the hub body (free-wheel). This enables the cyclists to keep the pedals still or to pedal backwards while the bicycle is in forward motion. The free-wheel mechanism is not present upon presentation. |
8714 93 00 | |
773/2011 of 2.8.2011 (OJ L 201, 4.8.2011, p. 4) |
1 | A foot-propelled, two wheeled vehicle of a weight of approximately 10 kg. It consists of: - a steel frame with a chrome-plated aluminium fork with suspension, - height adjustable handlebars, - a platform with dimensions of approximately 38 x 11 cm, with holes and grip tape, - two wheels with the following dimensions: 26 inches (front) and 18 inches (rear), - hand-operated front and rear brakes, and - a kickstand. The vehicle does not have a saddle, pedals or a crank gear. The height of the handlebars, when fully extended, is 97 cm. | 8716 80 00 |
2017/285 of 15.2.2017 (OJ L 42, 18.2.2017, p. 5) |
A remote-controlled multi-rotor helicopter (so- called 'drone') with a diagonal length
of 35 cm and a weight of 1 030 g together with a remote control unit in a package for
retail sale. The helicopter is equipped with a system to ensure stability, Wi-Fi and a global positioning system (GPS) module. The maximum flight speed is approximately 54 km/h and the flight time is 25 minutes. The remote control unit operates at a frequency of 2,4 GHz and is operated by four batteries. The helicopter can be controlled by the remote control unit (in an open area) for a distance of up to 1 000 m. |
8802 11 00 | |
652/2007 of 8.6.2007 (OJ L 153, 14.6.2007, p. 6) |
3 | Vessel of the 'catamaran'-type, designed for the transport of persons. It has a length of approximately 49 metres and a maximum speed of 34 knots (approximately 63 kilometres per hour). It can transport up to 600 passengers. It is designed to operate in rivers, estuaries or coastal waters. However, it is constructed so that it may sail on the sea but without passengers. It is not constructed to carry passengers more than 20 nautical miles (approximately 37 kilometres) from shore. |
8901 10 90 |
477/2009 of 5.6.2009 (OJ L 144, 9.6.2009, p. 15) |
1 | Product consisting of a rectangular plate of semi-tempered glass upon which several anti-reflective and absorbent layers of plastic are bonded. The product is not framed. It is used in the manufacture of plasma monitors. | 9001 90 00 |
305/2001 of 12.2.2001 (OJ L 44, 15.2.2001, p. 22) |
5 | Element, consisting of glass with layers with a polarising effect ('screen-filter') mounted in a frame. A cable with a clip is attached to the frame. It has the following functions: glare-reduction, reflection-reduction, UV-radiation-reduction, contrast-enhancement and static-charge-reduction. | 9002 20 00 |
477/2009 of 5.6.2009 (OJ L 144, 9.6.2009, p. 15) |
2 | Product consisting of a rectangular plate made of semi-tempered glass upon which several anti-reflective and absorbent layers of plastic are bonded. The product is framed with a metal band. It is used in the manufacture of plasma monitors. | 9002 20 00 |
48/90 of 9.1.1990 (OJ L 8, 11.1.1990, p. 16) amended by Reg. 936/1999+1179/2009 |
4 | Optical element consisting of an octagonal lens made of acrylic resin fixed on a simple metallic support, of a kind used in overhead-projector assemblies. | 9002 90 00 |
1288/91 of 14.5.1991 (OJ L 122, 17.5.1991, p. 11) amended by Reg. 936/1999 |
6 | Disposable photographic camera, consisting of a plastic box (98 x 58 x 35 mm) enclosing a sensitised 24-exposure 35 mm photographic film, with a lens, shutter-release, viewfinder, indicator of the number of exposures, and a lever for winding the film on. The box cannot be re-used after opening. | 9006 53 10 |
1508/2000 of 11.7.2000 (OJ L 174, 13.7.2000, p. 3) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
3 | Device ('digital film-recorder'), consisting of a cathode-ray tube (CRT), a camera-back with a colour-filter, and various electronic assemblies, all mounted in the one housing. It works in conjunction with an autoomatic data-processing (ADP) machine. Images from the ADP-machine are transferred via the CRT to film inserted into the camera-back (instant pictures, or negative-film in rolls of a width of 35 mm or more). | 9006 59 00 |
457/2008 of 23.5.2008 (OJ L 137, 27.5.2008, p. 4) |
3 | Appliance designed to increase the amount of natural light in a room, consisting of a prismatic dome lens, a system of tubes and diffuser lenses. The appliance captures light through a dome on the roof and transfers it to the ceiling of the room, through its internal reflective system, where the light is diffused. | 9013 80 90 |
396/92 of 18.2.1992 (OJ L 44, 20.2.1992, p. 9) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
5 | Stand-alone system which enables the operator to create images in two or three dimensions on-screen. It has no other function and cannot be programmed for applications other than computer-aided graphic design. It consists of: a processing unit, including a microprocessor, a graphics processor and a dedicated memory; controls, such as a keyboard, mouse, programme-function keysand graphic tablet; and a visual-display unit ('stereoscopic screen'). | 9017 10 90 |
112/2011 of 7.2.2011 (OJ L 34, 9.2.2011, p. 35) |
1 | A module with dimensions of approximately 8,5 x 30 x 23 cm, designed for monitoring the respiratory and anaesthetic gases of a patient under medical treatment (so-called 'Gas Analyser Module'). It works solely in conjunction with and is controlled by a patient monitoring system. The module analyses a patient's respiratory gas by spectroscopy for its content of, for example, carbon dioxide, nitrous oxide, halothane or isoflurane. The patient monitoring system processes the data received from the module and verifies it against prefixed parameters. The results are displayed on the monitor. When those parameters are not met, an alarm is triggered. | 9018 19 10 |
2017/1170 of 26.6.2017 (OJ L 170, 1.7.2017, p. 59) |
A compact battery-operated fingertip apparatus (so called 'pulse oximeter') combining
an electronic processor, a pair of light emitting diodes (LED), a photo diode and an LED
display (offering various display modes) in one unit. It is also equipped with a low
battery indicator, an alarm function in case of high or low pulse rate or blood oxygen,
and a 'clip in' attachment to the finger. It is used as a non-invasive method of monitoring a person's oxygen saturation and for measuring a pulse by means of optical radiation. After attaching to a person's finger, the LED pass two different wavelengths of light through the finger to a photo diode. It measures the changing absorbance at each of the wavelengths and subsequently determines/calculates the oxygen saturation and heart rate. It can be used in professional medical practice and in research, sport, business etc. (for example, oxygen chambers, extreme mountaineering in low oxygen atmosphere, deep-sea diving; by pilots, firefighters, astronauts etc.). |
9018 19 10 | |
1038/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 14) |
1 | A plastic tube with a length of 142 cm with a plastic balloon at one end (so-called 'balloon catheter'). The proximal segment of the catheter has a diameter of 0,63 mm and is made of hypotube material and coated with polytetrafluorethylene (PTFE). The distal segment of the catheter has a diameter in a range from 0,79 to 1,02 mm and is made of polyether bloc amide (PEBA) material and coated with hydrophilic material. The balloon has a length of 6 to 27 mm and a diameter of 2 to 5 mm. The tube has a Luer connection, an atraumatic (flexible) tip and 2 golden marker bands. The Luer connection makes it possible to connect the tube to an inflating device which is used to inflate the balloon. The atraumatic tip is used to move the catheter via a vein up through the body into the coronary artery. When the catheter is on the right place in the coronary artery, the balloon is inflated so that the fatty deposits (atherosclerotic plaque) are pressed against the wall of the vein. By compressing the plaque, the inside diameter of the vein increases. The marker bands make it possible to locate the exact position of the atraumatic tip in the body. The balloon catheter is removed from the body and discarded after treatment. The article is presented in packaging and is sterilised. | 9018 39 00 |
1038/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 14) |
2 | A plastic curved tube (so-called 'guide catheter') with an inner diameter ranging from 1,47 mm to 2,29 mm and a length of 100 cm with a radiopaque marker and an atraumatic (flexible) tip. The article comprises a double interlock knit flat section of stainless steel, encapsulated in plastic material (PEBA, polyphthalamide (PPA), Nylon) and it has a lubricant coating applied to the silicon inner surface of the guide catheter. The guide catheter enables access to the coronary artery through a vein. Other appliances can be directed by this guide catheter to the artery. The radiopaque marker makes it possible to locate the exact position of the atraumatic tip in the body. The guide catheter is removed from the body and discarded after treatment. The article is presented in packaging and is sterilised. | 9018 39 00 |
1038/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 14) |
3 | A flexible metal wire (so-called 'guide wire') with a diameter of 0,35 mm, a length ranging from 180-300 cm, two radiopaque markers and a rounded tip. The wire is made of a metal alloy for biomedical use, with a proximal coating of PTFE and a distal coating of silicone or hydrophilic material. The radiopaque markers make it possible to locate the exact position of the wire in the body. The wire is used for guiding and positioning devices for interventions in the coronary artery. The guide wire is removed from the body and discarded after treatment. The article is presented in packaging and is sterilised. | 9018 39 00 |
1638/94 of 5.7.1994 (OJ L 172, 7.7.1994, p. 5) |
6 | Endotracheal tubes, principally used with anaesthetic apparatus. | 9018 90 60 |
241/96 of 7.2.1996 (OJ L 31, 9.2.1996, p. 14) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Intra-uterine device, consisting of a plastic appliance to which two nylon threads are attached and an insert containing progesterone. | 9018 90 84 |
1038/2014 of 25.9.2014 (OJ L 287, 1.10.2014, p. 14) |
4 | A hand-operated inflation device made of high- strength polycarbonate, equipped with a manometer and a volume scale. It has a high pressure hose connection (Luer-type) and can inflate, with precise pressure adjustments, up to 20 atmospheres (atm). The device is to be used in a medical environment for the inflation and deflation of balloon catheters. The manometer is used for monitoring the pressure inside the balloon catheter when inflating or deflating and during surgery. The volume scale indicates the amount of liquid (maximum 20 ml) that is, by means of pressure, inserted into the catheter and also the amount of liquid that flows back freely as the balloon deflates. The Luer connection makes it possible to connect the inflation device to the balloon catheter. The device is for single patient use only and is discarded after treatment. The article is presented in packaging and is sterilised. | 9018 90 84 |
74/2012 of 27.01.2012 (OJ L 27, 31.1.2012, p. 1) |
A panel made of aluminium and tempered glass, measuring approximately 140 x 30 cm (so-called "shower panel with hydromassage"). The panel is equipped with a mixing tap, 6 horizontal hydromassage nozzles, an "anti-calc" handheld shower head, an upper shower head with a wide spraying range, and a shelf for accessories. It is also equipped with control knobs for setting the temperature of the water, its intensity, etc. The panel is designed for mounting in compatible bathroom shower cabins. In addition to the shower function, it also provides hydromassage by narrow water streams under high pressure coming through the nozzles. | 9019 10 90 | |
616/2013 of 24.6.2013 (OJ L 175, 27.6.2013, p. 11) |
An article made of rigid moulded plastic consisting of three or four arms. The article has no free-moving parts (for example, wheels, balls or rollers), soft nubs or other flexible attachments. It is designed to be used as a hand-operated article for massaging the body by rubbing one or more of the arms over the relevant body parts. The massage effect is created by the pressure exerted by the person performing the massage. | 9019 10 90 | |
1195/2011 of 16.11.2011 (OJ L 303, 22.11.2011, p. 10) |
1 | A product consisting of a plastic collar shaped to fit the neck with a shock-absorbing foam layer and hook-and-loop fasteners (so-called "cervical collar"). It is used to support the cervical portion of a person's spinal cord (neck) and head, for example, when rescuing and transporting patients with suspected or known spinal injuries, or for supporting the neck of a person who has suffered an injury such as whiplash. | 9021 10 10 |
1213/2014 of 11.11.2014 (OJ L 329, 14.11.2014, p. 6) |
A cannulated, cylindrical, threaded product made of extra hard titanium alloy, of a length of between 20 to 56 mm. The product has a cannulated shank with an outer diameter of 4 mm and a head with a hexagonal drive. The shank is wholly threaded in 2 mm increments. The product corresponds to the ISO/TC 150 standards for implant screws and is presented for use in the field of trauma surgery for setting fractures. It is to be installed in the body using specific tools and by means of a guide wire, which is to be inserted in the cannulated shaft and which allows precise placement through a small incision in the body. At importation, it is presented in a sterilised packing. The product is marked with a number and therefore traceable throughout production and distribution. | 9021 10 90 | |
1214/2014 of 11.11.2014 (OJ L 329, 14.11.2014, p. 8) |
A solid, cylindrical, threaded product (so-called 'pangea dual core screw') made of extra hard titanium alloy, of a length of between 20 and 45 mm. The shank is wholly threaded with a dual core thread containing a transition zone for the core diameter change. It is of a constant outer diameter of 4,0 mm, with a self-tapping profile and a blunt, threaded tip. The product has a polyaxial (movable) U-shaped, internally threaded head that offers 25° of angulation around its axis allowing its adjustment. The product has a specialised saddle in locking cap for fixing a rod (presented separately) in its head. The product corresponds to the ISO/TC 150 standards for implant screws and is presented for use in trauma surgery as a part of a system for posterior stabilisation of the spine. It is installed using specific tools. At importation, it is not presented in a sterilised packing. The product is marked with a number and therefore traceable throughout production and distribution. | 9021 10 90 | |
111/2011 of 7.2.2011 (OJ L 34, 9.2.2011, p. 33) |
1 | Article in the form of a conical piece of titanium having, at its lower end, a shank with an external thread (so-called 'artificial tooth stump'). It is for use in dentistry. It is intended to be screwed into an artificial tooth root implanted in the jaw and connect the root with the artificial crown. At importation, it is in a sterilised packing. | 9021 29 00 |
314/2011 of 30.3.2011 (OJ L 86, 1.4.2011, p. 57) |
1 | An apparatus (so-called 'infrared thermal camera') for capturing images of infrared
radiation by means of a microbolometer and displaying such images in colours representing
different temperatures, with dimensions of approximately 26 x 8 x 11 cm. The apparatus comprises: - a detachable lens, - a microbolometer with a resolution of 160 x 120 pixels, capable of measuring temperatures within a range of - 20 °C to 250 °C, - a colour liquid crystal display (LCD) with a resolution of 320 x 240 pixels and a diagonal measurement of the screen of approximately 7 cm (2,5 inches), and - a memory capable of storing up to 200 images in JPEG format. The microbolometer, being a thermal sensor used as a detector in the camera, provides for 19 200 pixels in each image where each pixel represents the result of a temperature measurement. The image is displayed in various colours representing the measurement of various temperatures together with a vertical scale showing the temperature at the top and bottom of the chosen range of temperatures and the range of colours going from top to bottom. The apparatus is also capable of measuring the temperature of a specific point and displaying the result on a temperature scale. The apparatus is used for preventative maintenance to detect defective construction or insulation and heat leaks. |
9025 19 20 |
2018/1208 of 27.8.2018 (OJ L 220, 30.8.2018, p. 4) |
A sensor based electrical analogue apparatus (so-called 'oxygen analyser') measuring
approximately 240 x 220 x 200 mm and weighing approximately 4,3 kg. The apparatus uses coulometric technology in order to detect and measure trace oxygen and paramagnetic technology in order to accurately measure the percentage of oxygen in pure gas streams and multi-gas backgrounds. It includes an LCD monitor to display the results of the measurement. It also includes an audio and visual alarm and analogue and digital outputs and two-way serial communication. The apparatus is used in industrial gas process and quality control. |
9027 10 10 | |
310/2010 of 9.4.2010 (OJ L 94, 15.4.2010, p. 27) |
1 | An apparatus having the appearance of a walk- through portal used at airport security
points (so- called 'mass spectrometer'). It is designed for the detection of illicit
substances, such as explosives and narcotics, by using Ion Trap Mobility Spectrometer
(ITMS) technology. The analysis is based on samples of air which pass through a semi-permeable membrane and enter an ionisation chamber where an ionisation source emits beta particles resulting in ion formation in the gaseous phase. The ionisation is then pulsed into a drift tube where an electric field accelerates the ions to a collector electrode. The sample is then analysed based on the time taken by the ions to reach the collector. Consequently, the apparatus separates ionised vapours and then measures the mobility of the ions in an electric field. The apparatus does not use optical radiation. |
9027 80 17 |
129/2005 of 20.1.2005 (OJ L 25, 28.1.2005, p. 37) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
3 | Network analyser, consisting of: an analyser module, a capture memory, and an interface to an automatic data-processing (ADP) machine, contained in a single housing. The analyser is designed to provide information on the performance of networks, by monitoring the network activity, by decoding any major protocol and by generating network traffic. The ADP machine is not presented with the analyzer. | 9031 80 38 |
129/2005 of 20.1.2005 (OJ L 25, 28.1.2005, p. 37) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
4 | Network analyser, consisting of: a central management bus, an analyser module, an automatic data-processing machine, a monitor, and a keyboard, contained in a single housing. The analyser is designed to perform the following functions: analysis of the operational state of existing networks and network products, simulation of traffic and fault conditions in existing networks and network products, and generation of network traffic. | 9031 80 38 |
273/2013 of 19.3.2013 (OJ L 84, 23.3.2013, p. 2) |
2 | An electronic apparatus (so-called 'body composition analyser') in a form of a personal scale incorporating an indicator panel with dimensions of approximately 36 x 32 x 6 cm, comprising the following main components: - for weighing: a load cell and hardware for processing and displaying the weight, - for measuring: a detachable hand bar with 4 electrodes, 4 electrodes on the scale upper surface, control buttons and hardware for processing and displaying the measurements. Through the 8 electrode system placed in the hands and under the feet, the apparatus sends electrical currents in multi-frequency measurement which, using bioimpedance characteristics, allow the apparatus to determine, for example, the percentage of body fat, the body fat mass, the body mass index (BMI), the skeletal muscle mass, the body water. The apparatus can be used either by health professionals in diagnosing obesity or by other users to provide information about their physique, or to check or improve it for sporting or appearance purposes. The apparatus can also be used as a scale only. The apparatus can store data for 99 users and 300 measurements. The data can be transferred to an automatic data-processing machine using a USB memory stick. | 9031 80 38 |
273/2013 of 19.3.2013 (OJ L 84, 23.3.2013, p. 3) |
3 | An electronic apparatus (so-called 'body composition analyser') with a weighing base and a column on top of which is a control board incorporating an indicator panel with the dimensions of approximately 120 x 87 x 52 cm, comprising the following main components: - for weighing: a load cell and hardware for processing and displaying the weight, - for measuring: 2 detachable hand bars with 2 electrodes each, 4 electrodes on the scale upper surface, control buttons and hardware for processing and displaying the measurements. Through the 8-point tactile electrode system placed in the hands and under the feet, the apparatus sends electrical currents in multi- frequency measurement which, using bioimpedance characteristics, allow the apparatus to determine, for example, the intracellular water, the extracellular water, the protein mass, the mineral mass, the body fat mass, the total body water, the fat free mass, the body mass index (BMI), the skeletal muscle mass. The apparatus is equipped with the following connectors: - RJ45, - USB, - RS232, - 25 pin D-sub. The apparatus can be used either by health professionals in diagnosing obesity or by other users to provide information about their physique, or to check or improve it for sporting or appearance purposes. The apparatus can be connected to an automatic data-processing machine or a printer. | 9031 80 38 |
1212/2013 of 26.11.2013 (OJ L 317, 28.11.2013 p.30) | 1 | Heartbeat measuring equipment consisting of: - a heartbeat sensor and a wireless transmitter, incorporated in a chest strap, - a heart rhythm monitoring device incorporating a wireless receiver and a watch, with control buttons and an opto-electronic display, which can be worn on the wrist, - a bracket for fixing the heart rhythm monitoring device to the handle bars of a bicycle. The heartbeats are captured by the sensor and the corresponding data is transmitted wirelessly to the monitoring device which calculates the heart rhythm (actual, maximum or average) and displays the result. The equipment also works as a watch and a stopwatch. | 9031 80 38 |
2015/805 of 19.05.2015 (OJ L 128, 23.05.2015, p. 10) | An electronic instrument (so-called 'rate gyro') with a weight of 35 g, comprising up to three angular velocity sensors, in a housing with dimensions of 24 x 24 x 28 mm. The housing also contains a temperature sensor and various electronics and is equipped with a cable. The instrument senses angular velocity in a range of approximately 50-1 200 °/s (degrees per second) and produces, by means of its electronic components, an electrical output signal proportional to the detected values. The signal is not displayed on the instrument, but transmitted to other apparatus connected via the cable. The temperature sensor provides information for compensating eventual variations in the output signal due to temperature change. The instrument is presented to be used for giving various apparatus, such as wind turbines, engines or industrial machines, instructions on the appropriate position to operate. | 9031 80 38 | |
1124/2012 of 26.11.2012 (OJ L 331, 1.12.2012 p.7) | A hermetically sealed weighing sensor (so- called "load cell") incorporating a strain gauge in the form of a bridge circuit with dimensions of approximately 13 x 3 x 3 cm. The load cell operates at the deflection of the strain gauge filament when it is subjected to a physical force. The physical force creates a change in resistance of the filament, thereby unbalancing the bridge circuit which in turn changes the voltage of the current passing through. The load cell converts the physical force acting on it into an electrical signal proportional to that force. The signal is read out, processed and shown by a device not included upon presentation. The load cell is designed to be used, for example, in floor scales, blenders, hoppers and tank scales. | 9031 80 98 | |
726/2012 of 6. 8. 2012 (OJ L 213, 10. 8. 2012, p. 3) |
An electronic apparatus (so-called 'remote elevator monitoring unit') in a housing with dimensions of approximately 28 x 22 x 9 cm for incorporation into a lift shaft. The apparatus, which receives information from various external sensors, is used for monitoring the functioning of the lift operations and detecting any malfunctions, for example, in starting and stopping, door opening and closing, levelling, in the traction motor, brake, cabin lighting. The information received is checked and processed by the apparatus and transmitted via a modem to a maintenance centre. After presentation and incorporation of a modem, the apparatus can provide two-way voice communication between the lift cabin and the maintenance centre through a microphone and a loudspeaker installed in the cabin. | 9031 90 85 | |
1212/2013 of 26.11.2013 (OJ L 317, 28.11.2013 p.30) | 2 | A heartbeat sensor and a wireless transmitter, incorporated in a chest strap intended to be worn round the chest for sensing heartbeats. The product senses heartbeats and transmits the correspondent data wirelessly to a heart rhythm monitoring device which is not included upon presentation. | 9031 90 85 |
634/2005 of 26.4.2005 (OJ L 106, 27.4.2005, p. 7) |
5 | System consisting of: a central processing unit with a keyboard, mouse and visual display (personal computer), a central processing unit (server), and a precision scanner. The scanner consists of a device known as a "scanner sensor support", on a frame. The "scanner sensor support" is fitted with various sensors for checking the quality of the paper (humidity, temperature, weight, etc.), and moves back-and-forth over the frame, to obtain data by means of laser beams or infra-red light or other means of measurement. The data are sent, via the server, to the personal computer where they are processed, to provide information on the quality of the paper. This information can be used for adjusting the output from the paper-manufacturing equipment, the latter not being part of the system. | 9032 89 00 |
863/2013 of 5.9.2013 (OJ L 240, 7.9.2013, p. 17) |
A product (so-called "Real Time Clock Module") consisting of a monolithic integrated circuit and a quartz crystal assembled together on a metal frame and embedded in a plastic housing with dimensions of approximately 10 x 7 x 3 mm. The product operates with an oscillating frequency of 32,768 kHz and a supply voltage of between 2,7 and 3,6 V. It has a digital output signal. The product is used in various apparatus as the source of a clock signal for determining intervals of time. | 9114 90 00 | |
1288/91 of 14.5.1991 (OJ L 122, 17.5.1991, p. 11) |
7 | Apparatus, known as 'chromatic tuners', with the following characteristics: several tuning-methods and two transposition-functions adapted to a range of musical instruments; microphone, quartz oscillator, pointer-type frequency meter and light-emitting diodes whether or not with a loudspeaker; seven-octave tuning range (from 32,7 to 395,1 Hz). | 9209 99 40 |
242/96 of 7.2.1996 (OJ L 31, 9.2.1996, p. 16) |
1 | Air-pistol, made of plastic, with the internal mechanism and the inside of the barrel made of metal, capable of firing plastic pellets. | 9304 00 00 |
2017/1169 of 26.6.2017 (OJ L 170, 1.7.2017, p. 56) |
An article in a form of a ball (so called 'paintball') made of a hard gelatine shell
containing water-based paint. The article is designed to be used as a projectile for a paintball gun (air gun with a nozzle velocity of 91 meters per second) during the multi- player game 'paintball'. |
9306 90 90 | |
2458/95 of 19.10.1995 (OJ L 253, 21.10.1995, p. 1) |
1 | Coverings, designed to be permanently fixed over the front and rear seat-stuffing and -frames of motor vehicles, made up of: a seat-bottom with an external surface mainly of synthetic fabric (polyester) and plastic (PVC). Inside, there is a flexible metal rod; a seat-back with an external surface mainly of synthetic fabric (polyester) and plastic (PVC). Inside, there are tapes with plastic fastenings, a rubber strap and flexible metal rods; and a headrest-cover with an external surface mainly of synthetic fabric (polyester) and plastic (PVC). The fabric is backed with a thin layer of cellular plastic covered with a polyamide net, and the plastic is backed with acrylic fabric. | 9401 90 80 |
2795/1999 of 29.12.1999 (OJ L 337, 30.12.1999, p. 36) |
1 | Covers, made from cotton, intended to be fixed permanently to the back or seat of upholstered furniture. The covers are used in conjunction with sets of furniture for assembly. After assembly of the furniture, the covers cannot be taken off without disassembling the furniture. | 9401 90 80 |
772/2011 of 2.8.2011 (OJ L 201, 4.8.2011, p. 1) |
1 | An article made of metal and plastic, designed for attaching a child safety seat to a motor vehicle (so-called "child safety seat base"). It comprises an extendable leg and a system with red/green indicators informing, for example, whether the article or the seat is correctly installed. It is for temporary attachment to anchorage points, which are fixtures generally fastened permanently to the car body at the back of a vehicle seat. The article allows different models of child safety seats to be clipped in and out. | 9401 90 80 |
106/2012 of 7.2. 2012 (OJ L 36, 9.2.2012, p. 23) |
A metal disc-shaped device with a diameter of approximately 8 cm and a thickness of 2
cm (so-called "round recliner"). The device has an uneven surface with a central shaft hole and it consists of the following: - a guide plate, - a spiral spring, - a hinge cam, - a slide cam, - two slide pawls, - a ratchet, and - a ring plate. It is a component of reclining mechanisms for motor vehicle seats. The device is used to adjust the angle of the seat back according to the needs of the driver or passengers and contributes to the strength of the seat. |
9401 90 80 | |
1964/90 of 6.7.1990 (OJ L 178, 11.7.1990, p. 5) |
6 | Ice-storage bin, for the storage of ice-cubes. The bin consists of a shaped frame with an internal container of steel sheeting. The bin is double-skinned, with a layer of foam plastic between the skins. | 9403 20 80 |
840/92 of 1.4.1992 (OJ L 88, 3.4.1992, p. 29) |
2nd. | Mobile shelving-unit of a height up to 225 cm, consisting of a base mounted on four small wheels, with four steel corner-supports and at least two wooden shelves. The shelving-unit is generally used during the transport and storage of goods sold by florists. | 9403 20 80 |
313/2011 of 30.3.2011 (OJ L 86, 1.4.2011, p. 55) |
1 | A piece of furniture (so-called 'television stand') with measurements of approximately 80 x 40 x 45 cm. The product consists of a top and two shelves made of clear tempered glass, and four cylindrical legs of approximately 45 x 5 cm made of metal. The maximum weight load of the product is 80 kg. The metal components and the glass components comprise approximately 47 % and 44 %, respectively, of the total value of the product. | 9403 20 80 |
2016/1321 of 3.8.2016 (OJ L 209, 26.7.2016, p. 4) | An article (so-called 'hammock with frame'), with dimensions of approximately 230 x
140 x 205 cm. It consists of a triangular stand to be placed on the ground, made of metal
(steel) bars, in which a reclining surface serving as a lying area is hung. The reclining
surface measures 100 x 190 cm (W x L) and contains slightly curved rods on the long sides
and straight rods on the narrow sides, which are fitted with a fabric covering. The
article is equipped with a 'roof' of textile material and mosquito nets. The article weighs 45 kg and can cater for persons weighing up to 180 kg. It is made of weather resistant material, which signifies that the article is suitable for outdoor use. |
9403 20 80 | |
2017/982 of 07.06.2017 (OJ L 148, 10.6.2017, p. 24) | An article (so-called bathtub step) with measurements of approximately 41 x 31 x 14
cm, consisting of a plastic surface held by four legs made of aluminium. The bottom of
each leg is surrounded by a buffer i.e. a non-slip cap made of rubber. The article is presented as a step to assist persons in getting into and out of a bathtub. |
9403 20 80 | |
2016/1211 of 20.7.2016 (OJ L 199, 26.7.2016, p. 3) | An article (so-called 'hammock with stand'), with dimensions of approximately 380 x
120 x 140 cm. The article consists of a wooden stand to be placed on the ground, on which
a hammock, measuring 240 x 120 cm, made of cotton fabric, is hung. The narrow ends of the
hammock are finished with wooden rods and are provided with cords to be attached to the
stand. The article weighs approximately 32 kg and can cater for persons weighing up to 150 kg. |
9403 60 90 | |
2017/181 of 27.1.2017 (OJ L 29, 3.2.2017, p. 10) | A single glass shelf presented with metal supports for fixing it to the wall. The glass shelf consists of a transparent glass plate measuring approximately 60 x 13,5 x 0,7 cm of irregular shape with processed edges (the front edge is formed in a curve shape) and two holders made of an alloy of copper and zinc (brass), plated with nickel and chrome. The glass plate has two holes for mounting on the holders. The product is presented unassembled, together with screws and dowels for mounting, packed in a carton box. |
9403 89 00 | |
2015/677 of 23.04.2015 (OJ L111, 30.04.2015, p. 21) | An article consisting of four table legs of base metal, fixed with screws to four metal plates holding them together. In order to avoid sliding and to protect the floor, the bottom end of each table leg is covered with rubber. The top ends of the table legs have holes for screws to allow for fixing a tabletop. | 9403 90 10 | |
465/2010 of 27.5.2010 (OJ L 129, 28.5.2010, p. 64) |
1 | An article with overall dimensions of 197 x 90 x 2 cm consisting of 16 slats of solid wood held together by two bands of textile fixed to the wood by means of metal staples. The slats are not curved, and they are of non-flexible massive pine. The article is intended to be used together with a bed frame to support a mattress. | 9404 10 00 |
51/2009 of 15.1.2009 (OJ L 17, 22.1.2009, p. 17) |
1 | Quilted rectangular article, measuring approximately 260 cm x 240 cm, consisting of three layers, the two outer layers are made of woven cotton fabric, the middle layer is synthetic wadding which constitutes the internal fitting. The upper layer has a sewn-on border, approximately 30 cm wide, of a contrasting colour. The layers are held together by decorative stitching (bedspread). | 9404 90 90 |
152/2010 of 23.2.2010 (OJ L , 23.2.2010, p. 3) |
1 | An article consisting of dark green electric cables incorporating 160 clear mini filament lamps (1,5 V/0,5 W), joined together so as to form a net of 320 x 150 cm (so called 'light net'). The individual meshes of the net are 19 x 19 cm so that the distance between each lamp is approximately 19 cm. The article is presented in a package for retail sale together with a 24 V static converter, 8 suction pads with hooks and 10 spare lamps. The light net is made for both outdoor and indoor use. The article is intended for decorating, for example, a Christmas tree or a window. | 9405 30 00 |
337/2014 of 28.3.2014 (OJ L , 2.4.2014, p. 3) |
An electric lighting article (so-called 'LED floodlight') in a rectangular shaped
aluminium housing with a glass cover, with dimensions of approximately 23 x 19 x 13 cm. The article comprises an aluminium reflector and has a mounting bracket on the back for adjusting the light angle. It is fitted with a high-power LED chip and a power supply with a transformer. It has a power consumption of 95 W, a luminous efficacy of 100 lm/W and a beam angle of 120°. The article is used outdoors for illuminating, for example, landscapes, buildings, construction areas, billboards, lawns or gardens. Apytiksliai 23 x 19 x 13 cm dydzio elektros apsvietimo gaminys (vadinamasis LED prozektorius) staciakampiame aliuminio korpuse su stiklo dangteliu. |
9405 40 99 | |
2017/1476 of 11.8.2017 (OJ L 211, 17.8.2017, p. 3) |
A product (so-called 'LED dental light') made of different materials such as glass,
plastic and various metals and including several light-emitting diodes (LED). It is
presented attached to a pivoting arm. The pivoting arm can either be mounted on a dental
chair or e.g. on the wall or ceiling of a dental surgery. It is designed to illuminate the oral cavity during dentistry treatment. The level, colour and pattern of the light produced is specifically for use by dentists. |
9405 40 99 | |
731/2010 of 1.8.2010 (OJ L 214, 1.8.2010, p. 2) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | A so-called 'light installation' consisting of six circular fluorescent lighting tubes and six lighting fittings of plastics. It has been designed by an artist and operates in accordance with instructions provided by the artist. It is intended to be displayed in a gallery, fixed to the wall. The fittings are separate from each other and are intended to be mounted vertically. The tubes are to be placed into the fittings, providing two alternating shades of white. The product is presented disassembled. | 9405 10 40 |
453/2014 of 29.4.2014 (OJ L 133, 6.5.2014, p. 27) |
An apparatus (so-called 'TV simulator') in a plastic housing with a transparent cover on the front and with dimensions of approximately 8 x 7 x 6 cm. The apparatus is equipped with four LEDs for generating light, a quartz crystal, a dusk sensor, a timer, an operating mode display and control buttons. It is presented with a power supply. The apparatus simulates a television set that is switched on, by generating random flickering light of varying intensity and colour during a pre-programmed period of time. It gives the impression that there are people present in the house with the purpose of deterring burglars. | 9405 40 39 | |
708/2013 of 23.7.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p. 10) |
An article (so-called "LED strip") comprising light-emitting diodes (LED), transistors, resistors and protection diodes. The components are assembled in a printed circuit in the form of a flexible metallic strip with an adhesive layer protected by a detachable paper on the bottom with dimensions of approximately 17 x 1 cm. The components are interconnected. Contacts at the ends of the strip prepared for soldering (for example, wires) allow connection to a 12 V DC power supply. The article provides light when supplied with electrical current. The article is a lighting fitting designed to be used, for example, in furniture. | 9405 40 99 | |
760/2014 of 10.7.2014 (OJ L 207, 15.7.2014, p.10) | A cylindrical container made of plastics, approximately 8 cm high, with a diameter of 6 cm, containing 180 ml of paraffin-based lamp oil (a mixture of paraffin containing 68 % of tetradecane, 25 % of pentadecane and approximately 4 % of hexadecane) and a wick. It is covered by a metal seal with a plastic cap that prevents evaporation of the oil and holds the wick in place (so-called 'oil lamp'). The container cannot be refilled after the oil has been consumed. The product is used as a mood light. It can either be placed in a holder (for example, a glass pot) or it can be used independently. | 9405 50 00 | |
1220/84 of 30.4.1984 (OJ L 117, 3.5.1984, p. 20) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
1 | Colourless glass rosettes ('strass'), octagonal (about 14 mm in diameter), cut and polished, mechanically, and having several facets on both sides, fully pierced symmetrically in two places near the edge; they are normally mounted on electrical lighting-fittings. | 9405 91 10 |
1220/84 of 30.4.1984 (OJ L 117, 3.5.1984, p. 20) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Colourless glass pendants ('strass'), oval (about 50 x 29 mm), cut and polished, mechanically, and having several facets on both sides, fully pierced near the apex; they are normally mounted on electrical lighting-fittings. | 9405 91 10 |
1220/84 of 30.4.1984 (OJ L 117, 3.5.1984, p. 20) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
3 | Colourless glass balls ('strass'), (about 30 mm in diameter), cut and polished, mechanically, and having many facets fitted with small metal attachment-hooks; they are normally mounted on electrical lighting-fittings. | 9405 91 10 |
687/2002 of 22.4.2002 (OJ L 106, 23.4.2002, p. 3) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
3 | Article consisting of an aluminium platform to stand on, which is connected to a small wheel at the rear. The front is connected to a height-adjustable and lockable steering column. The steering column is provided with a small wheel and handlebar grips. The article is suitable to be ridden by adults and children alike. | 9503 00 10 |
441/91 of 25.2.1991 (OJ L 52, 27.2.1991, p. 9) amended by Reg. Nr. 1179/2009 + Nr. 41/2013 |
Plastic doll with movable limbs, of a height of 140 mm, with a transparent plastic chest filled with about 10 g of small sweets (chewing-gum) containing sucrose and which can be removed via an aperture below the belt-buckle of the doll. | 9503 00 21 | |
687/2002 of 22.4.2002 (OJ L 106, 23.4.2002, p. 3) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
4 | Unassembled plastic model (1 : 200) of a Boeing™ 767-300ER aeroplane with the dimensions (L x W x H) 27 x 24,5 x 8 cm. The model consists of the following elements: a fuselage or principal body, two wings (each carrying a motor), a tailplane, a tailfin, a standard, and a pedestal. The pedestal and both sides of the body carry the name of an airline company. The tailfin, the motors and the pedestal carry the logo of the airline company. | 9503 00 30 |
2184/97 of 3.11.1997 (OJ L 299, 4.11.1997, p. 6) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
6 | Stuffed article made of pile fabric, about 30 cm high and representing a dog. It is decorated with a 'Santa Claus' cap permanently glued on, a red textile ribbon decorated with printed stars around its neck, and Christmas boots. It contains a battery-powered music-module which produces a Christmas song when the paw is pressed; at the same time, a red heart-shaped bulb in the dog's chest flashes and the lower jaw moves. | 9503 00 41 |
199/2014 of 28.2.2014 (OJ L 62, 4.3.2014, p. 7) |
1 | A product in the form of a stylised giraffe (approximately 36 cm high and weighing approximately 820 g), consisting of a soft, textile exterior filled with various materials. The head is filled with a soft textile material while the body and limbs contain a loose millet and lavender filling (which cannot be taken out for use as a separate cushion). The product can be heated in either a microwave or a traditional oven and also cooled in either a fridge or a freezer in order to be used as a heating or cooling cushion. | 9503 00 41 |
2015/352 of 2.3.2015 (OJ L 61, 5.3.2015, p.5) | A stuffed article made of fabric representing an animal, approximately 15 cm high, with a built-in musical module.The music is activated by pulling a string at the bottom of the article. | 9503 00 41 | |
2338/96 of 5.12.1996 (OJ L 318, 7.12.1996, p. 3) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
4 | Rigid figurine of a bear standing, made completely of plastic, with some human features (e.g. smiling face, left arm bent, right arm outstretched with stylised human hand) and red neckerchief painted on. The figurine is approximately 4 cm high and is packed in a small plastic container. | 9503 00 49 |
2184/97 of 3.11.1997 (OJ L 299, 4.11.1997, p. 6) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
7 | Plastic toy representing a non-human figure (robot) and containing a battery-powered motor to move the robot around and to move its arms. | 9503 00 49 |
617/96 of 3.4.1996 (OJ L 88, 5.4.1996, p. 1) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
1 | Children's portable, battery-powered electronic keyboard, of coloured plastic, with thirty-two keys reduced in size, and control-buttons for orchestral instruments, rhythms, demonstration-mode, volume and power. | 9503 00 55 |
618/96 of 3.4.1996 (OJ L 88, 5.4.1996, p. 3) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
3 | Musical mobile for a baby, disassembled, consisting of: a plastic suspension-strap with device for attaching it, a music-box with a spring-mechanism for winding it up, and a mobile consisting of two crossed plastic arcs with, attached by threads to the centre and the ends, stuffed textile figures representing animals (rabbit, duck, frog) but dressed as humans. When wound up, the music-box plays a tune and rotates the mobile. | 9503 00 55 |
1655/2005 of 10.10.2005 (OJ L266, 11.10.2005, p. 50) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
4 | A paperboard puzzle book for children consisting of sixteen pages. Eight of the pages (left side) contain a short children's story with an illustration relating to that story. Seven of the pages (right side) contain a puzzle consisting of 9 pieces, which reproduces the colour illustration of the corresponding page. The last page contains only an illustration. | 9503 00 69 |
1056/2006 of 12.7.2006 (OJ L 192, 13.7.2006, p. 6) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
4 | Eight small plastic cubes, with 48 faces, held together on two edges. The position of the cubes can be changed so as to create geometric shapes with correct illustrations. | 9503 00 69 |
2015/1384 of 10.8.2015 (OJ L 214, 13.8.2015, p. 3) | An article ('puzzle book') consisting of puzzles, educative texts, maps and other
illustrations bound together, made of cardboard and measuring approximately 34 x 24 cm,
with 14 pages. Every other page contains a puzzle with approximately 40 pieces, showing a map with information and illustrations on a single-coloured background. The puzzles relate to, and complete, the educative texts, maps and illustrations on the opposite pages. |
9503 00 69 | |
1480/83 of 7.6.1983 (OJ L 151, 9.6.1983, p. 27) amended by Reg. 2080/91 + 1179/2009 |
1 | Set for children, consisting of: (1) a base-metal chain, a cameo-type pendant of base metal and plastic, two earrings, a brooch and a ring of base metal and plastic, put up in the same packing; (2) a base-metal chain, a pendant in the shape of a watch, two earrings, two bracelets and two rings of plastic, put up in the same packing. | 9503 00 70 |
2338/96 of 5.12.1996 (OJ L 318, 7.12.1996, p. 3) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
5 | Set, consisting of a children's book of cardboard, four plastic bricks of various colours, and a plastic figurine in the form of a brick with a girl's head. The book has simple stories printed, with colour illustrations, for the amusement of children. A removable blister-pack, containing the figurine and the bricks, is fixed to the last page of the book. The figurine and the bricks are intended to be placed, by children following the narrative, into coloured slots on the appropriate pages. | 9503 00 70 |
2184/97 of 3.11.1997 (OJ L 299, 4.11.1997, p. 6) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
8 | Set, put up for retail sale, consisting of a model mouse of textile, six wooden cubes bearing the letters A, B, C, X, Y, and Z on the faces, and a children's picture-book made of cardboard. | 9503 00 70 |
1508/2000 of 11.7.2000 (OJ L 174, 13.7.2000, p. 3) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
1 | Set, consisting of vampire teeth made of plastic and a small plastic tube containing a red liquid ('make-believe blood'), put up in packaging for retail sale. | 9503 00 70 |
1386/2003 of 1.8.2003 (OJ L 196, 2.8.2003, p. 19) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
6 | Set of reduced-size kitchen utensils, consisting of two spoons (17 cm long), a spatula (17 cm long), and two scoops (8 cm long and 11 cm long), made of wood and packaged in a plastic bag. | 9503 00 70 |
299/2009 of 8.4.2009 (OJ L 95, 9.4.2009, p. 37) |
1 | Set put up for retail sale in a cardboard box consisting of: - various plastic beads and pieces of costume jewellery for threading, - a roll of synthetic thread string, - magnetic cubes, - instructions, and - a drawstring pouch made of fabric. The set is intended for children to make imitation jewellery which can be modified using the magnetic cubes. The pouch can be used to store both the various pieces and the imitation jewellery once it has been put together. | 9503 00 70 |
2016/1320 of 26.7.2016 (OJ L 209, 3.8.2016, p. 1) | A mat and a 'special pen' put up together for retail sale. The mat is rectangular consisting of two layers of textile fabric which are hemmed together along the edges. The upper layer is a woven fabric of textile fibres having cartoon-like images printed along the edges. In the centre colourful prints are coated with a white chemical which becomes transparent when wet, making the colourful prints of the fabric visible e.g. wet fingers leave coloured traces. Once the textile material has dried up, the colours disappear under the white coating again. The 'special pen' of plastics is used for 'writing' on the mat through wetting the surface coating with its wet point. The 'special pen' is refillable with water. |
9503 00 70 | |
2017/226 of 7.2.2017 (OJ L 35, 10.2.2017, p. 3) | Toys, put up in the same packing for retail sale, consisting of: - a battery-powered locomotive and a carriage, of plastics, - wooden tracks, - traffic signs, cars, human figures, animals, trees, etc. |
9503 00 70 | |
215/96 of 2.2.1996 (OJ L 28, 6.2.1996, p. 9) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
3 | Replica of a Mercedes AMG car from the year of construction of 1994, mass-produced and mounted on a plate. The bodywork of die-cast zinc bears various markings. Some of the components (e.g. headlights, tail-lights, window-frames) are stencilled. The other components (e.g. spoiler, windscreen-wipers, door-handles, wing-mirrors, steering wheel) are made of plastic. | 9503 00 85 |
2016/302 of 25.2.2016 (OJ L 58, 4.3.2016, p. 21) |
1 | An article in the form of a plastic drawing board measuring approximately 31 cm x 32
cm, with a bright layered plastic magnetic surface for drawing and erasing. The surface is
surrounded and held by a plastic frame. There is a drawing pen made of plastics with a metal tip attached by a string to the board which is pressed on the surface and produces pictures, letters, etc. using the magnetic property of the surface. There are four small magnetic stamps made of plastics loosely laid in the plastic frame, with which figures can be stamped on the surface. The erasing function works by lifting the upper layer of the plastics; the mechanism for lifting the upper layer is built-in at the bottom of the drawing board and disconnects the magnetic function. The article is designed for the entertainment of children. |
9503 00 95 |
442/91 of 25.2.1991 (OJ L 52, 27.2.1991, p. 11) amended by Reg. 705/2005 + 1179/2009 |
4 | Portable transmitter-receiver radio, of the 'walkie-talkie' type, of plastic, of a maximum power-output not exceeding 5 mw ERP (effective radiated power), battery-operated, whether or not incorporating a morse-system, but not containing noise-suppressors, channel-selectors or voltmeters. | 9503 00 95 |
2087/92 of 22.7.1992 (OJ L 208, 24.7.1992, p. 24) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 1179/2009 |
5 | Plastic 'cookie cutters', primarily intended as children's toys, for cutting out plasticine into the shape of 'Disney' characters. | 9503 00 95 |
2087/92 of 22.7.1992 (OJ L 208, 24.7.1992, p. 24) amended by Reg. 936/1999 + 1179/2009 |
6 | Inflatable beach-balls, of welded plastic sheets, with a valve. | 9503 00 95 |
2184/97 of 3.11.1997 (OJ L 299, 4.11.1997, p. 6) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
9 | Plastic picture-panel (about 29 x 22 cm) protected by a cover made of cardboard. The picture-panel with pictures of animals is fixed to the inside-right of the cover. It contains a battery-powered electronic module, with press-buttons (below the pictures of the animals), a switch and a loudspeaker. The module is activated by pressing one of the buttons, and plays back mainly a recorded voice and only a few bars of music. There is a book with blank pages on the inside-left of the cover. | 9503 00 95 |
981/98 of 7.5.1998 (OJ L 137, 9.5.1998, p. 9) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
2 | Laptop computer-type device, in a coloured plastic casing approximately 20 cm long, 23 cm wide and 6 cm thick, and having the following components: a loudsdpeaker, an electronic processing unit (not freely programmable), a keyboard with contacts under a sturdy plastic sheet, an LCD-display approximately 6 x 3 cm, and controls to adjust the volume of the loudspeaker and the contrast. It has sixteen built-in programmes which allow for exercises in writing, arithmetic, logic and music to be carried out. | 9503 00 95 |
2518/98 of 23.11.1998 (OJ L 315, 25.11.1998, p. 3) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
6 | Battery-powered electronic apparatus, in a flat rounded plastic casing approximately 6 cm in diameter, containing a LCD-display, a miniaturised loudspeaker, several push-buttons, and a keyholder. The toy represents a 'virtual creature' which has to be kept 'alive' by using the input-buttons. In addition, the apparatus can display the time. | 9503 00 95 |
2518/98 of 23.11.1998 (OJ L 315, 25.11.1998, p. 3) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
7 | Inflatable ring, made of coloured printed plastic sheeting, with animal-features on it (dorsal, tail and pectoral fins of a fish), designed for use in the water. The ring has an outer diameter of about 40 cm and an inner diameter of about 20 cm. It has a safety-valve. | 9503 00 95 |
184/2000 of 26.1.2000 (OJ L 22, 27.1.2000, p. 48) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
1 | Device, in a laptop computer-type plastic case, comprising: electronic processing unit, liquid-crystal display (LCD), keyboard, switches (to select an activity and to adjust the volume and contrast), loudspeaker and connections for a mouse and printer. It is presented with a mouse. It does not have its own operating system, but has the following programmes: more than 40 fixed programmes (for language-learning, writing, reading and arithmetic, and for performing logic exercises), office programmes (e.g. word-processing and a daily-planner), and creation and execution of programmes written in BASIC. The features of the device may be extended by using additional cartridges. It is aimed at children of nine years and upwards. | 9503 00 95 |
442/2000 of 25.2.2000 (OJ L 54, 26.2.2000, p. 33) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
3 | Balloons, of aluminised bonded plastic foil. The plastic foil forms the exterior of the balloon. The balloon has a filler-neck in which a valve of a strip of synthetic material is inserted, to seal the gas automatically inside the balloon and prevent it from leaking out. The balloon can be filled with gas (air or helium). | 9503 00 95 |
652/2007 of 8.6.2007 (OJ L 153, 14.6.2007, p. 6) |
4 | Reduced-size (scale) model replica of a football stadium made mainly of plastics on a fibreboard plinth. It has no movable components. | 9503 00 95 |
1510/96 of 26.7.1996 (OJ L 189, 30.7.1996, p. 89) amended by Reg. Nr. 42/2013 |
1 | Plastic shell, in two pieces, containing: plastic spinning-top of a diameter of 2,5 cm, and chewing-gum, in the form of a sugar-coated ball, with a sucrose-content of 69,5 % by weight (including invert sugar expressed as sucrose). | 9503 00 95 |
711/2013 of 24.7.2013 (OJ L 200, 25.7.2013, p. 16) |
An unassembled toy figurine of plastics, approximately 4,5 cm tall, consisting of two parts. It is presented in a plastic container in the shape of an egg consisting of two separable halves which fit snugly together at the edges. The figurine has humanoid features of a man. It does not have movable parts or detachable clothing and it maintains its position unsupported. The figurine represents a wizard from a comic-book series and forms a part of a collection together with the other characters from the series. | 9503 00 95 | |
860/2014 of 5.8.2014 (OJ L 235, 8.8.2014, p. 7) |
A product consisting of a luminous disc (so- called 'luminous frisbee') and a hand-operated launch system with retractable string, made of plastics. The disc contains battery powered LEDs. The luminous disc is to be released in the air by tugging the string. It may be propelled up to a distance of 20 m before landing on the ground. It is presented for use as a flying propeller toy. | 9503 00 95 | |
2087/92 of 22.7.1992 (OJ L 208, 24.7.1992, p. 24) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
7 | Play-tent, for use by children either indoors or out, consisting of a one-piece cover of woven nylon-textile fabric, a tubular plastic frame, and small metal pegs for anchorage when used outdoors. | 9503 00 99 |
1488/1999 of 7.7.1999 (OJ L 172, 8.7.1999, p. 25) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
2 | Kite, so-called 'stunt kite', with delta-wings and a frame of plastic sticks or tubes and a covering of plastic fabric. The kite is steered from the ground by means of two or four cords. | 9503 00 99 |
442/2000 of 25.2.2000 (OJ L 54, 26.2.2000, p. 33) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
4 | Kite, in the form of a frameless rectangular sliding parachute, with cells of plastic fabric which swell in the wind. It can be used on its own or in series, with several kites of the same kind stacked one above the other. It is steered from the ground by two or four cords. | 9503 00 99 |
2180/2001 of 9.11.2001 (OJ L 293, 10.11.2001, p. 5) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
1st. | Product, in the form of a square textile mat (65 % polyester, 35 % cotton) measuring approximately 70 x 70 cm, upholstered with polyester fibres. Two flexible plastic rods, upholstered with plastic foam and a textile covering, are supplied with the mat; they are approximately 1,5 m long and can be attached to the edges of the mat. The following accessories are supplied for attachment to the plastic rods: a mirror made of textile and plastic, a plastic rattle, and a flower made of textile and containing an electronic module which produces a piece of music when pressed. The product is intended for children up to the age of 10 months. | 9503 00 99 |
2180/2001 of 9.11.2001 (OJ L 293, 10.11.2001, p. 5) amended by Reg. 1179/2009 |
2nd. | Product, in the form of a textile mat, upholstered with plastic foam. The mat consists of four segments which can be connected in various ways by means of velcro fasteners. Three of the segments have and windows, and are supplied with the following accessories: a plastic mirror, a textile ball containing a rattle, a textile star which produces a noise when squeezed, a plastic bag containing plastic fish (for filling with water, and images of animals. This segment also has round textile animal-figures containing an electronic module to reproduce the call of the relevant animal. The fourth segment is provided with accessories in the form of geometrical patterns. The accessories are attached to the segments by means of velcro fasteners or textile laces. The product is intended for children up to the age of 18 months. | 9503 00 99 |
153/2010 of 23.2.2010 (OJ L 48, 25.2.2010, p. 5) |
1 | A product in the form of a so-called 'pop-up book' incorporating printed pages of paperboard, two of them with a limited text related to the playing activity. It has six other pages which, when opened, produce a three-dimensional representation of several sections of a space station. It also incorporates a page with press-out, stand-up figures made from paperboard which can be inserted into different parts of the space station. | 9503 00 99 |
1129/2012 of 1.26.11.2012 (OJ L 331, 1.12.2012, p.17) |
1 | A set put up for retail sale consisting of the following articles: - 2 packs of playing cards, - 300 poker chips, - a dealer chip, - a DVD with instructions. It is presented in a case made of aluminium with an interior which is specially fitted to contain the articles. The articles are to be used together to play a game of poker. The chips and the DVD are supplementary to the playing cards and cannot be used individually. | 9504 40 00 |
2016/1758 of 28.9.2016 (OJ L 269, 4.10.2016, p.1) |
An article (so-called 'memory card game') comprising 20 square cards, made of
cardboard and measuring approximately 60 x 60 mm. All cards have the same design/image on
the reverse and various images on the face. Every card contains an image that can be
paired with another card (couples contain the same image on the face). This card game is suitable for two to four players. |
9504 40 00 | |
1508/2000 of 11.7.2000 (OJ L 174, 13.7.2000, p. 3) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
4 | Set of electronic devices, consisting of: a video-game console, a controller-module, and a portable hand-held module. The video-game console consists of a CPU, a memory, a graphics-processor, a sound-processor, an optical-disc drive, a modem for Internet-access, and various sockets such as ports for controller-modules. It has a fixed operating system which has been customised for video-games. The optical-disc drive is capable of reading special compact-discs containing games developed for the video-game console. The game-programmes cannot be modified by the user.The sockets enable the video-console to be connected to several devices such as a television-receiver, a data-monitor, a keyboard, a mouse, an external storage-unit, or a printer.The controller-module has different control-buttons which are used for playing games on the console. The controller-module has to be connected to the video-game console by cable.The portable hand-held module has different control-buttons for playing games, and a small LCD-screen which displays game-information. The module can download game-information and scores, and may be used for playing basic games in its own right. The portable hand-held module can be linked to the controller-module, but may also be used independently. | 9504 50 00 |
2015/21 of 5.1.2015 (OJ L 4, 2015 1 8, p. 10) |
An electronic component contained in a rectangular plastic housing (so-called 'game cartridge') with dimensions of 35 x 33 x 4 mm. The game cartridge consists of a printed circuit board with integrated circuits (read-only memory (ROM) and flash memory), passive elements (capacitors, resistors) and several contact pins. The ROM comprises an application program (a video game) and cannot be changed or upgraded by the user. The flash memory is used for storing data created when the game is played, such as preferences or reached levels and scores. Due to its special shape and specifically configured contact pins, the cartridge can only be used in a specific brand and type of video game consoles of heading 9504. | 9504 50 00 | |
324/2007 of 23.3.2007 (OL L 85/5, 27.3.2007 p. 5) amended by Reg. 441/2013 |
2 | Handheld, battery-powered, electronic apparatus, for a single player, in a plastic
housing with an LCD screen and input buttons. The product has more than one million
builtin SUDOKU puzzle games and has different levels of difficulty. The screen displays a
grid of nine boxes, each with 3 x 3 cells. Each box has to be filled in, so that every
row, column and box of 3 x 3 cells contains the digits 1 to 9 only once. The apparatus contains a time function which, inter alia, shows the time spent on the game being played. |
9504 90 80 |
442/91 of 25.2.1991 (OJ L 52, 27.2.1991, p. 11) |
5 | Article in the shape of a bird's nest, consisting of tressed osier canes and decorated with six chickens, artificial flowers and artificial leaves. | 9505 90 00 |
1165/95 of 23.5.1995 (OJ L 117, 24.5.1995, p. 15) |
7 | Little star- and heart-shapes, in a variety of colours (red, green, shiny silver), and multicoloured granules of the size of pinheads, made from plastic film and used to decorate e.g. a table on which food for a carnival celebration, children's party or Advent festivity is served. The decorative effect is achieved by sprinkling the products. | 9505 90 00 |
1578/2006 of 19.10.2006 (OJ L 291, 21.10.2006, p. 13) |
2 | A pair of inflatable plastic rings, each with two air chambers. They are designed to be worn by children around the arms in order to keep them afloat in shallow water. Their construction does not provide a level of safety for rescue or security. | 9506 29 00 |
399/2012 of 7. 5. 2012 (OJ L 124, 11. 5. 2012, p. 11) |
1 | An unassembled article, (so-called "safety net for trampoline") comprising: - a net with 6 snap closures, - 6 upper metal bars with cellular plastic covering, - 6 lower metal bars with cellular plastic covering and welded mounting brackets, - 12 rubber bands with hooks, - 12 screws with locking nuts. Each upper bar is to be fitted to the lower bar which is then fastened to the legs of the trampoline using the screws and locking nuts. The net is sewn into the shape of a cylinder and it comes in a size to fit a specific trampoline. The net has an entrance opening that can be closed by a zipper. The snap closures on the upper part of the net are to be fastened to the top end of the metal bars. The rubber bands with hooks are used to fasten the bottom of the net to the frame of the trampoline. | 9506 91 90 |
384/2004 of 1.3.2004 (OJ L 64, 2.3.2004, p. 21) |
3 | Article (snowshoe), 65 cm in length and 23 cm at its widest, consisting of an aluminium frame with a plastic covering, tapered at one end and rounded at the other. The frame has an 1-mm-thick plastic attachment serrated on the underside for metal blades, to ensure better footing in snow. A rigid metal plate is secured to the upper side of the frame by a plastic strap. There are rubber pads on the plate, to fit around a shoe, with rubber/fabric straps for attachment to the shoe. The article is an aid to walking on snow. | 9506 99 90 |
2015/386 of 5.03.2015 (OJ L 65, 10.3.2015, p. 5) |
A four-wheeled skateboard with dimensions of approximately 80 x 27 x 17 cm, a weight of 10 kg and a maximum load capacity of 65 kg. The article is equipped with an electric motor powered by two rechargeable 24 V batteries. The article has the following characteristics: - the wheels are made of polyurethane and have a diameter of 85 mm, - only the two rear wheels are driven by a belt, - the surface of the article is covered with an anti-slip layer, - the electric motor is mounted under the article, - it has a speed range of 10-32 km/h, no brakes and no steering system. The skateboard is presented with a handheld remote control. The skateboard is powered by an electric motor, which is operated by the person riding the board by means of the remote control. While riding the skateboard, its speed can be regulated by pulling a trigger on the remote control. | 9506 99 90 | |
1065/2010 of 19.11.2010 (OJ L 304, 20.11.2010, p. 7) |
1 | A product consisting of a paperboard roll and a handle made of moulded plastics (so-called 'textile roller'). The paperboard roll is covered by a paper which is self- adhesive on the outer side and covered by synthetic plastics on the inner side. The paperboard roll, with a self-adhesive paper, is disposable and interchangeable. It is wrapped in a protective layer of paper containing a description of the functioning of the product. The product is intended to be used for the removal of, for example, dust, lint, hair, dandruff, from textile clothes, etc. | 9603 90 91 |
384/2004 of 1.3.2004 (OJ L 64, 2.3.2004, p. 21) |
4 | Base-metal toothed wheel, of a diameter of 6,74 mm and a thickness of 3,54 mm, with a central hole of a diameter of 3 mm. It is for incorporating into the ignition mechanism of a cigarette-lighter. | 9613 90 00 |
2015/1785 of 5.10.2015 (OJ L 260, 7.10.2015, p. 1) |
An article (so-called 'mop head') consisting of cords of textiles fixed to a plastic adaptor which is designed to connect the article with a handle. | 9603 90 99 |